Home
        MxCC User Manual
         Contents
1.               MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Collecting Information About The System    335 392       A l Collecting Information About The System    The following table contains the information you need to have before actually starting    the configuration     Information    Hardware    List of components and locations    Storage requirements of cameras    Customer Requirements    Purpose of the VSS    Remark    List of cameras  switches  file servers NAS  computers   monitors  UPS     Columns for model names  network names  locations   IP addresses     Which cameras are recording  How many days are the  recordings to be stored  See Storage Requirements  Planner on www mobotix com     Floor plans site maps as required   using scanned emergency building escape         Live surveillance only  Types of video searches  Signed  recordings for export        List of NAS user groups and users    Read write access for cameras  read access for MxCC   full access for administrator           List of MxControlCenter User  groups and users    Administrators  management owners  middle manage   ment  users  privacy protection officials consultants   union representatives           Legal restraints       Worker unions  protection of privacy  max  days of stor   ing recordings           Customer Infrastructure    If not available internally  get suitable time server  address from www   ntp   org  This is an important       Ti
2.          k CO       lt  gt  Li   e   Vio   k y Piera     eoj ot  Ld lecordng   P gt    a I     oe    Sy   x  ee om    mo ee  MxCC PTZ commands       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    270 392    MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       Integration into an IP network means that the analog cameras connected to MxServer  can be accessed the same way as network cameras  using the IP address and a port of  the MxServer computer   You can display an image from the analog camera in a browser   in MxControlCenter or in any other application that can access HTTP servers and display  M JPEG streams     The video cable of the analog PTZ camera is connected to a port of the frame grabber card  in the computer while the control cable of the camera is connected to the serial interface  of the computer  RS232 RS485   MxServer ensures that the relevant channel of the frame  grabber card is mapped to a network port  for example  80  81           You can also control the motorized pan  tilt and zoom features integrated into the analog  cameras of MxControlCenter using a joystick  Live streams of the cameras can be recorded  on a file server     Live video streaming is used as a bridge between the video stream supplied by the ana   log camera and Windows computers with MxControlCenter  MxServer reads the video  frames digitized by the frame grabber card and then converts these bitmap data into   jpg  images  or M JPEG streams   
3.         Image processing    Automatic correction of image distortion   wide angle lenses     Yes  in live image  and in recordings    Storage of the original ensures that data  are suitable for admission to a court of law       vPTZ control    Yes  in live image  and in recordings    Software PTZ enables digital zooming   panning tilting in the live image and in  recordings        PTZ control    Yes    a dart various rotor heads including  Pelco D protocol and cameras from  third party manufacturers  e g  Bosch   Siemens        Image optimization    Yes  in live image  and in recordings       Correction of brightness  saturation   contrast and sharpness  always printed  with the original image  usable in a  court of a         Event detection       Image analysis    Yes  decentralized    Movement detection within definable  areas directly in the cameras  exclusion  areas can be defined for interfering  influences        Movement analysis    Yes    Analysis of visitor flows including  detection of direction of movement   ene of direction and departing from  sketched out paths        Use of internal camera sensors    Yes    All camera sensors can trigger events   number function dependent on camera  model         Logical combination of events    Yes    Event detection can be made dependent  on preconditions        Event Filter    Yes    Frequency of events per time period  can lead to alarm or prevent alarm   alarm only when a specific number is  exceeded         Activation of e
4.         i   i  HHE  i       set noe C  ee        Background Layout  for site plans  floor plans  etc         Grid Layout  display windows only      e Select an image      jpg or     bmp  for a background layout or a grid for a grid layout        An ideal background image of a building can often be found in the emergency  plans        The Auto grid is a special type of grid layout that automatically splits the display area  into smaller sections to show all of the layouts video sources  Auto grids are basically  square and can have more columns than rows        This is the default grid type when creating a new grid layout     e Click on OK to close the dialog box  MxControlCenter creates the new layout and  adds an icon according to the layout type  grid or background      Note that MxControlCenter automatically activates the Layout Manager if it had not  been activated before     e You can now rename the new layout using one of the following methods       Double click on the layout and overtype the existing name         Right click on the layout  select Rename from the context menu and overtype  the existing name         Press F2 and overtype the existing name     e  f you want to create a hierarchical layout structure  use the mouse to move and  reorder the layouts based on your requirements         Drop a layout on another one to start a group       Move a layout up or down to change the order         Move a layout to the left and out of the current group  either up or down
5.        Enter admin as the new login name  this will overwrite the existing password  for the admin user          Enter the password in the New password field      MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    MxServer   Integrating Third Party Cameras    273 392           Enter the password again in the Retype new password field       Click on Send to update the MxServer configuration     e The default Configuration IP address  0 0 0 0  listens to all IP addresses of all  network interface cards  NICs  of this computer  Only change this setting if you have  several NICs installed on this computer and you want MxServer to listen only on a  specific NIC     MxServer is now running and ready for connecting third party analog and IP cameras     5 5 3 Connecting An Analog PTZ Camera To MxServer    To connect an analog camera into MxServer  do the following   e Make sure that MxServer is running     e Click on File  gt  Configure in the menu to show the configuration interface in the  web browser     e Select an available Falcon Channel from the list     e Activate this channel and adjust the camera configuration as required        Configure channel BOSCH Autodome    IDS analog  FalconQuattro   Activate this channel    YES NO  Image quality 70      Video standard    PAL NTSC SECAM  Image size VGA  640x480  X  Clip Scale scale    Channel IP address 0 0 0 0    Channel name BOSCH Autodome       e The default Channel IP address  0   
6.        Windows XP SP 3 or higher        Ubuntu Linux  MxRemotePreview for this operating system is available upon  request only     Web Server    e Apache  see Section 5 6 2    Installing MxRemotePreview On Windows With Apache  Web Server       e Microsoft Internet Information Server 7  see Section 5 6 3    Installing MxRemotePreview  On Microsoft Internet Information Server 7       5 6 2 Installing MxRemotePreview On Windows With Apache Web Server    1  Install the Apache web server on the Windows computer         Download an Apache web server installation file for Windows from httpd   apache org         Execute the apache _xxx win32 64 xxx msi installation file and follow the  instructions         Install Apache as a Windows service and make sure that the server is listening  to port 80  default          Open a web browser and enter http    127 0 0 1 to verify that the web  server is running     2  Install the MxRemotePreview CGI module       Copy the MxRemotePreview cgi exe file to the Apache program folder   C  Program Files Apache    cgi bin   3  Configure the Apache web server       Copy the configuration file httpd conf to the Apache program folder     C  Program Files Apache    conf        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features            Open httpd conf and edit the following lines     DocumentRoot     lt camera recordings folder gt      ScriptAlias  cgi bin      lt apach
7.       3G  Third generation of wireless telephone technology  see   UMTS 3G      ActiveX  Control element on Windows computers  which can also be used in other programs  including  Windows Internet Explorer  to run special tasks  The   MxPEG ActiveX control provides a mecha   nism for other applications to play the video and audio data generated by MOBOTIX cameras     Arming  Refers to the process of activating an alarm system so that specific events can trigger the  corresponding alarms  Traditional alarm systems can be armed using a key switch or by  entering a code on a keyboard  MOBOTIX cameras can be armed using a    software switch      a key switch  other systems  e g  an alarm system   or automatically using weekly schedules     AVC Video  Abbreviation of Advanced Video Coding  AVC Video is a standard for video compression   same as   H 264      Auto Grid  Automatically generated   Layout used for displaying the live images from all cameras     Background Layout    Layouttype in MxControlCenter  which shows cameras and camera icons on a background  image  e g  the floor plan of a building   In contrast to a   Grid Layout you can place cameras  and icons at any position on the background image     Bandwidth  Describes the capacity of a network connection  Bandwidth is commonly measured in kilobits  per second  short kbit s  also kbps  for slower connections  modem  ISDN    GSM 2G   in  megabits per second  short Mbit s  also Mbps  for fast    UMTS 3G    Fast Ethernef  a
8.       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    240 392    MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features          G         A Options g     Language Camera Preview  7    Stil image     English  or    i paS Live stream  French  At Program Start    German    Open recent camera list    Search for cameras in the network    Table Columns  Start with an empty ist    J  Sei J  Look for new software downloads    Name  7i Address Software Download  vJ  Version  J  Progress  amp  Update server  http   update mobotix com  Factory Address No proxy      System Settings  S ox    Resolution    7 oy    Custom proxy    Alt  Address          ay Software Packages list stays empty  Make sure that the Look for new software  downloads checkbox in the At program Start section is activated  To manually  update the list of software downloads  you can select Help  gt  Download Software  from the menu     Note that this option is not available when you click on the Settings button in the  Software Downloads dialog     E3 Wrong unavailable update server  A wrong update server has been set in the  Software Download section  by default  this is http    update  mobotix   com         Proxy required  The proxy for accessing the update server has not been set up  properly in the Software Download section     The    Camera Information    Panel    The Camera Information panel shows  additional information about the last cam   era you selected in the camera list   
9.      Available if the alarm list has  Show Alarm List bach acivatad  33 4    Show as grid layout  Auto   Helpful for background layouts  to see all video sources  23 21    Scalable to any size  automati   Open extra window  cally maintains aspect ratio   P2  Change scaling of display   Applies to all display windows  gt 33   windows  in a layout      Shows the image as gener   ated by the camera   s image  sensor s      Activate image post  Use dropdown   s Settings com  3328  processing     mand to configure this function  a  Save current image to the   MxControlCenter stores the last 336 1   desktop    selection of the dropdown     ae Permanently stores live video 3 2 10  Record to Local Archive stream on MxCC computer  34 3 4  Allows to manually add interest     ing images of selected display  window     Shows two images if using post   Print current image  processing or virtual PTZ  3 6 2    1 Available only when camera is selected    Drop down button    Activate Full Image live  view     Copy current image to  Alarm List       E  a  a  e  a          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Elements Of The Application Window       Toolbar Button Name Remark See    Show camera   s alarm Available if instruction file has 33 43  instructions  been set in Properties  ide  Show camera s preferred   Available if preferred layout has 3343  layout been set in Properties     Show camera s reference   Available if reference 
10.      MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       5 6  5 6 1  5 6 2  5 6 3  5 6 4  5 6 5    5 7    6    6 1  6 1 1  6 1 2  6 1 3  6 1 4  6 1 5  6 1 6  6 1 7    6 2  6 2 1  6 2 2  6 2 3  6 2 4    6 3  6 3 1  6 3 2  6 3 3  6 3 4  6 3 5  6 3 6  6 3 7  6 3 8  6 3 9    6 4        A l    A 2  A 2 1    Using MxRemotePreview To Access Remote Recordings  MxRemotePreview   System Requirements And Installation   Installing MxRemotePreview On Windows With Apache Web Server  Installing MxRemotePreview On Microsoft Internet Information Server 7  Testing the Web Server With MxRemotePreview   Using MxRemotePreview Servers To Access Video Sources    Using MxControlCenter To Read SD Cards    Reference    The    Options    Dialog   The    General    Tab   The    Connection Defaults    Tab  The    View    Tab   The    Alarm Handling    Tab  The    Remote Control    Tab   The    Monitoring    Tab   The    Action Log    Tab    The    Properties of    Dialog  The    Access Data    Tab  The    Information    Tab  The    Display    Tab   The    PTZ Rotor    Tab    The    Camera Configuration    Dialog  The    Overview    Tab   The    Image Settings    Tab   The    Exposure    Tab   The    Recording    Tab   The    Audio    Tab   The    Events    Tab   The    Network Messages    Tab   The    Time Server    Tab   The    MxAnalytics    Tab    MxControlCenter Start Parameters    Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline  Collecting Information A
11.      Using MxControlCenter         After installing for the first time  MxControlCenter does not have any users  This  automatically means that you have all rights on the system and that you can change  the configuration as you like     lf  however  you cannot change the configuration of the MxControlCenter system   you are probably not logged in as a user that belongs to the admins group  see  Section 4 7    Users  Groups And Group Rights        Note that creating user accounts in a multi user installation is a    must    if you are set   ting up a professional video surveillance system  For more information on this topic   see Section 4 7    Users  Groups And Group Rights    For additional information on  how to make the MOBOTIX video surveillance system more secure  see Section 4 8     Security Considerations                4 1 Getting Started    Before you start configuring your video surveillance system  you may need to perform some  additional steps to prepare your cameras and the MxControlCenter workstation for the task     My 4 1 1 Installing MxControlCenter Manually  a       e Obtain the MxControlCenter V2 5 1 zip file for manual installation         Download the zip file from the MOBOTIX website and save the file on your com   puter  for example  on the Desktop          If you have received installation media  CD  DVD  USB stick   find the folder of  the zip file        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com
12.      e Create a shortcut to MxCC   exe in the MxControlCenter program folder     e Set the shortcut properties  right click on the shortcut  select Properties from the  context menu          Add the MxNoSave parameter to the MxControlCenter launch command in the  Target field to prevent inadvertent changes to the configuration        C  Program Files MOBOTIX MxCC MxCC exe    MxNoSave        Enter the location of the working folder in the Start in text box so MxControlCenter  loads the configuration from this folder         Set Shortcut  gt  Run to Maximized to launch MxControlCenter as a maximized  window         Click on OK to close the dialog        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Security Considerations    223 392       e Copy the shortcut to the Windows Startup folder of the Gate Guard user  this  will automatically launch the application when the gate guards are logging in      e ifthe gate guards are allowed to shut down and re open MxControlCenter  also  copy the shortcut to the Desktop of the Gate Guard user     e Log out of the computer     e Login again as Gate Guard user and test the configuration        Make sure that you properly document the configuration and that you instruct the  staff on how to use the system        4 8 4 Using Encrypted Connections To Access Cameras    Encryption is a method to ensure that the data sent back and forth between the cameras  and the computer are protected from i
13.      mx10 2 1 43 MX V3 5 2 23 13 Q  V3 5 2 23 13     mx10 3 94 200 MX V3 5 2 23 13 Q                                           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       244   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features    Camera Status And The Update Log       MX V3 5 2 23 r3  amp   During the update process  the Update Log tab of the Camera Information panel shows the  MX V3 5 2 23 13  amp  messages that are returned by the camera  Since these are rather technical  Update Assistant  shows the status of the software update behind the camera version     w3 5 2 2304   g Update OK  The software upload has been successfully applied and the camera  has rebooted properly     P Update failed  An error occurred while uploading or installing the software  If this  happens  the application shows the Update Problem dialog with the contents of the  update log to inform you about the problem  Make sure that you are uploading the  proper version for this camera and try to update the camera again     Downloading And Updating The Software In Two Steps    e g Instead of using the Install button to automatically update the selected cameras  you can  Spel eS also click on the Save button  In this case  Update Assistant downloads the selected file  piel oda Santee and you can later update the cameras by clicking on the Upload Software button  If you  click on the down arrow of this button  see adjacent figure   you can upload one of the
14.     76   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration           All cameras that are monitoring the foyer and the elevators go in one group         All cameras in the West wing of the building go in one group     e Grouping by task       All cameras that are controlling doors from the outside go in one group       All indoor cameras go in one group         All cameras that have specials tasks  e g  server room access  machine monitor   ing  go in one group     Again  these are only examples and you may have to combine the ways of grouping  the cameras   or you need to find a totally different way of grouping the cameras  Once  you have identified the groups  you can start creating the layouts by putting one group  of cameras into one layout     Using Overview Layouts With Live Cameras    Using background layouts as overview lay   outs to present a few important live cameras  is one approach that is used quite often in  existing systems     From these layouts  the operators can  branch out to the other layouts using either    Eeen  GD e           the LAYOUTS section of the Navigator side  a A    i   bar panel or layout buttons as described k  rete    in Section 4 3 2    Configuring Layout a       Selection       Using Overview Layouts With Status Icons    Status icons  on the other hand  provide  a different type of overview  These icons  allow monitoring the status of the cameras  and whether or not somebody is currently  watching a camera or not  for an explana   tion of thi
15.     An event sequence includes all images that have been recorded for one particular    event  alarm   This normally includes the video and audio data recorded before the  event  the actual event image itself and the data recorded after the event        Navigating The Recordings    When the Player panel of the sidebar is active  you  can use its buttons to browse the recorded images   This section shows how to use the individual buttons     Buttons For Playing Back All Images    The playback buttons within the red frame allow  playing back all recorded images either one by one  or consecutively  Use these buttons to review the  individual sequences more closely        Using The Mouse Over Buttons    In addition to the controls in the sidebar   you can also use the buttons that appear  when you move the mouse over the bottom  edge of a Player window  i e   you can use  them even if the Player sidebar is not visible      Click once on the button to execute the  corresponding function  the button turns  yellow   Move the mouse again over the  same position and click again on the but   ton to stop the function        The corresponding bright blue buttons have been added in the Player Window column  of the table below     PR ili Aaa  bade Name Explanation    Fast Starts fast reverse playback of the recorded    lt  lt   A   K   Backward   images from the current position  Click again  J to stop     Previous Goes back one image  frame    wm g  Play Starts normal pa of the recorded  
16.     Drag amp drop a camera or other video source from the sidebar to a grid display  window in the display area         Right click on a display window  select Edit from the context menu  select an  Element type and select a Video source      See the   Additional Rules for Assigning Video Sources to Grid Layouts   section below  for more information on the available options      Quit the Layout Manager  see   Deactivating The Layout Manager   in Section 4 2     Creating And Editing Layouts       The layout definition is saved automatically     Additional Rules for Assigning Video Sources to Grid Layouts    Video sources already placed in the layout can be moved to another display window  using drag amp drop     When moving a video source to a display window that is already used  the two video  sources swap positions as soon as you release the mouse button  as indicated by  the    swap    mouse cursor and the green frame of the target window      Dragging a video source from the Navigator sidebar panel to a display window that  is already used replaces the original source with the dragged one     You can drag amp drop multiple video sources to an empty layout  keep the CTRL or SHIFT  key pressed and click with the mouse to select multiple video sources         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com            6 6   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration          When dragging more video sources onto a  fixed  grid
17.     Getting Started    151 392       e Unpack the MxControlCenter V2 5 1 zip file into a suitable folder  e g  c     Program Files MOBOTIX MxCC 2 5 1       e Create a shortcut  right click on MxCC exe and select Create shortcut from the  context menu      e Copy the shortcut to the desktop or another suitable folder     4 1 2 Updating an Older Version of MxControlCenter  If an older version of MxControlCenter is installed on the computer  do not overwrite the  existing installation  Rather  proceed as follows     e   Install MxControlCenter  see Section 2 3 2    Automatic Installation of MxControlCenter    and Section 4 1 1    Installing MxControlCenter Manually   into a different folder than  the existing installation     e Copythe configuration files and all other necessary files  background images  print  templates  etc   from the existing installation to the new program folder  Make sure  to retain the existing folder structure     e Test the new installation by double clicking on the Mxcc  exe file     e Make sure that all user shortcuts use the new installation by adjusting the path to  the correct program folder and the configuration file     4 1 3 Installing MxControlCenter Language Packages    MOBOTIX offers additional language packages  short    LangPacks   for MxControlCenter  version 2 3 and higher  You can download the language packages for the corresponding  version from the MOBOTIX website  Support  gt  Software Downloads  gt  MxControlCenten     The files are 
18.     Installed IDS Falcon QuattroPro drivers      Installed Video for Windows driver  automatically installed with MxServer     e MxControlCenter on a client computer with proper configuration for the relevant analog   IP camera for controlling the pan  tilt and zoom features  Section 5 4 3    integrating  Analog Third Party PTZ Cameras   and Section 5 4 2    Integrating Third Party IP PTZ  Dome Cameras    respectively      The Falcon QuattroPro frame grabber card has four inputs  channels   but you should  only connect at most two analog cameras  When using two cameras with the same  frame grabber card  the frame rate is limited to 12 5 frames per second for each camera     You can also install more than one frame grabber card in a computer  However we  advise against this as only low frame rates would be possible     We recommend using multiple computers with one Falcon QuattroPro card each and  at most two connected analog cameras each for large installations  If a high frame  rate is required  more than 12 5 fps   each analog camera should be connected to  its own MxServer computer     Detailed information on connecting analog cameras and configuring MxServer can  be found in the PDF documentation that is installed with MxServer           Downloading And Installing MxServer  1  Download the correct MST  Windows Installer  file for your hardware platform from  www mobotix com  Support  gt  Software Downloads       The P3 release is optimized for Pentium 3 with SSEI and AMD 
19.     Issues  Solutions 348    JPEG  glossary  355    LAN  glossary  356  Latency  glossary  356    Launching MxControlCenter  For the first time 52    Layout elements  Buttons 69  Display windows 69  Icons 69    Layout  glossary  356    Layout Manager  Activating 150    Layouts 20  Auto grid 23  Background 20  Creating 151  Creating  overview  149  Definition 61  Editing 150  Editing  overview  149  Element types 69  153  Generating 57       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       LAYOUTS  Navigator sidebar panel 66    Layout selection  Configuring 171    LED  glossary  356  Linux  glossary  356    Live images  Virtual PTZ 78  vPTZ 78    Live Recording 87  Configuring 174  Example 88    Live video monitoring  Configuring 169    Live Video Surveillance 67    Local Archive  Configuring 174  Playing back recordings 126    LOCAL ARCHIVE  Navigator sidebar panel 66    Logical  glossary  356    M    Megapixel  glossary  356  Menu Bar 19  microSD card  glossary  358    microSD cards  Accessing the recordings 276    Minimized application window  Functions 91    Minimized MxControlCenter  Configuring functions for 186      383 392  Grid 22 M JPEG  glossary  356  Options when editing 164 MOBOTIX  PANNO GAYOD SUUCIUTE 167 Installing application software 231  Switching 71  Switching automatically using OBOU CANAS  Sequencers 73 Connecting using DynDNS  Updating 228    Uploading configuration files 234    MOBOTIX Video System So
20.     Start Trigger  Sets the events which trigger a recording with increased    event  frame rate     see below          Event frame rate  Increased frame rate during and after an event         Recording time  Time during which the camera records the video stream with  increased frame rate     External Recording O    In addition to configuring the camera for internal  RAM  recordings  the camera can also  store video data on external storage options  SD card  USB drive  etc    the current com   puter or a file server on the network  Click on the Setup button to display the External  Recording dialog box     Depending on the selected option in the Target Computer section  the External Recording  dialog has different settings   e Create a shared folder on this computer       Shared folder  Enter a name for this shared folder       Local path  Select the folder on this computer you would like to use for storing       User name  Set a user name for accessing this shared folder         Password  Set a password for accessing this shared folder  Activate the Show  checkbox to see the password     e Use a different server or storage medium         Storage  Select the type of storage you would like to use  NFS  CIFS  SMB  Samba    USB Storage  USB Hard Drive  SD Flash Cara   Note that these options reflect the  hardware that is available on this camera         Server  Enter the name or the IP address of the server       Shared folder  Select the shared folder you would like to use     
21.     When configuring either an analog or IP camera  you can enter a storage location for that  specific camera  using either a mapped network drive or a UNC address  Make sure that  you have the following information before proceeding     e Which folder on a network share  computer name IP address and share name  can    use to store the video data     e How much capacity is available on this share        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    MxServer   Integrating Third Party Cameras    275 392       To Configure The Storage Location     Activate the ON option to record the selected channel     Enter the storage location in the Recording root directory path as mapped network  drive or UNC path     M   DATA    mapped network drive         MyFileServer DATA   UNC path    Set a recording disk quota and or the maximum age to appropriate values so as  not to exceed the capacity of the share     Set the Frame rate as required     ON    OFF Activate recording for this channel        Rec  root directory path     MADATA   Rec  disk quota  MB    4096 0 dO h    Rec  max age  Frame rate           12 frame per second X    Click on Send to update the parameters in MxServer and save the settings     Using The Recordings Of Third Party Cameras In MxControlCenter    To use the recordings of these cameras in MxControlCenter  enter the File server path in  MxControlCenter depending on the type of camera     Analog cameras connected t
22.     e Double click on the Windows Firewall icon    e Inthe Windows Firewall dialog  click on the Exceptions tab and then on the Port button     e Inthe Add a Port dialog  enter a descriptive name  e g MxCC Alarm Handling  Port  and the port number 31754  as in the example      e Make sure that the TCP option is activated and click on OK     e Close all open Firewall related dialogs and the Control Panel        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring Alarms And Recordings 2 03   3 9 2       Windows Vista     Open the Windows Control Panel  Start  gt  Settings  gt  Control Panel         In the Security section  click on Allow a program through Windows Firewall   Click on Continue  if the system asks for your permission     In the Windows Firewall Settings dialog  click on the Exceptions tab and then on  the Add port button     In the Add a Port dialog  enter a descriptive name  e g MxCC Alarm Handling  Port  and the port number 31754     Make sure that the TCP option is activated and click on OK     Close all open Firewall related dialogs and the Control Panel     Windows 7     Open the Windows Control Panel  Start  gt  Settings  gt  Control Panel       Click on System and Security and then on Windows Firewall     In the left panel  click on Advanced settings  Enter an administration password or  allow this action if the system prompts you to do so     In the Windows Firewall with Advanced Security dialog  
23.     e Find the event you want to store   e Drag the event to any folder in the LOCAL ARCHIVE section  MxControlCenter shows  a progress dialog      You can now export the event as a video clip in different formats  For more information on  how to do this  Section 3 6 3    Exporting Recorded Video Footage       3 5 9 Using Post Video Motion Detection In Recordings    Detecting movements in live video motion windows is a feature that is common fo alll  MOBOTIX cameras and that is known as   Video Motion Detection  If the cameras detect  movements in the video motion windows  they typically store the event images  event  recording   The event searches allow finding these events  Section 3 5 8    Using Event  Searches        Cameras set to continuous recording  on the other hand  typically store images at a  reduced frame rate  e g  2 fps  over longer periods of time  When searching for a specific  event  however  this could mean that you would need to play back several days worth of  recorded video  This is where the Subsequent Video Motion Detection  Post VM search  in short  comes into play     A Post VM search can help answer questions such as the following   e Who stole the laptop that had been placed on the desk an hour ago   e Was the car already damaged as it entered the parking lot this morning     e Did anyone successfully evade the video motion windows     In order to run a Post VM search  the following requirements need to be fulfilled     e The recorded video stream 
24.    Setting The Basic Configuration    Once you have activated MxAnalytics in the Basic Configuration sub tab  enter further  settings according to your requirements  You can check the effect of the settings made by  visualizing the motion detection in the camera s live image via the Visual Configuration  sub tab  The sub tab is structured into the following sections     General Settings    Arming  The Activate option must be selected in order to run the video motion  analysis     Configure MxAnalytics storage  We recommend setting up MxAnalytics after  activation and then configuring storage of the data generated  See   Setting Up  Storage   for information on how to configure this     Time table profile  If the video motion analysis is only be used during specific  times  for example  Monday to Friday  4 p m  to 7 p m    it is possible to set the  camera to use an appropriate time table  There are several predefined time tables  available  Switch to the browser to create a new time table     Minimum luminous intensity  Image analysis is disabled if the current illumina   tion falls below the set value     Detection Settings    Installation height  Installation height of the camera to the floor in centimeters       It is important to set the value accurately to correctly detect the moving objects   The height should be at least 250 cm     Tilt angle  Tilt of the camera in degrees  Ceiling mounting corresponds to  90     wall mounting  not recommended  corresponds to 0       L
25.    Z MxCC User Manual  i A    The HiRes Video Company MO BOTIX    decentralized    Video Walls    patented    MxControlCenter  z    Dual Screen  Free camera definition    Professional Video Management          more than 500 cameras    Reliable    MxCC backs    Euro 2012   Donbass Arena          Floor Plans    Layout editor with  indiv  floor plans    Free Software Download mome  www mobotix com T a    Alarm time or image    Alarm    Event list sorted by  camera or by time    wane rooms Mormane    Search    pse i  Sees D Search possible even  BRAY Hiena Tai while recording    ameta        Event Search    Synchronized search    SP on several cameras    Q a  7 sr  RES thy   lt  EN    Image improvement    Post Processing    Zoom  contrast   distortion correction    e Proven worldwide in the most demanding video applications   a    ae  e Unlimited number of users and cameras  no license fees    OF  e Individual user interface  adaptable to each individual user Analog and digia        Simplest installation and complete use on any standard PC ms 4    amp     Convenient layout editor for integrating real building plans i cl i  e Integration of conventional network and analog cameras eh  w    Exports recordings as AVI or Quicktime video with sound canter   gt     Third party cameras  Hybrid    Integration of analog   amp  digital systems    HiRes Video Innovations Synchronized  realtime viewing of  The German company MOBOTIX AG is known as the leading pioneer in network camera technol
26.    _   _         _   Free   Download  aiiae ne Te DONGSNM ORD ENT RASS    gt  Ee 3 J oz MxControlCenter    for free from  www mobotix com          MOBOTIX AG e     Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    14 392    MxCC User Manual  The Decentralized MOBOTIX Concept          Original image  MOBOTIX camera     Size comparison of  standard CIF versus  MOBOTIX HiRes    A standard sys   tem requires an  extra PC including  software for evalu   ation and storage    Innovator And Technology Leader    The German company MOBOTIX AG is known as the  leading pioneer in network camera technology since  its founding in 1999  and its decentralized concept  has made high resolution video systems cost efficient   MOBOTIX has been producing megapixel cameras  exclusively for many years now and is regarded as  the global market leader for high resolution video  systems     Why High Resolution Systems     The higher the resolution  the more accurate the detail  of the image  With analog technology  a recorded  image generally has no more than 0 1 megapixels   CIF   Yet  one MOBOTIX camera with 3 1 megapixels records around 30 times more  detail  This means that greater image areas  including 360   panoramas  are possible   while still reducing the number of cameras  and thereby enormously reducing the costs  as well  For example  four lanes of a gas station may be recorded with a single MOBOTIX  camera  instead of the four standard cameras normally n
27.    e MxControlCenter shows the first available recording of any camera in the layout     e ifthe Player sidebar panel is visible  MxControlCenter moves the current position  indicator to the first available recording     e Clicking on one of the playback buttons starts  playing back the timeline  i e   every Player win   dow starts playing back its contents  when the  current time matches the start of the recording     Kontoservite    10 11 2010 06 01 48 278    e Time gaps in the  virtual  timeline are skipped  if they are longer than 10 seconds  with date   time boxes indicating the start and the end of  the gap  see figure to the right      10 11 2010 06 02 40 044    gt           The Player mode for all video sources button will only stay pressed if MxControlCenter  finds at least one recording for each of the live windows        To export some or all of the video data  you can use the export functions  Section 3 6 3     Exporting Recorded Video Footage           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings   1 3  3 9 2       Example  Let   s expand on the detective scenario presented in the live recording example  of Section 3 2 10    Using The Live Recording Feature    Using Live Recording  the store  detective has started the live recording at 3 30 pm     To find out what the suspicious person did before the detective activated live recording     the detective activates the Syne 
28.    gt    images from the current position  Click again  to stop        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany       www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings    109 392       Player Panel Player i   Sidebar  Window Name Explanation    Next Goes forward one image  frame    D Frame  Fast Starts fast forward playback of the recorded    D gt    Forward images from the current position  Click again    to stop     Jump to Displays the first saved image     KK Beginning   Jump to Displays the last saved image   dl   DA   End    Buttons For Playing Back Event Images Only    The playback buttons within the red frame are  marked by a red lightning bolt and are used to  browse the event images only        Use these buttons to get an overview over the recorded events     Pia t a Name Explanation    nrer Displays the previous event image   Play Events Starts reverse playback of the recorded event images  Backward from the current position  Click again to stop     Play Events Starts forward playback of the recorded event images  PF  Forward from the current position  Click again to stop   D Next Event Displays the next event image     When using continuous recording  MxControlCenter creates a    pseudo    event every  minute  also called    minute    event   When playing back events only  see buttons  in table above   MxControlCenter shows both  the actual event images and the  pseudo events     You can thus use the event playback butto
29.    ments  Display Mode As required  Sharpness 4 4 1 4  Mox  Exposure Time 1 30s k 1 30s 1 30s  Exposure Settings  Average Brightness 40  a 40  40                    1 Hemispheric has additional options       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 5 2   392 MxCC User Manual  Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline          Criteria for Creating Sets                   bier  sella Dual eae Hemil Mono  Text and Display Text Display On   Comment      ID   HOSTNAME    engs Date and Time Date  amp  Time  vPTZ Settings vPTZ Actions Allow or lock as required   Event Control   Arming As required available    General Event Settings    Time Table Profile    Select profile  if required                                                                               Arming Delay As required  Event Dead Time 20s  Passive Infrared Enabled   Enabled          Video Motion Enabled  Video Motion   ate S generate    Event Settings Definitions  Copy Video Motion    Definitions Disabled   Enabled   gt       Dual Lens Video    Motion Enabled   Disabled          Other events Activate as required available  Arming Enabled   Enabled   Enabled   Enabled  Time Table Profile Select profile  if required  Recording Status  Symbol On  Full Image Recording On  Recording Mode Event Recording  Recording Time Before  Eveni 2 to 5s  Recording Recording Time Min  30s  Visual Alarm  VA  On  Left   Camera Selection o Auto          Auto   Resolution Mega 
30.    tion has been saved  then test the  setup again        Testing The Remote Control    Before testing the remote control features  make sure that you have properly set up  the network message as outlined in   Setting up Alarm Messages from the Camera to  MxControlCenter   in Section 4 5 1    Configuring Alarms on the Cameras       e Minimize MxControlCenter to the Windows taskbar   e Open the live view of the MOBOTIX camera in a browser window   e Click on the UC Event button on the browser interface of the camera     The network message will now be sent to the MxControlCenter computer  the application  window should appear on the screen on top and display the camera that triggered the  alarm in its preferred alarm layout        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring Alarms And Recordings 2 05   3 9 2       4 5 4 Configuring Where To Record    MOBOTIX cameras support a variety of storage targets  i e   locations where the cameras  can store their recordings   By default  the MOBOTIX cameras are using the built in SD  Flash card  This section expands on the example and shows how to configure different  storage targets for the MOBOTIX cameras and how to access these targets directly from  MxControlCenter     e Open the Camera Configuration dialog  E  e Click on the Recording tab  4  e Make sure that the External Recording checkbox at the bottom is activated  eevee    Folder  SD Flash Card       e Click on
31.   Camera Information Gx  Status    Connected    Model  MOBOTIX Q24M Secure    Note that this panel has two more tabs  the ere  88561    Update Log and the Preview tab  Alt  IP     Host name  main entrance    e Update Log  Shows the messages Software version  MX V4 0 6 9    from the camera while uploading Resolution  Custom Size  1024x384   software or settings  Encryption   Progress     e Preview  Shows a preview image of  the last camera you selected in the  camera list     Update Log Preview Camera Information       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Update Assistant   Software Updates And More          You can detach the individual tabs of this panel by dragging the title bar of any  outside of the application window  To attach the tab again  drag the title bar of the  tab onto the panel again until the entire panel turns dark and then let go           5 1 4 Checking The Camera Connection Status    Ifa camera is listed with the status  Connection refused  Password   Protected or Insufficient Privileges  in the camera list  you first need  to enter a valid user name and  password with administrator level  access     Move the mouse over one of the  status icons at the beginning of a  line  red frame in the figure  to see  the status and a legend     To change the access informa   tion  select a camera  click on  the Connection Settings button  and enter the proper user name  and password        pi aiani    The 
32.   Errors    Activating MxControlCenter error log 351  Finding and correcting 348    Ethernet  glossary  354    Evaluating  Recordings 100    Events 26  Camera Configuration tab 314  Filtering 33       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Index    381 392       Event searches 114    Event Searches  Filtering results 117    EVENT SEARCHES  Navigator sidebar panel 66    Events  glossary  354    Example  Adding a MOBOTIX camera 54  Display modes 89  Entering a reason for an action 204  Live Recording 88  Preview video stream 154  Remote access 154  Synchronized playback 109  Two man rule 142  203    Example application  Donbass Arena  Ukraine 42    Example scenarios  Recording 100    Exporting 130  Entire installations 218    Recordings 132  Video 33    Exposure  Camera Configuration tab 305    ExtlO  glossary  354  Extra live windows  Using 73    Extra windows  Using 72    Fast Ethernet  glossary  354    Filtering   Action Log 214   Alarm List 98   Events 33   Event Search results 117  Finding   Video sources 53    FixDome  glossary  354  Flash memory  glossary  354    Folders  Global folder 217  Program folder 217  Working folder 217    fps  glossary  354  Frame rate 354  FTP  glossary  354    Functions  Minimized application window 91  Virtual PTZ 78  vPTZ 78    G    General  Options tab 279    Generating  Layout 57    Getting started  Update Assistant 224    Gigabit Ethernet  glossary  354  Global folder 217  Graph
33.   MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Properties of    Dialog    305 392       6 2 The    Properties of    Dialog    The Properties of  lt video source gt  dialog displays information on how this video source  is integrated into MxControlCenter  To open this dialog  select a video source in a layout   yellow frame  or in the VIDEO SOURCES  gt  Cameras section of the Navigator sidebar  panel  then right click and select Properties from the context menu or select Video Source  gt   Properties from the menu     The Name field is available above the tabs  You can use this field to set a different name   such aS Main gate in the figure below   This name will be used once you click on OK  or Apply in this dialog     The information entered in this dialog is only used by MxControlCenter to accessthe  camera or its recordings and to set other camera specific details  Changing items  in this dialog will not change anything on the camera           6 2 1 The    Access Data    Tab    This tab contains the following parameters     Properties of Main gate    Name  Main gate    Access Data Information   Display   PTZ Rotor    Address  10 9 42 99  Secure connection  SSL   User name  admin    Password  eescesese    Access recordings  Via camera          e Address  Contains the IP address of the camera   e Port  Contains the port number of the camera  default is 80      e Secure connection  SSL   Activate this checkbox if t
34.   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Installing MxControlCenter    51 392             2 3 Installing MxControlCenter    The current version of MxControlCenter is available for download on the  MOBOTIX website  www mobotix com  in the Support  gt  Software  Downloads  gt  MxControlCenter section      Only registered users are permitted to download MOBOTIX software from the website   If you are not yet a registered MOBOTIX user  now is a good time to register  Registered  users have the following benefits     e Access to the entire range of the freely accessible MOBOTIX software     e Automatic subscription to the newsletter  if desired  to inform you about the  latest MOBOTIX products     If you are updating an MxControlCenter computer with an existing installation  please  read the notes in Section 4 1 2    Updating an Older Version of MxControlCenter                2 3 1 System Requirements    Depending on the intended use  the system requires different hardware to properly run  MxControlCenter       ThinClient   Minipc   Mid RangePc   High End PC    MxCC surveillance   MxCC surveillance   Intended Use T ce system  video wall   system  video wall  main computer main computer  Max  Number  of Displays per 1 1 2 4  Computer  Max  Display  1280x1024 1920x1200 2560x1600 2560x1600    Max  Number of  Concurrent Live  Camera Streams  per Computer    Max  Resolution QXGA QXGA   per Camera  2048x1536   2048x1536   2048x1536  2048x1536   Frame Rate per 30 fos M
35.   Mi 12  Dez 14 20 33 2012        Automatically generate new layout  MxFFS Volume 1 of mx10 10 49 22       e If you have encrypted the SD card when formatting it  click in the area below Keys  in the Encryption keys field and enter the encryption password        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Using MxControlCenter To Read SD Cards       e Click on OK to see the recordings  one for each display window  in the new layout   e Open the Player sidebar panel and click on one display window to select it     e Click on the Play button to play back the recording        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       288 392    MxCC User Manual  Reference       6    6 1    REFERENCE    The    Options    Dialog    The Options dialog controls the basic settings of MxControlCenter  Click on Tools  gt  Options  in the menu to open this dialog     Overview of the    Options    Dialog Tabs    General  This tab controls the application behavior when launching  automatic logon  and automatic bandwidth reduction as well as the custom folder for the local archive     Connection Defaults  This tab stores the default connection parameters for accessing  cameras  the settings for a default file server and for a MxRemotePreview server  Note  that you can override these settings for individual video sources later on     View  This tab controls all settings regarding the mouse  t
36.   User name  Set a user name for accessing this shared folder         Password  Set a password for accessing this shared folder  Activate the Show  checkbox to see the password         User ID  When using NFS storage devices  enter the user ID         Group ID  When using NFS storage devices  enter the group ID        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    322 392    MxCC User Manual  Reference          Quota    The maximum size of the storage can be limited according to the criteria listed in the  following  As soon as one of the criteria has been reached  the cameras delete old video  sequences to make sure that there is enough storage capacity for new recordings     e Max  storage size  Sets the maximum size of the storage space  maximum number  is device dependent      e Reserve  Assigns a reserve for burst mode  If the camera cannot delete old recordings  from the file server before writing new files  the reserve storage space is used for writ   ing  Deleting the old recordings is postponed until there is less load on the file server     e Max  age  Sets the maximum number of days to retain video data  max  10 000 days      e Max  sequences  Sets the maximum number of events  max  1 000 000      Details    This text area indicates information  e g  error or success messages  that is available from  the camera  For example  if you have entered an incorrect password for a user name  the  camera shows a correspond
37.   cameras and Snap Servers  Other video sources need to be added manually using  the Add button                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    56 392    MxCC User Manual  System Installation and Initial Operation       Unknown status    ok    Access denied    Unknown error    Snap Server  O Different subnet    Statuses Of The Discovered Video Sources    MxControlCenter automatically monitors and displays the operating status of all video  sources  The status is shown as a colored dot to the left of the video source   s name     I              Unknown status   Gray  MxControlCenter has not yet determined the status   but is working on it      OK   Green  The camera is ready and responding  hence it can be integrated  immediately     Access denied   Green with blue lock  The camera can be integrated  but is  password protected and the password is yet unknown to MxControlCenter   Right click on the camera  select Authenticate and enter the correct user name  and password  Once a valid user name and password have been entered  the  symbol changes to a green dot and the lock disappears     Unknown error   Red  The camera is found  but not responding  This occurs  while a camera is rebooting  but can also be caused by a disruption in the HTTP  connection  network error  firewall  during normal operation     Snap Server   Blue  These devices are   Snap Server   NASsystems detected on your  network  Right click on a
38.   define the detection areas  counting lines and object sizes of the objects that are to  be detected in the Visual Configuration sub tab     Setting The Visual Configuration        n  MxAnalytics can capture and evaluate move   ments in the camera image  The frequency  of the movements is shown in a heat map   Select the areas in the camera image that  are to be evaluated as detection areas  The  complete live image will be analyzed if you  do not define any areas and MxAnalytics has  been activated  Counting lines can be used  to capture how many people go in and out of  an entrance during the day  for example  To  do this  define counting lines at the desired  positions in the camera s live image  Define  detection areas and counting lines in the  Visual Configuration sub tab        The Visual Configuration contains the fol   lowing areas     Detection Area    This can be used to define detection areas  Select the Detection area option  A predefined  detection area opens     e Proceed as follows to adjust this detection area       Use the mouse to drag the area to the desired position       Drag the corner of the area using your mouse to increase or decrease its size         Use the mouse to draw a new area  You can define as many areas as needed  at any one time        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring MxAnalytics    213 392       Object Size    Specify the minimum object size for detection  This
39.   gt  Show  gt  Toolbar in the menu     e Right click anywhere on the toolbar or on the display area and deactivate View  gt   Show  gt  Toolbar in the context menu     Similar to activating the layout buttons in the toolbar  see above   hiding the entire  toolbar will not remove any privileges from user groups  If you want to disallow  users from using any of these functions  you need to configure the group privileges  accordingly  see Section 4 7    Users  Groups And Group Rights                    MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       190 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       4 4 3 Configuring MxControlCenter Views    The MxControlCenter Views  called workspacesin some applications  provide a convenient  way to store different user interface configurations and to switch between them later on  Note  that you can store any combination of window  display and scaling options in such a view     What s in a View     A view basically contains the current settings of the Seve View Ac  commands accessible from MxControlCenter   s View    i Name  Gate Guard v  menu  When saving a view  you can select what ES eae ee  to include by activating deactivating the following reine os a   existing  options  Include  V  Display Area Options    i     Sequencer states  scaling and grid  e Display options  Sequencer  scaling and grid options  options J  Application Window Areas  Title bar  tool bar  menu bar  status b
40.   language  softbuttons     Image Control Event Control  vV  Camera  time server  LEDs  Video Motion windows    Select all    Warning  Caution  you are updating the network settings for other cameras     A  The configuration file is not intended for this camera   Take care not to override important settings     J  Back up Configuration Files    Before uploading  store configuration files      Users Thilo Desktop CustomerXYZ q24 thilo 2011 09 01 cfg Choose       J  Reboot the camera after the configuration has been updated       9  Select the checkboxes as shown above     Make sure that you have at least one user name and password of the admins  group for administrative access later on  If you apply this configuration to all  other cameras without knowing an administrative user name and password   you will have to send all cameras back to MOBOTIX to have them reset   This service is not free     Make sure that IP address and host name is not activated  Setting all cameras  to the same IP address will render them unreachable     Activate the File Server section only if you are using the same file server NAS  on all cameras     Deactivate the Image Control and Event Control sections  These settings will  be configured later  see Section A 6    Adjusting Sets Of Cameras                 10  Click on OK  you can safely ignore the warning   wait until all cameras have been  rebooted  then disconnect them from the network     11  Repeat Steps 5 to 10 until you have uploaded the maste
41.   s Switch Works    e ifthe application cannot detect any user interaction  mouse clicks or keyboard entries    the blue button starts blinking red 30 seconds before the dead man   s switch interval  expires     e lf still no User interaction is detected within the next 10 seconds  MxControlCenter  shows an additional countdown dialog during the last 20 seconds of the interval     e If the interval has expired without detecting any user interaction  MxControlCenter  plays a warning sound  If this has been configured  MxControlCenter also sends an  e mail to one or more e mail addresses     How To Reset The Dead Man   s Switch    You can reset the dead man   s switch using one of these methods   e Click on the red or blue button in the toolbar   e Click anywhere within the application window of MxControlCenter     e Press any key on your keyboard while MxControlCenter is the active application        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    e               MxControiCenter   Dead Man s Switch z      i Dead Man s Switch wil actvate in 14 seconds      Cancel      g    gt       148   3 Q 2 MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter    3 8 2 Using The Two Man Rule       A two man rule mandates that two persons need to be present to execute certain   critical  system functions  A common task where the two man rule is required is the  playback of recordings in which the employees of a company are visible  This usually  necessitat
42.   software versions you already downloaded to the selected cameras  After that  the process  proceeds as outlined in the   Downloading And Updating The Software In One Step   sec    tion     Using The Software Downloads Dialog       The Software Downloads dialog rf    T   Tools  gt  Software downloads in the     o  ofai    MxControlCenter men u  shows an There are 136 new software packages available for download from update mobotix com    r    Software Packages  overview of the available software ver  ya        f Name Platform Version Time Languages Extension  sions  It shows the same information     a MX System 4 04 19  the Software Packages panel of the E  paea r2e qzaumza 5 13 11    Update Assistant  see   The    Software        Sanaa A a  Packages    Panel    i MX System 4 0 2 33 r2  s D24M Q24M M24M 7 8 10  n new mpl German  Russian  Japanese English  It  Similar to the Software Packages panel   ou can use the tabs at the bottom to er oo  y is M22M D12 V12 022M M12 Q022M 7 6 10  switch between camera and application new mpl English  Chinese  software  The New tab shows software    n   MX System 3 5 2 23 r3  that has been made available since you Ste   eee  new mol German  English    last opened the dialog  The dropdown          __ MX System 3 5 2 23 r3   in the bottom right corner of the dialog E Re ee g    red frame in the figure  allows filtering a i ES C   the packages  oe          Click on one of the packages to save or install it  If you choose to install a package 
43.   to  change the hierarchy level        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Creating And Editing Layouts    159 392       To change the definition  i e   the contents  of the layout  proceed as described in Section 4 2 3     Defining Grid Layouts   and in Section 4 2 4    Defining Background Layouts     depending  on the layout type      4 2 2 Element Types Used In Layouts    This section describes the types of elements that are available in grid and background  layouts to display video sources  As explained in Section 3 2 1    Displaying Video Content  In Layouts    there are three basic element types  display windows  icons and buttons         Elements With Permanently Assigned Video Sources    Live  This type of display window basically shows a live video source    as is    with  the selected frame rate     Available video sources  MOBOTIX and third party cameras  This is also the default  type when using drag amp drop to add video sources to a layout     Live icon  This is a variant of the Live display window that is only available in back   ground layouts  It consists of a camera icon  which automatically shows the live  stream when the camera detects an alarm  Double clicking on such an icon opens  the live video stream in an extra window     Preview  This type of display window shows the preview image stream of a MOBOTIX  camera in order to save bandwidth  In addition  you can select the lens  the frame  r
44.   www mobotix com    sales mobotix com      Q 8   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration    4 5 2 Configuring What To Record       E e Open the Camera Configuration dialog   4 e Click on the Recording tab   Recording    This tab of the Camera Configuration dialog allows selecting several cameras   Use CTRL SHIFT click   Any changes to this tab are applied to all selected cameras        e Apply the settings as shown in the arming switch                                     figure to the right  3 Arming   On    e  f you would like to check the data Recordina switch  integrity later on  activate the E biis rerea A  Digital signing of recorded images  Z  Digtal signing of recorded images  checkbox  see Section 4 8 5    Signing     xecording mode  The Recorded Video Data     H Recording mode   mana anaES an  2  e Ifyou are configuring a Hemispheric Fu image recording l    Image Size   Mega  1280x960      camera  you should activate the Full Hain 5  image recording checkbox  see Text Display   Date Time     Section 3 5 7    Using The Virtual _ recording start and Duration  PTZ Features When Playing Back     Sees   Bces  Recordings     NVT  Note  The HD  1280x720  and Full HD nice   1920x1080  resolutions available in  E  image anaysis  vm    the live image and in the image pro   rane rnis   iaman  P  Time betore    Ott z  files are not available for this mode  re afer  a    Since these resolutions do not have an  aspect ratio of 4 3  full image record   ing would clip parts of
45.  0 0 0     Camera   10 8 0 99        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    For the Q24M  M24M   D24M  and T24M cam   eras  you need to use the  new blue MX NPA PoE   Set  Previous MOBOTIX  network power acces   sories such as the NPA  Set  Power Box and  Power Rack  MX NPA   Set  MX NPR 4 and  MX NPR8 20  are not  suitable for use with  these camera models     og    The IP addresses  in the diagram are  only an example     50 392    MxCC User Manual  System Installation and Initial Operation       The IP addresses in  the diagram are shown  only as an example     2 2 2 Power Supply And Network Connection Using A PoE Switch    1  Connect the pre installed cable of the camera to one of the PoE powered Ethernet  connectors of the PoE switch router  The switch router must support the PoE stan   dard IEEE 802 3af     2  Connect the Ethernet cable of the computer to a regular port of the switch router        PoE PoE   LAN www switch router      PC      10 8 0 11 255 0 0 0     e a   Camera    10 8 0 99     If everything has been connected properly  the camera LEDs in the front start blinking and  the camera powers up  this takes about one minute      Although you can test a camera with a direct connection to a computer  see Section 2 2 1     Power Supply When Connected Directly To A Computer     however  itis recommended  that you use a switch for a production system                 MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems 
46.  213  10 8  104 215  10 8  104 216  10 8  104 217  10 8  104 218  10 8  105 145  10 8  105  146  10 8  105 147  10 8  105  148    48 video sources found   24 selected    Video sources    Version    MX   4 0 4  19  MX   4 0 4 19  MX   4 0 4  19  MX   4 0 4 19  MX   4 0 4  19  MX   4 0 4 19  MX   4 0 4 19  MX   4 0 4 19  MX   4 0 4 19  MX   4 0 4  19  MX   4 0 4  19  MX   4 0 4  19  MX   4 0 4  19  MX   4 0 4  19  MX   4 0 4  19  MX   4 0 4 19  MX   4 0 4 19  MX   4 0 4  19  MX   4 0 4  19  MX   4 0 4  19  MX   4 0 4 19  MX   4 0 4  19  MX   4 0 4 19  MX   4 0 4  19             O Different subnet    ms   esa Comenh    Automatic search Add manually Preview image Legend          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Launching MxControlCenter For The First Time 5 5   3 9 2       A video source is any source offering video content that can be displayed in  MxControlCenter  The term not only refers to MOBOTIX cameras  but also to third     party IP cameras  recordings stored on file servers   file server paths     and other devices   e g    Snap Server   NAS systems   MxPEG clips and analog cameras connected via  MxServer  e g  an analog   Dome Camera         The application automatically finds all MOBOTIX cameras and other devices  e g  Snap  Servers  on the same physical network  see below      A   Physical Network refers to a system of computers and networked devices that are  connected by network cables    Switch  wir
47.  231    UPS  glossary  359    User interface  Configuring 181  MxControlCenter 62  Update Assistant 223    Users 36  Creating 201  Creating  overview  201  Editing 201  Editing  overview  201  Entering reasons for actions 204    Using  Audio features of a camera 75       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 8  amp    3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Index       Dead Man   s Switch 141   Different MxControlCenter configura   tions 219   Different MxRemotePreview servers 273   Event Searches 114   Extra live windows 73   Extra windows 72   Image post processing 76   Joysticks   Live Recording 87   MOBOTIX cameras with pan tilt heads  246   MxControlCenter 60   MxRemotePreview to access remote  recordings 266   Pan tilt heads 246   Saved views 90   Sequencers 73   Snap Server NAS systems 237   Switching features of a camera 76   Third party cameras 246   Two man rule 142   Update Assistant as stand alone applica   tion 235   Video sources 56   Video wall 74   Virtual PTZ on Live images 78    Video  Displaying content in layouts 67  Exporting 33    Video Motion detection  glossary  359  Video Motion window  glossary  359  Video Player 18   Video Search 124   Video SIP  glossary  359    Video sources  Adding manually 55  Configuring 53  Editing list 56  Finding 53  Properties dialog 295    Status of discovered 54  Using 56    VIDEO SOURCES  Navigator sidebar panel 66    Video sources  glossary  359  Video surveillance 67    V
48.  4 08 12 16 17 21                                                   counting lines  14 08 12    1617 21   Pe    TZ Smee z Open analysis via   _ Softbuttons   om event searches  amp   MxControlCenter    MxAnalytics    e Area for counting line reports in a table  This area displays the reports for the period  of time of the selected profile  Line designations and designations for line limits  in  both directions  are assigned  automatically or manually  when the counting lines  are defined  These designations are shown in the counting lines report  You can  show or hide counting lines in the lower part of the reference image  The designa   tions for line limits are then also displayed on the counting lines in the image  This  way  it is easy to assign the counting lines to the values in the counting lines report     a    e Camera reference image with heat map  This area displays the heat map for the  period of time of the selected profile  You can show and hide the display of the heat  map and the legend for the heat map in the camera s reference image     g    The counting line and heat map evaluations can be called up in the event search or gener   ated regularly and automatically sent via e mail  This way  you have the reports regularly  at the desired time intervals without another thought  See Section 4 6 4    Generating  Reports And Sending Automatically Via E Mail   for additional information on generating  and sending report profiles     Furthermore  the counting line r
49.  4 Using Pan Tilt Heads  Third Party Cameras and Joysticks    Besides MOBOTIX cameras  you can also connect third party IP or analog cameras  for  example  Axis IP cameras  Bosch AutoDome  Siemens Speed Dome  to MxControlCenter     Some camera models feature motorized pan tilt units and zoom lenses that can be con   trolled from within MxControlCenter using a joystick or the PTZ Controls sidebar panel   If a MOBOTIX camera is mounted on a pan tilt head and configured accordingly  its pan  and tilt features can also be controlled from an MxControlCenter computer     In the remaining parts of this section  we are going to describe the following scenarios     e Section 5 4 1    Using MOBOTIX Cameras With Pan Tilt Heads    This standard scenario  describes how to set up a MOBOTIX camera with one of several supported rotor  head protocols  including notes of using PelcoD rotor heads     e Section 5 4 2    Integrating Third Party IP PTZ Dome Cameras    This scenario describes  how to connect an IP PTZ dome camera directly in MxControlCenter set up for M JPEG  Live Streaming and PTZ controls  This includes setting up MxServer for continuous  M JPEG recording in the MOBOTIX file server structure     e Section 5 4 3    integrating Analog Third Party PTZ Cameras    This scenario describes  connecting live video streams from analog cameras to MxServer or an alterna   tive application  such as Axis Video Servers  This includes setting up MxServer for  continuous M JPEG streaming and reco
50.  5 5 1    Introduction To MxServer      Note that connecting third party IP cameras to MxServer works without any additional  hardware components   To connecting a third party IP camera to MxServer   e Click on File  gt  Configuration in the menu to open the configuration page in a browser   e Inthe New Channels section  select the camera type to add   e Fill in the camera configuration  login data and set the image parameters as required     e Enter a Channel name that describes the camera s purpose or location     Using A Third Party IP Camera In MxControlCenter    To use this camera in MxControlCenter  enter the IP address of the camera as described  in  Step 1  Add The IP PTZ Dome Camera To MxControlCenter   of Section 5 4 2    integrating  Third Party IP PTZ Dome Cameras       Some third party IP cameras can only deliver one video stream  e g  Axis M7001   If  this is the case  you need to decide if you want to either displaythe live video stream  in MxControlCenter or just record it using MxServer  Devices with such a limitation  should be replaced as soon as possible by MOBOTIX cameras  since they can handle  multiple video streams and store their recordings autonomously              5 5 5 Setting Up Recording In MxServer    Setting up a storage path for both third party analog and IP cameras provides the mecha   nism to store digital video data in a MOBOTIX file server structure  MxControlCenter can  then read that data from the storage location as a file server path 
51.  92       Deleting Unwanted Softbuttons    If browser access to the cameras will be allowed for users later on  you can delete any  unwanted softbuttons in Admin Menu  gt  Page Administration  gt  Softbuttons  It is recom   mended to keep only the following softbuttons  Admin Menu  Setup Menu  Multiwatcher   UC Event        Admin Menu Admin Menu  Setup Menu Setup Menu  Arm  amp  Record Multiwatcher z   Audio on UC Event  MxPEG on    _                     _     MxPEG off  UC Event E  LEDs Blink    Play Sound    A 5 4 Additional Camera Settings    Depending on the video surveillance system that you are setting up  the further configura   tion of the camera may vary to a great extent  Again  the general idea is to save time by  configuring certain settings even though they may not be used on all cameras     For example  you can configure the e mail server settings and create e mail profiles  In  case you need to set up e mail notifications on a camera later on  you only need to select  the predefined profile    Depending on the customer requirements  it may be useful to configure the following settings     e Set the network message profiles in Admin Menu  gt  Transfer Profiles  gt  IP Notify  Profiles so the camera can send alarm messages later on     e Do likewise to create the corresponding profiles in Admin Menu  gt  Transfer Profiles  gt   FTP Profiles  if FTP transfers are part of the system     e Create the time tables and set the custom days in Admin Menu  gt  General  Ad
52.  Access Control Lists Create three groups  admins   remote  mxcc     Create at least three users  one per    Users and Passwords     group  e g  andrew  richard   mike   Language Set browser language  X  Language and Start Page  Select Start Page Set start page for browser     BOOTP DHCP Activate Off     DNS Servers Enter DNS servers as required   Ethernet Interface Domain Enter domain name as required     Enabled recommended  disable if    AI   Items marked by an    X    can also be set using the Quick Installation wizard  see below            MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Creating And Distributing A Camera Master Configuration    341 392       DiTel fore mAXe e    Storage on External File  Server   Flash Device    Available Storage  Targets    Storage Options    Select storage target     Set storage options as required        E Mail Profiles    Global Options    Profiles  amp  Options    Set global options as required     Create e mail profile with adminis   trator address for system storage  failure  another e mail profile for  alarm notification  if required            Storage Failure Detection    E Mail       Select e mail profile with adminis   trator address to notify in case of  storage failure           Error Notification    E Mail    Select e mail profile with adminis   trator address to notify in case of  critical error and after rebooting           Speaker and Microphone    Audio input    Activat
53.  Acknowledging Alarms   in this section           Manually added alarms    Adding Images To The Alarm List   below  are always  acknowledged by default           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com         0  2   3 Q 2 MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter    Display Options Of The Alarm List       When the Alarm List contains many cameras and alarms  you may want to adjust how  MxControlCenter displays the Alarm List contents  Use the buttons below to change the    display options     e Hides the images in the alarm list and shows only the title bars of the alarms   Fa   e Enlarges the alarm list images  twice the regular size              T e Enables alarm list filtering    Filtering The Alarm List   below    Filtering The Alarm List  T Since the Alarm List can contain many alarms at once  you want to filter the alarm list     Note that the alarm list filter button can have more than two states  To test the filter  keep  on clicking on the filter button until it returns to the original state     Depending on whether or not you have selected a camera  yellow frame   MxControlCenter  provides these options for filtering the alarm list     eS coe   e No camera selected  Shows only    Lost Connection    errors  Click on the button again  to return to the unfiltered list       mooeone    Connection Lost      10 7 10 12 58 57 PM      Camer  a selected            MxControlCenter stores new alarms from other cameras in 
54.  Availability Config     Shows the live video stream of a MOBOTIX  Live DW   camera or a camera from a third party manu   facturer   This element is basically a live    video on   a demand    window that is normally hidden   Live icon IC When the camera detects an alarm  it auto   matically shows the live stream     Shows the live video stream of a camera   but with reduced frame rate and optimized    resolution to save bandwidth  These windows  Preview DW   are typically used for video sources that are  attached via low bandwidth network con   nections     This element is used to play back recordings  Player DW   from one video source using the buttons of the  Player sidebar panel   i This element plays back a specific file server  Fi ial DW   structure as recorded by a MOBOTIX camera   p an MxServer or exported by MxControlCenter     Shows the location  viewing direction and  whether or not the MOBOTIX camera is cur   Status icon IC rently displayed on a monitor  When clicking  on an icon  a different window can show the  camera s live video stream  for example     DW   Display window  IC   Icon  BT   Button  BG   Background layout   X   Multiple elements per layout  1   One element per layout  O   Not available          MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    12 392    wl CT       MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       ft     ee         windows in background layouts have a title bar  If the icons    Element
55.  DHCP server  e g  a DSL router  on the  network  MxControlCenter automatically selects the DHCP option  see Section 2 4 2     Using The Video Sources In MxControlCenter        e Generate layout  Decide if you want to have MxControlCenter automatically generate  a layout for you that contains all selected cameras     After you have completed these steps  MxControlCenter displays the selected cameras     2 2 Power Supply And Network Connection Of Cameras    You can supply the MOBOTIX cameras with power using the MOBOTIX Network Power  Adapter  MX NPA Po   or a switch that supports the PoE standard IEEE 802 3af  Both  of these methods are briefly described in the following sections  For information about  additional power supply options and for more details  see the   Connecting The Camera To  The Network And To The Power Supply   section in the corresponding   Camera Manual     2 2 1 Power Supply When Connected Directly To A Computer    1  Connect the pre installed cable of the camera to the Camera connector of the Network  Power Adapter     2  Connect the Ethernet cable of the computer to the PC Power connector of the  Network Power Adapter     3  Plug the RJ45 connector of the external power supply into the LAN Power con   nector of the Network Power Adapter     If everything has been connected properly  the camera LEDs in the front start blinking and  the camera powers up  this takes about one minute      PoE Adapter   MX NPA PoE        Power supply       PC   10 8 0 11 255
56.  Dome  In MxControlCenter   of Section 5 4 2    Integrating Third Party IP PTZ Dome Cameras       Scenario B  Integrating Analog PTZ Cameras Using A Third Party Video Server    In this scenario  a third party video server handles the digitizing of the video generated  by an analog PTZ camera  MxServer again handles the recording by continuously storing  M JPEG images from the analog PTZ camera     To connect an analog PTZ camera for live streaming and playback using a third party  video server    1  Connect the analog PTZ camera to the third party video server    2  Setup recording of the analog PTZ camera to MxServer    3  Add the video server in MxControlCenter as a video server channel    4  Set the storage location of the analog PTZ camera in MxControlCenter      These steps are described in more detail in the following        MxControlCenter currently supports the following third party video servers     e Axis Video Server       Step 1  Connect The Analog PTZ Camera To The Video Server    Please read the video server s product manual on how to connect an analog PTZ camera  and how to configure the video server        Since MxControlCenter only supports the M JPEG video streaming format  please  configure the video server accordingly           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 6 8   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features    Step 2  Set Up Recording Of The Analog PTZ Camera In MxServer       Set up reco
57.  Failure Detection and select the e mail profile you created for this purpose     It is highly recommended to always use this feature in order to avoid the loss of  recordings     In larger projects  you should activate this feature later on when adjusting sets of  cameras  see Section A 6    Adjusting Sets Of Cameras        e Oncameras using file server NAS storage  configure at least one camera  but  not more than two  per file server NAS     e On cameras using internal SD card storage  every camera should send stor   age failure notifications              Setting Up Error Notification    Likewise  the camera can send e mails in case of system errors  Open Admin Menu  gt   Error Notification and select the e mail profile you created for this purpose     Configuring Audio Settings    Activate the microphone  if not prohibited by law or company regulations  and the speaker  in Audio and VoIP Telephony  gt  Speaker and Microphone     Configuring The Outgoing Calls Phone Profiles    Likewise  create the corresponding call profiles in Audio and VoIP Telephony  gt  Outgoing  Calls Settings Phone Profiles  may vary according to different camera software versions      Setting The Time And Date    e Click on General Administration  gt  Time and Date    e Time Server  Select NTP  RFC 1305     e Enter the IP addresses or host names of the time servers   e Adjust automatically  Activate this checkbox    e Click on Set        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    w
58.  Fi  among other  less common technologies     Wizard  Refers to a software component that helps the user install or set up a particular program  and that guides the user through the configuration process by means of simple questions     WLAN  Abbreviation of Wireless Local Area Network  Used to provide network  and thus  also Internet   connections without requiring cables  This is a synonym of   Wi Fi     Zeroconf  A technology  which allows devices in IP based networks to automatically    advertise    their  services without the need of a   DHCPserver  A printer commonly advertises its printing service  over the network  a MOBOTIX camera its imaging service  Using Zeroconf  MxControlCenter  can find other MOBOTIX cameras    Snap Servers  etc        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       Notes                                                                                  MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       3 78   392 MxCC User Manual  Index       Symbole    2G  glossary  352  3G  glossary  352  ACIF  glossary  353    A    Access Data  Properties tab 295    Accessing  Recordings on microSD cards 276  Recordings on SD cards 276  Remote recordings using  MxRemotePreview 266    Access rights 36  Users  amp  groups 36    Acknowledging alarms 97  Acoustic alarm features 96    Action log  Configuring 214  Monitoring 214    Action Log  Filtering 214  
59.  Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    282 392    MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features           Enter the following value in the Add Virtual Directory dialog     e Physical Path  lt camera recordings folder gt     This value may point to a share on a different computer or NAS  provided  it has already been mapped as a network drive on the local computer            Click on OK       In the Connections pane  select the server name         Double click on MIME Types to open dialog  under Actions in the right pane   select Add  This opens the Add MIME Type dialog         Enter the following values in the Add MIME Type dialog     e File name extension  erdinfo    e MIME Type  application octet stream           Click on OK     5 6 4 Testing the Web Server With MxRemotePreview    Testing The CGI Module In The Browser    1  Open a web browser     2  Enter 127 0 0 1 in the address bar and press ENTER  the web browser should  now list the folders of the file server      3  Keep clicking on folder links until you see   jpg files   4  Click on an   00001  jpg file     5  Add 2previewsize 320x240 amp quality 20 to the address in the address bar and  press ENTER  If the image changes accordingly  the CGI module is working properly     Using Different CGI Parameters In The Browser    To test the CGI module in a web browser  you need to specify recording parameters in the URL     Syntax  http     lt URL gt   lt folder path gt   lt image file gt   lt parameter gt  amp    
60.  Options    A 9 Final Lab Test Of All Components  A 9 1 Testing And Correcting  A 9 2 Exporting And Distributing MxControlCenter    A 10 Mounting And Initial Operation  A 11_ Adjusting Individual Cameras  A 12 Final Tests   A 13 Hand Off And User Training    B    Troubleshooting    B 1 Solutions To Common Issues  B 1 1 Power and Connectivity Issues  B 1 2 File Server NAS Issues   B 1 3 Camera Issues   B 1 4 MxControlCenter Issues    B 2 Using The MxControlCenter Error Log  C MOBOTIX Glossary    Index    337  337  338  338    338    340  340  342  342  347  347  348    350  353    353  353  353  354  355  355    356  356  356    357  357  358  359    362    362  362  363  363  364    365    368    378       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    9 392       About This Manual   In order to indicate special elements  this manual uses the following formatting conventions   e User interface elements  Click on the Activate Player mode button   e Values in selection boxes  Select Unlimited in the selection box     e User input  Double click the camera name and enter the desired name  Back  Entrance  for example      e Keys on the computer keyboard  Press the HASH KEY     to reset the zoom settings   e File names  Double click the MxcontrolCenter Setup exe file to install it     e Cross references  For more information on this topic  see Section 3 1    Elements Of  The Application Window     Note that you can click on such 
61.  PTT   in Meee  Ia Carera  A W     Raimage ve O    Inegs Ae bd  Vv       PTI Vieng   In MOC          EONAR ETE j i ME 2e kae 1283 1443 48 Mon 20 09 10          MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com             Automatic Distortion Correction     Live And In The Recording    The correction of wide angle lenses at up to 180   fisheye  is integrated as a standard feature  in both the live  display and playback  When a correction takes place  in the camera  hardly any load is placed on neither the  network nor the control center computer while the image  is already transferred after correction  Uncorrected record   ings can still be corrected later using MxCC     PTZ  Pan Tilt Zoom    Live And In The Recording    The cameras can be moved by remote control and the images zoomed both via the virtual  joystick integrated in the software and via a real  connected joystick  In MOBOTIX  cameras  this is always done using digital technology without moving components  which  makes the system particularly  low maintenance           few Hee    Eoo  Q  Ha So as   0  Rs O00         Prensa                  q    tJ  siji                 WA RI et an RD he    ai  Bi  p      i  a    4 Oo        a          D  Q H ISS s  0 ero o       om          f  f    HE      o00    Hi        E  frit      2    SS eg h    CETAN  T T E  TEE EL  So 4s  WOLA       Recorded video sequences can also be analyzed later using PTZ  MxCC offers an  intuitive  virtu
62.  Post Processing dialog to the right or left Settings       of the MxControlCenter application window   e Check the Activate checkbox     e Move the sliders up and down to see how the image of the  selected video source changes     The Image Post Processing dialog stays on your desktop until  you close it  so you can try to change the settings for other video  sources  too  Simply select a different video source and follow the  steps above until you are satisfied with the results  If you want to  undo your changes  click on the Default button to reset the values        The image post processing settings are per video source settings  i e   the settings  are stored separately for each video source  This allows applying different settings  for different video sources              Once you have defined the desired settings  you can click on the Image post processing    button to activate or deactivate post processing for the selected video source in a layout  EDs   yellow frame      Post processing does notchange the actual video data delivered by the video source   live or recorded   it only changes the way MxControlCenter displays the video        From a technical point of view  the virtual PTZ features of MOBOTIX cameras  including  distortion correction for wide angle lenses  are also post processing features  Since  these features are quite complex  they are examined in detail in Section 3 2 9    Using  The Virtual PTZ Functions On Live Images          MOBOTIX AG    Securit
63.  Seto Browser  Quick Setup  Quck Seto creates cefa users and shares on the Snap Server  You must prode passwords for these users  In  addition  you can change te password of the Snap Server s odmi user  asoword for user MuCame   eseese           seeeee  besward fo uoe MCC teeth te  asoword for user admin  optonallc sessse    sesece  C  Son passwords  Ox Carce Apot  B configure Snap Server 2 EJ                   Server s web interface  see Browser below      Browser  If you want to control the entire setup in detail  you can click on this    button to open the Snap Server s web interface  Then change the settings to your  requirements  see the Snap Server documentation on how to do this      3  Save the changes by clicking on OK     To use the Snap Server as storage location for the MOBOTIX cameras  proceed as described  in Section 4 5 4     Configuring Where to Record     To configure MxControlCenter for direct  access to the recordings  i e   to free the cameras from the task of handling the record   ings   see   Changing MxControlCenter   s Access To The Recordings Of Individual Cameras      in the same section        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Connecting Remote Cameras Using DynDNS    253 392       5 3 Connecting Remote Cameras Using DynDNS    MxControlCenter cannot find cameras that are outside of the local  physical  network   These cameras need to be added manually to the camera list  The simplest 
64.  Snap Server to configure it directly from MxControlCenter   You can rename the Snap Server  add  edit and delete users  etc   see Section 5 2 2     Configuring And Editing Snap Server Settings        Different subnet   Yellow  Besides the cameras that have already been added  in the same logical network  subnet  as your computer  MxControlCenter also  finds new MOBOTIX cameras with factory IP addresses using   Bonjour  see  Example above      Preview image    MxControlCenter displays the live images from the selected  camera in this field as long as this camera is available   f  more than one camera is selected using  CTRL  click  the pe  preview window displays the images from the last camera  you clicked on  You can thus quickly find the cameras you      want to use in MxControlCenter           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Launching MxControlCenter For The First Time    57 392       Manually Adding Video Sources To The List    In addition to MOBOTIX cameras that are found automatically  you can also manually add  video sources to the list of video sources in MxControlCenter     e Camera  Enter the IP address or the DNS name of a MOBOTIX camera or a third party  IP camera  see Section 5 4     Using Rotor Heads  Third Party Cameras and Joysticks     and Section 5 5    MxServer   Integrating Third Party Cameras     This also applies to  cameras that are to be integrated via DynDNS  see Section 5 3    Conne
65.  Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    174 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration          Reference Image    The reference image allows comparing the current camera image to an image stored  earlier  This image thus provides an easy way to determine changes in the positions of  the camera itself or of other objects  vehicles  containers  etc  Click on the Show camera   s  reference image button in the toolbar or on the icon in the title bar of a display window  to show the reference image in a separate window     To set the reference image   e Make sure that the Layout Manager is active     e Right click on a live display window     e Select Define reference image for camera from the context menu        The settings for Instruction File  Preferred Layout and Reference Image are per   camera settings        Setting An Audio Path    By default  MxControlCenter sends sound  i e   announcements  to the selected camera   which plays back the sound on its own speaker  Setting the audio pathto a different camera  uses the  external  speaker of that camera instead of the selected one     When setting the audio path to a different camera  MxControlCenter always uses this  audio path camera to output the audio sent by the MxControlCenter computer  As a  consequence  the users of the system do not need to know which camera to select in  order to make an announcement    The following scenarios are possible     e Groups of cameras in a layout have t
66.  The PTZ Controls In MxControlCenter    The PTZ Controls sidebar panel contains a number of controls that you can operate with  a mouse and that work just like a joystick     e Turn the joystick left right or use the slider      Adjusts the  zoom setting of the selected video source  blue arrows in  figure      e Move the joystick left right up down  Moves the visible image  in the direction you choose until you let go of the joystick  red  arrows in figure   Note that you may have to zoom in before  you can use this feature           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    8 8   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       Devices For Controlling The PTZ Features    You can execute the following actions to control the PTZ  Pan Tilt Zoom  features       H   gt    Actions Mouse Sidebar Panel Joystick      Mouse wheel Turn right     Mouse wheel Turn left     Pan left ALT click in left half Tilt left   of image    Pan right ALT click in right half Move right    Tilt right   of image  Tilt down ALT click in bottom Move up    Tilt forward   half of image  Tilt up ALT click in top half Move down  Tilt backward   of image    o  o        G     oooga    Remarks    Unless inverted  see   Adjusting The Joystick Control Settings       see   Using The Preset  Views          Adjusting The Joystick Control Settings    Depending on your needs  you can invert the direc        tion of the joystick control  aes       e Make sure
67.  This button  opens the Sequencer Configuration          Show Camera IP Name  dialog  which provides a convenient      gt  petat 10212168  way to configure the order of display      ao ja E    3 vi Defa t 21   and the sequencer times for all video   7 Deta 10218        V  Default 10 2 1 93  sources contained in the layout  naan aN    Right click on the button to delete it      075A 19212169  or to set its background color     Sequencer configuration    e Layout  This button opens the cor  Show for 3  1  60  sec   responding layout when clicked     Right click on the button to delete it  or to set its background color        e Command  This button executes the assigned HTTP command when clicked   Command buttons are mainly used to control video wall layouts  where the    main     MxControlCenter computer controls other MxControlCenter computers connected to the  monitors of the video wall  See Section 4 3 6    Configuring MxControlCenter Remote   Control And A Video Wall   for more information on how to use a command button     Right click on the button to edit or delete it or to set its background color        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com      64   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       Status Icons And Focus Windows    Unlike in grid layouts  which only accept one focus window  background windows can  have more than one focus window  By clicking first on a focus window and then on a  status icon 
68.  Type Explanation Availability Config     Shows the saved alarms from any camera that  you click on in the alarm list  The saved alarms  are not displayed in a list  but rather as a video  from a video recorder  You can therefore fast  forward or rewind through the alarms and the  recorded image sequences of each alarm     Automatically shows the live images of the  camera or video source for which an alarm  was triggered most recently  If there are sev   eral  live  alarm windows in a layout  the first   Live  Alarm D alarm window always shows the live stream  D    Alarm Player  window    window of the camera with the most recent alarm and  the last alarm window shows the live stream  of the camera with the nt alarm  Upon a new  alarm  the live streams of all other cameras  are pushed back by one window     This element is not Sean to one spe   cific MOBOTIX camera  but rather switches  Sequencer    between the selected cameras at preset  window    intervals  The sequencer windows are very  effective when used in conjunction with status  icons  particularly in background layouts     window monitors  for example  a focus window can  reside on the second monitor to provide a  more detailed view of the selected live camera        Close  Windows    Closes all open extra  floating  windows     button       Configure ES Opens a dialog  which allows activating the  B    Sequencer       cameras of this layout that are supposed to be  button    controlled by the camera sequencer butt
69.  Uses the right image sensor of the camera  default    Left  Uses the left image sensor of the camera     Both  Creates a double width image consisting of the image of the left image sensor  on the left and the image of the right sensor on the right     Auto  Automatically switches to the sensor  only available on Day Night and IT models         This section is available for all Dual camera models with exeption of the D14D 180      model         Exposure Time  amp     Exp  program  Represents a filtering mechanism that increases or decreases the  exposure time used for low light conditions  this setting is sometimes adjusted by  individual image program settings  see   Image Program   in Section 6 3 2    The     Image Settings    Tab        The default exposure program is 0 Standard  Negative values   2 Reduce    1 Reduce   reduce the exposure time and have the tendency to increase image noise  Positive  values increase the exposure time and reduce image noise     Min  exp  time  This parameter sets the minimum  shortest  exposure time  It is  recommended to leave the factory default unchanged     Max  exp  time  This parameter sets the maximum  longest  exposure time  This  setting is extremely important since it has to provide for crisp images  short expo   sure time  on the one hand and for properly exposed noise free night images  long  exposure time  on the other hand     For moving objects  it is recommended to use a maximum exposure time of 1 60  second to avoid motion
70.  Windows  Media Player  after installing the MxPEG DirectShow codec  see Section 4 1 4    installing  The MOBOTIX MxPEG DirectShow Codec     Files in MxPEG format also include the audio  data recorded by the camera  if this had been activated at the time of recording         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Saving  Printing And Exporting    141 392       AVI MPEG4  Creates an avT file for Windows systems  The audio track is included   if audio recording had been activated for the camera     Time lapse  Allows the export of recordings as a time lapse  which is interesting for  the documentation of construction progress  for example     Custom  Allows using different codecs for special purposes  For more information  on this topic  Section 3 6 3    Exporting Recorded Video Footage       Selecting The Format Settings    In the Export List dialog  click on the Settings   Bi Sport Format settings Sra   button to open the Export Format Settings encoder  anan   Subnie   rie size umtanon   Wii  dialog  If you have selected one of the pre  Fixed resolution     defined export profiles above  your choices    Use recording resoiution    may be limited according to the specifics  of that profile  The tabs allow changing the  following parameters     7  Start new clip when resolution changes    1 v H    V  Only use event images    Minimum interval between trames  60  gt   seconds vw    Encoder  Allows adjusting the reso  Co
71.  acti   vated     Deactivate Low Light  Suppression        Camera does not reach maxi   mum frame rate        Frame rates depend on many  factors  resolution  quality  full  image recording  exposure  times  lighting  etc          Open camera in browser and  select Image Program  gt  Fast  in Quick Controls              MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 64   3 92 MxCC User Manual  Troubleshooting       Issue    Camera uses wrong image  resolution when recording full  images  e g  Mega instead of  QXGA            Possible Cause    Full Image Recording acti   vated  but Mega still set as  image resolution        Solution    Select image resolution for   full image recording in Setup  Menu  gt  Recording  click on  parameters link below  Activate Full Image Recording           B 1 4 MxControlCenter Issues    Issue    Live video stream in MxCC is  slow or has high latency     Possible Cause    Virus scanner checks video  stream     Solution    Add camera ports  typically 80  and 443  on MxCC workstation  to virus scanner exceptions        Workstation is downscaling  many cameras with large  image resolutions     Reduce number of cameras  in one layout or select smaller  image resolutions        Insufficient user rights  MxCC  uses guest rights to access  camera      Create dedicated    mxcc    user  on camera with proper rights        Display window shows    No  image available   check pass   word       Wrong glo
72.  addition  the trendsetting VoIP SIP technology of the MOBOTIX cameras makes it  possible to listen to the intruder live from anywhere via camera and MxCC or a smart  phone  Of course  announcements can also be made        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       1 392          hen JANE Acoustic Alarm      l Email with Alarm  Image Attachment      Alarm SMS  via a      Provider                    Building Plan of the Branch Offices in  Question including Camera Preview Images    VoIP SIP Technology       MOBOTIX AG e     Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com             IX camera  intruder  an alarm    1 individu   a alarm    he camera    30 392    MxCC User Manual  Fast Availability Of Video Evidence       A mouse click makes  a simple change to  the recording of  other cameras at the  same point in time    Important events are recorded every day not only in connection with criminal acts   Sometimes a receptionist would simply like to know if someone rang the doorbell  during his her brief absence  or if an agitated customer really left his bank card at cash  register 3 an hour ago     In another case  it is important to filter out the decisive video evidence as quickly and  simply as possible from the recorded data and export it as evidence for a court of  law   possibly printing it out  MOBOTIX with MxCC has the right solutions available     Time Controlled Event Searc
73.  and M JPEG is also  available in MxCC        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    MXxCC printout with  original image  above   and zoom image  below              CARA AKY ArAdrrnce  11 Qn Q  Camera IP Adaress  10 8 0 118  Recording time  9 15 2010 3 52 PM e printing time  9 15 2010 3 52 PM       sAAKAL mA nATY en  WWW MODOTIX cCOomMm       MxCC User Manual  Get the Most Of What Is There        HOIR naola 3  0 GReoo       Despite later fine  adjustment or  change of image  size  the original  image is always  preserved as well    Later Video Movement Detection    Each video recording of a MOBOTIX camera can also  be searched later in MxCC for changes using the VM  windows feature  VM   Video Motion   For example  a  VM window is placed over a door using the mouse and  the recording sequences are immediately displayed in  which something occurred only at the door at a speci   fied time frame     The high performance computer in the camera allows  this post VM evaluation to be done extremely rapidly     Fine Adjustment For More Meaningful Images    Not only detail and enlargement but also contrast   saturation and brightness can be finely adjusted with  MxCC in both live and recorded images videos for an optimal evaluation or data  export  The unprocessed image data of the original camera recording are preserved  and are always included in storage        BS v oe iB oa BONS s 79clqs   ORA o o A             Deeply Mode
74.  archive for restoring the configurations of all cameras     When loading a configuration backup archive  MxConfig  lt date gt   zip  see   Contents  Of A Zipped Backup Archive     the configuration files of the cameras are automatically  uploaded to the individual cameras     These System Backup commands basically automate the Camera  gt  Save Settings and  the Camera  gt  Upload Settings menu commands for all cameras in one step  They can  thus be used to comfortably backup and restore the complete set of camera configura   tions of the MxControlCenter system     5 1 9 Changing The Configuration Of Many Cameras At Once    By properly configuring one camera and applying that configuration  or parts thereof  to  many other    target    cameras  you can save a considerable amount of time  The procedure  follows these steps     e Configure one camera using the Camera Configuration dialog  see Section 4 5     Configuring Alarms And Recordings        e Save the configuration from that camera  see   Creating A Backup Configuration File  For One Or More Cameras   in Section 5 1 7    Saving And Uploading Settings Of One  Or More Cameras        e Select the cameras you would to configure and upload the configuration to the  selected cameras  see   Restoring Camera Configuration Settings From A Backup  File   in Section 5 1 7    Saving And Uploading Settings Of One Or More Cameras        e Select the configuration sections you would like to apply to the target cameras        MOBOTIX A
75.  blur  For still objects  you can use a maximum exposure time  of 1 1 second to ensure proper exposure of the image        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    316 392    MxCC User Manual  Reference       Exposure Mode  amp     These options let you select the appropriate image area that the camera uses as a basis  to optimize the exposure area     e Recording  Corresponds to the full image area of the sensor and is recommended  for recording  In this mode  you can define and apply exposure windows     e Virtual PTZ  Corresponds to the currently visible image area and is recommended  when using the virtual pan tilt zoom feature  In this mode  you cannot define or  apply any exposure windows  In addition  the options of the Exposure Windows   Weights and Frame Details sections are not available     Exposure Windows O    This section allows using exposure windows to control the exposure for the images gener   ated by the camera  Besides the Custom setting  which allows drawing individual expo   sure windows  you can select one of the predefined exposure window sets  Full Image   Quarter  Center  etc       e Toadda window  Use the mouse to draw a green frame within the camera s image  area     e To change the size of a window  Click on an exposure window to select it  Next   move the mouse over the frame of the window and drag the border as indicated by  the cursor     e Tomove a window  Click on an exposure window t
76.  cameras    e Installing and configuring MxRemotePreview to access remote recordings in low   bandwidth scenarios    e Reading SD cards with recordings of MOBOTIX cameras    5 1 Update Assistant   Software Updates And More    MOBOTIX cameras are always delivered with the latest version of the software  firmware   to guarantee that your cameras are working properly  Nevertheless  it may be necessary  to update the camera software from time to time  as this not only corrects software bugs   but also adds new features to the camera     In MxControlCenter  two mechanisms are available to update and maintain the software  for all MOBOTIX components of an MxControlCenter installation     e Software Downloads  This component provides a quick overview over new software  that is available on the update server  by default  this is update  mobotix  com    Select Tools  gt  Software Downloads from the MxControlCenter menu to open this  component     e Update Assistant  You can either open this component as a dialog from the  MxControlCenter menu  Tools  gt  Update Assistant  or start it as a stand alone  application from Start  gt  Programs  gt  MOBOTIX  gt  MxControlCenter in Windows     The table below gives an overview over the differences between the two components        Software Update  Downloads Assistant  List the camera and application software on the update x x  server   Download and install MOBOTIX application software  X X  Download the camera software and retrieve the corres
77.  connected via MxServer  e g   an analog   Dome Camera            MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    64 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter            Overview   Outside   H Main Entrance   H west gate   B Parking   B Garage Entrance  4 aj  Overview   Inside    IDEO SOURCES  4 Cameras  pa    Fina    VENT SEARCHES  P Search    3 1 1    MxControlCenter User Interface Elements    The title bar shows the name of the current layout and the selected video source     The menu barallows switching between views  opening additional dialog boxes and  executing all the features assigned to the various toolbar buttons described below     The toolbar contains buttons for the most important features  To see what a particular  button does  simply place your mouse pointer over it and read the tooltip that appears   The toolbar can also be shown at the bottom of the main window     For more information  see Section 3 1 2    MxControlCenter Toolbar Buttons   and  Section 4 4 2    Configuring The Toolbar       The status bar shows information for all video sources in the layout  nothing selected   e g  combined frame rate and required bandwidth  or of the selected video source   e g  individual frame rate and required bandwidth      The display area of the application window displays the current layout or an event  search  see below   The selected video source  e g  a camera  in a grid layout has a  yellow frame and is t
78.  criteria  so  when you click on this search for the first time  you will only see a blank search results  panel  If the properties bar  see figure below  is not visible  click on the separator at the  top of the search results area and drag it downward     Sources      From 3  Daysago v  6 00AM   Sort By   Date Time v   Reload  Automatically v   Search mode     Until Now X Order  Ascending A Reload now  gt  a   Selecting The Video Sources  e Click on the Sources button     e Select one or more cameras     Setting The Time Range For Searching  e Click on the From dropdown and set the start time of the search     e Click on the Until dropdown and set the end time of the search        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings    121 392       Filtering The Event Search Results  When MxControlCenter finds many events  you may be interested in only specific types  of events  For instance  you could limit your search to video motion  VM  events only    e Click on the Search mode button    e Deselect all event types except the Video Motion items     MxControlCenter only shows the events triggered by Video Motion 1 and Video Motion 2   move your mouse over the events displayed in the search results to see the event type  in the tooltips      Sorting Events    The Sort by and Order dropdowns allow setting the sorting criteria  date time  video source   etc   and specifying the sorting ord
79.  display an IP PTZ dome camera in MxControlCenter   e Select Video Source  gt  Add from the menu to open the Add Video Sources dialog   e Click on the Camera button to open the Add Camera dialog     e Select the appropriate camera Type                Axis IP camera  MxServer channel  Merit Liin IP camera      Toshiba IP camera  Axis Server channel    Panasonic IP camera  Sony IP camera       e Enter the IP address  or DNS name   port number and login data  User name and  password   and activate SSL  if necessary      e Click on OK to close the dialog  This adds the camera to the Add Video Sources list     e Select the camera in the Add Video Sources list and add it to the system as described  in Section 2 4 2    Using The Video Sources In MxControlCenter       Step 2  Connect The IP PTZ Dome Camera To MxServer For Recording    If you want to store and playback video data from a third party IP PTZ dome camera   you need to connect the third party IP camera to an MxServer instance to store the video  streaming data in a MOBOTIX file server structure  This allows MxControlCenterto access  the recording and play it back     Two steps are necessary to integrate a third party IP camera in MxServer  Please see the  sections in Section 5 5    MxServer   Integrating Third Party Cameras   as listed below     1  Add the third party IP camera as a New Channel in MxServer  Section 5 5 4     Connecting A Third Party IP Camera To MxServery      2  Add an Event Recording path to the IP camer
80.  e Execute the search by clicking on the Search button     MxControlCenter starts searching the event images in the defined  time range and starts filling the search results panel above  While  the search is running  the progress bar is filling  If MxControlCenter  detects movements within the boundaries of a video window  it  turns red and the clip is added to the search results panel     Once the search has finished  you can double click on a clip in the search results panel  to play it back in the Player panel  Note that the red video motion window indicates the  area in which MxControlCenter detected video motion  if several windows had been  defined  the others may stay yellow      v orang  OSB a a HE    2 O  G AB OBOl a s   0IeDe o  raa H inean  A  pe wieny es inry 84 858  Triggering  Post  VM         window     is Pe le   G  bunch Mode     Post VM  x window     PTL Cortrets      sombenoms    MeCentrotieste        Playing back the events works exactly as explained in Section 3 5 8    Using Event Searches       Modifying An Existing Post VM Search    If you want to change an existing Post VM search  simply click on the search in the EVENT  SEARCHES section of the Navigator sidebar panel  You can now edit the window as  outlined in   Creating A Post Video Motion Search   above or create new windows  move  and delete them  etc     Once you are done  click on the Search button to restart the search        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobot
81.  export recorded videos and still images and how to use MxControlCenter in different  network environments     Prerequisites    e You or an administrator have properly installed the cameras and attached them to  MxControlCenter  Chapter 2    System Installation and Initial Operation        e  fyou are using a professional MxControlCenter video surveillance system  you need  to have access to the documentation of the system  which should have been provided  by the administrator or the system installer     If you want to find out more about how to configure MxControlCenter  you should first read  this chapter to get acquainted with MxControlCenter and then read Chapter 4    System  Configuration       Starting MxControlCenter    Once you have installed MxControlCenter  Chapter 2 3    Installing MxControlCenter     you  can start the application  Double click on the shortcut on your desktop  click on Start  gt   Programs and find the link to MxControlCenter or double click on the MxCC   exe file in  the program folder     Logging In    By default  MxControlCenter is a single user applica     tionwhere the user that started the application has  full control of the entire system  By adding groups and    Login as       users  however  you can configure the application MxCC Login   as a multi user system  Section 4 7    Users  Groups   And Group Rights     User    user  Users    If this MxControlCenter installation has been set up a Soeeneeees   as a multi user system  the dialog in
82.  exporting an MxPEG file  for example     Available video sources  MxPEG     mxg  files  When added to a layout using  drag amp drop  MxPEG files are automatically added as video clips     e Player  Select this display window to show video source s recordings  You can play  back the recordings of this element using the controls of the Player sidebar panel   In addition  you can set the size of the display window     This element is typically used to define    player    layouts that are copies of layouts with  live display windows  Using such a layout allows you to quickly access the recordings  of an entire set of cameras     Available video sources  MOBOTIX and third party cameras     e File server path  This display window can be used to show the recordings of a video  source on d file server or other storage medium  This happens without requiring  access to the video source that stored the recording  allowing you to examine record   ings stored on a NAS system of your customer  for example  You can play back the  recordings of this element using the controls of the Player sidebar panel  In addition   you can set the size of the display window     Available video sources  File server paths  In the Navigator in the VIDEO SOURCES  gt   Storage Devices  gt  Recording Folders section   When added to a layout using  drag amp drop  recording folders are automatically added as file server paths     e Status icon  You can use this icon  background layouts only to create overview  l
83.  for devices on the network are manually assigned  ask your network  administrator for an IP address range  start and end addresses   a subnet mask and a  default gateway  Once you have obtained this information  do the following     e Activate the Use the following IP    imguesascea camer  address  range  option     e IP address  start   Enter the first  address of the range     Get IP address automatically  DHCP     e IP address  end   Enter the last Use the following IP address  range   address of the range  this field is  only active if you had selected more  than one camera in the Add Video  Sources dialog   a    This computer accesses the following subnet s   10 0 0 0  192 168 0 32    IP address  start      IP address  end      e Subnet mask  Enter the subnet anes eaner     mask   F  Store configuration in camera    e Default gateway  Enter the IP  address of the default gateway        Now wait until MxControlCenter modifies the network settings of the cameras and restarts  them  The status of the reconfigured cameras changes from Different subnet  yellow dot   P g   to OK  green dot         MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Launching MxControlCenter For The First Time 5 9   3 9 2    You can open the Configure Selected Cameras dialog box again for any video  source  Simply right click the video source you want to configure in the Add Video  Sources dialog box and select Configure network from the context 
84.  g     quality  lt percent gt   amp quality 30    noaudio Exclude audio from recordings    5 6 5 Using MxRemotePreview Servers To Access Video Sources    By default  MxControlCenter retrieves the recorded video via the camera or by directly  accessing the corresponding files on a file server  If you would like to use MxRemotePreview  when getting preview images in MxControlCenter  you need to tell MxControlCenter that  specific video sources are using preview datainstead of accessing the original recordings     Recommended Procedure When Using MxRemotePreview Servers  1  Set the Default Preview Settings to the MxRemotePreview server that is used most  often for this installation     2  Use the Access Recordings dialog to instruct MxControlCenter that specific video  sources are using preview data when accessing the recordings     3  For the video sources that are using a different server than the default  MxRemotePreview server  set the desired MxRemotePreview server in the corre   sponding Properties of dialog     Step 1  Set The Default Preview Settings To An MxRemotePreview Server    e Open Tools  gt  Options from the menu and select the Connection Defaults tab   e Set the following parameters in the Default Preview Settings section        Set Preview Mode to Remote Preview        Specify the MxRemotePreview server access data         Set the default MxRemotePreview parameters  JPEG quality  frame rate  etc        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany   
85.  gt    Bidirectional Audio   E                    Reduce frame rate  CPU usage    10   When minimized    Pause  Sequential mode      0             Disconnect streams during Video Search  F   Disable Post VM ability in Live Recordings   F   Local Archive    O User folder       Custom folder              No configuration loaded       On Startup aD       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    Load   start  Controls the startup behavior of MxControlCenter  For example   MxControlCenter can automatically launch with the specified start layout or the lay     out opened at the time the program was last closed     Return to Start Layout after  Allows automatically returning to the start layout after  the specified period of time  You can use this option if the users frequently switch  between different layouts and you would like MxControlCenter to automatically return  to a certain layout  Leave the field empty to deactivate this option     Registered cameras  Allows automatically restarting the cameras attached to this  MxControlCenter installation or the NTP services on the cameras after launching    MxControlCenter  set to Nothing by default      www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 90   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference       Behavior  amp     Store changed image settings in camera  Changes of various image settings that are  made in the PTZ Controls sidebar panel only take effect when you change the layout  of the camera or the camera  This option contro
86.  in the left field  and a search time in the right field   If you click on the down arrow of 28 29 39  the left field  you can selecta date    from the calendar that pops up    see figure         Clicking on Go to starts searching for the recording that is closest to the date time you  specified     Playing Back Events    Now that you have found the events you have been looking for  you can use the playback  buttons    Navigating The Recordings   in this section  to play back the recorded video of  the selected video source     While playing back  the Current date time field in the Player sidebar panel serves as     global playback time     When you stop the recording at any given time to switch to the  next camera  MxControlCenter automatically sets the current position of the next camera       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings    1 392       to the playback position of the previous camera  If there is no recording available at exactly  this date time  MxControlCenter selects the event that is closest to the selected date time   The Current date time field then assumes the date time of the current event     Switching All Windows To Player Mode    The Player mode for all video sources button in the Player sidebar switches all live video  sources of the current layout to Player mode  provided there is at least one recorded event  per video source   If this button is pressed 
87.  inputs        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    27 392       What Happens Then  Recording  Alarm Message  etc     When a camera is programmed to record all movements persons in the warehouse  of a shoe store outside of opening hours  the MxCC user is offered a multitude of  reactions that are automatically triggered by the camera and or video management  system   jointly or individually     e The incident is recorded as video with sound and displayed in the MxCC  alarm list     e The camera emits an acoustical alarm or plays an audio file     e The camera sends Emails or SMS  via a provider  with an alarm image or calls  previously defined telephone numbers     e Devices integrated in the system such as lights or door locks are switched on     e Analarm is sent to selected PC workstations with MxCC  displaying  for example  the building plan including a live image of the camera reporting the alarm  loca   tion layout in case of alarm      e Display of instructions and important background information in the location  layout e g   telephone numbers  contact persons  etc       e Remote alarm alerting to an alarm center or the police  e g   by phone call  or e mail      e        New York       Notification       Alarm Center    Tokyo       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    MOBOTIX cameras use  VoIP SIP and H 264    i e  the most advanced  internatio
88.  layout than the grid  can actually hold  MxControlCenter ignores the superfluous video sources     This does notapply to auto grids  since they automatically adjust to the number  of dragged or appended video sources           e By default  the video sources in a grid layout are displayed with an aspect ratio of  4 3  The video sources can also be displayed with an aspect ratio of 16 9  However   this is only recommended for single width grid elements  u  s  m  1  h   Otherwise   parts of the image at the left and right of the image are grayed out    To change the aspect ratio to 16 9  right cklick the desired layout in the Navigator panel  and select 16 9  The change applies and is saved when closing the Layout Manager     e To change the type or the video source of a display window  right click on a window  and select Edit     e To remove the contents of a display window  right click on a window  select Empty  and confirm the prompt  The display window itself will remain in the layout and will  not be deleted  You can later assign a different video source to this display window   This option is also useful if a display window is to remain in the layout even though  the video source is temporarily unavailable     e To delete a display window  right click on a window  select Delete and confirm the  prompt  The remaining display windows will move up by one position     Configuring Display Windows In Grid Layouts    You can configure a display window in the Edit Display Elemen
89.  manual for more information on adjusting the image  sensors and additional options     2 4 4 Saving The Initial Configuration    Make sure that you save the initial configuration by clicking on the Save configuration  button  If you do not save the configuration manually  MxControlCenter asks you before  quitting the application     MxControlCenter automatically saves the initial configuration file  Mxcc   ini  inthe  hidden Windows user folder     e Windows Vista 7  C  Users  lt user name gt  AppData Roaming   MOBOTIX MxControlCenter     e Windows XP  C  Documents and Settings  lt user name gt    Application Data MOBOTIX MxControlCenter     MxControlCenter configuration files should not be edited manually              When starting the next time  MxControlCenter automatically uses the last configuration  file  For more information on the configuration files of MxControlCenter  see Section 4 9     Working With MxControlCenter Configurations          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    62 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       3 USING MXCONTROLCENTER    The previous chapter has shown how to install and set up MxControlCenter  In this chapter   you will learn how to work with MxControlCenter on a day to day basis     You will get to know the application s user interface  learn how to work with live cameras   how the alerting features work  how to search for events and alarms  how to store  print  and
90.  mobotix com         MOBOTIX Q24    2 2 6   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       Select one or more cameras  use SHIFT click or CTRL click to select more than one  camera      Right click on one of the selected cameras and select Properties from the context  menu  MxControlCenter opens a Properties of  lt camera name gt  dialog for each  selected camera      Activate the Secure connection  SSL  checkbox and set a port if you have assigned  a different port than 443 in   Step 3  Activate HTTPS in the Camera and Set a Port     Then click on OK to close the dialog  Repeat this step for all open Properties of   lt camera name gt  dialog boxes     Check all layouts to make sure that you do not have any connection errors  this typi   cally happens when a camera has not been set up properly to allow SSL connections  or it has not been rebooted after setting up SSL      4 8 5 Signing The Recorded Video Data    MxControlCenter can only check the data integrity of recordings if the cameras have signed  their recordings at the time of recording the video data     To do this  the cameras can sign the recordings using their digital certificate   s private key  as shown below     MOBOTIX camera Audio video recording MxControlCenter    Private    Public    e w Signs   Verifies    ia we Teel  lt j   _                MxControlCenter can later check the integrity of the recordings using the digital certificate   s  public key in these cases     When explicitly checking data integ
91.  network  see    VoIP      JPEG  Abbreviation of Joint Photographic Experts Group  This group is responsible for the development  of the JPEG standard method for image compression  JPEG is the most common lossy image       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 I 2 399     MxCC User Manual  MOBOTIX Glossary       format for photos on the Internet  Loss in image quality is barely noticeable at compression  rates between 99  and 60      LAN  Abbreviation of Local Area Network  Represents a computer network that is usually covering  a small physical area  e g  a home  office  school  building or manufacturing site      Latency  Interval between capturing the image of a camera and displaying the same image on a  monitor  also called    scene to screen time         Layout  Describes  how video sources  cameras    MxPEG clips  etc   are displayed by MxControlCenter   When displaying the images from network cameras  the layout determines the positions and  resolutions of the images displayed on the monitor  In addition to the actual video images   you can also incorporate graphic elements such as the location of the cameras  etc   see    Background Layout    Grid Layout    Auto Grid      LED  Abbreviation of Light Emitting Diode  An electronic semiconductor component  built in to  MOBOTIX cameras and add on modules  which emits light when current flows through the  component in the correct direction     Linux  Free and o
92.  not have the rights to set up a scheduled  task  please ask your system administrator for assistance     Configuring MxStatus On The MxControlCenter Computers    Let   s assume that you have set up an MxStatus computer that is using the same IP address  and port as in the example above     e  P address of MxStatus computer  172 16 0 20       e Port of MxStatus computer  8080    Do the following on each of the MxControlCenter workstations   e Open Tools  gt  Options from the MxControlCenter menu   e Click on the Connection Defaults tab     e Enter the IP address 172 16 0 20 in the Default Connection Data  gt  MxStatus  Server box     e Enter the port 8080 in the adjacent Port box   e Click on OK to close the dialog   Options    General   Connection Defaults   View   Alam Handling   Remote Control   Monitoring   Action Log    Connections to Cameras  Username  admin    Password  eeeeee    Proxy server IP        MxStatus Server  172 16 0 20 Port  8080    MxStatus has been used in the example in Section 3 2 1    Displaying Video Content In  Layouts   to update the status of camera icons for the head of the surveillance team        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       156 392     B  E       Grid    Background    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration          4 2 Creating And Editing Layouts    Layouts play a key role in MxControlCenter since they are used to show cameras and  other video sources  if you are unsure 
93.  now show the     Parking1    layout on Client 4        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Setting Up Live Video Monitoring    187 392       Using Additional Remote Control Commands    MxControlCenter offers three additional remote control commands  which can be used  in this context     e showInAlarmWindow  Shows the image of the given camera  IP address or host  name  in an alarm window     e showInExtraWindow  Shows an extra window of the given camera  IP address  or host name      e showMessage  Upon receiving this command  MxControlCenter shows a window  with the specified URL encoded message   Caution   door is open   at the receiving  computer  The MxControlCenter users need to acknowledge this message     Example    http    192 168 1 204 31667  showInAlarmWindow 10 3 0 31   amp showInExtraWindow 10 3 0 31   amp showMessage Caution 20  20door 20is 200pen     For a complete list of MxControlCenter remote control commands  see table in  Section 6 1 5    The    Remote Control    Tab             MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       188 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       4 4 Configuring The Program Views And The User Interface    This section examines how you can adapt the MxControlCenter user interface to the  requirements of the security system  Many of these settings are attached to group rights  as set in the Users  amp  Gro
94.  of conventional network and analog cameras   e Exports recordings as AVI or Quicktime video with sound    HiRes Video Innovations    The German company MOBOTIX AG is known as the leading pioneer in network camera technology and its    decentralized concept has made high resolution video systems cost efficient     MOBOTIX AG     D 67722 Langmeil    Tel   49 6302 9816 103    Fax   49 6302 9816 190    sales mobotix com    AAN    The HiRes Video Company MO BOTIX    decentralized    Video Walls    patented  Thin Client Concept    Dual Screen    Free camera definition  on 2nd screen    more than 500 cameras    Reliable    MxCC backs    Euro 2012     Donbass Arena    Floor Plans    Layout editor with  indiv  floor plans    Alarm time or image    Alarm    Event list sorted by  camera or by time    Search    Search possible even  while recording    Event Search    Synchronized search  on several cameras    Image improvement    Post Processing    Zoom  contrast   distortion correction    Audio    Lip synchronous audio  bidirectional via IP    Analog and digital    PTZ    Mouse or joystick  control via network    Remote Alerting    Remote    with automatic  switching of floor plans    Third party cameras  Hybrid    Integration of analog   amp  digital systems    Synchronized    realtime viewing of  several cameras    MxCC MxEasy    Licence free    Video Management   Software       MX SM MxCC 2 5 1 EN V1 0 2013 04 17    
95.  of the available commands  see   List of  Remote Control Commands   in Section 6 1 5    The    Remote Control    Tab        Step 3  Test The Remote Control    To test the remote control function using the beep command  do the following   e Open a web browser on the same computer that is running MxControlCenter     e Enter the IP address  the port and the command in the browser address bar as in  the example below     http   127 0 0 1 31667  beep    e Press the RETURN key     If the test is successful  these things will happen     e The computer plays the system sound or the sound you specified when configuring  the remote control functions     e The browser window shows the text OK on an otherwise blank window     e MxControlCenter   s network message log is listing the received command  To see the  log   s contents  do the following        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Setting Up Live Video Monitoring    185 392           Select Tools  gt  Options from the MxControlCenter menu         Click on the Remote Control tab  MxControlCenter lists the received commands  in the Network Message Log box     The Network Message Log box shows the commands received since the last launch  of MxControlCenter  the last remote control command is on top   If you close the  application and launch it again  the log is empty     The Network Message Log box does not update automatically  To see commands  that have been entered 
96.  other folder  see Section 3 5 11    Playing Back Recordings From The Local Archive    and Section 3 6    Saving  Printing And Exporting           Switching layouts while the Live recording button is activated will stop the recording   Make sure that you click again on the Live recording button to resume recording           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    92 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       E foe x     3 3 Display Modes Of The Application Window    The layouts of the display area   red frame in figure  show the  video sources  usually cameras   that are displayed using the size  defined by the display windows   When maximizing the applica   tion on the computer monitor   you can easily see that the size  of the display windows is adjusted      automatically by switching back and forth between the predefined display window sizes   Quarter PDA  PDA  CIF  VGA  Mega         Example  Consider the screenshot of a Quad layout with four VGA display windows   640x480 pixels  in the figure above  If you make the application window smaller and    MxControlCenter cannot display the four VGA windows any more  it will automatically  reduce the display windows to CIF size  320x240 pixels         3 3 1 Scaling And Display Commands    The commands and options presented in this section are controlling how MxControlCenter  shows the video sources of a specific grid layout  While it is possible to remove the 
97.  patch unless this patch has been installed on the corre   sponding MOBOTIX camera  The MxControlCenter controls for a pan tilt head do  notwork with the normal  unmodified camera software if the Fast patch option has  been activated  Additional information on this feature is available from our technical  support  www  mobotix com  gt  Supporf              Using The Pelco D Protocol To Control A Mechanical Zoom    MxControlCenter also supports mechani    AccessData   Information   Display   PTZ Rotor    cal zoom actions using the Pelco D pro  Type   PekoD  tocol  This option allows controlling a Sensitivity   Normal    Pelco D enabled  motorized zoom lens              Joystick control  vV  Invert horizontal direction    on a MOBOTIX camera     V  Invert vertical direction  Mechanical zoom       If such a zoom lens is attached to the cam    przheadaddress  3   era  activate the Mechanical zoom   checkbox and select a PTZ head address in the range from 1 to 255  It corresponds to  the serial address defined in the Pelco D device itself  This address is required to identify  the proper device if more than one Pelco D device is attached via the same serial cable              The PTZ actions are executed using either a physical joystick or In Camera   the elements of the PTZ Controls panel in MxControlCenter  If A       the Mechanical zoom checkbox is activated  the PTZ controls Y N   in MxControlCenter have an additional Focus slider opposite O  gt  C   the Zoom slider  see figur
98.  player fastforward Starts winding in fast forward   player jumptobeginning Jumps to the beginning of the recordings   player jumptoend Jumps to the end of the recordings   player rewind Starts rewinding in fast backward   player previousframe Skips to previous frame   player aos yyyy mm dd  Jumps to the frame before this time    MM SS stamp    openeventsearchattime Opens event search with given time    Poeyer yyyy mm dd hh mm ss stamp     showInAlarmWindow    showInExtraWindow     lt IP address gt    lt IP address gt     Shows camera in a  Live  Alarm window   Shows camera in an extra window                    showMessage  lt Text gt  Shows text in a modal message box   160x120  320x240   352x288  384x288   side 640x480  704x576  Temporarily sets the specified resolution  768x576  800x600  on the camera   1024x768  1280x960   2048x1536  customize    Temporarily sets the specified JPEG  quality 10  20  s90 quality on the camera     Temporarily sets the specified image  brightness  10   9       O       10 brightness on the camera     Temporarily selects the specified lens  camera right  left  both  auto an duel camera madel   sharpen 0 1      10 Temporarily sets the specified sharp           ness value on the camera           Make sure that any application that is trying to remote control MxControlCenter is  using the port specified in Tools  gt  Options  gt  Remote Control or else the remote  control features will not work           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    M
99.  power of the camera  in the remaining time for other  security  functions such as event controlled recording and  makes more efficient use of the storage space available on the SD card        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Using MxAnalytics    145 392       The movement data collected and saved with MxAnalytics based on the defined settings  can be used in MxControlCenter for statistical analysis using special MxAnalytics evalua   tions  Evaluations for both counting lines and heat maps are available here     Evaluating movement data is explained in the following section  The necessary activation  and set up of MxAnalytics on a Q24M camera and the creation of predefined MxAnalytics  evaluations in MxControlCenter are outlined in Section 4 6    Configuring MxAnalytics      3 7 2 Calling Up Evaluations    You can call up the movement and counting line evaluations as daily heat map reports  or as weekly and monthly counting lines reports  To do this  select heat map counting  lines report profiles  There are several predefined profiles available  Analysis of the data  and its display is performed according to the settings for the profile selected  You can also  create custom report profiles  However  at the moment  this is only possible in the camera  software with a web browser  For additional information on creating report profiles  see  Section 4 6 3    Customizing The Report Profiles Used For Analysis     O
100.  prerequisites need to be  fulfilled     e The recording camera needs a certificate  either self signed or issued by a certifica   tion authority      e The recording camera needs to sign the recordings  Section 4 8 5    Signing The  Recorded Video Data        Running The Data Integrity Check    The data integrity check can be executed for the entire recordings of a camera or only the  video sequences that have been collected for exporting     e Open the Check Data Integrity dialog using one of the following methods         Right click on a MOBOTIX camera in the VIDEO SOURCES  gt  Cameras section of  the Navigator panel and select Check Data Integrity  this will search the entire  video storage of that camera      Depending on the size of the storage  checking the integrity of the entire  recordings of a camera can take quite a long time  It is therefore recom   mended to use this feature only if you suspect that the data integrity of this  camera   s recordings is corrupted                  Inthe Export List dialog  Section 3 6 3    Exporting Recorded Video Footage     click  on the Check button  this will manually check the video clips in the export list          In the Export List dialog  activate Check data integrity and export the video clips   this will check the clips while exporting         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com      3 2   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       The dialog opens and
101.  ready  to test the entire system  Once you done so and corrected any errors  you can export the  MxControlCenter configuration     If you cannot test all cameras at once  you should make sure that all storage targets  are running  then test the cameras in groups        A 9 1 Testing And Correcting    e Jest the hardware         Are the switches  storage targets  cameras and MxControlCenter workstations  running properly     e Test the user functions       Are the joysticks working properly at the MxControlCenter workstation  if installed      Can you load all layouts in MxControlCenter without errors       Are the alarm functions working properly if you trigger events  e g  by clicking on  the UC Event softbutton in the Softbuttons sidebar panel of MxControlCenter      e Test the system performance       Are the system response times acceptable when viewing the live layouts   e Test the storage targets         Are the cameras recording on the storage targets  click once on the Player but   ton in one camera s browser interface  then click on the Player button again          Remove the network connection to storage targets  Are the cameras sending  warning e mails as configured         Cut the power to network components  Are the UPS working properly and are  you getting warning e mails as configured     Correct any errors you have found and repeat the corresponding tests   A 9 2 Exporting And Distributing MxControlCenter    Export the MxControlCenter configuration with all a
102.  right hand image below         Camera or  MxControlCenter     y  vS  CAN   AN  Image Area  slightly distorted  Area Corrected  distortion corrected     If you examine the blue line in the right hand image above  you will notice that the line  is straight     Note that the available views and features vary depending on where the Hemispheric  camera is installed  on the wall  the ceiling or the floon  If you have selected a Hemispheric  camera model in the layout  the PTZ Controls panel will be expanded so that you can  execute the commands available for this camera model     e Full Image  Delivers the full image as generated by the image sensor  Although this  mode is available  it is not suited for live viewing as the images are distorted by the  wide angle lens     The Full Image display mode of the cameras is to be preferred if several  workstations are accessing the same cameras  This way  MxControlCenter  can handle image correction and the users can execute their own PTZ actions  without disturbing the other ones                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Live Video Surveillance    85 392       e Image Area  Delivers a zoomed section of the full image  i e   anytime you zoom  into the image      e Area Corrected  Delivers a section of the image  where the distorted lines have been  corrected  This is the default display mode     e Surround  Delivers a virtual Quad view as if four cameras would be po
103.  search  And it is guaranteed that a  search for specific cameras in a specified time period which is predefined and stored  by the user in MxCC will deliver the results even faster  In this case  MxCC offers the  great advantage while it does not require repetitive entry of search criteria for each  individual search     For example  the recorded event videos of the last hour and only from the cameras  at the entrances and exits are immediately displayed to a security service manager  at the push of a button  This predefined search function  one hour ago  all cameras x  to y  lets him know after each inspection round who drove onto and left the company  premises based on the recorded license plates         Fite View Layout Wideo Source Recording Teoti Help  HS v oe HBg  ARL  Haaa s   oep o       Gow       Prom oye z Sort By   DarejTime  gt   Reload   Manua              d i           Fre 6O ibis OR    Video Player Quickfinder Selected Video    In order to directly obtain video clips with many events in succession  a quickfinder with  an event histogram is displayed for immediate access using a mouse  The number  and height of the vertical bars symbolizes the number and duration of the events  many  bars   many events         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com      33 392       Filtering Events    The recordings can be filtered specifically for special event types  e g  switch contacts   IR motion sensors  doorbell  
104.  section  to play back the recorded video of the selected video source     A display window in Player mode is always attached to one video source  i e    this display element does not change its video source dynamically  in contrast to  the Alarm Player windows described in Section 3 5 5    Playback In Layouts With  Alarm Player Windows                    MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       112 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       3 5 4 Synchronized Search Playback Of Several Cameras    MxControlCenter can use time synchronized playback mode to show the recordings of  all cameras in one layout as they happened  You can use this mode for both event and  continuous recordings     This playback mode works similar to a timeline in a video editor  event recording shown  below               Firstimage Current position Timeline Time gap  0 45 2 Pa hes   ae   a   E IESS L IHSE a  Event 1 Event 2 Event 3    The only difference between the event recording shown above and continuous recording  is that continuous recording does not have any time gaps     Click on the Player mode for all video sources button in the Player sidebar  the button  turns yellow once all video sources are in Player mode   Then activate the Syne checkbox  to enable synchronized playback  The entire playback now follows these rules     e The timeline starts at the first available recording and ends at the last available  recording  
105.  select File  gt  Print to PDF from the menu          Document the status of the cameras that are using a file server NAS as storage  target as follows  In the browser  click on the Player button on one camera per  storage target  click again on the Player button and store the entire HTML page   with images  or copy the HTML page to a text document     MOBOTIX Q24 Cam1 B10 F2 S3 A210 Camera List      00   J  as  Admin Menu Source Date from Date to Sequences Images Usage  Mbytes  Limits  Setup Menu     D  Internal Recorder 2011 09 06 13 04 00 2011 09 06 13 10 00 7 63 53 of 64    Arm  amp  Record   P   Camt B10 F2 S3 A210 2011 09 06 01 46 00 2011 09 06 13 10 00 6680 2942 of 3000    Audioon     P  fh  mx10 2 1 43 2011 09 06 13 09 54 2011 09 06 13 10 32 25 4 of 1024  MxPEG on     P   A mx10 2 24 80 2011 09 06 13 04 00 2011 09 06 13 10 00 52 23 of 1024       MxPEG off I   P   y mx10 3 205 236 2011 09 06 03 41 23 2011 09 06 11 26 59 6442 1021 of 1024  LEDs Blink    P     mx10 3 30 151 2011 09 06 11 45 02 2011 09 06 13 10 01 72 22 of 1024  E  __Piay Sound    F  y mx10 3 94 200 2011 09 06 13 03 46 2011 09 06 13 10 00 56  370f 1024  Play Last  _Pay Last evel  F  Q mx10 9 42 99 2011 09 06 12 05 51 2011 09 06 12 06 09 8 3 of 1024  Event ust    Mul Total Usage 4052 of 9144  Free Space on File Server 1899679       e Backup the system         Create a camera backup using the Update Assistant  see Section 5 1 8    Backing  Up And Restoring The Entire System            Create an MxControlCen
106.  sidebar     MxControlCenter   Overview   Outside  File View Layout VideoSource Recording Tools Help    H4 Overview   Outside HH Main Entrance EH West gate FA Parking       This toolbar replaces the existing toolbar     The layout buttons follow the order of the LAYOUTS section of the Navigator sidebar  panel from top to bottom              To Activate The Layout Buttons   e Select Tools  gt  Options from the menu   e Open the View tab   e  n the Layouts section  activate the Layout buttons in toolbar checkbox     e Enter the number of layouts to show in the toolbar  counted from the top of the layout  list as shown in the LAYOUTS section of the Navigator sidebar panel      e if you want to show the toolbar with the layout buttons at the bottom of the applica   tion  activate the Show toolbar at bottom checkbox        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Setting Up Live Video Monitoring    179 392       e Click on OK to close the dialog     How can I maximize the number of layout buttons in the toolbar   e Choose a wide computer monitor   e Maximize the MxControlCenter application     e Use short layout names           Setting The Start Layout    MxControlCenter automatically shows the start layout if Tools  gt  General  gt  On Startup  gt   Load   start has been set to Start layout     To define a start layout  proceed as described in   Setting A Start Layout   in Section 4 2 5     More Options When Editing Layou
107.  starts checking immediately  While the check is running  you  will see the rolling ring and the sequence number MxControlCenter is currently  checking  red frame in figure below      Check Data Integrity  Data Integrity Check Detected Problems    a 4q24 thilo2  V  47 Sequences OK    a 1940 Sequences not signed     x 3 Sequences  Integrity problem    Q24 thilo2  20692  1 4 11 2 30 00 PM OK      Certificates               e Click on the Certificates button to get more information on the camera certificate   MxControlCenter will also open this dialog automatically if it detects problems with  the certificate  e g  if it has expired      Once MxControlCenter has finished checking the video sequences  the rolling ring disap   pears and the results are listed in the Check Data Integrity dialog        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Saving  Printing And Exporting    133 392       3 6 Saving  Printing And Exporting    Once you have identified the recordings you want to present to the authorities  you can  save specific images or create videos from the recordings of one or more cameras     3 6 1 Saving Single Images    This process comprises finding a good image to save  storing the file as an image on the  desktop and sending it off via e mail  for example   To store an image on your desktop    e Select the camera you want to use  yellow frame     e lf you want to save an image from a recording         Make sure that
108.  that the PTZ Controls sidebar panel A  is visible or use the joystick attached to the qi   gt o  computer           Vv e2   e Right click on the camera in the layout  ea    a  e Select Properties from the context menu  salaia  Auto Move  6  0 js      e Move the Properties dialog so you can see the aooo  dialog  the PTZ Controls sidebar panel and the DEEE    camera image        e in the Properties dialog  click on the PTZ Rotor tab   e Zoom into the image using the slider of the PTZ Controls        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Live Video Surveillance 8 9  3 9 2       e Find the setting that is best for you  PTZ   In Camera        Activate deactivate the two Joystick control   Joystick controt  7 Invert horizontal direction   options as required  see figure to the right   ee A       Click on Apply to test the settings  do not  lt  O  close the dialog yet   X           Move the joystick and check if the joystick works as you need it  If this is not the vV  case  repeat the last two steps until you have found your setting     e Once you have found the setting that is best for you  click on OK to close the Properties  dialog     e Repeat the process for all other cameras     Using The Preset Views    Every one of the buttons 1 through 15 can be used to save and open a specific position     and zoom level of a camera view  Click the corresponding button for three seconds to  s   save a specified camera view  Cl
109.  the Setup button at the bottom of the Recording tab to open the External  Recording dialog  Click on Allow when prompted to run an unidentified program        This tab of the Camera Configuration dialog allows selecting several cameras   Use CTRL SHIFT click   Any changes to this tab are applied to all selected cameras        Using The    External Recording    Dialog    You can use this dialog to set up external recording for the camera depending on the  options selected at the top of the dialog     Option 1  Create A Shared Folder On This Computer    Use this option if you would like to set up EB een Recording    Target Comput    a share and a corresponding user for the  camera  a  Teannas    e  f this computer has two network  interface cards  select an IP Address     e Enter a name for the Shared Folder   e g  mxdata      e Seta Local path by selecting an exist   ing creating a new folder  e g  C     mxdata      e Select an existing User name and  enter the corresponding Password  or create a new user by clicking on  Create           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    206 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       Click on Apply to create the user and the shared folder   Check the Details box if everything has been set up properly     Option 2  Use A Different Server Or Storage Medium    Use this option if you want to use camera   BS Recording    hardware  built in or attached  or a different    Tar
110.  the camera is in Player mode  it shows a red recording icon in  the top right corner          Navigate to the image you want to store using the controls in the Player section  of the sidebar     e Click on the Save current image to desktop button to store the current image as     JPEG file  default      MxControlCenter saves the current file to the desktop and assigns a file name as follows     Syntax    lt camera name gt  _ lt yyyymmdd hhmm gt   lt sequence no gt   lt extension gt     Example   east gate 20101123 1453 374 jpg       You can now attach the file s  to an e mail  for example     Selecting The File Format    By default  MxControlCenter uses the   JPEG image format  Click on the down arrow to  the right of the Save current image to desktop button and select the format you want to  use  see Notes below   MxControlCenter saves an image with the selected format to the  desktop and uses this format from now on     e You can also use this feature on Live image windows     e Bitmap  BMP  images are usually larger than JPEG images  the image informa   tion in JPEGs is compressed   As an example  a QXGA image with 2048x1536  pixels uses 12 MB when saved as a BMP  at 32 bit color depth   but the same  image as JPEG uses approx  240 kB without any visible loss in detail  You should  thus use JPEG images whenever possible                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    T  c        CE    vV Automatic    Rite
111.  the figure at the    right appears  Select your user name and enter the  corresponding password to start MxControlCenter           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Elements Of The Application Window 6 3   3 9 2       3 1 Elements Of The Application Window    Upon launching  MxControlCenter opens its application window  showing the following elements     Title bar Menu bar Toolbar    Tools Help     OG HO G sselageo d sax    More Information on  page 64             Alarm list Display area  shows lay  Status bar        outs with video sources  Sidebar with panels and event searches     What Are Layouts And Video Sources     A layoutdisplays the video streams of one or more video sourcesin MxControlCenter   s  display area  The following layout types are available     e A   Grid Layout shows the video sources in a grid with either fixed sizes or an  automatic grid layout     e A   Background Layout shows the video sources in front of a background image   e g  a map of the building  either as a video window or an icon     Layouts can be grouped in the Navigator sidebar panel to provide a structured  tree  view     A video source is any source offering video content that can be displayed in  MxControlCenter  The term not only refers to MOBOTIX cameras  but also to third   party IP cameras  recordings stored on file servers     file server paths     and on   Snap  Server   NAS systems  MxPEG clips and analog cameras
112.  the image at  Eh roe   ars  re  cem    the top and the bottom of the image      V  Fxternal Recording          e Set the event triggers that start a recording         Inthe Recording Start and Duration group box  activate the All Events checkbox  in the Start Trigger list           As of now  MxControlCenter can only configure some of the event triggers that  are listed on this tab of the Camera Configuration dialog  Until this dialog can  configure all event triggers of the camera  the gray entries need to be config   ured manually in the camera   s browser interface  click on the Open camera  in browser button and then on Setup Menu  gt  Event Settings in the browser         e Click on Apply and wait until the camera configuration has been saved        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring Alarms And Recordings    199 392          Click on the Image Settings tab to change the image resolution  size  of the camera           If you are setting up a professional video surveillance system  you need to make  sure that all recordings are signed  see Section 4 8 5    Signing The Recorded Video  Data     This ensures that the owners operators of the system can use the record   ings in a court of law           4 5 3 Configuring MxControlCenter Reactions    In this section  you will activate the alarm list  the reception of alarm messages  the alarm  sound to play on the MxControlCenter computer and the instru
113.  the playback buttons execute the correspond   ing functions simultaneously for all  Player  windows     Click again on this button to return all windows to their original state  as defined in the layout         The Player mode for all video sources button will only stay pressed if MxControlCenter  finds at least one recording for each of the live windows        Section 3 5 4    Synchronized Search Playback Of Several Cameras   provides more infor   mation on how to play back the recordings in time synchronized fashion  i e  like playing  back all recordings according to a timeline      3 5 3 Search Playback In Layouts With Display Windows In Player Mode    Since the layouts can be created very flexibly  you may have layouts that contain both  player and live windows  While this may sound like a good idea in theory  layouts should  contain either only live windows or only player windows to avoid confusing live and  recorded images  One layout with live images could be called Overview  Live  while  the same layout with player windows would be called Overview  Player   You can  thus switch layouts to see either only Live or only Player windows  Note that the Player  windows always show the last recorded event  provided that the corresponding video  sources have recorded at least one event      To see the recorded video footage of one video source  click on the video source to select  it  yellow frame   You can now use the playback buttons    Navigating The Recordings   in  this
114.  to enter the path to   the share  e g   pativioss   Note  The pedia r has to wane mounting rights to the camera   Username of the camera account on Windows   Password of the camera account on Windows   Mode used for NTLM authentication     Unlimited M amp dmum size in megabytes used to store alarm images and  sequences        Time to Keep   Days   Hours      Unlimited Maximum time to keep alarm images and sequences before  removing   Number of Sequences   l M Unlimited Maximum number of sequences to store        Factory     _ Restore          e Click on Set     Make sure that you are using at least the Storage Size limit and also make sure  that the cameras have enough storage space on the storage target  Use the other  storage limits  Time to Keep  or Number of Sequences  as required              MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Creating And Distributing A Camera Master Configuration    345 392       Creating Required E Mail Profiles    In order to be able to send storage failure messages and error notifications to IT staff   owners or security staff later on  you should set the global e mail options and create the  required e mail profiles now  Open Admin Menu  gt  Transfer Profiles  gt  E Mail Profiles in  the browser and proceed as outlined in the camera help     Setting Up Storage Failure Detection    In case the selected storage target fails  the camera must send an e mail  Open Admin  Menu  gt  Storage
115.  to store the configuration of that camera and  upload its configuration to all other cameras  While doing so  you can instruct the  Update Assistant to only update the Security section of the camera configuration   see Section 5 1 7    Saving And Uploading Settings Of One Or More Cameras              Settings In MxControlCenter    Restrict access to ports of the MxControlCenter computer after testing  By default   the ports for alarm handling and for remotely controlling MxControlCenter can be  used by any computer on the network  By entering the IP addresses of cameras or  other MxControlCenter computers that are allowed to access these ports  you can  restrict access to specific computers only         On the Alarm Handling tab  enter the IP addresses of devices that are allowed  to send alarm messages in the Allowed IP addresses field         On the Remote Control tab  enter the IP addresses of devices that are allowed  to remote control MxControlCenter in the Allowed IP addresses field     Network messages from unlisted IP addresses will now be rejected     On the Alarm Handling tab  make sure the Accept only    camnotify    and    MxCC  Alarm    message types option in the Alarm messages section is activated     Do not use any of the ports  user names  passwords or other entries that appear  in this manual     Enter the user name and password of the dedicated MOBOTIX camera user to access  the cameras  see   Camera Settings  In The Browser    above         MOBOTIX AG    
116.  use the user interface  softbuttons  of the camera to pan and tilt the camera     Assembling And Activating A Pan Tilt Head In The Camera    e Attach the MOBOTIX camera to the mounting bracket on the pan tilt head     e Connect the supplied control cable of the pan tilt head to the D SUB 15HD connector  of the MOBOTIX camera     e Connect the pan tilt head and camera to the power supply     e Configure the serial interface of the MOBOTIX camera  Admin Menu  gt  Configure  Serial Interface  see figure below      e Save the configuration to the permanent flash memory of the MOBOTIX camera   Admin Menu  gt  Save  and reboot the MOBOTIX camera     fA     MOBOTIX X99 cke m12 d43 rotor Serielle Schnittstelle und Modem  Serielle Schnittstelle und Modem    Serielle  Schnittstelle     Geschwindigkeit     Bits     Stop Bits     Flusskontrolle     Echo   Zeilenendezeichen   Puffergr    e     Zeitstempel     Daten ey    Terminal  und Logger Mode       Aus  Serelie Scnnimstelic ist deaktivien    Daten  Seriele Scnnitistelie 10r Datenterminal oder t  r erweltenen  Schaltein  ausgang verwenden    Modem  Seriele Schnitistelie 101 Modem  Telefon oder GSM   verwenden    Wetter  Seriele Schnmstelie 10r den Emptang von Wetterdaten einer  unterst0izion Welterstation verwenden    Terminal  und Logger Mode  Erlaudt Terminaimodus  Remotezugrit   und Protokollierung    EinvAusgabemodus  Verwendung der drei zus  tzlichen Pins   Automodus  Automatische Umschaltung  falis m  glich     Uventragungsgesch
117.  used by MOBOTIX cameras to store audio video recordings     RoHS  Abbreviation of Restriction of Hazardous Substances Directive  Refers to EC Directive 2002 95   EC  which prohibits the use of certain hazardous substances when manufacturing products  and components  The goal of this directive is to prevent these substances from harming the  environment when the products are recycled after their useful life     Router  Network device that connects multiple networks with one another  The router creates the  physical connection between the devices in different networks  like a hub   analyzes the  relevant data packets and forwards     routes     these packets to the correct target network     SD Card   microSD card  Also called SD Memory Card  abbreviation of Secure Digital Memory Cara   A digital storage  medium based on flash storage modules such as USB sticks     Search  Monitoring of recordings  searching for a particular event     Sequencer  Feature that automatically switches the camera displayed in the main window after a specific  time delay     SIP  Abbreviation of Session Initiation Protocol  Network protocol for setting up  controlling and  terminating a communication connection via a computer network  SIP is frequently used by    IP Phones and   Softphones  but more recently also for   Video SIP        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    375 392       Signal Input Signal Output  Coupling an alarm trigge
118.  using the remote control functions of MxControlCenter     For the purpose of this section  we are assuming the following   e You have activated the Layout Manager     e You know how to deactivate the Layout Manager  see Section 4 2    Creating  And Editing Layouts        e You know how to store the configuration  see Section 4 9 2    Saving Program  Settings And Exporting Installations        e You have set up a computer to run MxStatus  Section 4 1 6    MxStatus  Status  Monitoring For Multiple MxControlCenter Computers                 4 3 1 Planning A Layout Structure    If you only have a few cameras  twelve or less   you can use a simple approach     e Create one layout for every four cameras with live camera windows  with each layout  name having a      Live    postfix      e Create the same layouts with player windows  with each layout name having a         Player    postfix      Grouping Cameras In Layouts    If the system uses more cameras  you should first try to create groups of cameras that  are at the same location or that are fulfilling the same fasks  Note that the following list  contains only examples that are supposed to pique your imagination    e Grouping by location         All cameras at the West gate of the factory go in one group  all cameras at the  East gate go in another group         All cameras overlooking the parking lot go in one group        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com        
119.  using the same file server  make sure  to use the correct path  factory IP address with underscore characters      You can now use the MxControlCenter data integrity check on file server paths that have  been added as video sources and that are not attached to any camera     Testing The Digital Signature    To test the digital signature  proceed as described in   Running The Data Integrity Check    of Section 3 5 12    Checking The Data Integrity Of Recordings          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Security Considerations    229 392       MxControlCenter will show a separate dialog to warn you if the certificate is invalid   generated or self certified     4 8 6 Configuring And Monitoring The Action Log    MxControlCenter   s action log records all actions performed by the application and the  cameras in an encrypted file  The action log also contains the reasons a user has entered  if you are requiring such a reason for specific actions  see Section 4 7 4    Requiring Users  To Enter A Reason For An Action        Configuring The Action Log    To configure the action log  select Tools  gt  Options from the menu and click on the Action  Log tab   Setting A Different Location For The Action Log    e In the Action Log File group box  click on the browse button       and navigate to a  folder of your choice     e Use the proposed file name or set a new one  then click on OK   e  f required  fill in the User na
120.  video for interesting scenes and export them if a case of  fraud has been discovered  for example        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Additional User Functions       Notes                                                                                  MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com         5 O   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       4 SYSTEM CONFIGURATION    The previous chapter has shown how to use MxControlCenter in a video surveillance  installation  In this chapter  you will learn how to configure MxControlCenter and MOBOTIX  cameras so that you can get a video surveillance system up and running     You will learn how to set up layouts  how to configure live video surveillance  how to  adjust the user interface  how to modify camera settings  how to set up the alerting and  recording functions  how to configure playback and evaluation of recordings and how to  adjust the options for storing  printing and exporting videos  In addition  you will also find  out how to manage user groups and users  how to make the system more secure and  how to work with MxControlCenter configurations     Itis assumed that you have properly installed and connected the cameras to MxControlCenter   see Chapter 2     System Installation and Initial Operation     and that you are familiar with  the basic operation of the application  see Chapter 3
121.  video wall      e Third party systems remotely control MxControlCenter to show specific layouts or  cameras  e g  a video wall in a traffic control center      e Camera remotely controls MxControlCenter  e g  to add an alarm image to the  alarm list even though the camera is not part of the current layout  see Section 4 5     Configuring Alarms And Recordings        Network messages are also used to trigger alarms in MxControlCenter  For more  information on this topic  see Section 4 5 1    Configuring Alarms on the Cameras       You only need to activate remote control  if you want to remote control MxControlCenter  from a different application or another instance of MxControlCenter running on a  different computer                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com      8 2   392 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       Example Application  Remote Controlled Video Wall    In this example  we will use an MxControlCenter workstation to remotely control other  MxControlCenter instances running on client computers with one monitor each  The work   station uses command buttons on a background layout to switch the layouts that have  been defined on the client computers  see figure below      MxCC workstation       Client 1 Client 2 Client 3 Client 4  192 168 1 201 192 168 1 202 192 168 1 203 192 168 1 204       Monitor 1 Monitor 2 Monitor 3 Monitor 4       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany   
122.  visual indication of the time range  during the entire recording period  By selecting an event in the list  the image associated  with that event is displayed in the area of the player window at the right     If you have identified an event as relevant   the time of the event can be defined as the  Reference time  MxControlCenter now  shows the time difference between the  reference time and the image that is currently displayed in the player window           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    128 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       a      S    GJE    The reference time works similar to the    global playback time    in the Player sidebar  panel    Playing Back Events   in Section 3 5 2    Search Playback In A Live Display  Window                 The Reference time follows image time button automatically sets the reference time to  the time of the image that is currently displayed     The Unlock Reference Time button deletes the reference time     Showing Only Layout Cameras    Having many cameras in the Cameras list can make finding the proper cameras a tedious  task  In order to narrow down the list of cameras to those in the current layout  you can  activate the Only show cameras from the current layout button     Filtering Events    If you want to search for special event types  for example  video motion detection only    you can filter the Events list  To do so  click on the Set event filt
123.  way  you can make sure that the  camera only analyzes objects that are relevant for you  Select the Object size option  A  predefined object size  red square  opens     e Proceed as follows to adjust this square       Use the mouse to drag the square to the desired position       Drag the corner of the square using your mouse to increase or decrease its size         Use your mouse to draw a new square     Counting Lines  Define the counting lines here  Select the Counting lines option     e Use the mouse to draw the counting lines in the desired positions and in the desired  directions  Fields for editing the counting lines open at the lower edge of the window         Start and end coordinates  Useful for precise synchronization of the counting lines     Counting line ID  Assigned automatically         Name  east title and west title  Name of the counting line and name of the  counting direction     e To delete a counting line  select the counting line and hit the DELETE key on the  keyboard  or select the Delete command in the shortcut menu      Reference Image    The frequency of the movements in specific time periods is shown in heat maps  It is use   ful if evaluations are based on the same background image in order to better compare  heat maps for different time periods with one another or in the event that no people can  be detected in the image  To do this  specify a reference image by clicking on the Save  reference image button     We recommend testing the effects o
124.  working with smaller security systems that only have one computer  chances  are that you do not need to bother working with different configuration files  For larger  installations  you may want to create different configuration files for testing and for the  individual workstations  for example        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Working With MxControlCenter Configurations 2 3 3   3 Q 2       You can store the current configuration by doing one of the following     e Save configuration  Click on this toolbar button to save the current configuration file   e File  gt  Save  Select this menu command to save the current configuration file     e File  gt  Save as  Select this menu command to open the Save Configuration as   dialog  This dialog can save the current configuration file with a different name  and   to a different location      e File  gt  Export configuration  Select this menu command to open the Export  Configuration dialog  This dialog provides more options for creating MxContro Center  packages  see   The Export Configuration Dialog   below         To see which configuration file MxControlCenter is currently using  select Tools  gt   Options from the menu and check the Configuration line at the bottom of the dialog        The Export Configuration Dialog    This dialog allows creating differ   ent types of configuration copies  by using one of the options below     Export Configuration    a  S
125.  www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 84   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features           Close the Options dialog by clicking on OK     Step 2  Instruct MxControlCenter To Use Default Preview Data For Video Sources    Access Recordings jes     B Select how MxControlCenter should access the recordings of     e Parking 1    Downtown office       Via camera  Default file server path  factory IP address will be appended   Specific file server path  factory IP will be appended    Specific File Server    J  Use preview data for playback and Video Search  Lok   cance       e Select allvideo sources in the Navigator sidebar panel  VIDEO SOURCES  gt  Cameras  section  that should be using the default preview settings as specified in Step 1     e Right click and select Access Recordings from the context menu     e Inthe Access Recordings dialog  activate the Use preview data for playback and  Video Search checkbox  red frame in the figure      e Click on OK        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Using MxRemotePreview To Access Remote Recordings 2  amp  5   3 9 2       Step 3  Use Specific MxRemotePreview Servers For Video Sources    e Select the video sources in the Navigator sidebar panel that should be using  MxRemotePreview servers other than the one specified in the default preview set   tings in Step 1     e Right click and select Properties from the context menu  MxControlCenter opens  one Properties o
126.  www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Creating And Distributing A Camera Master Configuration 343   3 92       Access Rights Guest Live Player MultiView PDA      Disable all      remote    mxce    Open Users and Passwords to manage users and to assign groups     o Pateummmmmned LO S    Set X Factory  Restore X Close         e Replace the guests group name by remote  Activate the Live and Multiview  checkbox for this group   e Replace the users group name by mxcc  Activate the Admin checkbox     e Click on Set     Creating The Users    e Click on Security  gt  Users and Passwords   e Create at least one user per group and assign user names as in the figure below     Open Group Access Control Lists to manage the group definitions and to set the group access rights     Caution   Make sure to store user names and passwords in a safe place   There is absolutely no back door into the camera without the administrator s login   Passwords have changed   if you are prompted for a password  remember to enter the new password       Set YO factory XC Restore XC Cose               e Click on Set to apply the changes  Note that the camera will ask you for the user  name and password of an admin user  e g  andrew in the example    Setting The Language And Start Page  e Click on Page Administration  gt  Language and Start Page     e Select the start page  set the language and click on Set   Setting The Ethernet Interface    e Click on Network Setup  gt  Ethernet Interface   e Deactivate BO
127.  www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Setting Up Live Video Monitoring    183 392       Configuring The Remote Control Functions Of MxControlCenter  Setting up the remote control functions of MxControlCenter involves the following steps     1  Activate and configure the remote control port in MxControlCenter   2  Read the list of remote control commands    3  Test the remote control   4     Configure the application device to send a remote command     Step 1  Activate And Configure The Remote Control Port In MxControlCenter    e Select Tools  gt  Options from the MxControlCenter menu   e Click on the Remote Control tab     e Inthe Remote Control box  activate the Activate checkbox     e Enter a port in the Port field  for this example  we will be using 31667         Avoid the Well Known Ports  When assigning a port for the remote control func   tions of MxControlCenter  make sure that you do not use any of the ports used by  other TCP IP services  For more information  refer to the List of TCP and UDP port  numbers topic on en wikipedia org           e Optionally enter the IP addresses of devices that are allowed to access this port of  the computer from the outside in the Allowed IP addresses field  for this example   we will be using 192 168 1 234      e Set the Sound options as desired or select a sound file to play if MxControlCenter  receives a remote control command     The Remote Control group of the Options dialog should now look like this     Remote Control    J  
128.  you  will be prompted to open Update Assistant  the installation itself works as described in  Section 5 1 5    Updating The Software Of MOBOTIX Cameras           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Update Assistant   Software Updates And More 245   3 9 2    5 1 6 Installing MOBOTIX Application Software       If you would like to get the newest MOBOTIX Sere Packages nos  application software  you can click onthe    2m Stem aa s anguages__Sxtension   Applications tab of the Software Packages EX  panel  The dropdown in the bottom right     corner of the panel  red frame in the figure     080 Wind4 Win32 11 19 2010  en iol       ilteri MxC iCent 2 4 0  allows filtering the packages  FN xControlcenter 4  Win64 Win32 7 22 2010  exe Spanish    To install a software  select it and click on  the Install button  Update Assistant down  MxControlcenter 2 4 0    loads the software and offers to install the   ae    exe ian  software     z  Camera    Applications     Win exe x x    5 1 7 Saving And Uploading Settings Of One Or More Cameras    Update Assistant allows creating backup of configuration files based on the cameras  shown in the camera list  To create a backup file for all cameras in the camera list  you  can also use the system backup function described in Section 5 1 8    Backing Up And  Restoring The Entire System       Creating A Backup Configuration File For One Or More Cameras    1  Select one or more cameras 
129.  you can dynamically assign different MOBOTIX cameras to the focus windows        Gelandeplan    To show the camera of a status icon in a focus window       Click on the focus window to select it   2 Click on the status icon to display the camera     Repeat clicking on a focus window  then on a status icon to see the corresponding live  stream in the focus window        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Creating And Editing Layouts    165 392       4 2 3 Defining Grid Layouts    By definition  grid layouts only have display windows  in con   trast to background layouts  which have a background   see  Section 4 2 4   Grid layouts are specifically suited to implement  systems in which showing the video sources is most important     Assigning Video Sources To Grid Layouts    1     Navigator  a A    4   Overview   Outside   B man Entrance    a VIDE    Activate the Layout Manager  see   Activating The Layout ros p  Managerin Section 4 2    Creating And Editing Layouts     2 d12 ti    Select the layout you want to edit  for example  Main a  site  Entrance  or create a new grid layout  see Section 4 2 1  anina      Creating Layouts        Select a grid type in the Grids panel  for example  VGA   VGA VGA VGA as highlighted by the red frame in the  figure      Confirm the system prompt  The display area of  MxControlCenter now uses the new grid     Assign a video source to a display window using one of these methods     
130.  you can use fo find relevant video  clips  to examine their contents and to check the data integrity     Before we start examining the different ways to play back recordings  however  let us take  a brief look at the types of recording offered by the MOBOTIX cameras     Snapshot Recording  Event Recording  Continuous Recording  MOBOTIX cameras basically provide three modes for recording video data     e Snapshot Recording  When the camera detects one of the activated events  it creates  an alarm and records the alarm images as individual     j pg images without audio   The images are stored as an image series based on pre alarm images  the alarm  image itself  showing the event that triggered the alarm  and post alarm images     e Event Recording  This recording mode is also based on the camera   s event triggers  to start recording  but records MxPEG clips     mxg files  that can include the audio  channel of the camera microphone  provided the camera microphone has been  activated   This is the default recording mode     e Continuous Recording  Stores continuous video and audio data as MxPEG clips   Recording usually uses reduced frame rates  e g  2 fps  and the camera can auto   matically increase the frame rate when the camera detects an event  Continuous  recording is only available if you have sufficient storage capacity  on an SD CF card  or file server      For more information on how to set up the individual recording modes  Section 4 5 3     Configuring MxControlCe
131.  you need to  set up a different start layout  you can do so yourself  provided you have the proper rights   right click on a layout in the Navigator panel  then select Use as Start Layout from the  context menu   If you do not have these rights  you should contact your system administra   tor to set a different start layout for you     3 2 2 Switching Layouts    Switching between different layouts is one of the main tasks when you are working with  many cameras  There are three methods to switch between the layouts of your  MxControlCenter installation     e Navigator  Make sure that the sidebar is visible  View  gt    Navigator    Sidebar  gt  Show  and the Navigator panel is open   4 ayvours  4 aj  Outside    EJ Overview    The layouts are grouped and have names that should  describe their purpose  Select the layout you want to  see  you may have to open a group by clicking on the  open icon in front of the group name       B Parking lot   B North side     B East side  See   Arranging Grouping Layouts In The Layout ii    Manager   in Section 4 3 2    Configuring Layout Selection       e Layout buttons within background  layouts  These buttons allow    Overview   Outside          aoe     t  A  nP  4     eo  p LY    FMD  S AS     ji  Jertrum f  r             switching directly from one layout to ne Wael E SEE    mee interdiszipl ait   the next  Asan example  you could    Forsch amg  2 West gate  switch from the country overview eee  as WEE  to one region  then to one city an
132. 0    MxStatus localhost 80     q   lt Enter gt  to quit     Server socket listening on addr   0 0 0 0 8080    status gt     mxstatus 172 16 0 20     lt port gt   Use this parameter if    you need a different port than the default port 8080     Note that you need to enter both parameters even though you only want to set a  specific port  enter 0 0 0 0 as first parameter to use this port on all network cards      mxstatus 172 16 0 20 9000    When running the application for the first time  Windows will ask if it should continue  to      P Windows Security Alert    G Windows Firewall has blocked some features of this program    Windows Firewall has blocked this program from accepting incoming network connections  If you  unblock this 2 progom  twi be unbioded on all private networks that you connect to  ihat arg    fhe rake of u     8       MxStatus exe   Unimown   C  users V mace 2  S mxstatus exe  Private network          block the program  Make sure that you click on  Unblock in the Windows Security Alert dialog  shown on the left  may look different depending  on your Windows version        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Getting Started    155 392       Running MxStatus As A Scheduled Task    When setting up a professional system with several MxControlCenter workstations  it is  recommended to start MxStatus as a Scheduled Task every time the computer is started   If you do not know how to do this  or you do
133. 0   0   0  listens to all IP addresses of all network  interface cards  NICs  of this computer  Only change this setting if you have several  NICs installed on this computer and you want MxServer to listen only on a specific NIC     e Write down the assigned port number  e g  1132   red frame in figure    e Enter a Channel name that describes the camera s purpose or location     To access the camera in the web browser  you need to know the IP address of the MxServer  computer and the port that connects to this channel  In this example  the correct address  for accessing the camera in the browser would be     http    lt IP address of MxServer gt  1132        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Channels       System state    eee  channels     Analog Falcon 1 0    KOCOM       Analog Falcon 1 1    2 Analog Falcon 2 0   lt   BOSCH Autodome    Analog Falcon 2 1       274 392    MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       Using An Analog PTZ Camera In MxControlCenter    To use this camera in MxControlCenter  enter the IP address and port of the MxServer  computer as described in  Sfep 3  Add The Analog PTZ Camera In MxControlCenter As  An MxServer Channel   of Section 5 4 3    Integrating Analog Third Party PTZ Cameras       5 5 4 Connecting A Third Party IP Camera To MxServer    In this scenario  MxServer is only used to store the   M JPEG images from a third party  IP camera in a file server structure  figure in Section
134. 0 1x MI2DNight  car dealership  1 398  Costs 13 200 5 238  Network infrastructure  500 m coaxial cabling 1 000 300mCAT 5 cabling 600  co  500 m power supply cabling 1 000 1x 8 port switch 500 E  5  Costs 2 000 1100            z  V  Camera software   licenses 3  Costs 1 000 oE    D     Central recording Internal video recording D  DVR system   software 4 900 6x SD card 4 GB incl  0 g  2  Total costs 21 100 6 338    This example is based on an average gas station with four lanes  store  car Savi  wash and repair shop  The left column shows the costs of a conventional aa  o    centralized storage video systems while the right column shows the costs of    MOBOTIX  According to the calculations in this example  the savings with MOBOTIX    come to 70    the reasons are simple  Fewer cameras thanks to more detail  no  software costs  no additional data storage devices  no weatherproof housing with    heating and less cabling        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       1392    42 392    MxCC User Manual  An Example  Donbass Arena  Ukraine          A total of  approximately 1 200  kilometers of electri   cal and data cable  was installed in the  Donbass Arena    MOBOTIX cameras  and MxCC fulfill  the highest UEFA  requirements with   out problems      A Football Dome Of Superlatives    The Donbass Arena built in the Ukrainian industrial  city of Donezk for 400 million US dollars opened  its doors on August 29  2009  The 
135. 0 for reference windows  see below      e Reference  Activate this checkbox to use this window as a reference window  These  windows are used to avoid false alarms for events that would be triggered by video  motion windows  e g  if lighting conditions change rapidly  sun and cloudy sky   headlights from cars  etc    As soon as a reference window triggers  all other video  motion windows of the same VM set are deactivated     Reference windows have the following colors         Video Motion 1  Yellow outline and background        Video Motion 2  Green outline and background       Make sure that you are creating reference windows outside of the other video  motion windows and at a position in the image where no movements are  to be expected  e g  on a blank wall above a window that does not get any  direct sunlight               MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Camera Configuration    Dialog 3 2 V  3 9 2    6 3 7 The    Network Messages    Tab       This tab allows sending alarm messages  i e   special IP network messages  from the  selected cameras to a list of MxControlCenter computers  the alarm targets  In addition   you can select the event triggers that will prompt the cameras to send network messages     This tab contains the following sections     Camera Configuration    BeBbwea      Overview Image Settings Exposure Recording Audio Events Network Messages Time Server MxAnalytics       Name Alarm T
136. 05    Camera softbuttons 18  CamlO  glossary  352  CCTV  glossary  353  CF card  glossary  353  CIF  glossary  353  CMOS  glossary  353    Commands  Display 89  Scaling 89    Common time server  Configuring 146    Concept  Decentralized MOBOTIX concept 14    Configurations  Backing up camera configurations 234  Restoring camera configurations 234  Saving camera configurations  Saving initial 59  Using different 219  Working with 216    Configuring   Action log 214   Alarms 189   Alarms  overview  187   Common time server 146   Dead Man   s Switch 216   Display functions 181   Functions for minimized hidden  MxControlCenter 186   Layout selection 171    MxControlCenter reactions to alarms 192  MxControlCenter views 183  Program views 181  Recording 191   Recordings  overview  187  Recording targets 197  Remote control 175   Scaling functions 181  Sequencers 173   Snap Server Settings 239  Toolbar 182   User interface 181   Video sources 53   Video wall 175    Connecting  Analog PTZ cameras to MxServer  Remote cameras using DynDNS 240  Third party IP cameras to MxServer 263  Third party IP camera to MxServer 263    Connection Defaults  Options tab 282    Connections  Encrypting connections to cameras 208  Monitoring  to the camera 215    Connection status  Checking  Update Assistant  227    Correcting  Distortion 34    Creating  Event searches 114  Groups 201  Groups  overview  201  Layouts 151  Layouts  overview  149  Users 201  Users  overview  201       MOBOTIX AG    Securit
137. 3   4  5 18 can be updated to 3 5 2 23 r3    e Cameras with software version MX V4   0  2   33   r2 can be updated to 4 0 4 19             Make sure that you are installing the proper MX System version  3 5 2 23 83  language version for cameras with soft  ee ae ee eee  A Fie  MX_system_de_3_5223r3 mpi   ware versions 3  X and lower  see red frame Software version in all available languages for al MOBOTIX M12  D12      2 s V12  M22M  D22M and Q22M cameras  Besides the many proven  IN figure   Camera softwa re versions 4 x features of the nirien versions  this e ers number of         improvements and enhancements n exposure control   im age settings   and higher contain all available languages  See re Hemme i Rx ED Sera ond a oem Acie                Do not close MxControlCenter or Update Assistant during the software update  process  You should also avoid any power failures or disruptions of the network  connection to the cameras              Downloading And Updating The Software In One Step    e Sort the camera list by version  click on the Version column heading      GS e Make sure that all cameras you would like to update are showing the OK connection  Status     e Select all cameras with the same first digit of the software version you would like  to update     e Click on the software with the same first digit on the Camera tab of the Software  Packages panel        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Update As
138. 4 7 1    Creating And Editing Groups And Users       4 Playback  For this example  the user names are    mike    and gary          gary     respectively   e Activate the Group Rights tab     e Forthe Union Representatives group  activate the Authorize checkbox in the  Access control section  Make sure that all other rights for this group are switched off     e For the Playback group  activate the Play checkbox in the Playback  Export  amp   Printing section     e Set all other rights for the Playback group as required       Playback  Export  amp  Printing  gt  Video search  Always       Playback  Export  amp  Printing  gt  Export  Always       Playback  Export  amp  Printing  gt  Local archive  Activate checkbox       Application  gt  Quit  Activate checkbox   e Click on OK to close the dialog     You can now use this feature as outlined in Section 3 8 2    Using The Two Man Rule          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    220 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       4 7 4 Requiring Users To Enter A Reason For An Action    In some jurisdictions  users are required to enter a reason for exporting recordings  for  example  You can implement this requirement by setting the Reason user right for the  corresponding function     Example  The guards at the MxControlCenter workstation of the gate  members of the  Guards group  can work with the system  but when exporting recordings  they need    to enter a re
139. 80 Image Change host name    mx10 2 24 80       mx10 3 11 47 10 3 11 47 Image Change host name  mx10 3 11 47       mx10 3 30 151 10 3 30 151 Image Change host name  mx10 3 30 151       mx10 3 94 200 10 3 94 2 Image Change host name  mx10 3 94 200       mx10 8 195 72 10 8 195 7 Image Change host name  mx10 8 195 72       mx10 8 52 239 10 8 52 239     Image Change host name  mx10 8 52 239    Note  If your Admin password matches  this task changes the host name on selected  cameras  stores their configuration to flash and reboots those cameras     4 in EEE nll  Change   Cancel               e Change the names of the cameras according to the list provided by the planner  and click on Change     e After the camera has finished changing the names  check the results in the Manage  Other Cameras dialog     Working With Sets Of Cameras    As shown in Section A 5 6    Distributing The Master Configuration    you can use the  Update Assistant to distribute configurations from one camera to many others  Since you       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Adjusting Sets Of Cameras    351 392       can also use the Update Assistant to distribute parts     sections     of a configuration  you can  use this mechanism to apply specific settings to sets of cameras as in the examples below     e Seta specific storage target for a set of cameras  when using several file servers NAS      e Apply specific image settings  e g  the Pano
140. 9  fs  mx 10 8 104 208 10 8  104 208 MX V4 0 4  19  fs  mx 10 8 104 209 10 8  104 209 MX V4 0 4  19  OLE Sure  10 8  104 210 MX V4 0 4  19  10 8  104 211 MX V4 0 4  19  10 8  104 212 MX V4 0 4  19  10 8  104 213 MX V4 0 4  19  10 8  104 215 MX V4 0 4  19  10 8  104 216 MX V4 0 4 19  10 8  104 217 MX V4 0 4  19  10 8  104 218 MX V4 0 4  19  10 8  105 145 MX V4 0 4 19  10 8  105 146 MX V4 0 4 19   105 147 10 8  105 147 MX   4 0 4  19  OLE StS  10 8  105 148 MX V4 0 4  19       FELLEEEEEEETEEEEEEETEEE    48 video sources found   29 selected          Select all MOBOTIX cameras     4  Right click on the cameras  gt  Configure Network to open the Configure Selected  Cameras dialog     5  Activate the Use the following IP  address  range  option     6  Enter the start and end of the IP  address range for this set of cameras     R Selected Cameras    This computer accesses the following subnet s   192  168  1 0 24      Get IP address automatically  DHCP    7  Enter the subnet mask and standard    Use the following IP address  range   gateway  IP address  start   192 168 1 100  8  Click on OK to close the Configure IES s92  108  1 129    Selected Cameras dialog  ter  t   255 255 255 0    9  Wait until all cameras have rebooted     then disconnect them from the net   work   7  Store configuration in camera    Standard gateway  192 168 1 254    Lx  _ cn         MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com          3 40   3 9 2 MxCC Us
141. AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    247 392    Update Assistant   Software Updates And More          This dialog will warn you if you have selected cameras without a corresponding  configuration file     Move the mouse over a configuration section to get more information on that section           4  Click on OK to upload the configuration settings   Sections For Updating    Each section in the Sections for Updating group box corresponds to one of the following  configuration sections in the camera   s web interface  Admin Menu  gt  Configuration  gt  Edit      Section    Camera Dialogs    Configuration File Sections       User and Passwords    access                Security Group Access Control Lists  IP Level Access Control accesscontrol  FTP ales ftp i    E Mail Protiles mai  Transfer Profiles IP Notify Profles imagelink  Image Profiles ipnotify  Time Tasks Time Tasks timetasks  Time Tables Time Tables timetable  Speaker and Microphone audio  Audio Manage Audio Messages audionotify  Sound Profiles rescon  General Image Settings camdriver  aioe Settings imageimprover  Color Settings imageimprover2  Image Control JPEG pe zoomcontrol  Text  amp  Display Settings views  vPTZ Settings vpiz  time  Time and Date signals  Camera  time server  LED Setup signalout  LEDs  Error Notification weatherstat    Sensor Configuration    systemalarm  sensors   Domes             admin  ethernet  Ethernet Interface Isdn  iP address and host 
142. AL OPERATION    This chapter covers the system requirements for running MxControlCenter  You will also  learn how to connect and power up the cameras and how to install MxControlCenter     For information on howto set up an entire video surveillance system based on MxControlCenter   see Appendix A    Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline       2 1 Setting Up MxControlCenter   Overview    In this section  we will describe the most important steps for a basic installation  These  steps are the same for all scenarios     For thorough instructions regarding camera mounting  see the  nsfallation section in the  corresponding   Camera Manual    For more detailed information on the power supply and  connecting cameras to the network  see the   Network and Power Connection   section in  the corresponding   Camera Manual       Mounting And Connecting The Cameras    e Install the cameras  Determine where you want to install the cameras  Run the  Ethernet cable to the mounting position of the camera  Install the cameras and  connect the Ethernet cable to the corresponding camera     e Setup the power supply  Determine the method for supplying power to the camera   Use either MOBOTIX power supplies with Network Power Adapters or a commercial  PoE switch  see Section 2 2    Power Supply And Network Connection Of Cameras        e Connect the cameras  Connect the Ethernet cable from the cameras to the PoE switch   or the Network Power Rack Network Power Adapter   The PoE switch is usu
143. Activate  listen for TCP IP messages     Port  31667    Allowed IP addresses  192 168 1 234    Sound No sound    System sound  File       e Click on OK to apply the settings and to close the dialog        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    184 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       1  Filter Allowed IP Addresses  As a security measure  make sure that you allow  only the IP addresses of devices that actually use the remote control functions     2  Configure Windows Firewall  After setting up the ports  the Windows Firewall  normally asks whether it should continue to block the MxControlCenter appli   cation  Click on Do not block so that the required remote control ports can be  opened from external computers  This usually requires that you have administra   tor privileges on the computer  If you are using a different firewall application   you may have to manually configure the firewall to allow accessing these ports  from other computers              Step 2  Get A List Of Remote Control Commands    To get such a list  do the following   e Open a web browser on the same computer that is running MxControlCenter     e Enter the IP address  the port and the command in the browser address bar as in  the example below  see also   Step 7  Activate And Configure The Remote Control  Port In MxControlCenter        http   127 0 0 1 31667     e Press the RETURN key     The browser window should now show a list
144. Add Video Sources dialog   e Configure the connection defaults  Tools  gt  Options  gt  Connection Defaults          In the Connections to Cameras section  enter the user name and password  for accessing the cameras as defined in   Creating The Users   in Section A 5 3     Setting The Admin Menu Options    mike in the example          If a file server NAS system is used in this surveillance system  enter the path   mapped drive or UNC path  to a common file server NAS system as well as  the user name and password in the Access Recordings section  See   Setting A  Default File Server In MxControlCenter   in Section 4 5 4    Configuring Where To  Record   for more information     e Configure the other global settings as required   A 8 2 Adding Video Sources To The MxControlCenter Workstation    e Open the Add Video Sources dialog  Video Source  gt  Add in the menu   The automatic  search finds all connected MOBOTIX cameras that are currently running     e Select all MOBOTIX cameras     e Click on Add selected video sources        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 5 4   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline       4 LAYOUTS  a   Overview   Outside   B Main Entrance   B west gate   B Parking   B Garage Entrance  4 g Overview   Inside   B Reception   B Elevators   B Back Entrance   B outside   Player   B Inside   Player    4 VIDEO SOURCES    Decide whether or not to generate a layout d
145. And Open Doors 78  3 2 8 Using Image Post Processing On Live Images 78  3 2 9 Using The Virtual PTZ Functions On Live Images 80  3 2 10 Using The Live Recording Feature 90  3 3 Display Modes Of The Application Window 92  3 3 1 Scaling And Display Commands 92  3 3 2 Using Saved Views 94  3 3 3 Functions When The Application Window Is Minimized 95  3 4 How The Alarm Features Work 96  3 4 1 Visual Alarm Features 97  3 4 2 Acoustic Alarm Features 100  3 4 3 Reacting To Alarms 101  3 5 Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings 104  3 5 1 Example Scenarios 104  3 5 2 Search Playback In A Live Display Window 107  3 5 3 Search Playback In Layouts With Display Windows In Player Mode 11  3 5 4 Synchronized Search Playback Of Several Cameras 112  3 5 5 Playback In Layouts With Alarm Player Windows 13  3 5 6 Post Processing Of Recorded Images 114  3 5 7 Using The Virtual PTZ Features When Playing Back Recordings 116  3 5 8 Using Event Searches 117  3 5 9 Using Post Video Motion Detection In Recordings 124  3 5 10 Using The Video Search 127  3 5 11 Playing Back Recordings From The Local Archive 129  3 5 12 Checking The Data Integrity Of Recordings 130  3 6 Saving  Printing And Exporting 133  3 6 1 Saving Single Images 133  3 6 2 Printing Single Images 134  3 6 3 Exporting Recorded Video Footage 135  3 7 Using MxAnalytics 144  3 7 1 MxAnalytics Overview 144  3 7 2 Calling Up Evaluations 145  3 8 Additional User Functions 147  3 8 1 Working With The Dead Man s Switch 147  3 8 2 Using The Two M
146. BOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    MxCC User Manual  More Security In Case of An Alarm          Whoever understands video surveillance systems knows that the surveillance personal  has to constantly and permanently monitor the video terminals of all installed cameras  at all times in order to discover an event  and notify the police  MxCC and the intelligent  network cameras with built in sensors can detect disturbances independently and react  with the necessary actions at lightning speed  This can be done without the need for  staff surveillance and at all times         2 Way Audio                            saeee         Microphone Notification    Recording    Recordable Events By A MOBOTIX Camera    In addition to an integrated high performance computer  a modern MOBOTIX camera  has a high quality image sensor for high resolution images to be used as evidence   supported by full duplex audio with a microphone and speaker for lip synchronized  sound  a passive infrared sensor  PIR   a temperature sensor  and can be connected to   for example  external smoke sensors and an electrical door closing device via various  camera connections  Depending on the application  a camera can be programmed in  MxCC in such a way to automatically     e record movements and persons in the  sub area detected by the camera using  digital image analysis or PIR     e detect temperature changes and noises     e process external signal
147. Center   A  Using MxServer to digitize the video stream   B  Using a third party video server to digitize the video stream   Both scenarios support live streaming as M JPEG video in MxControlCenter   In the first scenario  an MxServer computer digitizes the analog video signals using a  video grabber card  For this scenario to work  you will need an MxServer installed and    configured with an IDS Falcon QuattroPro Pro card and a network interface  LAN WAN   connection to the MxControlCenter client     In the second scenario  a third party video server  such as an Axis Video Server digitizes  the analog video signals  Note that these scenarios do not support audio     Regardless of the scenario used  MxServer can also record the digitized video as M JPEG  video in the MOBOTIX file server structure     Scenario A  Integrating An Analog PTZ Camera Using MxServer    Integrating analog cameras requires an intermediary step in which the analog video data  is converted to a digital format that is compatible with MxControlCenter  MxPEG or M JPEG      i r Cam Control  serial   E  M12 fe a mes PC Server  c Video grabber card  WindowsXP  MxPEG Server  4 m 2P 6    m22 TEA      Analog Kamera    Bosch  TVI Lederer   Bosch           PAL NTSC RAW RGB           MxControlCenter    D12 PC Server  WindowsXP  MxControlCenter       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    266 392    MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       Automatic searc
148. Correct port forwarding set   tings of router        DynDNS login of router failed     Establish DynDNS functionality  in router        Update Assistant does not find  any cameras           Zeroconfig of cameras not  enabled     Update Assistant started as  stand alone application for  the first time        Activate Zeroconfig on  cameras  Admin Menu  gt   Ethernet      Start Update Assistant from  MxCC or camera search in  Update Assistant              MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Solutions To Common Issues    363 392       B 1 2 File Server NAS Issues       Camera does not store images   video streams on file server NAS    Possible Cause    Firewall blocks network traffic     Solution    Correct firewall settings  Check  if file server share is accessible  from workstation        Access to stored recordings   video searches is slow     MxCC is set to access record   ings via the camera s      Directly access file server   NAS share using Access  Recordings dialog        Direct file server path set to  mapped network drive  but  drive is missing after next  login     Make sure that mapped  network drive is reconnected  on next login and that user  has proper access rights        File server NAS cannot handle  load of attached cameras     Add more file servers NAS to  distribute load more evenly        Camera cannot write to file  server NAS after some time     Storage capacity reached     Set or reduce st
149. Directly connected to computer 49  Network connection 49  PoE Switch 50    Preferred layout  glossary  358    Preview video stream  Example 154    Printing 130  Images 33  Single images 131    Program folder 217    Program settings  Saving 218    Program views  Configuring 181    Properties  Access Data tab 295  Dialog 295  Display tab 296  Information tab 296  PTZ Rotor tab 297  Video sources 295    PTZ 35    PTZ cameras  Connecting analog cameras to MxServer  262  Integrating analog cameras    PTZ Controls 18  Sidebar panel 66    PTZ dome cameras  Integrating 250    Restricting 205    Q    Quad display  glossary  358    Reacting to alarms 97  192    Recording 27  Camera Configuration tab 309  Configuring 191  Configuring recording targets 197  Example scenarios 100  Setting up in MxServer    Recordings  Checking data integrity 127  Configuring  overview  187  Evaluating 100  Exporting 132  Playing back 100  Playing back from Local Archive 126  Post processing 111  Post Video Motion Detection 120  Signing 211  Using MxRemotePreview to access   remote recordings 266   Using virtual PTZ when playing back 113  Video Search 124    Remote access  Example 154    Remote cameras  Connecting using DynDNS 240    Remote control  Configuring 175    Remote Control  Options tab 289    Remote recordings  Using MxRemotePreview 266       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 3 6   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Index       Resolution  g
150. EGA  30 fps MEGA  30 fos MEGA  30 fps MEGA    Camera 20 tps QXGA  20 tps QXGA  20 tps QXGA  20 tps QXGA   Intel Atom Intel Core i3 Intel Core i5 Intel Xeon    Clock Rate 1 6 GHz 3 2 GHz 3 2 GHz    Video card with Video card with     Reduced  if MxControlCenter computer runs additional tasks  e g   image correction  display scal   ing  etc          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       52 392    MxCC User Manual  System Installation and Initial Operation       Thin Client Mini PC Mid Range PC High End PC    Display Ports 1x VGA DVI 1x DVI 2 x DVI 4 x DVI  Ethernet Interface 100 Mbps 100 Mbps 1000 Mbps 1000 Mbps      Windows XP SP3   Windows 7 64 Bit   Windows 7 64 Bit   Windows 7 64 Bit     Reduced  if MxControlCenter computer runs additional tasks  e g   image correction  display scal   ing  etc          MxControlCenter also runs on operating systems with 32 Bit  However  when using  large camera installations  we recommend using an operating system with 64 Bit   Especially so  when event searches are used     The maximum number of live camera streams that can be shown concurrently will  decrease if the MxControlCenter computer needs to accomplish additional tasks   image correction  display scaling  etc       In Appendix A    Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline   you find further infor   mation and helpful hints for setting up a MxControlCenter based video surveillance  system              Netzwerk    W
151. EO SYSTEM SOLUTION FROM MOBOTIX    The MxControlCenter  MxCC  is the video management software developed by MOBOTIX    with all the functions necessary for a professional security control center  Above alll  KoL  MxCC maximizes its fullest potential when combined with the decentralized  high  100  EREE    resolution MOBOTIX cameras     a complete security system from one source and at an O  Y  unbeatably low total cost  Ny       Proven Many Times Over Worldwide  MxCC has been used in projects of all sizes for years     even with 1 000 cameras  and more  e g  Donbass Arena  University of Singapore      No Storage Limit  Unlimited Number Of Users        l MxCC supports  MxCC runs without third party software  needs no licenses  supports any number of Pitordable NAS  users  cameras and recording devices  and is completely cost neutral at the same time  mass storage  Individual User Interface  All functions can be managed centralized in the system by the administrator  a  group or an individual user   Simple Installation And Configuration  MxCC runs on any standard PC  finds cameras and storage in the network automatically  and configures all cameras at the push of a button   Layout Editor For Real Building Plans  All MxCC functions were developed from real practical requirements in the most  varied projects possible   Integration Of Varied Camera Types  In addition to MOBOTIX network cameras and door stations  analog and motor   controlled cameras can be integrated in MxCC      
152. G e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Update Assistant   Software Updates And More    249 392       Using The    Upload Camera Settings    Dialog    The Upload Camera Settings dialog  see   Restoring Camera Configuration Settings From  A Backup File    controls which parts of the configuration will be overwritten in the target  cameras     Note that the Back up Configuration Files option creates a backup file of the cameras  with an automatic file name  This allows restoring the current configuration of the selected  cameras  if required        Make sure that the IP address and host name option is deactivated  This would  apply the IP address and host name of the configuration file to the target cameras  and render them unreachable after rebooting           5 1 10 Using Update Assistant As A Stand Alone Application    The only difference between using Update Assistant from MxControlCenter and as a  stand alone application is that the stand alone application uses its own search mecha   nisms to find cameras and uses camera lists to store information on these cameras  In  other words  Update Assistant does not rely on MxControlCenter to maintain such a list     Using the Update Assistant as a stand alone application only makes sense if you  want to use its features independentof MxControlCenter installations  This would be  the case when updating the software of a large installation that comprises several  MxControlCenter wor
153. Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring Alarms And Recordings   97  3 92           Click on the         button   amp        Double click on the IP Address column in the new line and enter the IP address  of the MxControlCenter computer  172 16  0 23         Double click on the Port column in the new line and enter the port of the  MxControlCenter computer you would like to use for receiving network  alarm   messages  31754 in this example                Deactivate or delete        button  any other lines in this list     Alarm Targets  J  Enable  Acknowledge   On ax   IP Address Port      J  172 16 0 23 31754      e Set the event trigger       In the Event Trigger group box  set the Event switch dropdown to On     Activate the All Events checkbox   The Event Trigger group box should now look like this     Event Trigger    Event switch   On Z    fe All Events 3       V  Video Motion  VM   vV  Video Motion 2  VM2     As of now  MxControlCenter can only configure some of the event triggers that O  are listed on this tab of the Camera Configuration dialog  Until this dialog can  configure all event triggers of the camera  the gray entries need to be config   ured manually in the camera   s browser interface  click on the Open camera  in browser button and then on Setup Menu  gt  Event Settings in the browser               e Click on Apply and wait until the camera configuration has been saved        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany  
154. Heavy sunlight  well defined shadows         Show Getecton areas  J    Sou Track Helo Traneparency    White v  Yeow v   Gay v  0  E    Osaa  Une color Textcoler Line IDs Counter valves  s    Onandhighigmoncontng v  Bue v  White      4       Stow Mamua Madmum legend  J O   gt  MONS       Please refer to Section 4 6 1    Activating  Setting Process Parameters And Setting Up Storage    for descriptions of the individual areas        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Camera Configuration    Dialog 3 3     3 9 2    The Visual Configuration sub tab        Please refer to Section 4 6 1    Activating  Setting Process Parameters And Setting Up  Storage   for descriptions of the individual areas     B   Camere Configuration      d il   f N      amp  Q BOJE 8 OC Ww  Overview Image Settings Exposure Recording Audio Events Network Messages Time Server MxAnalytice   Name        Basic Configuration Visual Configuration     o10  Configure  Detector eres Object size    Counting ines   D mm            mm   j    ou    s  v    ta    Right Bottom Ignore Area a Tite East Tite West             MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 3 2   3 92 MxCC User Manual  Reference       6 4 MxControlCenter Start Parameters    It is possible to use various start parameters when launching MxControlCenter  These  parameters influence the application s startup sequence and can pe
155. IP addresses as large as possible in  P addresses gt   ownip the program s display area  The    ownip      keyword uses the IP address of the  command issuer    layout  lt Layout name gt  Shows the specified layout    port 1  2       65535 Sets the port for a single IP address   De Activates full screen display of the   fullscreen 0  1 application  0  deactivates  1  activates     Widerontrois 0  1 Shows buttons  Quick Controls  etc   0    shows  1 hides the controls      Selects the specified channel  number of  active O       n or  lt IP address gt  the display window in a layout from left  to right  top to bottom  starting at 0      zoom 0 1 Zooms the specified channel    full 0 1 Executes    fullscreen 1      hidecontrols 1     and    zoom 1       speaker 0 1 Starts stops the sound output        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    gt  Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Options    Dialog                                           Command Values Remarks  beep Plays a beep sound on the target computer   Moves MxCC to top and restores the  ec window   CloseMxCC Closes MxCC without saving       Changes channel n to IP address and  ChangeChannel n  lt IP address gt    lt params gt   Use parameters  port  PTZ      ioadprefayout Loads the preferred layout of the active  channel   player enable  disable Activates deactivates player mode   player play Starts playing the recordings   player stop Stops player   player nextframe Skips to next frame  
156. If the Switch lights via camera on off and Open door via camera buttons are  active  i e   not gray   they may execute other commands than switching the lights or  opening doors  respectively  Make sure that you have access to the documentation  of your system so you know the exact functions of these buttons                       3 2 8 Using Image Post Processing On Live Images    By default  MxControlCenter displays all live video images as they are transmitted by the  video source  Post processing allows adjusting the color saturation  brightness  contrast  and sharpness settings of live video footage  Applying post processing to a live video  stream can help when trying to recognize persons  for example     Post processing means that MxControlCenter can change both  live and recorded     images  Since this constitutes a manipulation of the original image  printing such an  image will always print two images  the original and the adjusted image           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Live Video Surveillance 19  3 92       Before you can activate image post processing in MxControlCenter  you should change  the settings until you get satisfactory results  Proceed as follows to activate and adjust  image post processing     e Make sure that you have selected a video source in the  layout  yellow frame      e Click on the down arrow to the right of the Image post   processing button     Bh    e Move the Image
157. M  M2 U  amp  Events M            noth cate    of von v On f w uc  H events        lt internal Ram gt  Hj mees  E  vaa  640x480  Bl 60    east gate von von von SB wm  wmz u BY Events    H   nes  10 0 32  148  Flmrcc  E  veas  Bad eo    south cate v n y on v on G wm wma  Hi events 4      lt ntemaiRam gt  F  msec fil  vea  540x480  Bal 60    Pakngi    off von v n G m mau H events m   R    lt Rec off gt  F mees fill vea cssoxs80  BI 60    mx105 42 9    of von v On     lt not spp    H  events 4    H   SO Flesh Card PY mees PA  xea  rozax7es  BI eo    manenvence YO von von     lt not spo    H  events qa    H   SO Flash Card Fi mses  E  xGa nozas  ES  eo  Camera    man gate Codec  F mees Speake f On Recording        On  Modet D12D Sec Resolution   E  VGA  640x480  Miro  y On Events  G mM  m2 uC  TT  Software version   MK Y3 5 2 23 r3 PEG quality  kal 60  6  Event     off Mode  H  Events poses do   Transfer rate   2 Macau leve      90 Target  HA crs  10 0 30 39   White balance      lt rotspperted gt  Width  ch 50  ms   a   8 z Ca Ca       Note that you can change some of the parameters of a video source directly in this dialog   To do so  select a camera  right click on the parameter you want to change and select the  new setting from the context menu     The following table lists the columns of the Overview tab  explains the corresponding  parameters  how to change them and where to find them on the other tabs     Column Provides Access to Change   Does not change   video source co
158. Monitoring 214  Options tab 294    Activating  Layout Manager 150  ActiveX  glossary  352    Adding  Overland Storage Snap Servers 238    Adding a MOBOTIX camera  Example 54    Additional user functions 141  Alarm features 92    Alarm Handling  Options tab 286    Alarm List 97  19  Filtering 98    Alarm message 27    Alarms  Configuring 189  Configuring  overview  187  Security 26    Analog PTZ cameras  Integrating 253    Application scenarios 16  Arming  glossary  352    Audio  Camera Configuration tab 313    Audio features of a camera 75  Auto Grid 23   Auto Grid  glossary  352  Automatic installation   38  AVC H 264 10   AVC Video  glossary  352    Background Images  Sidebar panel  Layout Manager mode   66    Background layout  glossary  352    Background layouts 20  Defining 162    Backing up  Camera configurations 234  Entire system 234    Bandwidth  glossary  352  Bonjour  glossary  352    Buttons  Layout elements 69    Camera Configuration  Audio tab 313  Dialog 299  Events tab 314  Exposure tab 305       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    379 392       Index  Image Settings tab 302 Live Recording 174  Network Messages tab 318 Live video monitoring 169  Overview tab 300 Local Archive 174  Recording tab 309 MOBOTIX video surveillance system 144    Camera configurations  Distributing 234    Camera layouts 20    Cameras  Accessing using encrypted connections  208  Power supply 49  Restricting public access 2
159. MxCC User Manual  Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline       Settings Remark    UPS Configure what to do in case of power failure     Create users and groups as specified in Customer    A 3 2 Configuring The Network Settings Of The Storage System  Access the administrative tools of the file server or the web interface of the NAS system  and set the following parameters    e  P address and subnet mask   e Default gateway   e Domain name servers  DNS    e WINS servers      e Domain name          These are special options  which should only be configured if absolutely necessary     A 3 3 Finishing The Configuration Of The Storage System    Reboot the storage system and access it again  If everything has been configured properly   you should get a dialog for entering the user name and password  Once you have logged  in again  you should check the system logs for errors and test the e mail notification     A 4 Configuring The Camera Network Settings    You are now ready to set up the cameras  Before you can start to configure the cameras  themselves  however  you need to set their IP addresses according to the IP address  grouping scheme  see Section A 2 1    Defining Hardware Groups     The ideal tool for this  purpose is MxControlCenter since it can automatically assign IP addresses from a range of  addresses to a set of cameras in one step  Note that you will change the camera host names  later  see   Changing The Camera Names   in Section A 6    Adjusting Sets Of Camera
160. MxCC icon _  ain   in front of the port  delete a recipient  select the corresponding item and click on the minus         button     The messages are sent to the recipients in the order of the list  from top to bottom    Select a recipient  then use the up down arrows to change the order of the list     Event Trigger 2     e Event switch  Activates the event triggers that can prompt the camera to send network  messages to the alarm targets         On  Activates the network messages of the selected cameras       Off  Deactivates all of the above         Signal Input Open  SI    Signal Input Closed  SI    f signal inputs have been con   figured on the camera  you can assign the corresponding option to use as an  event switch for the camera         Custom Signal 1  CS1    Custom Signal 2  CS2    Combined Signal  CSL   If time tables  or custom signals have been configured on the camera  you can use one of the  custom or combined signals as an event switch for the camera         From Master   Slave Mode  If the camera is configured to operate in slave mode   the event switch will be switched on or off according to the master camera   s  arming status     e Event Trigger Sensors  Lists all available trigger sensors for a camera  Activate the  sensors that will prompt the selected cameras to send network messages     Test Configuration       e Testing  This button triggers a test network message that is sent to the list of recipients   The results of the test are listed in the adja
161. MxControlCenter without parameters     MxNoSave Does not show a dialog box to save changes upon closing the  application              General Rules For Using Start Parameters    One or more start parameters can be used as a parameter block  The following rules apply     KA    e You must observe the sequence in the    List of MxControlCenter Start Parameters  table  from top to bottom         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    MxControlCenter Start Parameters       e If there are several parameters  separate them using commas  Spaces are not allowed   Enter the comma between the parameter block and configuration file  without a  space   The configuration file cannot be read if the comma is missing     e The    List of MxControlCenter Start Parameters    table is case sensitive  You must  observe case sensitivity  otherwise  the parameters will not be recognized     e Ifa specific configuration file is to be used for this shortcut  enter the file afferthe start  parameter block  see example in section   Adding Start Parameters To A Shortcut           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       3 3 4   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline       A VIDEO SURVEILLANCE IMPLEMENTATION GUIDELINE    Setting up a MxControlCenter based video surveillance system   VSS   can be a complex  task if many cameras are involved  This part of t
162. MxServer        Step 2  Set Up Recording Of The Analog PTZ Camera In MxServer    Set up recording of the analog PTZ camera in MxServer as described in Section 5 5 5     Setting Up Recording In MxServer       Step 3  Add The Analog PTZ Camera In MxControlCenter As An MxServer Channel    To add an analog PTZ camera as an MxServer channel   e Select Video Source  gt  Add from the menu to open the Add Video Sources dialog   e Click on the Camera button to open the Add Camera dialog     e Select MxServer channel as the camera Type        Merit Li Lin IP camera      Toshiba IP camera  Axis Server channel  Panasonic IP camera    gt  Sony IP camera          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Using Pan Tilt Heads  Third Party Cameras and Joysticks    267 392       e Enter the IP address  or DNS name   port number and login data  user name and  password  of MxServer for the camera  and activate SSL  if necessary      e Click on OK to close the dialog  This adds the MxServer channel to the Add Video  Sources list     e Select the MxServer channel in the Add Video Sources list and add it to the system  as described in Section 2 4 2    Using The Video Sources In MxControlCenter       Step 4  Set the Storage Location of the Analog PTZ Camera in MxControlCenter    Since this step works exactly as for setting the storage location of an IP PTZ dome   please proceed as described in   Step 3  Set The Storage Location Of The IP PTZ
163. OTP DHCP     e Enter the Domain as required        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 44   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline       e Disable Zeroconf  if this is required   e Click on Set     Setting Up Camera Storage    In this section  you will set up the camera to use one file server NAS or the microSD card  and specify the necessary details  if you want to use a different storage target later on   you can set this when applying individual settings      You should set up the camera storage at this stage only if you are using the same  file server NAS or SD card storage on all cameras of the system  If this is not the  case  you should set the storage targets later on when adjusting sets of cameras   see Section A 6    Adjusting Sets Of Cameras        Check if you can access the Windows  SMB CIFS  shares by entering the IP address  or DNS name in Windows Explorer  Enter the corresponding UNC path to the storage  system  e g    10 1 1 111 mxdata or   mxstoragel mxdata                        e Adjust the settings as in the figure below  see the corresponding camera manual  for the available settings      File Server IP 192 168 20 1 IP address of server     The server needs to be reachable via the network     emo irect ge sgia on the server to be mounted by the camera  A tD ory Share   t  When using CIFS  you n eo the share directly  e  9  Sdaia or data     When ere   hy u need
164. One example that may be cited is filtering for only the  images recorded at the video door stations after the doorbell is pressed     Convenient Playback Functions    Clicking directly on the preview window of a stored event activates the video player  integrated in MxCC  Selected video clips can be scrolled forwards and backwards  quickly or simply image by image  Details in still images can be enlarged via the zoom  function  The perspective of images distorted by very wide angle lenses can be corrected    digitally for easier evaluation     Printing Event Images    If an image has been corrected or zoomed by post processing   the original  non processed image will be also be printed  A print  file can also be output as a PDF for easy sending and archiving  of printouts     Video Export Made Easy    MxCC makes the processing and export of recorded video clips  with sound particularly easy  Both individual and several clips  can be selected and exported at once by a mouse click  They  can be either unprocessed original clips or files to process later   e g  only relevant time sequences or details changed using PTZ     MOBOTIX has developed its own compression method as MxPEG  It  requires less network load and computing power and is accordingly  extremely efficient  For third parties  these MxPEG videos can be  exported together with a simple viewer version of MxCC that can  only be used for pure playback and viewing  However  direct  export into standard formats such as AVI
165. Private    Public          You cannot check the integrity of unsigned recordings  If you intend to use this feature   make sure that all cameras are signing their recordings  For more information on  how to do this  Section 4 8 5    Signing The Recorded Video Data                How MxControlCenter Gets the Public Key for Checking the Data Integrity     e MxControlCenter automatically loads the public key from the cameras that are present  in the VIDEO SOURCES section of the Navigator sidebar panel     e If only the recordings have been added as file server paths  MxControlCenter checks  the root of the recording folder to find the cert   pem file that contains the public key     Cameras with software versions MX V4   0   6   x and higher can automatically store  the cert pem file that contains the public key in the root of the recording folder   Section 4 8 5    Signing The Recorded Video Data           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings    131 392          You can also manually download the cert   pem file from any camera and store the  file at the root of the recording folder  provided you have the proper rights   Please  proceed as outlined in Section 4 8 5    Signing The Recorded Video Data    or ask your  system administrator for assistance           Prerequisites For Running The Data Integrity Check    In order to check the data integrity of recordings  the following
166. Routing route  name Dynamic DNS Client dyndns  General Network Client Settings modem  Manage Hardware Extensions serial  rs232d  rescon  Storage on External File Server   fileserver  File Server Flash Device camerachecks  Storage Failure Detection rescon  Manage Image Files medialist  Logos Logo Profiles logolist  Image Profiles timetable          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       248   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features          Camera Dialogs Configuration File Sections  homepage  Language and Start Page httpd  Page  language and Softbuttons softbuttons  softbuttons  MultiView Screens multiview  Multi Watcher  softbutton  multiwatcher  cameras  General Event Settings  Event Settings eventdlite  Event Control Event Filter signalout  Video Motion windows Event Logic timetable  Recording rescon    Action Group Overview    5 1 8 Backing Up And Restoring The Entire System    Whereas the mechanisms described in Section 5 1 7    Saving And Uploading Settings Of One  Or More Cameras    can create and restore backups for individual cameras  Update Assistant  also provides a means for backing up and restoring all cameras in the camera list     e Select File  gt  System Backup from the menu or press F2 to create a zipped backup  archive with the configuration files      c   g  of all cameras in the camera ist     e Select File  gt  Restore System Backup from the menu or press SHIFT F2 to select a  zipped backup
167. S ensures high reliability  synchroniza   tion with the file server or NAS systems  for extra storage and use of backup  functions        Event recording with audio channel Yes Event controlled recording is only started  when the camera detects specific events    owerful internal sensors  flexible  implementation of the requirements by  connection of external sensors  Connec   tion of external sensors is possible     Continuous recording with audio channel   Yes Continuous recording optional with  fixed or reduced frame rate  min  0 2  fps  using automatic frame rate adjust   ment if events are detected  continuous  recording of the audio channel              Full image recording Yes  practically Recording of the complete camera sen   unlimited sor made independent of the current  live display  e g  PTZ    Local archive Yes Storage on local computer drive   Live recording Yes Direct storage of the live images in the  local archive  recordings of suspicious  events         Evaluation of recordings             Event search Yes Use of individually configurable search  profiles  e g  based on time  cameras   events     Later movement detection Yes Analysis of recorded video files for  movements in the desired area    Parallel time synchronized replay of Yes Replay of the recordings corresponding   several cameras to the actual time sequence    Reference time based evaluation Yes A mouse click makes a simple change    to the recording of other cameras at the  same point in time  r
168. Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 2 2   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration  ution    A computer running MxControlCenter with open ports  e g  when using the remote  control and alarm handling ports  should never have a direct connection to the Internet   Make sure that the computer is adequately protected by an appropriate firewall        Built in firewalls  e g  Windows firewall  on the MxControlCenter computer do not  provide effective protection and cannot replace a hardware firewall              4 8 3 Securing The MxControlCenter Workstation    To protect the MxControlCenter installation  it is highly recommended to create at least  two users on the Windows computer  an administrator and a user      Example Folders    e Program folder  c  Program Files MOBOTIX MxCC    e Working folder  c     MxCcC GateGuards  this folder contains the MxControlCenter  configuration for the gate guards        Proceed as follows  e Log in as Windows administrator or as user with administrative privileges   e Create a dedicated user without administrative rights  e g  Gate Guard      e Run MxControlCenter and export the configuration to the working folder  File  gt  Export  configuration in the menu  using the Configuration and resources option     e Open Windows Explorer and navigate to the working folder     e SetRead only privileges for the working folder for the Gate Guard user  right click  gt   Properties  gt  Security tab 
169. Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 6 6   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Troubleshooting    e  f you are only doing a one time documentation of a particular error  move the  MxControlCenter 1og file to a different location  otherwise copy the file        e Open the file in Notepad for further analysis or send the file to MOBOTIX Support        Do not leave the MxControlCenter error log activated for longer periods of time  This  may fill the hard drive of the MxControlCenter workstation     MxControlCenter does not create the MxControlCenter 1oglog file automatically   Note that MxControlCenter overwrites the log file when restarting        When trying to troubleshoot document a program malfunction  make sure the appli   cation does not restart automatically  default   Create a new desktop link to start the  program without automatic restarts by adding NoWatchdog  0 as a parameter  to the Target text field of the link  e g     C  Program Files Mobotix MxCC   MxCC exe    NoWatchdog  0                  MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       Notes                                                                                  MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       3 6 8 J392 Mmxcc User Manual  MOBOTIX Glossary       C    MOBOTIX GLOSSARY    2G  Second generation of wireless telephone technology  see   GSM 2G
170. Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com          amp  6   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       Prerequisites    e Remote control has been activated on the client computer  192 168 1 204    listening to port 31667     e Layoutnamed    Parking1    has been defined on the client computer   e Command button has been defined in a layout     If you want to send such a command from MxControlCenter to another computer running  MxControlCenter  e g  to show a different layout on a client   you should proceed as follows     e Edit an existing or create a new background layout  see Section 4 2 4    Defining  Background Layouts        e Adda command button       Right click anywhere on the layout and select Insert from the context menu       From the Element type dropdown  select    Command    button       Click on the Add button       Enter the command in the Add Command URL dialog       Add Command URL       URL  192 168 1 204 31667  layout Parking   amp beep           Click on OK to close the Add Command URL dialog       Highlight the command you just entered in the Command URL list         Enter a Button name that is shown on the button later on  Parking1  see red  frame   The Edit Display Element dialog now looks like this     http   192 168 1 204 31667  layout Parking  kbeep Edit    Delete       amel Parking         Click on OK to close the Edit Display Element dialog     Clicking on the Parking   button in a layout on the main computer will
171. TIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Camera Configuration    Dialog    325 392       the specified level  This value can be set independently for each camera lens if this  is a Dual and Day Night camera model     Use this parameter with due care  Video motion detection will be deactivated  completely if illumination drops below the specified level  Set this parameter  to Offif you would like to avoid this              Sensor Control       Click on one of the buttons to switch to the corresponding image sensor  lens   This section  is only available on Dual and Day Night camera models        The definitions of VM windows for dual cameras are valid for either the right or the  left image sensor  By default  this dialog activates the currently used image sensor  and you can switch to the other sensor  Note that this is not a temporary setting   but this actually switches the current sensor of the camera  If you had been using  a different setting before  such as Both or Automatic  you will have to manually set  this parameter to its old value afterwards  see    Camera Lens    under    Color Settings  and Resolution    in Section 6 3 2    The    Image Settings    Tab              Frame Details       Coordinates  This section shows the dimensions of the selected video motion window   click on such a window to activate it   Changing the values of the coordinates and  the dimensions modifies the selected window accord
172. TIX cameras use windows    Video Motion  Window to determine if there are movements in a video stream     Video Motion Window  Area in the live or recorded video stream in which MOBOTIX cameras can search for move   ments  see also   Motion Detection      Video SIP  Similar to   S P  but with an additional video channel     Video Source  Any source offering video content that can be displayed in MxControlCenter  These are usu   ally MOBOTIX cameras  but also third party IP cameras  recordings stored on file servers       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 76 399     MxCC User Manual  MOBOTIX Glossary           file server paths     and on   Snap Server   NAS systems  MxPEG clips and analog cameras  connected via MxServer  e g  an analog   Dome Camera      Video Wall  Wall with a set of  Usually large  monitors  used e g  in security applications to provide overview     VM  Abbreviation for   Video Motion Detection     VoIP  Voice over Internet Protocol  Telephony using computer networks     Wi Fi  Trademark of the Wi Fi Alliance  see   that manufacturers of electronic equipment can use  to brand certified products belonging to a class of wireless   LAN devices based on the IEEE  802 1 standards     Wireless Devices  Electronic devices that use electromagnetic waves to establish voice or data connections   rather than using some kind of wire connection   Wireless devices typically use   GSM 2G     UMTS 3G    Wi
173. TZ Actions In The Camera Or In MxControlCenter    As mentioned before  you can choose which part  of the image post processing should take place in  the camera or in MxControlCenter   MxControlCenter Display Modes    e Unchanged  All vPTZ actions are performed          by the active camera  Note that this changes Tn In Camere  the live image of the camera  and thus any     xzom    center   OOG  recordings that are taking place       Auto Move     alles    Panleft   Pan Right PS  i0   e All other settings  All vPTZ actions are per     views 1 15   Jump N    s w Jom       formed by MxControlCenter  This does not  change the live image of the camera or any recordings         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Live Video Surveillance    67 392       Display Modes Availability Explanation    Mode   Lens  Full Image Image as generated by the camera  Zoomed Zoomed image without distortion correction    Image section with straight lines       Fixed Quad view in four directions    Corrected  Surround  Panorama Horizontal 180 degree view    Panorama Focus As above  two additional windows below    As above  one additional Panorama window    Double Panorama below    Unchanged Image as generated by the camera    Zoomed Zoomed image    Corrected Image section with straight lines    Only if camera is set    to Full Image Horizontal 180 degree view    Panorama       Panorama Focus As above  two additional windows below    Using
174. These images are then transferred to the requesting clients  over the network  computers with MxControlCenter   The resolution of the transferred  images steams can be configured with MxServer  768x576  640x480 VGA  320x240 CIF      The maximum number of simultaneously requesting clients depends on the performance  of the Windows computers running MxServer and the available bandwidth of the network  connection     Regardless of that  the digitized video frames can be recorded by MxServer on the file  server  continuous recording  and then searched and played back in MxControlCenter   MxControlCenter directly accesses the data recorded on the server for that purpose     5 5 2 MxServer   System Requirements And Installation    Prerequisites For Using Analog Or IP Cameras With MxServer    e Computer  minimum Pentium 4 or equivalent AMD processor  with at least 512 MB RAM  e Windows 2000  XP  2003 Server  Vista  Windows 7  e MOBOTIX MxServer  e Third party analog or IP camera       IP  PTZ  camera connected to the network      Analog PTZ camera  e g  Bosch AutoDome  Siemens Speed Dome  connected to  the frame grabber card and a serial interface of the computer        Analog camera connected to the frame grabber card       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    MxServer   Integrating Third Party Cameras 2 7    3 9 2       e When using analog cameras       Installed and configured IDS Falcon QuattroPro frame grabber card  
175. To The Top    The following methods will bring the application back to the foreground of the desktop     Counting seconds  Enter the number of seconds to wait until MxControlCenter brings  itself back to the foreground of your desktop in the On top after field on the Tools  gt   Options  gt  View tab     When receiving alarm messages  Restores a minimized MxControlCenter  if a camera  sends an alarm message via the network         Select Tools  gt  Options from the menu       Click on the Alarm Handling tab         In the Alarm Messages group  activate the Activate alarm message server  checkbox and configure alarm messages accordingly  see   Setting up Alarm  Messages from the Camera to MxControlCenter   in Section 4 5 1    Configuring  Alarms on the Cameras            Activate the Restore MxCC  when minimized  checkbox         Click on OK to close the dialog        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring The Program Views And The User Interface    193 392          To prevent MxControlCenter from being hidden behind other applications in the first  place  you can activate the Always on top checkbox in the Tools  gt  Options  gt  View tab        Saving Bandwidth When MxControlCenter Is Minimized    Finally  you can also save bandwidth when MxControlCenter is minimized by setting the  When minimized dropdown on the Tools  gt  Options  gt  General tab to either Pause or Stop all     Pause  Suspends all vide
176. Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Index    387 392       Solutions to common issues 348  Starting  MxServer automatically 265    Start Layout  MxControlCenter 71    Status  Discovered video sources 54  Monitoring computers using MxStatus  147    Subnet  glossary  359   Switch  glossary  359   Switching features of a camera 76  Switching layouts 71    Synchronized  Playback of several cameras 108  Search of several cameras 108    Synchronized playback  Example 109    System  Installation and Initial Operation 48    System configuration 144    System requirements  Computer 51  MxRemotePreview 268  MxServer 259  Time synchronization 51  User accounts 51    System security 205    T    Testing  Web server with MxRemotePreview 272    Third party cameras  Integrating analog cameras 258  Integrating analog PTZ cameras 253  Integrating IP PTZ dome cameras 250  Using 246    Third party IP cameras  Connecting to MxServer 263    Time server  Configuring 146    Title Bar 19    Toolbar 19  Configuring 182  Update Assistant 224    Toolbar buttons  MxControlCenter 64    Troubleshooting 348    Two man rule 203  Example 142  203  Using 142    UMTS 3G  glossary  359    Update Assistant  Checking camera connection status 227  Elements of the dialog 223  Getting started 224  MOBOTIX application software 231  Overview 222  Toolbar buttons 224    Updating  MOBOTIX cameras 228  Software 222    Uploading  Camera configuration files 234  Camera configurations
177. You will need to decide on the following questions     e Which cameras should trigger which alarms using which sensors  See Section 4 5 1     Configuring Alarms on the Cameras       e What should the cameras record  See Section 4 5 2    Configuring What To Record       e How should MxControlCenter react when it receives the alarms and how can   test  the reactions  See Section 4 5 3    Configuring MxControlCenter Reactions       e Where should the cameras store the recordings  See Section 4 5 4     Configuring  Where To Record        e How should MxControlCenter access the camera s recordings  See   Configuring How  MxControlCenter Accesses The Recordings   in Section 4 5 4    Configuring Where  To Record       e Make sure that you have administration privileges on the MOBOTIX cameras  you need for the installation     e Make sure that you document the procedures you have set up for the user              Configuration Example    The following example shows you how to set up MxControlCenter and a camera so  that the camera sends a network message to the MxControlCenter computer when a  particular event  i e   alarm  occurs  When the computer receives this network message   it automatically loads the preferred layout assigned to that camera        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring Alarms And Recordings   9 5  3 9 2       Example  e MOBOTIX camera     IP address  172 16 0 100      Video motion detectio
178. a Configuration allows selecting several video sources        Arming Switch      e On  Activates all events  actions  messages  and recording features of the camera     e Off Deactivates all of the above      MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Camera Configuration    Dialog    319 392       Signal Input Open  SI    Signal Input Closed  Si   If signal inputs have been configured  on the camera  you can assign the corresponding option to use as an arming switch  for the camera     Custom Signal 1  CS1    Custom Signal 2  CS2    Combined Signal  CSL   f time tables  or custom signals have been configured on the camera  you can use one of the  custom or combined signals as an arming switch for the camera     From Master   Slave Mode  If the camera is configured to operate in slave mode  the  arming switch will be switched on or off according to the master camera   s arming status     Recording Switch 2    Recording  This switch lets you enable or disable the camera recorder  If time tables   customized signal switches  or Master Slave mode have been configured  one of  these may be used to enable recording in the camera  see   Arming Switch   above  for an explanation of these settings      Display recording symbol in live image  When activated  the camera shows the  recording symbol in the upper right hand corner of a live image when it is recording     Digital signing of recorded images  When activated  thi
179. a background image  You also have the option of display   ing individual MOBOTIX cameras as icons on top of the background image  These icons  display the viewing direction and lenses of the cameras as well as the camera s status   Monitored  Not monitored  and Connection erron  Double click the icon to display the live  image of the camera in a separate window        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Creating And Editing Layouts   6 9  3 92          An ideal background image of a building can often be found in the emergency plans        Positioning Video Sources In Background Layouts    1  Activate the Layout Manager  see   Activating   Navigator       The Layout Manager   in Section 4 2    Creating        ail ae   Outside  And Editing Layouts      H main Entrance   B west gate  2  Select the layout you want to edit  for example  B N  ar trance  Overview   Outside  or create a new back  sa ee cS  ground layout  see Section 4 2 1    Creating oe  Elevators  Layouts      B sack re  3  Select a background image      jpg      bmp  R SE  x  gif  in the bottom panel of the Layout  4vineo sources  Manager  for example  Parking lot view  Click a    Storage Devices  4 EVENT SEARCHES    on Add Image to insert additional image files  in the Background Images sidebar panel     4  Confirm the system prompt  The display area    of MxControlCenter now uses the selected         FN  background image  Bist me   eee   External Bui
180. a cross reference in the  PDF file to jump to the corresponding location in the text      e Glossary entries  Monitor with a   Resolution of at least 1280x960 pixels   Note that  you can click on such a refererence in the PDF file to jump to the corresponding  glossary entry      e Web links  For additional information  see our website www mobotix com     e Examples     http    192 168 1 182 8001  fullscreen 1        minimizes MxControlCenter to the task bar     Explanation Of Boxes  Safety Notices    The safety notices in this manual are highlighted with the following boxes     This box highlights the contents of such a Warning box  Make sure that you thoroughly  read the information contained in this box and follow the instructions  Failing to do  so will result in damages     This box highlights the contents of such a Caution box  Make sure that you thoroughly  read the information contained in this box and follow the instructions  Failing to do  so may result in damages                          This box highlights the contents of such a Note box  The text in this box is for your  information           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    10 392    MxCC User Manual       Hints And Explanations       This box highlights the contents of such a Hint box  The text in this box is for your  information        This box highlights information that improves your understanding of the current subject     Why MxControlCent
181. a sequencer window  proceed as described in Section 4 2 2    Element Types  Used In Layouts       Make sure that you document the following items   e How do the operators switch layouts     e Which one of the layouts is the Start Layout        e Which sequencers have been configured and what do they do        4 3 4 Configuring Live Recording And The Local Archive    MxControlCenter uses the local archiveto permanently store video sequences from various  sources  This prevents video sequences from getting lost when the MOBOTIX cameras  overwrite older video sequences when the cameras are storing new sequences  The  operators can fill this folder using one of these methods     e Click on the Live recording button  see Section 3 2 10    Using The Live Recording  Feature        e Drag amp drop a video sequence from an event search  see Section 3 5 8    Using Event  Searches        e Drag amp drop a video sequence from a Post VM search  see Section 3 5 9    Using Post  Video Motion Detection In Recordings        By default  the local archive is a folder in the user   s folder as shown in the Options dialog   If you need to move this folder to a different location  e g  a share on a server   proceed  as follows     e Select Tools  gt  Options from the menu   e Open the General tab     Local Archive  User folder       Custom folder        e Inthe LOCAL ARCHIVE section  activate the Custom folder option  the current folder  is shown behind the User folder option      e Select a diffe
182. a to store the video streaming data on  MxServer in MOBOTIX file server structure  see Section 5 5 5    Setting Up Recording  In MxServer           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com      Automatic search       Insert manually    l Camera                  MPEG dip                 Recording path            2 64   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features    Step 3  Set The Storage Location Of The IP PTZ Dome In MxControlCenter       Once the MxServer environment has been set up  return to MxControlCenter and open  the Properties dialog of the camera  Then update the path of the Storage location with  the same path used in MxServer for storing video image data   To Set A Path From The IP Camera To MxServer   e Select the camera from the Video Source  gt  Cameras node     e Open the Properties of dialog for the camera and go to the Access Data tab     Properties of axis 1       Name  axis 1      Access Data   Informatio Display l PTZ Rotor   Urls      Address  172 16 250 27 Port  80  Secure connection  SSL   User name  root    Password  eececcee    Access recordings  M  axis_0    e Click on the Change button in the Access recordings section to open the Access    This path can point Recordings of dialog   either to a shared       folder on MxServer  or E Access Recordings of axis 1  a mapped network drive Access Recordings  ona separate file server No recording folder  Defauk file server path  factory IP address     Sp
183. about video sources  layouts and how they are used  in MxControlCenter  please see Section 3 1    Elements Of The Application Window     This  section focuses on how to create and edit layouts and also on the different layout types   For more general instructions about planning a layout structure and when to use which  layout type  please see Section 4 3 1    Planning A Layout Structure       To automatically create layouts for different video sources  MOBOTIX cameras  file server  paths  MxPEG clips and third party network cameras   you can proceed as described in  Section 2 4 1    Finding And Configuring Video Sources    If you want to customize layouts  or create new layouts from scratch  you will need to activate the Layout Manager  In  this application mode  you can create new layouts and modify or delete existing ones     Activating The Layout Manager    To activate the Layout Manager  do one of the following   e Click on the Layout Manager button in the toolbar   e Select Layout  gt  New in the menu to create a new  empty  layout   e Select Layout  gt  Edit in the menu to edit the current layout   e Right click in the LAYOUTS section of the Navigator sidebar panel and select         New layout to create a new  empty  layout that is inserted on the same level  as the current layout         New sub layout to create a new  empty  layout that is inserted as a sub layout  to the current layout     e Right click on a layout in the LAYOUTS section of the Navigator sidebar pan
184. ackground layouts  the yellow Preferred Layout icon in the title bar of a display  window also indicates that such a layout is available for the selected video source  Click  on this icon or right click on the window and select Load preferred layout to manually  switch to the preferred layout of the active camera  yellow frame      Showing The Reference Image Of A Video Source    If a Reference Image has been set  you can compare it to the current image of a cam   era  The main purpose of such an image is to provide an unchanged  original view of  the camera  You can thus see if the camera has been tilted sideways  for example  If a  reference image has been set for the active camera  yellow frame   this button is active in  the toolbar  Click on this button to show the reference image or right click on the window  and select Show reference image     On background layouts  the yellow Reference Image icon in the title bar of a display window  also indicates that such a file is available for the selected video source  Click on this icon to  show the reference image or right click on the window and select Show reference image        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    f       104 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       3 5 Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings    MxControlCenter offers numerous possibilities for playing back the recorded audio video  data  This section presents the different mechanisms
185. ade in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com             3 O 2   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference    6 1 6 The    Monitoring    Tab       This tab contains the following group boxes     Options       General   Connection Defaults   View   Alam Handling   Remote Control   Monitoring   Action Log      Waming Sounds          On connection loss       No sound     amp     System sound       File     Error Display z  On connection loss  C No display    2   Eror message       Graphic   Vertical image coverage  100  On latency timeout    No display  C  Eror message      Graphic   Vertical image coverage  100  Maximum latency time   Maximum overdue time   Automatic stream recovery       Dead Man s Switch       Activate after     20 Minutes of inactivity       Logout user   Send e mail message to  Mail settings     Event Cache    O Enable fast event search  requires event cache     Network cache size  64 MB                Warning Sounds aD    e On connection loss  Plays back a system sound or a sound file over the computer  speakers if MxControlCenter loses the connection to one of the cameras listed in the  VIDEO SOURCES  gt  Cameras section of the Navigator sidebar     Error Display  amp     e Onconnection loss  Shows an error message or a graphics file instead of the camera  image if MxControlCenter loses the connection to one of the cameras listed in the  VIDEO SOURCES  gt  Cameras section of the Navigator sidebar     e On latency timeout  Shows an error message or graph
186. ade in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    60 392    MxCC User Manual  System Installation and Initial Operation          If you do nofcreate a new layout in this step and  no layouts have been defined in MxControlCenter  so far  the selected cameras will only be shown in  the VIDEO SOURCES subsection of the Navigator  sidebar panel  In this case  you need to manu   ally create a layout as described in Section 4 2    Creating And Editing Layouts   and add the Sevene tomes  cameras as required              2 4 3 Initial Installation Of Hemispheric And 180   Cameras    Hemispheric models or 180   dual lens models with panorama views  such as D14D 180     should be set up at this point     Initial installation involves selecting the mounting position  wall  ceiling  floor  and preferred  viewing direction for the hemispheric cameras  The images of the two 90   image sensors  in 180   dual lens cameras are positioned in such a way that they fit together seamlessly   These settings are not usually changed following initial installation     Performing Initial Installation    Select a camera to be set up     Open the PTZ Controls sidebar panel  click on View  gt  Sidebar  gt  Show in the menu  if this is not visible      Zoom in on the PTZ Controls panel until another area  Hemispheric Installation   Configuration of Panorama View  opens below the PTZ Views section     Proceed as outlined below in the Hemispheric Cameras and 180   Dual Lens Cameras  sections     Initi
187. age        Manuals For MOBOTIX Products    All MOBOTIX products have corresponding manuals that you can download as PDF files  from www mobotix cominthe Support  gt  Manuals section     Disclaimer    Neither MOBOTIX AG nor any subsidiary of MOBOTIX AG will assume any responsibility for  damage resulting from improper use of its products or failure to comply with the manuals  and the applicable rules and regulations     Our General Terms and Conditions apply  You can download the current version of the  General Terms and Conditions from our website at www mobotix   com by clicking on  the COs link at the bottom of every page     Copyright Notice   All rights reserved  MOBOTIX    MxControlCenter    and MxEasy    are protected trade   marks of MOBOTIX AG  Microsoft  Windows and Windows Serverare registered trademarks  of Microsoft Corporation  Apple  the Apple logo  Macintosh  OS X  Bonjour  the Bonjour  logo and the Bonjour symbol are trademarks of Apple Computer  Inc  Linuxis a trademark  of Linus Torvalds  All other brand names mentioned herein may be trademarks or registered  trademarks of the respective owners    Copyright    1999 2013  MOBOTIX AG  Langmeil  Germany    Information subject to change without notice        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com     9    od          ee    sees    Sets tay yy  f       3 Da e          MOBOTIX Video System Solution   3  392       PERFECT INTERACTION  THE HIGH RESOLUTION VID
188. al  Reference    6 3 2 The    Image Settings    Tab       This tab contains the following sections     Camera Configuration      E Q amp Q BJE S CO f    Overview Image Settings Exposure Recording Audio Events Network Messages Time Server MxAnalytics    E En   Apply changes immediately     axs 1   Camera Lens       main gate   lt Mult v     Select the camera lens you would like to change      north gate    t    east gate 2              lt   naases  E      Parking 1 Resolution    VGA  640x480     mx10 9 42 99 JPEG quality   60    main entrance Camera frame rate   Maximum    Downtown office Image quality   Normal    back door                         Image Settings  Night improvement   On  White balance           Noise suppression   Low  Automatic contrast   Automatic              ox   cance       This tab of the Camera Configuration allows selecting several video sources     The Apply changes immediately checkbox automatically applies the camera settings  as they are changed  without having to click on OK or Apply               Camera Lens aD  This dropdown selects the lens  image sensor  that the camera currently uses  only avail   able on Dual camera models     e Right  Uses the right image sensor of the camera  default     e Left Uses the left image sensor of the camera     e Both  Creates a double width image consisting of the image of the left image sensor  on the left and the image of the right sensor on the right     e Auto  Automatically switches to the sensor  only avai
189. al Installation Of Hemispheric Cameras    Select the mounting position of the camera  wall  ceiling or floor installation    Set the other options depending on the mounting position         Mounting to a wall  Select the desired mode from the Camera Default Start  Mode dropdown menu in the PTZ Controls panel         Mounting to the ceiling floor  Rotate the camera in the desired direction using  ALT click and then click on Set North to set the preferred viewing direction of  the camera        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Launching MxControlCenter For The First Time    61 392       The mounting position and other options can be set up separately per image sensor  in S14D cameras  To do so  select the view of the corresponding image sensor with  ALT click and perform the installation              See the corresponding camera manual for more information on the mounting positions  and the available display modes     Initial Installation Of 180   Dual Lens Cameras  e To start the configuration process  click on the Activate button in the PTZ Controls  panel in the Configuration of Panorama View section     e Adjust the dual image of the camera using the OnScreen Control  as outlined in the  corresponding camera manual     e Click on the Deactivate button in the PTZ Controls panel in the Configuration of  Panorama View section to end the configuration process and save the results     See the corresponding camera
190. al joystick for pan tilt zoom        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com             High resolution  images can be zoomed  digitally  entirely  without a motor     36 392    MxCC User Manual  Secure Handling Of Sensitive Data       A reduced display of  MxCC is sufficient  for many users   large images and few  control elements    When an advantageous modern video monitoring solution is used  which is to some  extent even legally required  special care must be shown in the use of the recorded data   MOBOTIX has therefore integrated several important security functions in MxCC which  ease the daily work of all users and prevent undesired data abuse already in advance     User Dependent And Group Dependent Access Rights    It is neither desirable nor practical for every employee to be allowed and required to  use the same  complete scope of functions of the video system and the management  software  The tool    Users  amp  Groups    in MxCC therefore provides the system adminis   trator an extremely powerful and versatile tool for access rights     ie  MxControlCenter   192    SVeassnS CUTE    j File View Layout VideoSource Recording Took Help    EE tive EE Recherche       M   c 31 kbi 5870 09 10 04 Wed 15 09 10    Depending on whether a user or a user group is a system administrator  data protection  officer  security guard  a cashier  house detective  manager  works council member   policeman or private person  the 
191. ally con   nected to the local area network  LAN  via another Ethernet cable     e Check the cameras  Inspect the LEDs of the operating cameras to make sure that  the cameras are operating normally     The MOBOTIX cameras are now ready to use and available on the local area network   They can now be integrated into MxControlCenter     Integrating The Cameras Into MxControlCenter    e Install MxControlCenter  Insert the MOBOTIX Demo DVD  if available  or download  the MxControlCenter software for your operating system  Install the application  see  Section 2 3    Installing MxControlCenter        e Automatically search for cameras  Launch MxControlCenter  The application automati   cally finds all MOBOTIX cameras in the local network and shows a preview image for  each camera that is directly accessible  You can add cameras  which are outside of  the local network  e g  in your summer cottage   later on  At this point  you can enter  different access data  user and password  see Section 2 4 1    Finding And Configuring  Video Sources    and Section 5 3    Connecting Remote Cameras Using DynDNS           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Power Supply And Network Connection Of Cameras    49 392       e Configure the network settings of the cameras  MxControlCenter will prompt you to  enter the new IP addresses of the cameras on the network  or you can use DHCP to  automatically set the IP addresses   If there is a
192. amera is armed         During an event  Set this option to Highlightto see a solid red frame around the  video motion windows that triggered an alarm         Display window IDs  Shows the numbers  IDs  of the video motion windows in  the upper left hand corner     Image Sensors 2    Detect video motion on both sensors  Enables video motion detection on both  sensors  This setting is useful when using different VM windows sets  Note that this  option is only available on Dual and Day Night camera models     Apply window definitions to both sensors  This option will use the same video  motion windows defined for the right image sensor on the left image sensor of the  camera  Note that this option is only available on Dual and Day Night camera models        You should only use this option if you are intend to use the same video motion  windows on both sensors  This usually applies to MOBOTIX Dual or Day Night  models with identical focal lengths for both image sensors  e g  a MOBOTIX  M12 with one D43  right  day  and one N43  left  night  lens           Low Light Conditions  When illumination decreases  e g  at dawn   the camera s  image sensor tries to amplify the  remaining  light  which results in increased image  noise  also called dark noise   This noise produces unforeseeable changes in pixel  brightness and can result in malfunctioning video motion detection  Use this parameter  to automatically deactivate video motion detection if the illumination drops below       MOBO
193. ameras  time Servers for Standard Cameras  Note  Selecting a camera makes it a master  camera  Cameras with attached MOBOTIX  GPS boxes are shown in red  EMM oF  Time Servers tor Master Cameras       Note  The camera wil automatically usca Eytemal NIP     MOBOTIX GPS box as reliable time server if   ver      such a box is attached            lt None  gt  X        ox   cance    sooty         The settings described below are applied for all of the cameras selected in the dialog  box s camera list  Select multiple cameras in the list using  Shift click  or  Ctrl click           Time Zone And Local Time      Here you can synchronize the time between computer and camera  Select the time zone  and click on Set time on cameras        The manual time set takes effect immediately  whereas the time synchronization with  one or multiple time servers with defined time differences can take up to one hour        Time Servers For Standard Cameras  amp     You can synchronize the cameras selected with up to three time servers to ensure alll  cameras are running in a synchronized manner  This ensures that all cameras have the       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 3 O   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference       same system time  regardless of whether or not there is a time source  if you set up more  than one time server  External time servers or other cameras can be used as time servers   A red label is used to indicate if on
194. an Rule 148       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       4    4 1  4 1 1  4 1 2  4 1 3  4 1 4  4 1 5  4 1 6    4 2  4 2 1  4 2 2  4 2 3  4 2 4  4 2 5    4 3   4 3 1  4 3 2  4 3 3  4 3 4  4 3 5  4 3 6    44  4 4 1  4 4 2  4 4 3  4 4 4    4 5  4 5 1  4 5 2  4 5 3  4 5 4    4 6  4 6 1  4 6 2  4 6 3  4 6 4  4 6 5    4 7   4 7 1  4 7 2  4 7 3  4 7 4    System Configuration    Getting Started   Installing MxControlCenter Manually   Updating an Older Version of MxControlCenter   Installing MxControlCenter Language Packages   Installing The MOBOTIX MxPEG DirectShow Codec   Configuring A Common Time Server   MxStatus  Status Monitoring For Multiple MxControlCenter Computers    Creating And Editing Layouts  Creating Layouts   Element Types Used In Layouts  Defining Grid Layouts   Defining Background Layouts   More Options When Editing Layouts    Setting Up Live Video Monitoring   Planning A Layout Structure   Configuring Layout Selection   Configuring Sequencers   Configuring Live Recording And The Local Archive   Configuring Extra Windows   Configuring MxControlCenter Remote Control And A Video Wall    Configuring The Program Views And The User Interface   Configuring The Scaling And Display Functions   Configuring The Toolbar   Configuring MxControlCenter Views   Configuring Functions For A Minimized Or Hidden MxControlCenter    Configuring Alarms And Recordings  Configuring Alarms on the Cameras  Configuring What To Reco
195. an object that  has crossed a line is no longer counted by the line  This setting increases the  accuracy of the object counting process if objects are moving on the line in close  proximity and crossing the line more than once     Display  Specify how counting lines are displayed in the camera image   Counting line color  Specify the color for counting lines     Text color  Specify a color for counting values and line IDs to ensure that they are  easily visible against different background images     Counting line IDs  Choose whether you would like to display the counting line  IDs in the camera image     Counting values  Choose whether you would like to display the counting values  in the camera image        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    21 2   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       Heat Map Settings    e Display  Choose whether you would like to display heat maps in the live image   We recommend switching on the display for a short check only  as the display  in the live image generates a high computing load     e Minimum and maximum values  This setting allows you to specify whether you  would like to display all the movements captured in the heat map or movements  within specific value ranges only  This way  you can choose to only display move   ments that occur very frequently  for example     e Legend  Choose whether you would like to display an explanation of the color  meanings     Next
196. and higher   Hemispheric cameras  e g   the Q24M with 180   lens and 11 mm focal length   on the other hand  deliver images just  like a regular PTZ camera     Setting up the display mode of a Hemispheric camera is a process that involves several  steps  It is also possible to set up the display mode in an S14D camera for both image  sensors separately  To do so  select the view of the corresponding sensor with ALT click  and enter the desired setting  When mounted to the ceiling  Hemispheric cameras actu   ally deliver full 180   images of the area beneath  this mode is called Full Image   see  right hand image below      4  Ceiling       Ceiling mounted Q24M Full Image       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       84 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter          Although the entire room is covered  the resulting full image from the camera is not really  suited for live viewing  For this purpose  the camera takes a section of the full image and  zooms in to show an Image Area  see right hand image below               Camera or  MxControlCenter       Full Image Image Area  slightly distorted   As you can easily see from the right hand image above  the blue line is bent  i e   the  displayed image is slightly distorted when looking at an Image Area     This is where automatic distortion correction takes over and produces a corrected image  section  this mode is called Area Corrected   the blue line in the
197. ange  the settings until you get satisfactory results  Proceed as follows to activate and adjust  image post processing     e Make sure that you have selected a video source in the perms  layout  yellow frame   Lm terion ressiuton    PTZ    Lens type     e Click on the down arrow to the right of the Image post   processing button     Camera mount     e Move the Post Processing dialog to the right or left of the  MxControlCenter application window     e Check the Activate checkbox     e Move the sliders up and down to see how the image of the  selected video source changes     The Post Processing dialog stays on your desktop until you close  it  So you can try to change the settings for other video sources   too  Simply select a different video source and follow the steps  above until you are satisfied with the results  If you want to undo  your changes  click on the Default button to reset the values           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings   1 5   3 9 2  te    The image post processing settings are per video source settings  i e   the settings  are stored separately for each video source  This allows applying different settings  for different video sources                 Once you have defined the desired settings  you can click on the Image post processing bal  button to activate or deactivate post processing for the selected video source in a layout  ED    yellow fram
198. anguages Extension  MX V3 5 2 23 r3 z Software Packages  __ MX System 4 0 4 19 panel with list of     MX V4 0 6 9 E  D2MT2M QM MM 5 13 11     software for down   mol German Russian  Japanese    loading  MX V3 5 2 23 13  nen    gt  Pee a    MX V4 0 7 31 Camera Information ax    Camera Information  MX V3 5 2 23 r3 oD Consactad panel with Update  Model  MOBOTIX Q24M Secure Log Preview Camera  MX V3 5 2 23 r3 Address  abemi Information tabs  Factory IP  10 38 85 61  MX V3 5 2 23 r3 Alt  IP   Host name  main entrance  Software version  MX V4 0 6 9  Resolution  Custom Size  1024x384   Encryption   Procrece  List of MOBOTIX  cameras   Update Log   Preview   Camera information               7 cameras   1 selected       To show or hide individual panels of Update Assistant  check uncheck the checkboxes  in front of the panel names of the View menu           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 3 8   3 92 MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features    5 1 2 Update Assistant Toolbar Buttons       As shown in the overview of the Update Assistant s main window above  the toolbar  provides quick access to the most important functions     Manually add cameras by IP address  IP  aP Add Cameras address range or URL        Allows changing the connection settings  e g   L Connection Settings    user name and passwords  of the selected  cameras           Finds all available cameras available in the                af Search Cameras physical 
199. application  Double click on the shortcut on your desktop  in Start  gt   Programs or on the MxCC   exe file in the program folder        When launching MxControlCenter for the first time  the Windows Firewall shows a  message asking you whether or not to block the application  Make sure that you  click on Unblock so that MxControlCenter can function properly     By default  MxControlCenter is a single user application where the user that started  the application has full control of the entire system  By adding groups and users   however  you can configure the application as a multi user system  see Section 4 7     Users  Groups And Group Rights        MxControlCenter supports different languages  To switch to a different language while  the application is running  select Tools  gt  Language in the menu  click on one of the  available languages and restart MxControlCenter  To install additional languages   see Section 4 1 3    Installing MxControlCenter Language Packages             2 4 1 Finding And Configuring Video Sources    When MxControlCenter is launched for the first time  the Add Video Sources dialog box opens     Add Video Sources       Name   mx 10 8 100 132  ODES OSES  E mx10 8 104 199   8  mx 10 8 104 200    4    IP Address Path  10 8  100  132  10 8  100  135  10 8  104  199  10 8  104 200  10 8  104 201  10 8  104 203  10 8  104 204  10 8  104 205  10 8  104 206  10 8  104 207  10 8  104 208  10 8  104 209  10 8  104 210  10 8  104 211  10 8  104 212  10 8  104
200. ar   e Window areas  Show options  menu  title bar  ee ee  etc    sidebar and toolbar options   ancam       Example for Using Views    In this example  two views are used on one MxControlCenter installation   a simple view  for live monitoring only and the view of the store detective  see example in Section 3 2 10     Using The Live Recording Feature        e Live monitoring only  Reduced   bare bones   view with grid layouts that can be  selected using the layout buttons in the toolbar  as briefly described in   Creating A  Reduced     Bare Bones     MxControlCenter View        e Store detective   s view  View with all required sidebar elements  Navigator  Player   PTZ Controls  etc    The user can select this view after logging in     Creating A New Or Overwriting An Existing View  This procedure stores the current user interface configuration as a new view and also  allows overwriting existing views    e Configure the user interface according to your requirements    e Select View  gt  Saved views  gt  Save as from the menu     e Inthe Save View as dialog  enter a name for the new view or select an existing one  from the Name dropdown  in this case  the existing view will be overwritten by the  new configuration      e Activate the Display Area Options and Application Window Areas checkboxes  as required     e Click on Save to store the view and to close the dialog        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Con
201. argets    O axis 1       main gate     north gate    east gate    Parking 1    mx10 9 42 99         main entrance    Downtown office    back door          Event Trigger 2  Event switch   On X      F  Al Events      v Video Motion  VM       video Moton 2  M2          4  User Click  UC     Test Configuration          This tab of the Camera Configuration allows selecting several video sources        Alarm Targets Gp    e Enable  Activates the sending of network messages for the selected cameras     e Acknowledge  When set to On  this setting activates an alarm acknowledgement  request that is also sent to the IP addresses ports in the list below        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 2 8   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference          If a recipient does not acknowledge a network message  the selected cameras  will send the message to the next recipient in the IP Address Port list     To acknowledge such a request  the users need to click on the title bar of the  alarm image in the alarm list as described in Section 3 4 3    Reacting To Alarms             The local MxControlCenter e IP Address Port  Click on the plus       button below to add a new IP address   computer is always listed port as recipient of the network messages  Double click on the  lt IP gt  and  lt Port gt   as a recipient  This is f       ae entries of the new line and enter the proper IP address and port of the recipient  To  indicated by an 
202. as  section of the Navigator sidebar panel     e Do one of the following       Right click and select Configure from the context menu     Select Video Source  gt  Configure from the menu         Click on the Open camera configuration button FE    The    Camera Configuration    Dialog Tabs     E camera Configuration      E Q HVK  amp  O m    Overview Image Settings Expomre Recording Audio Events Network Messages Time Server Mioinaiy  cs    arming  4 Recording       audo    Gmer H ies      lt tntenainam gt  pi  vaa csoxa DEl  G mmu H  events o    H   nes  10 0 32  248  Pl  vaa  640x480    G mmr H iets      lt intensinam gt   5  voa  640x080  I  G wm  v2  u_ H   Events    H    lt Rec off gt   E  vGa  640x480     gt   lt rot suppo    H  events o    H   SO Fash Card  F  vsa  1024768       lt rot suppo    H  Events oH    H   50 Fash Card  E  wea  2024x768     Codec  F mees q y n   Resolton  PS  vGa  440x480  G YM  wma UC  TT  JPEG quality  bel 60     vert       HI Events poft do   Transfer rate   2 Maimu T  get F   CIPS  10 0 30 39   Whyte balance  D mot supperted gt        e Overview  This tab lists the settings of all cameras available in MxControlCenter   e Image Settings  This tab controls the image settings of the cameras   e Exposure  This tab allows adjusting exposure settings of the cameras     e Recording  This tab allows configuring the recording settings  which determines how  and where the video data is archived     e Audio  This tab activates and deactivates the microp
203. ason  MxControlCenter logs the reason in the action log that is checked  regularly by a supervisor        To implement this scenario  you need to set the Export right of the Guards group to Reason   e Select Tools  gt  Users  amp  groups in the menu and activate the Group Rights tab     e For the Guards group  set the Export dropdown in the Playback  Export  amp  Printing  section to Reason     e Click on OK to close the dialog     The guards will now have to enter a reason every time they are exporting video and  MxControlCenter automatically logs the reason in the Action Log  To view the contents  of the action log  proceed as outlined in Section 4 8 6    Configuring And Monitoring The  Action Log       4 8 Security Considerations    When setting up a video surveillance system  you should also take every precaution to  avoid security problems     4 8 1 General Thoughts On Network Security    e Certain MxControlCenter features  remote control  for example  require additional  ports to be open on a Windows computer  Make sure that the Windows computer  running MxControlCenter is behind a firewall     e Some anti virus scanners are checking all data streams that enter the computer   As a result  an anti virus scanner may identify the video audio data received in  the MxControlCenter camera as malicious code and block it  If the corresponding  mechanisms of the anti virus scanner are deactivated  the anti virus protection of  the computer is incomplete  For this reason  the MxC
204. ate  max  4 fps  and the image size of the transferred video stream     A preview window requires significantly fewer resources and causes less network  traffic compared to a live window  This element is particularly efficient when your       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Display windows    Icons    Buttons    Display windows    rs    Q24M live  icon      60   3 Q 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       network has limited bandwidth and you are displaying many different video sources  in the layout     Available video sources  MOBOTIX cameras     You can use the preview video stream with a specific image sensor  reduced frame  rate and resolution in addition to and independent of a live  regular  video stream  of the same camera              Example  You would also like to see images from your cameras at home in the office   At home  you can run MxControlCenter with a regular live window  In the office  you    are using a preview window for the same camera since the upstream bandwidth of  your home DSL connection is too low for a live video stream        e Video clip  This display window can be used to automatically show a previously  recorded MxPEG video clip      mxq file  in continuous playback  This element type can  also be used for alarm list files  In addition  you can set the size of the display window     This element is typically used to quickly see the video from a live recording or after 
205. ation       4 LAYOUTS  4    Overview   Outside   B Main Entrance   B west gate   B Parking   H Garage Entrance  4 a  Overview   Inside   B Reception   B Elevators   B Back Entrance   B outside   Player   B Inside   Player    4 VIDEO SOURCES  Back to Overview    West gate      e Operators are using toolbar buttons at the top or at the bottom of MxControlCenter   s  main window  Continue with   Using Layout Buttons In The Toolbar       Arranging Grouping Layouts In The Layout Manager  To group or rearrange the layouts in the LAYOUTS section of the Navigator sidebar panel   proceed as follows    e Drop a layout on another one to start a group    e Move a layout up or down to change the order     e Move a layout to the left and out of the current group  either up or down  to change  the hierarchy level     Using Layout Buttons In Layouts    These buttons represent a convenient way for the operators to switch from one background  layout to a different background or grid layout  To define the buttons  proceed as described  in   Other Elements   in Section 4 2 4    Defining Background Layouts       Using Layout Buttons In The Toolbar    Layout buttons in the toolbar allow switching between layouts  but are part of the applica   tion window rather than a layout  such as layout buttons   The layout buttons can be shown  either at the top of the application  as in the figure below  or at the bottom  You can use  these buttons to access the layouts without having to permanently show the
206. ation  the system successfully proved its performance  capability by identifying rowdy fans     The police officers were actually more  than surprised by the high detail images to be used as evidence from  our MOBOTIX cameras     happily commented Donbass Head of Security  Sergey Burgela        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    44 3    MxCC User Manual  MxCC Performance Details       MxControlCenter Functions                Audio transmission    Yes  bidirectional    General   Number of manageable cameras Yes Practically unlimited number of cameras   license free    Integration of analog digital cameras Yes  including Analog cameras can be integrated via   from third party manufacturers PTZ control MxServer  various IP cameras  from  third party manufacturers  can be  integrated directly    Decentralized system concept Yes Decentralized recording directly in the  cameras with event detection an  flexibly configurable alarm actions    Cascadable installations Yes Central management and monitoring of  several MxCC locations from a central  MxCC location     branch operation        Joystick support Yes Complete support of current joysticks    including storage movement to  positions  presets      If supported by camera model                 License fees No No license fees  no hidden costs    MxControlCenter is available free of  charge at www mobotix com    Localized program versions Yes German  English  French  Ch
207. avor of the decentralized  high resolution  video system  MxCC not only operates optimally with MOBOTIX cameras  but also allows  you to continue using already existing video cameras from other manufacturers  hybrid  solution   IP cameras and even analog  motor controlled PTZ cameras can be integrated   displayed live and remotely controlled via a virtual or real joystick  The recorded  videos of these third party cameras can also be evaluated and exported at the monitor  with MxCC     MOBOTIX Cameras Wie  a                      Analog Cameras    Z 7       Wxece       PTZ Cameras       For A Minimum Of Hardware Requirements    Once again  the decentralized camera technology plays a part as the system advantage  of decisive importance  Because the MOBOTIX cameras and not the video management  software perform the computational work  e g  movement detection  recording  storage   etc    MxCC needs only one standard PC with a monitor as the hardware platform     The modern system configuration based on the Internet Protocol  IP  can set up and  manage security projects of any size extremely economically using standardized network  components and connection paths that are usually already available        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       17 392    ilt zoom     stems from    entium 4 or better    s XP SP3 or higher      8   392 MxCC User Manual  All Functions At A Glance                Layouts  A layout includes 
208. ay back the event as described    in the   Playing Back The Event   section below     To resize the Player panel and the size of the playback window  simply move the separa   tor at the top of the panel up or down  To close the panel  double click on the separator     Playing Back The Event    Use the controls in the Player sidebar panel to play fo ne   back the events  The Player controls work just as TCI caac    described in Section 3 5 2    Search Playback In A  Live Display Window               MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings    123 392       The event you open in the Player panel serves as a starting point when browsing  the event images  When playing back an event  the Player will automatically move  to the next event in the direction of the playback  provided there is such an event    Once the end of the last event  or  when playing backwards  the beginning of the  first  has been reached  playback will stop automatically              Exporting Video Content    To export events from an Event Search   e Search the start of an interesting scene using these methods         Scroll through the list of events in the results panel and double click on the event  to open it in the Player panel         Set a date and time and click on the Go to Date Time button in the Player  sidebar panel         Move the red position indicator above the slider in the Player sidebar panel t
209. aying back MOBOTIX recordings  in MxPEG format in Windows Media Player  for example  see Section 4 1 4    installing  The MOBOTIX MxPEG DirectShow Codec        Availability of conversion tools  If you need files in AVC H 264 format  you can use  third party applications for converting AVI MPEG4 and MOV MPEG4 files  the video  formats exported by MxControlCenter  into this format  The following table contains  some examples of commercial as well as open source and freeware applications  that are suitable for this purpose        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    11 392                               Operating System Application Type Website  Expression Encoder Commercial www microsoft com  Windows H 264 Encoder Freeware www h264encoder com  Handbrake Open source www handbrake fr  ffmpegX Freeware www fimpegx com  Mac OS X Handbrake Open source www handbrake fr  Quicktime Pro Commercial www apple com  Handbrake Open source www handbrake fr  Linux MEncoder Open source www mplayerhq hu  VLC Open source www videolan org                      This table is by no means complete since there are many applications that can convert  video files into AVC H 264 format  When you search for    AVI to H 264 converter     or   MOV to H 264 converter    on the Web  you will find hundreds of applications for  this purpose that are suitable for your computer s operating system  see also Section 3 6 3     Exporting Recorded Video Foot
210. ayout buttons in the toolbar     e Hide the entire toolbar        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring The Program Views And The User Interface    189 392       Removing Group Rights  This method removes the buttons that are attached to the corresponding group privileges   If you want to prevent the users of a group from activating the audio from a camera  for  example  proceed as follows    e Open the Users  amp  Groups dialog  Tools  gt  Users  amp  groups in the menu     e Click on the Group Rights tab     e Set Live  gt  Audio right in the column of the user group that is not supposed to use  this function to Never     e Click on OK to close the dialog     For more information on users and rights  see Section 4 7    Users  Groups And Group Rights       Activating The Layout Buttons In The Toolbar    This method replaces the existing toolbar    buttons by the layout buttons  see    Using Layout Buttons In The Toolbar    in Section 4 3 2    Configuring Layout  Selection        The functions executed by the buttons on the replaced toolbar remain accessible  via the menu and the context menus  If you want to disallow users from using any  of these functions  make sure that you configure the group privileges accordingly   see Section 4 7    Users  Groups And Group Rights                 Hiding The Entire Toolbar    This procedure removes the entire toolbar from the application window   e Deactivate View
211. ayouts in which the icons indicate the viewing direction and image angles of the  cameras  This element also indicates the surveillance status of the camera using  different colors  i e   whether an MxControlCenter computer is displaying the live  image of the assigned video source        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Creating And Editing Layouts   61   3 92          7 Image sensor 1    Image sensor 2  Viewing drectiox 0 j  Viewing drection 120  Focallength 32 n Focallengh 22  Apex ange  90 ft Apex angle  90  Name  Nosthwest  Tookip  Nodhwest comer  Diameter 20  Camera OK  Camera OK  No connection to  monitored not monitored camera    When you click on a status icon in the layout  the live image of a camera or video  source will automatically be displayed in the focus window  see the Focus window  element above         When setting up an installation with several MxControlCenter computers  you can use  MxStatusto remotely monitor the status of all cameras connected to MxControlCenter  computers     For more information about installing and configuring MxStatus  see Section 4 1 6     MxStatus  Status Monitoring For Multiple MxControlCenter Computers                MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com      6 2   3 Gg 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       Elements With Variable Video Sources    Alarm Player window  This display window shows t
212. bal or specific user   password used     Use proper user password  in global settings or camera  properties        MxCC uses too much RAM when  showing a layout with many  cameras    Local Recorder uses too much  RAM per camera     Reduce Local Recorder size  to 1 MB  Tools  gt  Options  gt   General         Layouts do not fill the monitor     MxCC does not scale freely     Activate free scaling in MxCC        MxCC workstation does not play  alarm sounds although sound  system is working     Sound on alarm not activated  in MxCC     Activate alarm sounds in  Tools  gt  Options on Alarm  Handling tab        MxCC responds slowly     Computer performance insuf   ficient for number of cameras  in layout     Use more powerful computer   reduce number of cameras  in layout        Free scaling of many cameras  uses too much performance     Deactivate free scaling in  MxCC        MxCC does not show camera  in focus window of background  layout any more     Layout Manager active     Deactivate Layout Manager        PTZ features do not work     Layout Manager active     Wrong or no user password  set in MxCC for this camera     Deactivate Layout Manager     Set proper user password in  MxCC for this camera        When activating Player mode  for a display window  camera  shows    No frame available     message     After replacing camera  MxCC  does not show any new record   ings     Wrong storage target set in  MxCC     Storage target in MxCC still set  to path of replaced camera     S
213. bcam  Image quality is the key factor for webcam applications  This image program  hence uses Quality image quality and the M JPEG video codec     6 3 3 The    Exposure    Tab    This tab shows any defined exposure windows with a thin green border  Click on an exposure  window to activate it and to show its coordinates in the Frame Details group  see below      This tab contains the following sections     E Camera Configuration et           E eQ AJA V OC fw    Overview Image Settings Exposure Recording Audo Events Network Messages Time Server MxAnalytcs       Sensor Control  Left Sensor    _ Exposure Time  Exp  program    O Standard     2     Min  exp  tme  1 8000 sec X  Max  exp  tme    1 8 sec      Exposure Hode    Virtual PTZ    Exposure Windows   Quarter O    j Show windows   Off X    Jed e  4  ETEN Weight   100  v   w Balance  Tota      Brightness    40   2             MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Camera Configuration    Dialog    315 392          This tab of the Camera Configuration allows selecting only one video source   On dual lens camera models  the right sensor is the default image sensor     The options of the Exposure Windows  Weights and Frame Details sections are  only available if Exposure Mode has been set to Recording           Sensor Control GD    These buttons allow selecting the lens  image sensor  that the camera currently uses  only  available on Dual camera models      Right 
214. bout The System    Lab Installation Of Components  Defining Hardware Groups    A 2 2 Naming Labeling Of All Components  A 2 3 Connecting And Powering Up All Components  A 2 4 Installing MxControlCenter On One Workstation       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    277  278  279  281  282  283    286    288    288  289  292  294  296  299  302  304    305  305  306  306  307    309  310  312  314  318  322  323  327  329  330    332    334  335    335  335  336  336  337    7 392    8 392    MxCC User Manual       A 3 Configuring The Storage Systems   A 3 1 Configuring The Server Settings Of The Storage System  A 3 2 Configuring The Network Settings Of The Storage System  A 3 3 Finishing The Configuration Of The Storage System   A 4 Configuring The Camera Network Settings    A 5 Creating And Distributing A Camera Master Configuration  A 5 1 Overview   A 5 2 Using The Quick Installation Wizard   A 5 3 Setting The Admin Menu Options   A 5 4 Additional Camera Settings   A 5 5 Storing And Testing The Master Configuration   A 5 6 Distributing The Master Configuration    A 6 Adjusting Sets Of Cameras  A 7 Finishing The Lab Configuration Of The Cameras    A 8 Configuring MxControlCenter   A 8 1 Configuring The Global Settings   A 8 2 Adding Video Sources To The MxControlCenter Workstation  A 8 3 Creating A Basic MxControlCenter Configuration   A 8 4 Configuring The Alarm Handling   A 8 5 Setting Additional Operating System
215. boxes   Options  General   Connection Defaults View   Alam Handling Remote Control   Monitoring   Action Log  Mouse  On double click    Open extra window    Q Alt Click for PTZ   v    MouseOver  off      On  By MultiView   V  Small area          Show toolbar at bottom        Layout buttons in toolbar     Show grid borders   Center grid layouts   Show Player icon in recordings     Application  On top after  seconds       Always on top     Demo mode     Synchronize clips on start     No configuration loaded    Mouse D    e On double click  Controls the behavior of MxControlCenter when double clicking  a video source in a layout          Do nothing  Deactivates the double click feature  default setting          Switch lens  dual cameras only   Switches from the right to the left lens and vice  versa         Open extra window  Opens an extra window that can be freely moved and scaled   depending on the original  this is either a player or a live window        Open extra Live window  Opens an extra window that is always a live window   regardless of the type of original window        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Options    Dialog    295 392       Alt Click for PTZ  When setting On double click above to Open exira  Live  window  a  double click by default also executes a pan tilt action  i e   moves the clicked position  to the center of the visible image section   Activate this option to avoid this behav
216. button in the toolbar  and the yellow Alarm Instructions icon in the title bar of a display window indicate  that an instruction file is available  Click on the button or the icon to see the file or  right click on the window and select Show Alarm Instructions     e Alarm List  Make sure that MxControlCenter shows the alarm list  Right click on an  image of the alarm list and select Show Alarm Instructions     The alarm instructions file can be an image  an HTML file or web page in your browser   a text file or any other file type that contains further instructions     Showing The Preferred Layout Of A Video Source    When working with more cameras that fit comfortably into one layout  you may need to create  several layouts  While you can easily switch to a different layout by clicking on a different  one in the Navigator  MxControlCenter can automatically switch to the Preferred Layout  of the video source that sends an alarm message  provided such a layout has been set      Using this approach  MxControlCenter can automatically show the alerts in layouts that  have been optimized for this purpose  You can thus show exactly the information needed  by the operator when a certain alarm comes in     if a preferred layout has been set for the video source  yellow frame   this button is active  in the toolbar  Click on this button or right click on the window and select Load preferred  layout to manually switch to the preferred layout of the active camera  yellow frame      On b
217. c alarm     Recording parameters  Events detected by the camera activate a recording with a  specific frame rate  resolution and pre alarm and post alarm recording  In addition to the  internal SD card recording  the camera can also store on a PC or NAS  e g   SnapServer         e 0e Avv e    Bidensiekryen Beidhtung Aufeidrug Audo Ereignisse Netzwerkmeidungen          Nane    928 411    192 468 4114    192 168 41 136    192 168 41 164    192 168 41 177    ae   ie     izina   Same oS a E E ee Bl     192 168 41 19 a    n it       192 168 41 20 on an aay nt im pt     192 168 41 27 A               192 160 41 28  i s Pid im IE z I My  f     19219 40 apii     192 168 41 49       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    39 392       Installing MOBOTIX Cameras    With MOBOTIX  both software and hardware are equally easy to install  Unpack the  camera  screw it to the ceiling  wall or pole  Connect the network cable and you are  done  Probably no other camera can be connected more quickly or easily     Integration Of MOBOTIX Video Door Stations    MxCC also integrates the new MOBOTIX T24 IP video door station   you can open the  door  switch on the lights and speak over the intercom with a live image very comfortably  from any MxCC workstation        T24 MxCC    Door Station Door Station Integration    Functions    Door  Light  Speak    Free Of Charge  A Convenient Update Wizard    A large share of the functions of the entire 
218. cal camera network     without an Internet connection or an existing time server   but a MOBOTIX GPS Box is connected     Here  the GPS Box is automatically used as a time source for the MOBOTIX camera  connected to it  In turn  this camera is used as a time source for all other cameras  and devices     3  Camera network with an Internet connection or an existing time server     In this constellation  one or multiple cameras can be linked with an external time  server and these cameras can then be used as a time server for other cameras     To find more information about using NTP on Windows computers  go to Microsoft s web  site and search for Windows Time Service     MxCC allows you to quickly and easily set a common time reference for all the cameras  according to the three scenarios outlined above  You can do this in the Time server tab  of the Camera Configuration dialog box  See Section 6 3 8    The    Time Server    Tab   for  additional information and troubleshooting on configuring a time server     4 1 6 MxStatus  Status Monitoring For Multiple MxControlCenter Computers    MxStatus is a stand alone program that collects and distributes information about the  monitoring status of MOBOTIX cameras  Using MxStatus  you can implement the Background  layout example of a soccer stadium scenario described in Section 3 2 1    Displaying Video  Content In Layouts     f required  see Note box below   you can execute this program on  one computer in the network  Note that the p
219. called LangPack MxCC_V2 5 1  lt language _country  gt  exe  where      lt language _ country   gt     is replaced by the corresponding language and country  codes as in these examples     e For Italian  download the file McCLanguagePack V2 5 1 it exe     e For Chinese  China   download the file LangPack MxCC_V2 5 1 zh CN exe     To Install An MxControlCenter Language Package  Make sure that you are only downloading language packages for the installed version of  MxControlCenter  e g     LangPack MxCC_V2 5 1 zh CN exe    for MxCC Version 2 5 1     e Obtain the LangPack MxCC_V2 5 1   exe installation file  where         is the  language and country code          Download the installation file from the MOBOTIX website and save the file on  your computer  for example  on the Desktop          If you have received installation media  CD  DVD  USB stick   find the folder of  the installation file     e Quit MxControlCenter if the application is running        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com      5 2   3 Q 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       e Launch the LangPack MxCC _V2 5 1  lt language  country  gt  exe instal   lation file    e Follow the instructions of the installation wizard  Make sure that you are installing  the language package into the same program folder as MxControlCenter  if you  changed the target folder  you may have to delete the extra    Mxcc    appended by  the installation wizard      e Th
220. calls MxRemotePreview  for specific file types  MxRemotePreview reads the original files from the file server  recodes  the video contents on the fly as specified in the HTTP request  and returns the transformed  data back to the MxControlCenter computer  This allows MxControlCenter to receive the  data fast enough to build an event list and to play back the video sequences     MxRemotePreview runs as a CGI module within a dedicated web server  Apache or  Microsoft Internet Information Server  on a Windows or Linux machine  The cameras  can store the recordings on the same machine or on a different file server NAS system  If       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    MxControlCenter  computer    278   3 92 MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       the recordings are available on a different file server NAS system  the MxRemotePreview  server should have a high bandwidth connection to that file server NAS system     e Make sure that you are using the web server on the computer only for recoding  purposes and not for anything else     e You can use this computer also as a file server for the camera recordings   However  if the computer displays performance problems  you should consider  using a different computer as file server              MxRemotePreview Installation Overview   e Install and configure the web server    e Install the MxRemotePreview CGI module    e Configure the web server     Specify the file type
221. cameras       7 7   Export from 1 17 11 3 54 23 AM to 1 17 11 4 09 10 AM  Slider control with                   start stop markers J     12 23 10 10 29 59 AM 1 17 11 8 45 12 AM  Export format of  target video Apply image post processing ind  PTZ Export as   MxPEG    mxg       Settings        v  Copy application files Details  w  as ZIP archive  Container  MxPEG    mxg   video  MxPEG  audio  MxPEG  max  file size  128 MB    Check Digital Signature  Check      Cose     Export options    You can fill the Export List with video sequences from different cameras and using  all methods provided by MxControlCenter  such as Player windows  event searches   recordings in the local archive as well as the Video Search dialog                 When exporting  you should keep the Copy application files checkbox activated   This exports the video data  the application files  and the PlayVideo cmd file   Double clicking on this file automatically launches MxControlCenter and starts play   ing back the exported video              MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    136 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       Deciding On A Target Video Format    Before we actually start compiling a list of interesting scenes for exporting  we need to  take a moment to decide upon the format of the exported video  Since this depends on  the operating system of the target computer and the intended use of the video  you should  select the f
222. can be converted as desired via the  main computer by a mouse click and MxCC  The main computer activates a port of  the client s IP address in a purely technical manner and transfers the preset monitor  display as a network message     now switch to MxCC display x using cameras y and z         Decentralized Video Wall  Reduces Costs  Increases Reliability    e Easy to implement decentralized concept for video walls of any size   e No licensing fees and no additional software required except for MxCC   e Cost effective mini PCs as clients  no keyboard  no hard drive    e ifa client malfunctions  its display can simply be switched to a different monitor    e Layout of video walls can be modified with a network command  the command  can also be automatically triggered by specific events or at specific times from  a MOBOTIX camera    e Scenarios can be defined  e g  all parking spaces  all vehicle access points   and  allows you to switch between individual monitors and the entire video wall at  the push of a button       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    25 392       The same MxCC  software as on the  main computer runs   on each client  but in  remote operating mode    The layouts of the  clients are switched in  the main computer  e g   display of parking lot   1 or 2 on monitor 4        The layout displayed on each client monitor can be changed via the main computer   remote control function of MxCC         MO
223. can create a layout in  which the display of a camero   s live image alternates in a large window     You can define a global time interval for the sequencer window under Tools  gt  Options  gt   General  gt  Behavior  gt  Sequencer time  Sequencer windows in background layouts  have a gray title bar     Focus window  This display win   dow always shows the images of  the last live window or status icon   background layouts only  you clicked  on  Click on a different camera s live  window to show the live stream of that  camera in the focus window     A typical use of this element is one  focus window in the center with  many smaller live windows around   see figure         A layout can only have one focus window  Focus windows in background layouts  have a gray title bar        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Creating And Editing Layouts   63  3 92    Other Elements       Besides the layout elements already described in   To Install An MxControlCenter Language  Package   and   Elements With Variable Video Sources   above  the following additional  elements are available for background layouts only     e Close Windows  This button closes all extra  floating  live image windows  Extra  live image windows are automatically opened when you double click any display  window or icon that has an assigned video source     Right click on the button to delete it or to set its background color     e Configure Sequencer 
224. can therefore  create new folders  move folders up and down or onto other  folders to create subfolders  In addition  you can rename 4    Suspicious  and delete folders  with the exception of the Live Recordings i March 23  folder  which only stores the recordings when clicking on the   corresponding button      4 LOCAL ARCHIVE    MxControlCenter shows the stored clips in the display area when you click on one of  the folders        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       130 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       3 5 12 Checking The Data Integrity Of Recordings    If you intend to use recorded video content in a court of law  you need to make sure that  the recordings of the cameras have not been manipulated  MOBOTIX cameras can digitally  sign the video sequences at the time of recording using public key cryptography  see  en wikipedia org   The digital signature allows verifying the publisher of the files  i e    a MOBOTIX camera  and that the recorded content has not been manipulated later on     In order to sign the recordings  the camera uses a private public key pair  also called a  digital certificate  that is either self signed  generated  or has been issued by a certificate  authority  CA in short   MxControlCenter can later check the signatures of the recordings  against the public key of the certificate     MOBOTIX camera Audio video recording MxControlCenter      wo Signs    _ Verifies  
225. case is a  camera that can be reached using a fixed IP address     In many cases  however  the cameras are connected to the Internet using a broadband  connection with dynamic IP addresses that change every day  This kind of Internet con   nection requires using DynDNS  dynamic domain name resolution   The dynamic DNS  process allows using a given name registered with a free DynDNS service provider  e g   www  dyndns   org  instead of a fixed IP address  e g  213 117 53 215   The inte   grated DynDNS client of your broadband router automatically updates the IP address of  the DynDNS service if the IP address changes  This service thus allows adding the camera  using its DynDNS name and the corresponding port  e g  mycamera  dyndns org  8001      The IP addresses of cameras  routers  the ports and the DynDNS name mycamera   dyndns  org are only examples  Make sure that you are not using the same  names and ports  but rather assign your own names and ports for accessing your  cameras via DynDNS                 It is highly recommended to only use flat rate tariffs for the Internet connection of  the cameras or the router  Using a different tariff may produce costs that are too high     Make sure that the factory access data of the cameras  user name    admin    and  password    meinsm     have been changed              MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       2 5 4   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       Ho
226. ce on the  ideal sensitivity  Therefore  it is recommend to test the settings to determine the best  one  Normal  Linear  Exponential  Short  Ultra short     e Fast patch  Use this option to control the pan tilt head faster and more precisely   This option is only available for specific pan tilt heads     The Fast patch option requires a camera software version that has been modi   fied by a patch from MOBOTIX     Do not activate the Fast patch option unless this patch has been installed  on the corresponding MOBOTIX camera  The MxControlCenter controls for a  pan tilt head do notwork with the normal  unmodified camera software if the  Fast patch option has been activated  Additional information on this feature is  available from our technical support team  www  mobotix   com  gt  Support               e Joystick control  By default  the displayed image  or the camera itself  is moved to  the right when moving the joystick to the right  You can use these options to invert  the horizontal  X direction  and vertical  Y direction  movements        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Camera Configuration    Dialog 3 O 9  3 9 2       6 3 The    Camera Configuration    Dialog  The Camera Configuration dialog is the main dialog for configuring the cameras of a  MOBOTIX surveillance system  Do the following to open this dialog     e Selecta video source in a layout  yellow frame  or in the VIDEO SOURCES  gt  Camer
227. cent text box     Ifthe local MxControlCenter computer has not yet been configured to receive network  messages  the Camera Configuration dialog automatically adjusts the settings in  the Options dialog  Tools  gt  Options  gt  Alarm Handling  Alarm Messages section   accordingly                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Camera Configuration    Dialog    329 392       6 3 8 The    Time Server    Tab    The system must be synchronized to ensure all cameras and devices are running in a  synchronized manner  To do this  use this tab to set the local time of the computer as  the current system time for the cameras selected or set one or multiple time servers to  synchronize the cameras     The tab contains the following sections     Camera Configuration           ROE SV O  amp     Overview Image Settings Exposure Recording Audio Events Network Messages Time Server MxAnalytics          Name    Recommendations  Select the cameras to configure in the list of video sources  Press  Set time on cameras    to apply  the local time of this computer to the selected cameras  Setting one or more time servers will keep    all selected cameras in sync  Using one or more time servers as master cameras wil provide more  rebable time synchronisation  You should also configure your computers to use one of the time    Wednesday  December 5  20127 1057 23  co nma an amarae  AM Mitteleurop  ische Sommerzeit Set time on c
228. checkbox  sets the search time in the Player sidebar  panel to 3 30 pm  clicks on the Go to Date Time button and then clicks on the Fast  Backward button  MxControlCenter now plays back the cameras in synchronized fash   ion so the detective can check the individual cameras to find out which way the suspi   cious person took through the entire building        3 5 5 Playback In Layouts With Alarm Player Windows    An Alarm Player window shows the last recording of the camera you clicked on in the  Alarm List  You can use one or more of these display elements to quickly access the  recordings of the last camera that triggered an alarm     How Alarm Player Windows Work                          Alarm 4 j   camera 2  5 l    i j   h  i    i    S N    Alarm 3    ee i   camera 2  G oF af 5  i       ee  en   a za    gt         j   i       a  Alarm 2  iii       camera 1  PE  gt  a               g 3 a    E Za      i  x 49600 uc  gt  b By  lt     Alarm 1 BS etre Alarm Player window always shows alarm of last cam    camera       era clicked on in the Alarm List  eo bs     ee    Alarm List Display area with layout    Click on a camera in the Alarm List dropdown to fill the Alarm Player window   e MxControlCenter shows the selected alarm of the camera     e ifthe Player sidebar panel is visible  MxControlCenter moves the current position  indicator to the last available alarm     e Clicking on one of the playback buttons starts playing back the recorded alarm     To export some or all of th
229. ck  the recorded video stream until you find the interesting footage of an incident  for example        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings    117 392       When playing back recordings  you can only apply distortion correction if the cam   era had been recording full image  If this had been the case  you can use the  MxControlCenter Panoramaand Panorama Focus display modes  for example  see  table in the   MxControlCenter Display Modes   section               Activating The Virtual PTZ In Recordings    e Open a recording by doing one of the following     On alive window  click on the Activate Player mode button       Click on a player window         Open any event search in the Navigator  gt  EVENT SEARCHES section in the sidebar   then double click on an event to open it in the player panel     e Open the PTZ Controls sidebar panel     e Inthe MxCC Display Mode group  set the lower dropdown to Image Area or Area  Corrected  depending on the camera model      Once you have activated the virtual PTZ on a recording  you can use the PTZ controls as  described in Section 3 2 9    Using The Virtual PTZ Functions On Live Images       3 5 8 Using Event Searches    Predefined event searches provide an excellent method for quickly finding the events  recorded by the MOBOTIX cameras  This type of search also allows fulfilling specific sur   veillance requirements similar to these exam
230. click on Inbound Rules in  the left panel  then click on New Rule in the right panel     In the New Inbound Rule Wizard  select the Rule type and click on Next     Select the TCP option  enter 31754  as in the example  in the Specific local ports  field and click on Next     Select the Allow the connection option and click on Next     If this is not a mobile computer  you should deactivate the Public checkbox for security  reasons  Click on Next     Enter a descriptive name for the rule  e g  MxCC Alarm Handling Port  and  click on Finish     Close all open Firewall related dialogs and the Control Panel        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 04   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       P    fs AJ  i 1   en      Network Messages    Testing The IP Address And Port    Alarm Targets    e Open the Camera Configuration  dialog  Adwemtedoe   on      IP Address Port    e Click in the Network Messages tab  J  172 16 0 23 E 31754    e Inthe Test Configuration group box   click on the Test button     e Check if the test is successful  Je JAA      If it is successful  the box shows ee oe on    the status OK     J  Al Events      If it is not successful  the box  shows the status Timeout  This J   Video Motion  VM       Video Motion 2  VM2     usually points to some kind of con   nection error  wrong IP address   port or firewall issue   Fix the  problem  click again on Apply   wait until the camera configura
231. company com  Port  25 5  defauk port 25     Encrypted connection  Never   TLS  f available SSL    If server requires authentication     User name  Password     Message    From  mxcc mycompany com   To  addresseel  mycompany com  addressee2 mycompany com   Ce    Bcc    Reply to   Contact  Phone    t   MxControlCenter  Dead Man s Switch on tsc vbox vista     Rich Text and Plain Text    Content  Only Plain Text       indicates a required field     Seaurity Vision Systems    face of P video    MxControlCenter    Ge aoe  88    Edit Template     for experts     Cancel    Send Test Mail       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    232 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       a    4 9 Working With MxControlCenter Configurations    Now that you have configured your MOBOTIX system  you may want to copy this configura   tion to other workstations  use different configuration files or create installations with specific  subsets of cameras  for example  This section of the manual will explain how to do this     What are MxControlCenter Configurations     MxControlCenter uses a configuration file  by default  MxCC   ini  to store its settings   When you add layouts or video sources  change the window size or other specific options  related to MxControlCenter  the corresponding settings are stored in this configuration  file  To store the configuration manually  select File  gt  Save from the menu or click on the  Save 
232. computer  for example  on the Desktop          If you have received installation media  CD  DVD  USB stick   find the folder of  the installation file     e Launch the MxcontrolCenter V2 5 1 Setup exe installation file     e Follow the instructions of the installation wizard        Make sure that you install the Apple Bonjour Service if the installation wizard prompts  you to do so or else the application may not be able to automatically locate MOBOTIX  cameras     MxControlCenter can automatically check for new program versions on the MOBOTIX  website  If new software is available  you can start the Update Assistant to download  and install the software as described in Section 5 1    Update Assistant   Software  Updates And More                   Today s anti virus programs are typically checking all streams that are entering a  computer  including the HTTP image streams from MOBOTIX cameras  It is therefore  highly recommended to add Mxcc  exe to the list of exceptions of your anti virus  program  Please consult the documentation of your anti virus program or your system  administrator if you do not know how to do this              MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    a         54 392    MxCC User Manual  System Installation and Initial Operation       2 4 Launching MxControlCenter For The First Time    Once you have installed MxControlCenter  see Section 2 3    Installing MxControlCenter      you can start the 
233. configuration button in the MxControlCenter toolbar  In addition  MxControlCenter  will ask you to save configuration changes when you quit the program     MxControlCenter automatically stores the Mxcc   ini configuration file in the hidden  Windows user folder     e Windows Vista 7  c  Users  lt user name gt  AppData Roaming   MOBOTIX MxControlCenter     e Windows XP  c  Dokuments and  Settings  lt user  name gt    Application Data MOBOTIX MxControlCenter      MxControlCenter configuration files should not be edited manually   Open Tools  gt  Folder options in the Windows Explorer  click on the View tab and    activate the Show hidden files and folders option in the Enhanced Settings list in  order to browse the AppData and Application Data folders              4 9 1 Automatically Loading Program Settings    As long as the Always select configuration file checkbox is notactivated  see Section 6 1 1     The    General    Tab     the MxControlCenter configuration file which was last saved opens   default setting   The last configuration file does not automatically load if this checkbox  is activated  Instead  the application displays the dialog box to open any configuration  file every time you start the program     If you would like to MxControlCenter always load a specific configuration file  use the shortcuts  to do so  as outlined in Section 4 9 3    Using Different MxControlCenter Configurations       4 9 2 Saving Program Settings And Exporting Installations    If you are
234. connection status of this camera is    Connected   Successfully connected to the camera        en Software upload in progress  te   Rebooting i g  eo  Connected             B Password  Protected  B linsufficient Privileges    Unreachable       Not a MOBOTIX Camera      Not a MOBOTIX Camera  or MOBOTIX Camera on Backup System  io  Connection refused      Unknown       Petected                              If cameras have identical user names and passwords  you can select several cam   eras using CTRL SHIFT click or press CTRL A to select all cameras  Then click on the  Connection Settings button and adjust the settings accordingly     The settings in the Proxy section of this dialog are per camera settings  They are  not to be confused with the proxy settings of the software download mechanisms   see   Why Is The Software Packages Panel Empty                  Make sure that the No Proxy option is activated when using the Connection Settings  dialog or else updating the software on the cameras may fail           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    241 392    242   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features    5 1 5 Updating The Software Of MOBOTIX Cameras       When updating the software of MOBOTIX cameras  you need to make sure that the  proper software versions are applied to the cameras  As a general rule  the first digit of  the software versions need to match     Examples    e Cameras with software version MX V
235. crease image    noise     e White balance  Sets a color profile to use for white balance control  default is  Automatic WB      e Noise suppression  Sets the level of noise suppression  default is Low   e Automatic contrast  Sets the strategy for improving image contrast        Off No contrast enhancement        Automatic  default   Applies uniform contrast enhancement      Extended  Applies non uniform contrast enhancement         Aggressive  Applies increased non uniform contrast enhancement  can result  in unnaturally looking images         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Move mouse pointer  over sliders to see  the controls    names    3   4   3 Q 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference       Image Program 5     The Image Program setting allows selecting from preset configurations that combine  various camera settings to provide the best quality image for a given application scenario     e Fast This image program prepares the camera for delivering live images as fast  as possible     e Security Application  This is the preferred image program for security applications   It uses Normal image quality     e Quality  This image program constitutes a good compromise between high quality  and fast images even if the illumination decreases  It uses Normal image quality     e High Quality  This image program puts higher priority on high image quality even  when illumination decreases  It uses Quality image quality     e We
236. cted in advance     Dead Man   s Switch  In the MxCC Toolbar  Provides Staff Protection    To be sure that a security control center is occupied and that the staff is not in danger   an alarm is sent on request by email or phone call in case the deadman switch was  not operated for an extended period        MOBOTIX AG e     Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       that only recent   seemed unimag    MxCC User Manual  Simple MOBOTIX Installation          Automatic Installation    You do not have to be a software specialist to set up MxCC  An installation assistant  guides you step by step  All cameras installed in the network  newly added or removed  are automatically found by MxCC  even in current operation  and can be configured  and remotely operated as desired     Fast Configuration In MxCC    With MxCC you can push a button to get an overview of all available cameras and  their basic settings such as the status of the camera arming  type or recording or stor   age location  You can change the configuration settings for individual  several or all  MOBOTIX cameras at once     Exposure control  To set the optimal exposure  you can use the camera s predefined  exposure window or set up your own exposure window for adjusting to local circum   stances  large window areas      Event settings  In addition to other events  it is possible here to set up one or more  camera image areas in which movements in the image trigger an automati
237. cting Remote  Cameras Using DynDNS      e MxPEG Clip  Adds an MxPEG video clip previously recorded by a MOBOTIX camera  as a video source     e Recording Path  Adds the path of an external file server that is used by a MOBOTIX  camera to store its recordings  The videos or snapshots recorded at that location  can be played back using the Player  Video Search or Event Search features of  MxControlCenter        A recording path is helpful when examining the recordings stored on an external  storage medium  for example        Editing The List Of Video Sources    To edit items in the Add Video Sources dialog  right click on an item in the list and select  one of the following options    e Select all  Selects all video sources    e Deselect all  Deselects all video sources    e Remove  Removes the selected video sources from the list    e Remove all  Removes all video sources from the list     e Configure network  Opens the Configure Selected Cameras dialog  which allows  configuring the camera s network connection so it works properly on your computer s  network     e User  amp  password  Allows you to define a different user and password in MxControlCenter  for accessing the camera  This is typically required when the camera uses a different  password other than the default  user admin  password meinsm      2 4 2 Using The Video Sources In MxControlCenter    You are now ready to add the MOBOTIX cameras to MxControlCenter  In the Add Video  Sources dialog  select the cameras you 
238. ction file for this camera   You will also configure the firewall on the MxControlCenter computer so that it does not    block the port used to receive the alarm messages     Make sure that the following prerequisites are fulfilled     e The cameras have been added to MxControlCenter   s list of video sources  see  Section 2 4 2    Using The Video Sources In MxControlCenter        e The cameras have been configured to send network messages  see   Setting  up Alarm Messages from the Camera to MxControlCenter   in Section 4 5 1     Contiguring Alarms on the Cameras                 Activating The Alarm List    e Select Tools  gt  Options from the MxControlCenter menu   e Click on the Alarm Handling tab   e Configure the Alarm List group box as shown below     Alam List  J  Activate List size   16 MB     Add live stream events           Alam List file   V C  Users  Tis  App Data  Roaming Mobotix Mixt  Open on new alam   V  Auto acknowledge alams after     Explanation Of Options    e Add live stream events  Detects alarms in the live video streams of the cameras that  belong to the current layout and automatically adds these alarms to the alarm list        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       200   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       Alarm List file  Stores the alarms in a separate file rather than in the computer s  memory  When restarting  MxControlCenter opens the alarm list file and automati   cal
239. ction is only necessary if you are  working with older cameras that do not include information on the lens type in the  video stream              To open the Post Processing dialog  click on the down arrow fo the right of the Image  post processing button     On older cameras  you can set the installed lens  and the mounting position in the Image Processing  dialog box  The results of distortion correction are  immediately visible as it straightens any skewed   i e   distorted  lines        3 5 7 Using The Virtual PTZ Features When Playing Back Recordings    As explained in Section 3 2 9    Using The Virtual  PTZ Functions On Live Images    MxControlCenter  provides enhanced virtual PTZ features  or short  vPTZ  features for zooming  panning and tilting  the video data delivered by MOBOTIX cameras              One of the truly remarkable features of the  MOBOTIX system is the fact that it can apply the  same mechanisms no only to live  but also to     ixzoom   Center  recorded images  This offers an entirely new per                    spective on the way recordings are taken and  i  processed later on              Consider the example below        Recorded full image Zoomed and corrected during  playback    The camera is recording full images  left   but when examining the recordings later on  you  can use the MxControlCenter   s virtual PTZ features to zoom into the recorded image and  to pan tilt the image section  right   You can thus find a specific image area and play ba
240. d    Parking  Z 2 Volt non maof ai  on to one store without having to Internationa i  Fia    RAaasar iret     open the Navigator sidebar panel     See   Using Layout Buttons In Layouts   in Section 4 3 2    Configuring Layout Selection          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       74 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       e Layout buttons in the toolbar  On some installations  these buttons  located either  above or below the display area  provide a quick method for switching between a  limited number of layouts     MxControlCenter   Overview   Outside       File View Layout VideoSource Recording Tools Help   H4 Overview   Outside HH Main Entrance HA West gate FA Parking  See   Using Layout Buttons In The Toolbar   in Section 4 3 2    Configuring Layout  Selection          When using the toolbar to show layout buttons  the toolbar does not show any  other toolbar buttons        3 2 3 Using Extra Windows To Display Video Sources    Up to this point  we have only examined video sources in layouts  However  certain situa   tions may require having an additional window of a video source  This is useful in instances  where  for example  the active windowis in Player mode  yet you want to see the camera  simultaneously in real time   MxControlCenter opens such an extra  floating  window if you do one of the following    e Double click on any display window or icon of a video source in a layout    e Doub
241. d door  openers as well as external audio components  speakers and microphones      Fast Ethernet    Ethernet connections with speeds of up to 100 Mbit s     FixDome  Camera without moving parts in a dome shaped housing     Flash Memory  See   CF Card     fps    Abbreviation of frames per second  see   Frame Rate      Frame Rate  Specifies how many frames per second    fps  are generated and sent by the camera  The  human eye perceives movement as a fluid video sequence when more than 16 images per  second are produced     FTP  Abbreviation of File Transfer Protocol  one of the standard protocols used to transfer large  files over the Internet  MOBOTIX cameras are using FTP to update webcam images on web  servers  for example     Gigabit Ethernet    Ethernet connections with speeds of up to 1000 Mbit s        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    371 392       Grid Layout    Layouttype in MxControlCenter  which shows cameras in a table with rows and columns  e g   the classic Quad view with four cameras in a two by two grid   In contrast to a   Background  Layout  you can only place the cameras in one of the grid   s display windows  MxControlCenter  comes with a set of predefined grids and also allows creating custom grids  The   Auto Grid  is a special type of grid layout  which automatically adjusts the size of the display windows  accroding to the display area and the numbers of cameras     GSM 2G  Abbreviatio
242. d operator then sends the recordings to the  authorities and switches back to the live display  This allows following the offenders so  that the authorities can pick them out of the crowd     Synchronized Playback Of Recordings    In order to prepare video clips for a case against one of the offenders  the operator of the  surveillance system at the soccer stadium is reviewing the recorded video footage  For  this purpose  the operator uses the synchronized playback feature of MxControlCenter   In this mode  MxControlCenter plays back the recordings of all cameras in a layout in  synchronized fashion  i e   the recordings are shown as they happened at the time     Once an interesting part of the recording has been identified  the operator can set the  start and end markers for the clip and can add it to the Export List     Finding All Recorded Events    Every morning when starting their workday  the operators of the video surveillance system  at a factory are required to check for new events that happened during the night  They  need to check the cameras at the entrances of the factory and additional cameras that are  securing specific points of interest  e g  server room  parking deck  etc    These cameras       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com             106   392   MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter    have been set up to start recording when they are detecting specific events  such as video  motion  sen
243. d to different monitors       Ae OB  O H OO     gt        Menu Bar O   DRR Function areas with associated sub    A os erario menu items such as Switch views   Forschung  2iF     Open files  etc   aA E Osnabr  dd  zo       T         Werthorstr                    Toolbar 7    Buttons for the most important func   tions such as live announcements via  a camera or printing       Display Panel O  All cameras of the currently selected  layout  e g  all cameras of the Hamburg  branch office  display as a grid or embed  as anicon video window in a background  image  e g  real building plan     Ne testelle    UME Fok O Heizwerk Sta    Koileweork Universitit    Fis kbi  s       Alarm List       Chronological display of the alarm images  from all cameras  a double click opens  the search that can be used to view and  export any recorded alarm       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       A site plan is  directly to four  video windows h    MxCC User Manual  Practical Camera Layouts             The highest priority of the MOBOTIX software developer is to make the daily work  of people in the security industry as simple and effective as possible with the video  management system and the cameras  This involves above all an immediate and reliable  recognition of unwanted situations and rapid reaction to all necessary measures  for counteracting the danger     MxCC therefore offers various possibilities for displaying the individ
244. data cable     Physical Network  A system of computers and networked devices that are connected by network cables    Swifches     Hubs  wireless devices or other suitable hardware  Physical networks may include one or  more   Logical Networks or be part of a logical network  The most simple network is a network  cable running from one computer s Ethernet port to the Ethernet port of a second computer   or a MOBOTIX camera  for example         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 4  39Q92 mxcc User Manual  MOBOTIX Glossary       Preferred Layout    Layout of a camera that is automatically displayed by MxControlCenter if that camera  sends an alarm     PTZ  Abbreviation of Pan Tilt Zoom  Refers to the movement of a video camera to the left and right   up and down  and to the camera s ability to enlarge an image     Quad Display  Layout in which the images from four cameras are displayed in one window     Resolution  Indicates the number of pixels used to produce an image  The more pixels an image has   the greater the detail when the image is enlarged  The resolution is expressed as either the  number of pixel columns times pixel rows  or as a total number of pixels  A VGA image has  640 columns and 480 rows  640 x 480 pixels   which equals 307 200 pixels  or approximately  0 3 megapixels     Ring Buffer  Type of storage where the newest items overwrite the oldest ones if the assigned disk space  is full  Commonly
245. de  and many more     Tm se    Qer  SelB OB HAia  ET ihe ORs O   QS  SriiBoa HAQ 2     000 asa GRe00  m  z     u Seek geir          MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com        23 392       Auto grid is a grid layout where the display panel is automatically split by MxCC into  smaller sections to show the various video sources  The user thus does not have to  bother with the breakdown     Grid layouts are always needed in practical situations when the display of the video sources  is located in the foreground  As with the building plans  any number of grid layouts  can be created and stored with a generally unlimited number of cameras as well     The live image displayed on the screen can be adapted to the available bandwidth of  the transmission path to the camera  For instance  a camera image is displayed every  ten seconds  under alarm conditions the system can automatically switch to a higher  image repetition rate  As a consequence  the load on the network is effectively relieved  and the bandwidth dependent transmission costs are considerably reduced     Cost savings resulting  from reduced band   width requirements              MxCC lets you prepare individual grids from grid elements of varying  size     from 80x80 to 320x240 up to a maximum of 2560x960 pixels     with  little effort  The available space will be divided up according to the width  of the display panel     7  gt   r  5  FS          o         MxC
246. dec on the target computer  Section 4 1 4    Installing The  MOBOTIX MxPEG DirectShow Codec           When using MxPEG in Windows Media Player  you cannot check the data integrity        How To Export A Video From Camera Recordings    The entire process of creating a video from camera recordings involves the following steps   1  Find the events that contain the video sequences you want to export     2  Add entire events or parts thereof to the Export List dialog  Note that you can add the  video sequences of different cameras and export the entire contents of the export  list as one video later on     3  Set the format for exporting  depends on the operating system of the target computer  and the intended use of the video      4  Export the contents of the Export List dialog  optionally checks the data integrity      Step 1  Find The Events For Exporting  If you want to find video sequences you want to include in the exported video  you can  use one of the following methods     e Use the Player controls in the sidebar to find and add video sequences to the export  list  To open the Player controls  do one of the following         Switch a live camera window in a layout to Player mode       Click on a Player window in a layout         Click on a predefined event search in the EVENT SEARCHES section of the Navigator  sidebar panel         Open a recording in the LOCAL ARCHIVE section of the Navigator sidebar panel   e Open the Video Search dialog        MOBOTIX AG    Security V
247. deo sources are arranged in  H  rectangles of the same or different sizes     Think of a three story parking deck and the security staff that are monitoring the decks        The security staff constantly monitors the cameras as MxControlCenter cycles through  the three grid layouts Deck 1  Deck 2 and Deck 3  Using the corresponding layout  buttons  the security staff can manually select one of the three layouts     e Background  These layouts are typically used to show the camera images or camera fas   icons on a floor or site plan  Buttons and other links allow switching from one layout  to the next and back        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com        70 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       Think of a soccer stadium and its surroundings  parking lots  roads  etc          e The control room is staffed with three officers who are watching the live images on  different workstations with dual monitors as shown above  in this case  two instances  of MxControlCenter are running concurrently on one computer      e The left monitor of each workstation shows an overview map of a part of the soc   cer stadium  The command buttons in the left monitor allow switching the camera  windows at the bottom of the left monitor     e The right monitor allows switching between the different layouts that show a specific  group of cameras in a grid layout        e The head of the surveillance team has a similar set
248. dialog opens again and a new user can be logged in     If MxControlCenter is configured in such a way that the menu bar and the context  menu are not available for the current user  the logout command can be selected  by using the key combination Ctrl   F12 or Ctrl   Shift   A                 Changing Rights By Moving Users To A Different Group    To change the privileges of a user  you can simply move the user from one group to another   Moved users automatically get the privileges of the group they have been moved into     4 7 2 Editing Group Rights    To edit the privileges of the groups  select Tools  gt  Users  amp  groups from the menu  In the  Users  amp  Groups dialog  click on the Group Rights tab     Users  amp  Groups    Users  amp  Groups Group Rights  Please specify user rights for the groups     Live  Live PTZ  Live PTZ configuration  Post processing    Post PTZ configuration  Audio   Camera signal outputs  Sequencer   Alarm handing       e Adjust the privileges for the groups as required  red frame shows Owners group  as an example         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    218 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       The Right To Control Group Rights    The most powerful right on the Group Rights tab is the Access control right in the Access  control section at the bottom of the dialog since it controls access to the Users  amp  Groups  dialog itself  Make sure that you grant this righ
249. ds dm dl dh panorama  views  double  vaidth   Grid Definition Preview  Width  3  gt  Columns  160 pixels    480 pixels  s m A s  Grid editor    Preview of new grid definition          The grid definition is shown in the grid editor as a list of grid elements  see the   Grid  Windows   table below      To Change An Existing Or To Create A New Grid Definition     1  Select a definition you want to modify  duplicate an existing definition  Duplicate  button   or create a new definition  New button      2  Set the width of the definition as a number of columns having a width of 160 pixels Cna patana    each Wet  3 5 Coumns  160 pixels    490 pixels    The total width of the definition can be based on the available screen resolution   for example  1920  2560      pixel width   The total width of the grid definition is  determined and displayed according to the specified number of columns  layout  width in pixels   x columns times 160 pixels   The width is always a whole number    and a multiple of 160 pixels  ds s ds    1 S  8  8 S  3  Enter the grid window definition in the text box  see also the   Grid Windows   table ds u u  ti    uu    below   The preview window shows the resulting layout structure as you type     MxControlCenter will initially place an element in the row to the right whenever pos   sible  provided that enough space is available in the layout  If this is not the case        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany       www mobotix com    sales 
250. e         Post processing does notchange the actual video data delivered by the video source   live or recorded   it only changes the way MxControlCenter displays the video        Automatic Image Distortion Correction    MxControlCenter automatically applies distortion correction in newer camera models to  fix the distorted view caused by wide angle lenses  Newer cameras include information  on the lens type in the video stream so MxControlCenter can automatically determine  the proper correction setting  If this does not work  the camera is too old and you need  to manually set the lens type to ensure proper correction    Manual Lens Selection For  Distortion Correction   below      A perfect example of where this distortion correction feature is used is in a ceiling mounted  Q24M camera whose 180   lens captures    hemispherical    images        Manual Lens Selection For Distortion Correction    In addition to the options described in Section 3 2 9    Using The Virtual PTZ Functions On f       Live Images   for correcting the distortion of currently displayed images in the PTZ Control  Ebe B i  sidebar panel  the Image Processing dialog box can also be used to manually set the Settings       lens type so MxControlCenter can properly apply distortion correction        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    116 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter          Manually setting the lens type for distortion corre
251. e Alarm Features Work   and Section 4 5 3    Configuring MxControlCenter  Reactions        e Activate alarm message server  listening for TCP IP message   Activates the server  part of MxControlCenter that listens to incoming alarm messages from MOBOTIX  cameras     e Port  Enter the port for receiving alarm messages  If this field is empty  the alarm  messages feature will not work     e Allowed IP addresses  Enter IP addresses that are permitted to send alarm messages  to MxControlCenter  You can enter either single IP addresses or computer names  or use wildcards  e g  172 16      When entering several addresses  separate the  different addresses by commas as in the example beneath the field  Leave the default  value         in this field if you want to allow all addresses     e Accept only    camnotify    and    MxCC Alarm    message types  Only adds alarm images  ifthe cameras are sending camnotify network messages to the MxControlCenter  computer     MxCC Alarm  Messages of this type can be activated using MxControlCenter   s  Camera Configuration dialog  see Section 4 5 1    Configuring Alarms on the  Cameras        camnotify  Messages of this type can only be configured via the camera   s  web interface              e Add image to Alarm List  Obtains an image from the camera that sent the alarm  message and adds it to the alarm list     e Open extra Live window  Displays an extra window showing the live video stream  of the alerting camera when MxControlCenter receive
252. e Assistant   Software  Updates And More     To start it as a stand alone application  click on the link or open the  MxControlCenter program folder and double click on the Update Assistant  exe file     1     ao Se SS S amp S    lf the camera list is empty  click on the Search Cameras button  You should see the  master camera  compare to the address in the browser window      Select the master camera and click on the Save Settings button    Save the configuration file to a separate folder and name the file appropriately   Disconnect the master camera from the network    Connect and power up the other cameras    Click on the Search Cameras button  You should see the cameras you connected     Select all connected cameras and click on the down arrow of the Upload Settings  button        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Creating And Distributing A Camera Master Configuration 349   3 92       8  Select the file you stored in Step 3  The Upload Camera Settings dialog opens          Upload Camera Settings    Upload configuration file  mx10 8 85 61 2011 09 01_MASTER cfg      Please select the sections of the configuration that should be updated     Make sure that you are not overwriting important settings like network addresses   Read the warnings at the bottom of the screen     Sections for Updating     Security v  Network  7 Transfer Profies  vV  Time Tasks v  File Server  V  Time Tables    Logos  J  Audio vJ  Page
253. e Display Window Scaling    The commands of the View  gt  Display window scaling menu and the options of the cor   responding button  see figure at the right  allow changing how the individual display  windows are scaled within the current layout  If you want to show the selected video  source as large as possible within the application window  select the Maximize command   for example        The available commands depend on whether or not you have selected a video  source  yellow frame         Showing Only The Display Area    To maximize the display area within the application window  select the View  gt  Saved  views  gt   Display area only  menu command  MxControlCenter hides all application con   trols and the menu bar and maximizes the current layout within the application window     Displaying The Layout In Full Screen Mode    If you want to show the current layout on the entire monitor  you can select the View  gt Saved  views  gt   Full screen  menu command  MxControlCenter hides all application controls and  the application frame and shows the current layout in full screen mode        e When using multiple monitors and several MxCC instances on one computer  the  Full screen view causes the corresponding MxCC instance to be automatically  displayed on the monitor that shows the Windows taskbar  If you would rather  show the MxCC instance on a different monitor in full screen mode  you can  maximize the MxCC programm window on that monitor  using the Maximize  functio
254. e Explanation column  contains descriptions of the individual fields  Open the Heat map report profile dialog  under Setup Menu  gt  MxAnalytics Control to customize the heat map report profile     4 6 4 Generating Reports And Sending Automatically Via E Mail    The counting line and heat map evaluations can be called up in the event search or  generated regularly and automatically sent via e mail  To do this  first create an e mail  profile and define a scheduled time task  You can do this in the browser     1  Select the camera in a layout and click Open camera in browser in MxCC     2  Open the E Mail Profile dialog under Admin Menu  gt Transfer profiles  Set up a  profile according to your needs  For counting line reports  select Counting line report  in the E Mail Attachment field and select the desired counting line report profile  in the selection field below  For heat map lines reports  select Heat map report in  the E Mail Attachment field and select the desired heat map report profile in the  selection field below     3  Next  select the corresponding e mail profile in the Time Tasks dialog under Admin  Menu  gt  Camera Administration for the scheduled time tasks     4 6 5 Creating And Storing Suitable Evaluations In MxControlCenter    The movements and heat maps are evaluated according to the defined profile and time  period  It is possible to create multiple MxAnalytics evaluations  depending on your needs   To reduce your workload  you can save the various MxAnal
255. e MxControlCenter by default accesses the recordings of the attached cameras via  the camera itself  MxControlCenter does not need know where the camera is storing its  recordings  The cameras can record on the built in SD card  default  or on different file  servers and storage media  This approach does have its drawbacks  however  since the  cameras have to carry the load of sending the recorded video images to MxControlCenter     In case the cameras are using a file server or NAS system to store their recordings   MxControlCenter can directly access the recordings  thus relieving the cameras from  handling the recordings  This requires that you reconfigure MxControlCenter to directly  access the recordings on the corresponding file server NAS system     Setting A Default File Server In MxControlCenter    By setting a default file server  you can easily instruct MxControlCenter to use this file server  for accessing the recordings of many cameras at once  Proceed as follows to do this     e Select Tools  gt  Options from the menu and click on the Connection Defaults tab     e Inthe Access Recordings section  enter a file server or select it on the network using  the       button     e Enter the User name and Password required to access the default file server     Changing MxControlCenter   s Access To The Recordings Of Individual Cameras    If you need to reconfigure MxControlCenter   s  access to the recordings for only a few cam   eras  you can use the Properties of dialo
256. e grids available   Layout sequencer Yes Shows all layouts for the set duration in    succession              MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com          MxControlCenter Functions    Display          Live image window    Yes  practically    Scalable display of the live images of                unlimited one camera    Player window Yes  practically For fast access to the recordings of one   unlimited camera    Alarm window Yes Automatic live display of the cameras  reporting an alarm    Sequencer window Yes No fixed camera assignment  shows  all cameras in the layout for the set  duration in succession    Focus window Yes No fixed camera assignment  always    shows the live stream of the camera  most recently clicked        Preview window    Yes  practically  unlimited    Displays the bandwidth optimized  video stream of one camera which is  integrated via narrow band connection   GSM  UMTS              Video clips images    Camera sequencer  for example  full  Image     Yes  practically  unlimited    Yes    MxPEG clips and JPEG can be inserted in  own windows  e g  for demonstration pur   poses or to display emergency numbers     Shows all cameras of a layout for the set  duration in succession        Symbol display    Yes  practically  unlimited    Especially helpful on overview plans   clicking an icon displays the video  stream in the focus window  automatic  display of the most recent alarm in the  alarm window
257. e installation wizard copies the language files to the Languages subfolder and  the print template file  PrintTemplates  lt language  country  gt  ts  to  the Templates subfolder of the MxControlCenter program folder  When starting  MxControlCenter  the application shows the user interface of the language you installed     To switch to a different language while the application is running  open Tools  gt  Language  in the menu and click on the desired language and restart MxControlCenter     4 1 4 Installing The MOBOTIX MxPEG DirectShow Codec    In order to play back native MxPEG recordings      mxq files  in Windows Media Player  for  example  MOBOTIX is providing the MxPEG DirectShow codec  You can download the  installation file for this codec from the MOBOTIX website  Support  gt  Software Downloads  gt   MxPEG DirectShow     The installation file is called MkPEG DirectShow Codec_  Setup exe  where          is the codec version    e Obtain the MxPEG DirectShow Codec _  Setup exe installation file         Download the installation file from the MOBOTIX website and save the file on  your computer  for example  on the Desktop          If you have received installation media  CD  DVD  USB stick   find the folder of  the installation file     e Quit Windows Media Player if the application is running   e Launch the MxPEG DirectShow Codec_  Setup exe installation file     e Follow the instructions of the installation wizard  Make sure that you are keeping the  defaults as propos
258. e is selected  this is not enabled on  Windows 7  but on Windows Server 2008          Continue to press Next until installation is completed         Open a web browser and enter http    127 0 0 1 to verify that the web  server is running     2  Install the MxRemotePreview CGI module     Create a folder named cgi bininC  inetpub      Copy the MxRemotePreview cgi exe file to this folder   C  inetpub cgi bin   3  Configure the Internet Information Server         Open Control Panel  gt  Administrative Tools and double click on Internet  Information Services  IIS  Manager         In the Connections pane  select the Default Web Site entry       Click on Advanced Settings in the right pane  opens the Advanced Settings dialog          Change the Physical Path to the shared folder where the cameras are storing  their recordings and click on OK         Double click on the Handler Mappings icon in the center pane  Below Actions  in the right pane  click on Add Module Mapping         In the Add Module Mapping dialog  enter these values in the following fields  of the center pane     Request path      jpg    Module  CgiModule    Executable  optional   C    inetpub cgi bin MxRemotePreview   cgi exe    Name  MxRemotePreview service           Click on OK         Confirm the Add Module Mapping dialog     Do you want to allow this ISAPI  extension            In the Connections pane  right click on Default Web Site and select Add Virtual  Directory        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems  
259. e mail  Simply click on this  button  save the file on your desktop and attach it to an e mail  for example     e You can also use this feature on Live image windows     e When printing post processed images  Section 3 5 6    Post Processing Of  Recorded Images     MxControlCenter will show two images in the preview   the modified  post processed  image on top and the original image below                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Saving  Printing And Exporting    135 392       3 6 3 Exporting Recorded Video Footage    Saving or printing single images is a good idea when you are trying to identify persons   for example  see Section 3 6 1    Saving Single Images   and Section 3 6 2    Printing Single  Images     A video  on the other hand  may give more clues on how a specific situation  evolved     The recommended procedure to create a video is to compile the interesting scenes in  MxControlCenter and to export the compiled scenes as one video  This section will show  you how to use the Export List dialog to collect the interesting scenes and to set the format  of the exported video  Once you have set the video format and the export options  you  can click on the Export button to create the video        The    Export List    Dialog  Export List    Source Sequence Start Stop  Video sequences q24 thilo2 1 11 11 6 33 03 AM 1 12 11 1 40 11 PM  TOM one armors m1 thilo 1 17 11 3 54 23 AM 1 17 11 4 09 10 AM    
260. e microphone and set  sensitivity  if not prohibited by law   company regulations         Audio output    Activate speaker  set volume  test  setting           Announce network  data       Disable  if this is a security risk           SIP Client Settings    Create SIP accounts as required           Outgoing Calls Settings   Phone Profiles          Create phone profiles for outgoing  calls as required           Time and Date    Time Zone  Time Server    Adjust automatically    Select continent and time zone     Select NTP  RFC 1305   set time  server     Activate checkbox                       LED Setup LED Main Switch Set as required   Add custom days  holidays  vaca   Time lables Custom Days tions  etc   as required   Profiles  amp  Options Add adjust time tables as required     Change reboot time to uncritical  Time Tasks Reboot camera time of day   SOADUNONE pa Remove all unwanted softbutton    definitions     AI   Items marked by an    X    can also be set using the Quick Installation wizard  see below         MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    342 392    MxCC User Manual  Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline       A 5 2 Using The Quick Installation Wizard    You can also use the Quick Installation wizard to complete some of the configuration  tasks listed in the table above  marked by an    X    in the QI column of the table above      Start the Quick Installation from the cam   era   s browser inte
261. e of these cameras has an MX GPS Box  The GPS Box  is then used as a reliable timer for the camera connected to it     Time Servers For Master Cameras       Cameras used as timeservers for standard cameras are    master    cameras  Specifying  one or more time servers for the master cameras increases the accuracy of the time  synchronization     If you select one or more MOBOTIX cameras as Time Servers for Standard Cameras   these cameras automatically become  master  cameras  Please note that when  applying the settings via OK or Apply together with the standard cameras using  the master cameras as time servers  these master cameras must also be selected  in the camera list on the left              6 3 9 The    MxAnalytics    Tab    Some MOBOTIX cameras allow image analysis  The MxAnalytics analysis tool is available  for this purpose  Use the    MxAnalytics    tab  structured in the sub tabs Basic Configuration  and Visual Configuration  to configure the settings and define the detection areas and  counting lines     The Basic Configuration sub tab     g Camera Configuration         RQR aJJ   O w    Overview Image Settings Expomre Recording Audo Events Network Messages Time Server MxAnalytcs    Name       Bese Configuraten   visual Configuration     0o General  3 mm       raren Stine   inten ietenivica moron  G ma    Tene Tabie Profie  No tmetabie x  7    Londght suppression    90 hax       so fc       Oo mu       Mounting heg  t  Moen    Tit angle   gt   Ught end shadow   
262. e program folder gt  cgi bin      Action mxremotepreview  cgi bin MxRemotePreview cgi exe     lt Directory     lt camera recordings folder gt     gt   lt FilesMatch  MEAPC    0 9    jpg  gt  SetHandler mxremotepreview     lt  FilesMatch gt   lt  Directory gt       Add desired MxRemotePreview settings     Frame rate  default  1 frame per second   SetEnv MXRECODER_FRAMERATE 1      Image size  aspect ration will be kept automatically     correlates to the resolution setting in MxControlCenter    SetEnv MXRECODER WIDTH 320  SetEnv MXRECODER HEIGHT 240      JPEG quality  1  100   SetEnv MXRECODER QUALITY 40      Audio output  1 to enable  0 to disable    SetEnv MXRECODER AUDIO 1       4  Configure or edit other Apache settings as necessary  optional  see httpd  apache   org docs 2 2       5  Restart the Apache service     6  Test the web browser and the CGI  see Section 5 6 4    Testing the Web Server With  MxRemotePreview           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Using MxRemotePreview To Access Remote Recordings 2 81   3 9 2       5 6 3 Installing MxRemotePreview On Microsoft Internet Information Server 7    1  Install the Microsoft Internet Information Server  IIS  on the Windows computer       Open Server Manager and select Add Roles       Select Web Server  IIS        Continue to press Next until reaching Role Services       Under Application Development  select CGI         Make sure that IIS Management Consol
263. e shop attracted the most  customers this month  Which waiting areas in  the departure hall are preferred in the after   noon  All movements of objects of a particular  size are recorded and evaluated  either in the  live image or in a previously defined detec   tion area  to provide answers to questions  like these  The frequency of the movements  is shown visually through different colors in  a heat map        Counting People And Objects  Counting Lines     How many people go in and out of an entrance  to a shop during the day  Counting lines can  be defined at the desired positions in the cam   era s live image  The system records how often  each counting line is crossed within a speci   fied period  The evaluation of the individual  counting lines can be viewed as weekly and  monthly counting lines reports in a table in  the event search  The reliability of the count  depends on the similarity of the sizes and  shapes of the persons or objects in the image  and how effectively they can be visually distinguished from one another and from the  underlying surface or background  For this reason  it is not possible to count groups  forming at entrances or cashiers using MxAnalytics        Controlling Motion Detection  Time Tables    If the video motion analysis is only be used during specific times  for example  Monday  to Friday  4 p m  to 7 p m    it is possible to set the camera to use a corresponding time  table  This provides an advantage by freeing up the full processing
264. e to the right   This slider is used to i   adjust the focus of the mechanical zoom after zoomingin or out          V      ocus Pan Tilt Zoom          5 4 2 Integrating Third Party IP PTZ Dome Cameras    This scenario describes how to integrate an IP PTZ Dome camera into MxControlCenter  for live viewing  MxServer  on the other hand  manages the continuous recording of  the video data in a MOBOTIX compatible file server structure  This scenario is based on  using the M JPEG format for live streaming and recording  and does not support audio     Integrating IP PTZ Dome cameras for live streaming in MxControlCenter requires the  following steps     1  Add the IP PTZ dome camera as additional video source in MxControlCenter   2  Connect the IP PTZ dome camera to MxServer for continuous recording     3  Set the storage location of the IP PTZ dome in MxControlCenter         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Using Pan Tilt Heads  Third Party Cameras and Joysticks    263 392       Step 1  Add The IP PTZ Dome Camera To MxControlCenter    When using a third party IP camera with a mechanical PTZ feature integrated into the  system  the pan  tilt and zoom features are automatically enabled  No further settings  are necessary  The mechanical PTZ actions for both pan tilt heads  as well as connected  PTZ dome cameras  are controlled in the same manner as the virtual  digital  PTZ actions  of MOBOTIX cameras   To connect and
265. e video data  you can use the clip start end markers  Section 3 6 3     Exporting Recorded Video Footage           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    114 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       on    Settings       e An Alarm Player window can change its video source dynamically  in contrast  to the display windows in Player mode described in Section 3 5 3    Search   Playback In Layouts With Display Windows In Player Mode        e One layout can have more than one Alarm Player window  If several of these  display elements are present in a layout  MxControlCenter shows the last alarm  camera in the first window  the second but last camera in the second window  etc           3 5 6 Post Processing Of Recorded Images    Post processing means that MxControlCenter can change both  live and recorded     images  Since this constitutes a manipulation of the original image  printing such an  image will always print two images  the original and the adjusted image        Image Post Processing    By default  MxControlCenter displays all recorded video images as they had been stored  by the video source  Post processing  on the other hand  allows adjusting the color satu   ration  brightness  contrast and sharpness settings of recorded video footage  Applying  post processing can help when trying to recognize persons  for example     Before you can activate image post processing in MxControlCenter  you should ch
266. ecessary for such a task     Disadvantages Of The Old Centralized Solution    Usually  cameras only supply images  while processing and recording take place later  on with a central PC using  more expensive  video management software  This traditional  centralized structure has many limitations  since it requires high network bandwidth  and the PC processing power is insufficient when using several cameras  An HDTV  MPEG4 film already places a heavy load on a single PC  so how can it be expected to  keep up with a dozen high resolution live cameras  Due to the high number of PCs  required  classical centralized systems are therefore becoming less and less appro   priate and cost effective       Standard System          MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    15 392       The Decentralized MOBOTIX Concept    In the decentralized MOBOTIX concept  each camera includes a high performance  computer and  if necessary  a digital long term flash memory  MicroSD card  for  several days of recording  The PC or the video control center now serves purely for  viewing and control of the cameras  PTZ   not for analysis or recording  This eliminates  overloaded  expensive video management software  as the important functions are  already contained in the MOBOTIX cameras                                   Recording  T souware stems  Fa   MOBOTIX System M en   iia Decentralized and secure er and      EE BEEN 5 jen without  MicroSD int
267. ecific file server path  M  axis_0  More         Use preview data for playback and Video Search    e Activate the Specific file server path option and enter the corresponding path       Click on the More button to open the Recording Folders dialog     You will have to add     Click on the Add button and navigate to the camera s recordings folder   a separate path for          Recording folders  each IP dome camera  EN  Name Path    1 F      psf Home mxdata 10_8_195_72  I psfHome mxdata 10_8_195_72  j2  H3 M  axis_0 M   axis_0    4 m p   Add       __Edit      _ Remove   __ Apply        Select the new recording folder and click on OK        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Using Pan Tilt Heads  Third Party Cameras and Joysticks    265 392       5 4 3 Integrating Analog Third Party PTZ Cameras    As a second part of the configuration process  an additional step lets you define an Event  Recording path  This step enables the converted digitized video streams to be stored in  a MOBOTIX file server structure by MxServer  The converted video streaming data can be  read into MxControlCenter later as offline playback or used for post video motion detection        If no Event Recording path is defined for the analog camera  MxControlCenter will  only show the live video coming directly from MxServer or the third party video server        This section describes two scenarios for integrating analog PTZ camerasin MxControl
268. eck Digital Signature       MxControlCenter offers several predefined export profiles that cover the majority of cases   On rare occasions  you may have to use the custom settings  but this should be done    only for very special purposes     MxControlCenter does notinclude support for exporting AVC H 264 videos  For an  explanation  please read   Why MxControlCenter Does Not Support AVC H  264   at  the beginning of this manual  This section also provides a list of applications that       can convert the MxControlCenter export formats to AVC H 264           You can create the following formats when exporting the contents of the Export List dialog     e File Server Structure  Folder structure with JPEG  images or MxPEG clips as stored by the camera for  playback in MxContro Centeror MxEasy  Unlike the  other profiles below  creating a file server structure  does not involve any recoding and hence requires    MIXPCG    Mxg g  File Server Structure    MxPEG    mxg    AVI MPEG4  Windows KP and newer   Quick motion  Custom       the least amount of time to export  It is recommended to use this profile when you  need to keep the files in their original format  for example  to preserve evidence for  law enforcement purposes   Using the file server structure also allows checking the  integrity of the recording  if the recordings are signed  see Section 3 5 12    Checking    The Data Integrity Of Recordings        e MxPEG  MOBOTIX format for playback in MxControlCenter  MxEasy and in
269. ecordings from the context menu     Set the options in the Access Recordings dialog as required  if a default file server has  been set in Options  gt  Connection Defaults  you can use it here         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring MxAnalytics 2 0 9  3 9 2       4 6 Configuring MxAnalytics  The following configuration steps are necessary to use MxAnalytics video motion analysis  on a Q24M camera in MxControlCenter     e Activate MxAnalytics and set the process parameters  such as detection settings   object display  and defining detection areas and counting lines     e Setup storage of MxAnalytics data for future evaluation  e Adapt the camera s factory supplied report profiles for the evaluation  where necessary    e Create and store suitable evaluations in MxCC    We recommend familiarizing yourself with the MxAnalytics product description and  read the notes  tips and tricks it includes for configuration in order to generate opti   mal analysis results  The description is provided on the MOBOTIX website at www   mobotix com  gt  Products  gt  Hemispheric Q24  gt  MxAnalytics              4 6 1 Activating  Setting Process Parameters And Setting Up Storage    You must activate MxAnalytics before video motion analysis can be used  Go to the Camera  Configuration dialog and open the MxAnalytics tab  which is structured in the sub tabs  Basic Configuration and Visual Configuration  to activate vide
270. ed by the wizard     Once the codec is installed  you can double click on any    mxg file to play it back in  Windows Media Player     4 1 5 Configuring A Common Time Server    Setting a common time base and the corresponding synchronization mechanisms is one  of the most critical tasks that you need to accomplish when setting up your video surveil   lance system  Since no computer can measure time with absolute perfection  you should  make sure that the following prerequisites are fulfilled     e All components of the MxControlCenter video management system  cameras  work   stations  file servers and   NAS systems  are using the same fime server        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Getting Started    153 392       e The time server should be an   NTP  Network Time Protocol time server  and not the  older Time Protocol   This ensures that the time is synchronized in a continuous man   ner  rather than once a week  which is the default setting  on Windows computers     It is possible to differentiate between three important situations regarding the network     1  Local camera network     without an Internet connection or an existing time server  and without a MOBOTIX GPS Box     In this case  set up ONE camera as the master camera to become the time server  for all other cameras and devices  This at least ensures time synchronicity within the  system  even if this time deviates from the global time     2  Lo
271. ed in the following    LAYOUTS Tree view  used for switching configuring layouts  B    Grouped tree view for direct access to cameras  video  VIDEO SOURCES clips and storage devices and for adding them to lay   outs     Stores preset event Post VM searches and allows creat     LOCAL ARCHIVE Used for creating ad hoc recordings on local computer     Contains the controls for playing back recordings in one   33 5 2 ff  Player or all player windows  34 2 2  Contains the vPTZ controls for live images and record  33 2 9    Softbuttons Shows the softbuttons from the selected camera      Grids Shows available grid layouts and allows creating new 33 2 1 f   ones  4 2 3  Background Images  oe background images and allows adding Eo    1 Only in Layout Manager  showing a grid layout  2 Only in Layout Manager  showing a background layout       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Live Video Surveillance 6 9  3 9 2       3 2 Live Video Surveillance    In smaller installations with only a few cameras  the monitoring requirements can be met  using only a few cameras in a single window  However for more complex monitoring  tasks  a single window will not suffice  MxControlCenter thus uses layouts to show the  video sources  additional information and navigation elements     3 2 1 Displaying Video Content In Layouts  MxControlCenter provides the following basic types of layouts     e Grid  The display windows of cameras and other vi
272. efault      Click on the Set button at the bottom of the dialog     Click on the Close button at the bottom of the dialog and permanently store the  entire camera configuration     Reboot the camera       In the Permanently Store Configuration dialog  click on the Reboot link         In the Reboot the Camera dialog  click on the Reboot Now button     Wait until the camera has rebooted before proceeding           If you want to use the existing  self signed certificate of the camera  configure  one camera as outlined in steps 1 to 3  Then use the Update Assistant to store  the configuration of that camera and upload its configuration to all other cameras   While doing so  you should instruct the Update Assistant to only update the Page   language  softbuttons  section of the camera configuration  this protects all other  settings of the cameras  see Section 5 1 7    Saving And Uploading Settings Of One  Or More Cameras        If you want to use encrypted connections with a third party or a generated cer   tificate on all cameras  you will have to upload generate the certificate separately  for each camera           Step 4  Instruct MxControlCenter to Use SSL for Connecting to the Cameras    Now that you have properly set up the camera s  to use SSL  you need to instruct  MxControlCenter to use SSL when connecting to the cameras     Open the Navigator panel and expand the CAMERAS section        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales
273. eference time                        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com          MxControlCenter Functions                                                 Export   Export list Yes Merging of selected video clips from  different cameras for export purposes    Various export formats Yes AVI and Quicktime as video with sound    Export optional with without image Yes Export of the original data for use   correction optimization permissible in a court of law  export of  prepared files for optimal view    Security   User management with group access Yes Group user management including   rights limitation of specific work areas and  mandatory action commentaries    Failure detection of individual cameras    Yes Including notification by phone call    storage systems e mail  network message    Dead man   s switch Yes Including notification by e mail    Falsification safety Yes By signature of the recorded files  data  integrity can be checked at the time of  export    Activity log Yes All activities of the users are recorded  and can be traced  filter functions for  fast access to desired information    Time synchronization Yes Uniform system time through support of  internal external time servers    Four eyes principle Yes Clearance approval of function  authenticated by a third party   supervisor  data protection officer        Private sphere    mode Yes To safeguard the private sphere  including switching off image gene
274. egrated    Recording Computer  SD Card Memory Reduces Storage Costs  Events of up to 64 gigabytes can be recorded both within the camera and externally with eeks a  ance o  no limitations via the network on a PC  server or inexpensive NAS file system  The high Bon lanes  storage capacity and the possibility of recording only sequences in which something is f video in  ae l 200 000  occurring make it necessary to use external storage such as disk drives only rarely  This E n high  reduces the need for recording devices  network infrastructure and the maintenance expense two million  of mechanical components in hard drives and fans  The internal storage on the other hand ages  is digital without mechanical components and is therefore maintenance free   Failover Storage a tani standare Ne teage g s  i ere i  e g  Hard Drives  standard  e  4 mo i   data are   lt a ie     atically    FERA 3  fea      ilable   Connection Loss  Even when external recording is preferred for cameras in positions at risk  the internal  storage ensures that the video will be buffered in the the event of bandwidth fluctuations A  or even network failures  In any case  the decentralized system ensures a lower recording r costs    load  so that ten times more cameras than usual can be stored simultaneously on a  PC or server  The results are obviously neither postage stamp size video  nor individual  images  but high resolution HDTV video with sound        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Ge
275. el and  select Edit to modify this layout     MxControlCenter changes as follows to indicate that the application is in Layout  Manager mode     e The title bar reads MxControlCenter   Layout Manager          e The background color of the sidebar   s panel headings changes from gray to  light yellow     e The sidebar only shows the Navigator on top and an additional panel below   depending on the selected layout  this is either the Grids or the Backgrounds  panel                  MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Creating And Editing Layouts   5 7  3 9 2       When activated  the Layout Manager shows the following panels in the sidebar     e Navigator        In the LAYOUTS section of this sidebar panel  you  can create  rename and move layouts to form  hierarchical structures  This panel shows gridand     bse rg  background layouts with different icons         Inthe VIDEO SOURCES section of this sidebar panel  poe ae  MxControlCenter displays the cameras  clips and       Bres  s  storage devices that have already been added to ea    MxControlCenter  You can drag and drop the video ei  ee    m1 thilo    sources into a grid element or onto a background aa slie  image  i aiii    Navigator     r    a Ji Overview   Outside   B Main Entrance    e Grids Background Layouts  The contents of this  panel changes depending on the type of the current  layout         Grids  In this sidebar panel  you can select and  modify t
276. elect Mode     Configuration and resources  instruction files  dips  images  sounds         Complete package  configuration  resources  MxControlCenter program files   e Configuration and    resources  Use this option  to save both the configura   tion file  Mxcc   ini  and all  required resources  back   ground images  instruction  files  audio files  MxPEG  clips  etc   to the target folder  set in Select Destination     Select Destination    m C  Users Gate Guards    Export as ZIP package       e Complete package  This option does the same as the Configuration and resources  option above  but also copies the MxControlCenter program files to the target folder   You can thus use this option to create entire installations on shared  server  folders   for example     e Export as ZIP package  Creates a ZIP package of an entire MxControlCenter installa   tion in the destination folder  You can transfer the ZIP package to a different location  using e mail or FTP  for example     To create an export of camera recordings including a full MxControlCenter environ   ment ready for playing back recordings  use the Export List functions as shown in  Section 3 6 3    Exporting Recorded Video Footage                   MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    234 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       4 9 3 Using Different MxControlCenter Configurations    The most simple method of using different MxControlCenter confi
277. elect Properties from the context menu   e Open the Display tab     e SelectthedesiredIinstructionfile e g  D   Instructions EmergencyProcedures   txt  or enter a URL  e g  http    webserver Instructions   as required        Certain characters in the URL need to be percent encoded  also called    URL encoded      e g  a space character would be     20    For more information on percent encoded  characters  see the Percent encoding topic on en wikipedia org              Configuring The Windows Firewall On The MxControlCenter Computer    The remote control and alarm handling features of MxControlCenter rely on network  messages  IP packets  that are sent from the cameras to the MxControlCenter computer   A built in or third party firewall product can block incoming IP packets on the MxControlCenter  computer and thus prevent the proper functioning of these features     V  Windows Firewall is helping to protect your computer    Windows Firewall is on    Inbound connections that do not have an exception are blocked    Display a notification when a program is blocked  Yes   Network location  Private network    What are network       Proceed as follows to instruct the Windows firewall to allow inbound IP network packets  through port 31754  according to the example in Section 4 5    Configuring Alarms And  Recordings     Note that you need administration rights in order to accomplish this task   Windows XP    e Open the Windows Control Panel  Start  gt  Settings  gt  Control Panel 
278. eless devices or other suitable hardware   Physical networks may include one or more   Logical Networks  also called subnets   or be part of a logical network     Example  lf you connect a MOBOTIX camera with factory defaults to the same switch  as your computer  both network devices are running on the same physical network   However  the two devices are most likely using different logical networks  or subnets    e Computer IP address  192 168 1 31  e Camera IP address  10 9 123 45    This means that they cannot talk directly to each other  MxControlCenter  however  can  find the cameras  and can reconfigure them for the same logical network as your  computer  see Section 2 4 2    Using The Video Sources In MxControlCenter           If the MOBOTIX cameras are properly connected  see Section 2 2    Power Supply And  Network Connection Of Cameras     they should appear together with the existing video  sources in the Add Video Sources dialog     lf MxControlCenter does not find any cameras  i e   the list of video sources remains  empty   you should check the settings of the Windows Firewall on your computer   if the firewall is blocking MxControlCenter  you need to allow connections to and  from the application  In case you are not allowed to change these settings on your  computer  please contact your system administrator     Make sure that the cameras have been set up according to the camera s user  manual and are running properly  MxControlCenter automatically finds MOBOTIX
279. encryption method makes    eavesdropping    on the data  and access information  virtually  impossible  To activate SSL encryption on the camera   proceed as follows     e Activate encrypted HTTP in the camera web interface       Admin Menu  gt  Network Setup  gt  Web Server  gt  HTTPS Settings  gt  Enable HTTPS        Click on Set  then Close and return to the Admin Menu  then the reboot camera  in General Tasks  gt  Reboot     e Wait until camera is available again and test by replacing    http    by    https    in the  address of the camera  You may have to acknowledge the certificate  and allow an  exception in the browser list for the camera     e Activate Port Forwarding for the camera port on the router    e Activate the Secure Connections  SSL  checkbox in Camera Properties for the selected  camera in MxControlCenter  Note that you may have to change the port back to  8001 as in the example     e Click on Apply or on OK to apply the  changes for this camera     Address  mycamera dyndns org  All communication to and from the camera    is now using an SSL encrypted connection   Note that you can also use the encrypted  connection in a web browser by entering the camera s address as in the example below     https   mycamera dyndns org  8001    Access Data   Information   Display   PTZ Rotor          MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Using Pan Tilt Heads  Third Party Cameras and Joysticks    259 392       5
280. enu and activate the Users  amp  Groups tab        Users  amp  Groups 2    Users  amp  Groups Group Rights    Create users and groups  and enter details   Name Group Settings   a  Group name  Admins  Users 3  Comment    Administrators have full access to ALL  Guards  Gei functions and configuration options of the    MxCC video surveillance system     Ca Cees       e To create a user  click on a group  then click on the Add User button  Admins group  is selected in this dialog      e Fill in the details for the new user     e When creating a user  remember to click ON   UserSettings  the Change Password button and assign a   Lognname  user  password  Fullname  User    e To create a group  click on the Add Group    button and fill in the details  Comment     Member of the    Users    group           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Users  Groups And Group Rights 2   7  3 92       User Login  If one or more users have been created in the Users  amp  Groups  E tss     dialog  MxControlCenter will show the Login as dialog when   n 7  starting  Without any users  MxControlCenter automatically    starts with full  i e   administrator  privileges  User   admin  Admins       Password  eeeeeeeeee  To log out the current user  select Tools  gt  Logout from the menu    or right click on the display area and select Authentication  gt   Logout from the context menu  Logging out will restart the    application  The Login as 
281. epending on the number of cameras  of the system       10 cameras or less  Generate a new grid layout and set a descriptive name       More than 10 cameras  Do not generate a new layout and only add the video  sources to the system     A 8 3 Creating A Basic MxControlCenter Configuration    Create groups and users for MxControlCenter  See Section A 1    Collecting Information  About The System   and set the corresponding group rights  For information on how  to do this  see Section 4 7    Users  Groups And Group Rights       Users  amp  Groups      Users  amp  Groups Group Rights    Create users and groups        and enter details   Name    Admins  Owners Group name  Admins    Group Settings       MxControlCenter has its own access rights management  The groups and  users defined for MxControlCenter have nothing to do with those defined f  r  the cameras  see   Creating The User Groups   and   Creating The Users   in  Section A 5 3    Setting The Admin Menu Options     The exception is the mike  user on the cameras  which is used by the MxControlCenter workstations to  access the cameras  see Section A 8 1    Configuring The Global Settings              Configure MxControlCenter views  See Section 4 4 3    Configuring MxControlCenter  Views       Assign cameras to other file servers   Faas        NAS  When using more than one file ae ea ee  server NAS  select all cameras that g Parking 1       are using one file server NAS in the acta  Navigator sidebar panel  then right   cl
282. eports and heat maps can be directly exported from the  event search as HTML and CSV files or as a JPEG file and stored locally or to a storage  device  Click on Export    on the corresponding counting line or heat map profiles        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Additional User Functions    147 392       3 8 Additional User Functions    3 8 1 Working With The Dead Man   s Switch    The dead man s switch is an operating mode of MxControlCenter that has been added  for security applications  This feature is used to make sure that the following require   ments are met     e The personal safety of the operators is monitored    e The video surveillance staff are fulfilling their monitoring tasks as assigned   In order to achieve this  MxControlCenter can do the following    e Play a sound after x minutes of inactivity  minimum interval is two minutes      e Optionally send an e mail if MxControlCenter did not detect any interaction after  the specified interval     If the dead man   s switch has been activated  the MxControlCenter toolbar shows  the blue dead man   s switch icon  see adjacent figure   Make sure that you have  access to the documentation of your system  so you know how long the dead man   s  switch interval actually is              For information on how to activate the dead man s switch and the configuration options   Section 4 8 8    Configuring The Dead Man   s Switch       How The Dead Man 
283. er Does Not Support AVC H 264    Although we have considered integrating AVC H 264 video export in MxControlCenter  we  have decided not to do so  The following reasons have moved us to make this decision     Costs for licensing the AVC H 264 codec  We would need to pay licensing fees for  every application with AVC H 264 support that we give away free of charge without  knowing whether or not the codec would actually be used  We feel that   rather than  paying licensing fees for something that is of little use to our customers   it is wiser  to invest these funds in the research and development of exciting new products     Legal aspects  Since MPEG LA has displayed inconsistent behavior in its application  of licensing fees  as documented in Nero   s antitrust suit against MPEG LA in 2010    we feel that integrating AVC H 264 into MxControlCenter is not an option     Examples of other companies  In order to avoid the licensing fees associated with the  AVC H 264 codec  Google has introduced its own WebM standard for royalty free   high quality open source audio video compression of web content  We concur and  we are also convinced that AVC H 264 will not play a major role in the near future     Easy playback of existing export formats  MxControlCenter has built in support  for creating AVI MPEG4 and MOV MPEG4 video files  which are among the most  wide spread codecs used nowadays  In addition  MOBOTIX has developed the free   of charge MxPEG DirectShow codec  which allows pl
284. er Manual  Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline       Finishing The Network Configuration    e Click on Cancel to close the Add Video Sources dialog     e Close MxControlCenter without saving the configuration  In case you saved the  configuration anyway  you should delete the MxCC ini configuration file in the  current MxControlCenter working folder     A 5 Creating And Distributing A Camera Master Configuration    Instead of configuring many cameras individually  you will now create a master configura   tion in the browser on one camera and copy that configuration to as many cameras as  required  This way  you can save a lot of time when configuring many cameras     The master configuration is a collection of generic settings and can be applied to  other projects as well     i If you have questions on the options in a dialog of the camera s browser interface   remember that the online help provides context specific information  click on the  adjacent button in the top right corner of any camera dialog               A 5 1 Overview    The following table provides an overview of the settings that need to be adapted in order  to create a camera independent master configuration  Some of these settings can be  changed in the Quick Installation wizard  marked in the QI column below   A more detailed  description is provided starting with Section A 5 2    Using The Quick Installation Wizard          Dialog  Admin Menu  Parameter Remark    Public Access Disable alll  X  Group
285. er button  Activate the  events you want to see in the filtered list      Event Filter    Select af events  Select Events     PI   Passive Infrared Detector      VM    Video Motion Window  J  VM Video Motion Window         RB   Recording Begin   RE   Recording End   RH   Recording History     RT   Recording Terminate   BT   Buttons    IR JIR Remote Control   RC  IP Receive    CI  COM in    TP   Temperature    IL   lamination    EL   Evert Logic    EL2  Evert Logic 2     MI  Microphone   SI  Signal Input    S12  Second Signal Input   SI3   Third Signal Input   S14   Fourth Signal Input   PE   Periodic Event   TT  Time Task    UC   User Click    RD   Random Event    Con    Canoe       Handling    Pseudo    Events In Continuous Recordings       Pseudo    event images are generated every minute by cameras that are recording con   tinuously  If you would like to remove the    pseudo    events from the list  you can do so by  activating the Exclude    pseudo    events button     e If the button is activated  yellow   the event list will only show    real    events  VM  UC   IR  etc       e ifthe button is deactivated  not yellow   the events list will also include the    pseudo     events of continuous recordings        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings    129 392       Printing Event Images    Click on the Print current and post processed image button to print the currently dis
286. er of the displayed events  ascending descending      Setting The Display Options    If you want to see new events automatically as they have been recorded  set the Reload  dropdown to Automatically  To force a manual reload  click on the Reload now button     To adjust the size of the search result images  move the slider in the properties bar to the  right and left     The changes are applied immediately and MxControlCenter shows the results  If  MxControlCenter searches many cameras  it will show an indicator  see adjacent figure   in the Player panel     Creating New Event Searches  To create new event searches  you can use one of the following methods in the Navigator  sidebar panel   e Create an empty search       Right click anywhere in the EVENT SEARCHES section       Select New search from the context menu       Enter a name that describes the search   e Duplicate an existing search       Right click on an existing search in the EVENT SEARCHES section       Select Duplicate search from the context menu       Enter a name that describes the search     Note that you can also keep the CTRL key pressed  then drag amp drop an existing  search to duplicate it     e Proceed by editing the search as outlined in the   Creating An Ad Hoc Event Search    section above        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    122 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       Grouping Event Searches    If you want to create 
287. er with at  least one harddisk that is used to store the video and audio data generated by analog or  digital cameras        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 0 399     MxCC User Manual  MOBOTIX Glossary    DynDNS  Abbreviation of Dynamic DNS  or DDNS  Dynamic Domain Name Service   Similar to   DNS   this links domain names  e g    with IP addresses  whereby the IP addresses may change at  any time  This service provides a convenient method to access your MOBOTIX cameras from  home or work if the camera internet connection is not through a   Router  which assigns a  fixed IP address  but instead over a   DSL connection with a dynamically assigned IP address  from the provider  A well known provider of this  free  service is         Ethernet  The most common technology for communication within a wired network  It provides for  data exchange between all devices  computers  printers  IP cameras  etc   connected to a  local area network    LAN      Events  Refers to a situation when something happens or changes  In terms of video surveillance  this  means a change in the status of an area that is being monitored  This can be movement of  a person  a change in brightness  a drop in ambient temperature  the detection of a noise  via a microphone  an electrical signal at a signal input  the manual operation of a button  etc     ExtiO  MOBOTIX expansion module that the camera uses to directly operate lamps  sirens an
288. era  yellow frame  on the computer  If the camera  microphone is not available  this button does not work     Activate announcement to camera  This button allows making announcements on  the active camera  When doing so  the MxControlCenter computer sends the audio  from the computer s microphone to the speaker of the camera         If a camera has been selected  MxControlCenter uses this camera to output the    announcement         If an audio path  see below  has been set for the selected camera  it will use    that camera to output the announcement     By default  MxControlCenter sends sound  i e   announcements  to the selected  camera  which plays back the sound on its own speaker  Setting the audio    path to a different camera uses the external speaker of that camera instead of  the selected one  see   Setting An Audio Path   in Section 4 2 5    More Options  When Editing Layouts           A typical application is a layout with several cameras and one audio path cam   era  This camera is attached to a MOBOTIX CamlO module  which relays the  camera   s audio output to a PA system        Ifthe audio path has been set to the audio path camerafor all other cameras  in the layout  this camera will always be used to make the announcement   regardless if a camera has been selected or not  If only someof the cameras  in a layout are using the audio path property  you need to select at least  one camera to make an announcement              If you have activated both buttons  yo
289. era Preview  The cameras provide the preview video data according to the  parameters specified for JPEG quality  Frame rate  etc  below         Remote Preview  An MxRemotePreview server provides the preview video data  according to the parameters specified for JPEG quality  Frame rate  etc  below     e Server Address Port  Sets the server address and port number for accessing the  MxRemotePreview server     e Username  Enter the user name required for accessing the MxRemotePreview server   e Password  Enter the password required for accessing the MxRemotePreview server     e SSL  Activate this option if the server connection is encrypted using SSL  Secure  Socket Layer      e JPEG Quality  Sets the JPEG quality of the preview video data delivered by the  MxRemotePreview server     e Frame rate  Sets the frame rate of the preview video data delivered by the  MxRemotePreview server        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 94   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference       e Resolution  Sets the resolution  size  of the preview video data delivered by the  MxRemotePreview server  Note that the Cusfom entry allows setting custom width   height values  in pixels  for the preview video data     e Audio  Activate this option if you need the audio channel in the preview video data   Note that deactivating this option saves 64 kbit s of network bandwidth     6 1 3 The    View    Tab    This tab contains the following group 
290. erate a subtitle file that contains precise information  on the events        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       142   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter          The Export List dialog    remembers    the format settings you specified for each of the  export formats listed in the Export as dropdown        Setting The Export Options  Optional     These options are used in different scenarios to create packages  check the data integrity or  to apply the virtual PTZ settings  Note that the availability of the individual options depends  on the selected export format    Setting The Video Format   above      e Apply image post processing incl  PTZ  This option will export the video while using  the same settings as in MxControlCenter       You have applied post processing options  e g  adjusted the image contrast  settings  Section 3 5 6    Post Processing Of Recorded Images            The camera has recorded full images while MxControlCenter is showing only  an image section  Section 3 5 7    Using The Virtual PTZ Features When Playing  Back Recordings           This option is only available for the AVI MPEG4 export profile        e Copy application files  Use this option if you intend to burn the exported video   File Server Structure or MxPEG  on a CD DVD  This will also copy the application  files and create the PlayVideo cmd file for playing back the exported video in  MxControlCenter         Crea
291. es the presence of an employees    representative when playing back the  recordings     Example  In order to access the recordings of the camera that monitors the inside of  the cash teller booths in a bank  the representative of the bank worker s union needs  to be present  For this purpose  a special MxControlCenter workstation has been set  up  which can only access the recordings of the cameras inside the cash teller booths        To implement this scenario  the administrator has set up two groups and at least one  user per group     e Playback  Users of this group can access recordings  but only if a member of the  Union Representatives group has given his her authorization     e User Representatives  Users of this group can authorize users of the Playback  group to access recordings     Using the two man rule requires that such a setup has been implemented and documented  properly  Section 4 7 3    implementing A Two Man Rule        e Start MxControlCenter     e In the Login as dialog  select the user that can access the recordings after autho   rization  gary  Playback  in the example  and enter the corresponding password     e Switch to a layout that shows the camera with the recordings you would like to see   e Click on the Player button     e MxControlCenter shows the Two Man Rule dialog  The user that can authorize this  action selects his user name  mike  Union Representatives  in the example  and  enters the corresponding password     User gary can now search the
292. esentative when playing back the  recordings           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Users  Groups And Group Rights 21 9  3 92       Example  In order to access the recordings of the camera that monitors the inside of  the cash teller booths in a bank  the representative of the bank worker s union needs    to be present  For this purpose  a special MxControlCenter workstation has been set  up  which can only access the recordings of the cameras inside the cash teller booths        To implement this scenario  you need to set up two additional groups and at least one  user per group     e Playback  Users of this group can access recordings  but only if a member of the  Union Representatives group has given his her authorization     e Union Representatives  Users of this group can authorize users of the Playback  group to access recordings     Creating The Groups  The Users And Setting The Rights  When setting up a two man rule  you need to create the two groups mentioned above  and the corresponding users    e Select Tools  gt  Users  amp  groups in the menu and activate the Users  amp  Groups tab     e Click on the Add Group button and create the    Union Representatives    group     2   e Click again on the Add Group button and create the    Playback    group   e Using the Add User button  create at least one User  4 Union Representatives L  for each group  do not forget to set passwords  see mike  Section 
293. esponding camera even if it is notin the current layout     In addition  the user can select a camera and click on the Show camera s preferred  layout button on the toolbar or on the corresponding icon in the title bar  display window  in background layouts only   Another method to show the preferred layout is to right click  on a camera and to select Load Preferred Layout from the context menu   To set the preferred alarm layout    e Open the camera s Properties of dialog doing one of the following         Right click on a camera in the VIDEO SOURCES  gt  Cameras section of the Navigator  sidebar panel and select Properties from the context menu         Right click on a camera in any layout and select Properties from the context menu   e Open the Display tab   e Select the desired Preferred Alarm Layout from the list of available layouts     e Click on OK to close the Properties of dialog     Instruction File  An instruction file contains specific instructions for this camera  e g  emergency phone f  D  numbers  standard operating procedures  etc    You can use all files that are recognized    on the computer running MxControlCenter  such as HTML or TXT files  Note that you can  also open web sites in a web browser by entering an entire URL  such as     http    www mycompany com emergency     To set the instruction file  please see   Setting The Instruction File For The Camera   in  Section 4 5 3    Configuring MxControlCenter Reactions          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision
294. et correct storage target in  MxCC     Set storage target to path of  new camera        MxCC does not allow starting a  second program instance           Link to start MxCC does not  contain    MxMultiinstances     command line argument        Edit link and add     MxMultiinstances    argument   ey ie end of the Target text  ield              MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Using The MxControlCenter Error Log 3 6 5   3 9 2       Issue Possible Cause Solution            Save MxCC configuration  After restarting  MxCC uses old   MxCC configuration not saved   Ysin g toolbar button or when    program settings  before quitting previously  closing       Camera is not listed in the Add camera to this MxCC  Navigator panel in the VIDEO   installation using Camera  gt   SOURCES  gt  Cameras section    Add     Add MxCC to the firewall  exceptions  see    Configuring             Firewall on MxCC computer is                      eal inbound alarm The Windows Firewall On The  dik MxControlCenter Computer       Make sure that the camera  Camera and the MxCC com  and the MxCC computer are in    i puter are in separate logical or   the same logical networks or  escent re Malai fe physical networks  that the alarm messages are  y g properly forwarded     alerting camera  although it is  a alarm messages via the Make sure that the proper IP  network  The camera is using a wrong   address of the MxCC computer  IP address to se
295. etc     e When playing back such a clip in MxControlCenter  please only select the first  file   lt file name gt  _01 mxg      e When playing backward  however  MxControlCenter will stop at the beginning  of the current clip  e g   lt file name gt  _03 mxg  and will nofcontinue playing  backward at the end of the previous clip   lt file name gt  02 mxg   In this  case  you need to select the previous clip manually   lt file name gt  02 mxg                  When handing exported MxPEG video clips to others  it is a good idea to include the  installation file of the MxPEG DirectShow Codec  see Section 4 1 4    Installing The  MOBOTIX MxPEG DirectShow Codec                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    144 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       3 7 Using MxAnalytics    3 7 1 MxAnalytics Overview    MOBOTIX cameras automatically detect movement within a monitored area     MxAnalytics     video motion analysis is built into the camera and delivered with every Q24M camera as  standard  It makes it possible to track people and objects and collect statistical behavior  data  Various specifications should be set in order to collect the appropriate behavior data  that deliver useful analysis results  You can find an overview of these technical specifica   tions at www mobotix com  gt  Products  gt  Hemispheric Q24  gt  MxAnallytics     Tracking And Evaluating Movements  Heat Maps     Which shelves in th
296. ethod  for permanently storing an interesting video clip without having to change the configura   tion of the system     Example  Think of a detective in a big department store  The detective uses a layout that  shows several MOBOTIX cameras  Once the detective spots a suspicious person  he she    presses the Live recording button  Since the suspicious person leaves the area monitored  by one camera  the detective simply clicks on the next camera to follow the person           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Live Video Surveillance 91   3 9 2  as Noe    lf the next camera is on a different layout  you need to restart live recording after  switching to the next layout  To stop the recording  simply deactivate the Live  recording button in the current layout                 How To Use Live Recording    e Start live recording  Click on the Live recording button  Ey    e Switch cameras while recording  Click on the desired camera in the same layout   yellow frame highlights current camera      e Switch layouts while recording  Automatically stops recording  see Caution box below    e Stop live recording manually  Click again on the Live recording button  Ey    e Access live recordings  Live recordings are stored in  J  55   ancune  the LOCAL ARCHIVE section of the Navigator sidebar  panel  You can view and export these video clips later   l My Recordings  on by dragging the clip to your computer s desktop or  any
297. ettings       For more information about the different types of display elements for layouts  see  Section 4 2 2    Element Types Used In Layouts       4 2 5 More Options When Editing Layouts    Setting A Start Layout  You can use one layout of the MxControlCenter installation  4 Y991S    rt   t  i e   MxControlCenter automatically shows 41 Overview  Outi  as start layout  i e   y Main Entrance  this layout when the program is launched  In the LAYOUTS  H westgate  section of the Navigator sidebar panel  the start layout is set  H Parking  in bold print  see red frame in figure    B Garage Entrance  4 a Overview   Inside  To set the start layout   B Reception   B Elevators  e Right click on a layout name in the sidebar   H Back Entrance    e Select Use as start layout from the context menu  Po   B Inside   Player  You can also define a time interval at which MxControlCenter  4 VIDEO SOURCES    automatically returns to the defined start layout  This ensures that MxControlCenter auto   matically returns to the scene you want to monitor  even if a different layout had been  selected in the meantime  see Notes box below         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       172 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       If you want to use a start layout  make sure that Load   start has been set to Start  layout  Tools  gt  Options menu  General tab  On Startup group box      To automatically return to the start layou
298. ettings And Exporting Installations 232  4 9 3 Using Different MxControlCenter Configurations 234  5 Enhanced Features 236  5 1 Update Assistant   Software Updates And More 236  5 1 1 Elements Of The Update Assistant Dialog 237  5 1 2 Update Assistant Toolbar Buttons 238  5 1 3 Getting Started With Update Assistant 238  5 1 4 Checking The Camera Connection Status 241  5 1 5 Updating The Software Of MOBOTIX Cameras 242  5 1 6 Installing MOBOTIX Application Software 245  5 1 7 Saving And Uploading Settings Of One Or More Cameras 245  5 1 8 Backing Up And Restoring The Entire System 248  5 1 9 Changing The Configuration Of Many Cameras At Once 248  5 1 10 Using Update Assistant As A Stand Alone Application 249  5 2 Using Snap Server NAS Systems 251  5 2 1 Adding Overland Storage Snap Servers 251  5 2 2 Configuring And Editing Snap Server Settings 252  5 3 Connecting Remote Cameras Using DynDNS 253  5 4 Using Pan Tilt Heads  Third Party Cameras and Joysticks 259  5 4 1 Using MOBOTIX Cameras With Pan Tilt Heads 259  5 4 2  Integrating Third Party IP PTZ Dome Cameras 262  5 4 3 Integrating Analog Third Party PTZ Cameras 265  5 5 MxServer   Integrating Third Party Cameras 269  5 5 1 Introduction To MxServer 269  5 5 2 MxServer   System Requirements And Installation 270  5 5 3 Connecting An Analog PTZ Camera To MxServer 273  5 5 4 Connecting A Third Party IP Camera To MxServer 274  5 5 5 Setting Up Recording In MxServer 274  5 5 6 Automatically Starting MxServer On The Computer 275  
299. ews  North  East  South  West   and MxControlCenter displays  5  one virtual camera at a time oe showing the next one  This display mode does  not support zooming     If you cannot use any of the features described above  one the following may apply           e The camera image is not zoomed  i e   original image or after pressing the  1x Zoom button   In this case  you need to zoom in before you can pan or tilt  the image     e The PTZ feature is locked and you cannot unlock it by clicking on the lock icon   In this case  you do not have the proper rights to use the PTZ controls  If you  need these features  you should ask your system administrator for assistance              3 2 10 Using The Live Recording Feature    The MOBOTIX cameras in the MxControlCenter installation can be set up to record the  video stream after specific events have occurred  e g  when someone walks into a room   or they can record continuously  These recordings are stored either in the cameras or on  file servers  Since the storage capacity on these storage locations is limited  old recordings  are usually overwritten after a certain period of time     The Live recording feature of MxControlCenter  on the other hand  creates recordings that  are permanently stored locally on your computer as MxPEG video clips  In addition  you  can start and stop the live recording manually  e g  if you suspect that you could use the  video later on without having to access the regular recordings  This is a simple m
300. example of an IP address grouping scheme     Hardware Group IP Address Range Subnet    Router   192 168 1 1 255 255 255 0    MxCC workstations 192 168 1 10 to 30 255 255 255 0  Cameras 192 168 1 10010199 255 255 255 0  File servers NAS 192  168 1 240 to 250 255 255 255 0       Note that there are enough spare IP addresses to add more cameras or other devices  later on  e g  192 168 1 200 to 192 168 1 239 for cameras      A 2 2 Naming Labeling Of All Components    After having defined the hardware groups  it is recommended to assign names to the  components and to label them accordingly  In order to identify the cameras easily in  MxControlCenter and to mount them at the proper locations later on  the names and the  labels should reflect these locations  Finding suitable names for the other components is  not as critical and you are therefore more flexible     For small projects  it may be sufficient to use location names  but you should use a more  detailed naming scheme for large projects     Small project     West gate        Main entrance       Large projects   lt device_type gt   lt building gt   lt floor gt   lt section gt   lt room gt   such as  Cam1 B10 F2 S3 A210 for a camera and FS2 B10 F1 S1 A120 for a file server        Make sure that you are entering the names in the List of components and locations  mentioned in the table in Section A 1    Collecting Information About The System       A 2 3 Connecting And Powering Up All Components  You are now ready to connect s
301. f dialog for each selected video source      e Do the following in the Properties of dialog of each video source       Select the Access Data tab and click on the Change button         In the Access Recordings of dialog  activate the Use preview data for playback  and Video Search checkbox         Click on the Settings button         Inthe MxRemotePreview Custom Settings dialog  activate the Use custom con   nection data checkbox  red frame in the figure      MxRemotePreview Custom Settings    Customize any preview setting for this video source or use the defaults defined in  Options  gt  Connection Defaults     V  Use custom connection data    Camera Preview      Remote Preview  IP address  172 16 0 333 Port  9000 SSL    Username  mxcc Password  eeeseseseees    Use custom JPEG quality  Use custom frame rate  Use custom resolution    Use custom audio setting           Activate the Remote Preview option         Enter the IP address or server name in the IP address field and specify the Port  to use  172   16 0 333 and 9000 in the figure          Enter the access information for the MxRemotePreview server in the User name  and Password fields         Ifyou want to use MxRemotePreview parameters that are different from the default  preview settings specified in Step 1  activate the corresponding parameters and  set the values you would like to use  blue frame in the figure      e Close all open dialogs by clicking on OK        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Ger
302. f these settings after configuring the process  parameters  Only after the settings have been tested can it be guaranteed that  MxAnalytics delivers usable data suitable for future evaluation  It is not possible to  perform or test evaluations or export processes if the recording is not activated  as  described in Section 3 7    Using MxAnalytics       Alternatively  you can activate the recording directly and delete any data saved during  setup by reformating the recording once configuration is completed              Switch to the camera s live image in the Visual Configuration sub tab to test the settings   Check whether the counting lines have the correct label and label color  for example   Allow one or more people to move through the live image and check in the camera s live       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2   4   3 Q 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       image to see  for example  whether the counter values in the counting lines increase or  if the movement of people is followed with a track color     Activate the storage of the data generated once you have correctly set up MxAnalytics  and tested the settings     Setting Up Storage    Movement data must be stored permanently in order to subsequently create and evalu   ate MxAnalytics statistics and use the export function  To do this  it is necessary to config   ure and format a MicroSD card accordingly  Configure storage in the MxFFS Vo
303. f this manual  The following  sections are listing some important configuration tasks you should accomplish before  configuring the cameras     Overland Storage Snap Servers can be configured using MxControlCenter  See  Section 5 2 1    Adding Overland Storage Snap Servers   for more information        A 3 1 Configuring The Server Settings Of The Storage System         Settings Remark    Server name According to name in the List of components and locations     RAID According to requirements  redundancy  performance  storage  capacity    One share per file server NAS  always use the same name on  different file servers NAS  e g  mxdata      Create camera user that can access share for writing  e g  mx cam   and MxControlCenter user with read access  e g  mxcc          Shares         Users      According to requirements  redundancy  performance   assign  IP address from File servers NAS pool  set gateway and DNS  Network interface s    server  Activate Gigabit and connect to backbone using Gigabit    network interface  Activate trunking when using several net     work interfaces     Set time server and time zone according to Customer    Time server Infrastructure     Configure the notification events and set up required e mail or        Error notification phone accounts                Trash feature   If available  make sure that any trash feature is disabled        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 3 8   3 9 2 
304. figuring The Program Views And The User Interface    191 392          You cannot overwrite the saved MxControlCenter views that are written in square  brackets  e g   A11          Using A View    This procedure opens the selected view and applies its user interface configuration     e Select View  gt  Saved views from the menu     e Click on the view you would like to use        e  f you want to keep the changes to the current view  make sure that you save  itas described in   Creating A New Or Overwriting An Existing View   above     e MxControlCenter stores the last view you used for the next launch           Deleting A View    e Select View  gt  Saved views  gt  Delete view from the menu     e Inthe Delete View dialog  select an existing view from the Name dropdown     e Click on Delete to remove the view and fo close the dialog        You cannot delete the saved MxControlCenter views that are written in square brack   ets  e g   A11          Creating A Reduced     Bare Bones     MxControlCenter View    Creating such a minimum view of MxControlCenter is commonly required when setting  up a system with minimum user interaction  This can be the case at a factory gate  for  example  where the gate guard is restricted to viewing the video streams and maybe  switching between several layouts     Such a bare bones user interface most probably needs some protection to avoid user  manipulation  You should hence create a dedicated user group on the workstation for all  users that w
305. for at most  12 seconds    MxControlCenter repeats the sound for a total of five times  once upon detecting  the alarm and after that  every three seconds for the next twelve seconds           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Options    Dialog    299 392       6 1 5 The    Remote Control    Tab    This tab contains the following group boxes   Options  General   Connection Defaults   View   Alam Handling Remote Control   Monitoring   Action Log    Remote Control  Activate listen for TCP IP messages     Network Message Log    2    No configuration loaded    Remote Control 1     e Activate  listen for TCP IP messages   Activates the server part of MxControlCenter  that listens to incoming remote control commands  The sender can use all available  commands  see   List of Remote Control Commands   in this section      e Port  Enter the port for receiving remote control commands  If this field is empty  the    remote control feature will not work     e Allowed IP addresses  Enter IP addresses that are permitted to send remote control  commands to MxControlCenter  You can enter either single IP addresses or computer  names or use wildcards  e g  172   16      When entering several addresses  separate  the different addresses by commas as in the example beneath the field  Leave the  default value         in this field if you want to allow all addresses     e Sound  Use this option to specify the sound that is t
306. fy alarm   Unacknowledged IP Notify alarm from selected camera   MxControlCenter has lost the connection to this camera     Unacknowledged connection alarm     Unacknowledged connection alarm from selected camera   User has manually added an image to the alarm list      11 39 18  10 3 205 238  U Had   Manually added user image     Manually added user image from selected camera        For more information on how to acknowledge alarms  see Section 3 4 3    Reacting To Alarms       Using One Or More  Live  Alarm Windows In A Layout     Live  Alarm windows automatically show the live  images of the camera or video source for which  an alarm was triggered most recently  If there are  several  live  alarm windows in a layout  the first  alarm window always shows the live stream of the  camera with the most recent alarm and the last alarm  window shows the live stream of the camera with  the n  alarm  Upon a new alarm  the live streams of    all other cameras are pushed back by one window        If you have five alarm windows in one layout  for example  you will always see the live  streams of the last five cameras that have triggered an alarm  Alarm windows in back   ground layouts have a gray title bar        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    100 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       Using An Alarm Player Window In A Layout    An Alarm Player window shows the saved alarms from any camera that you clic
307. g  See aacr   To do so  right click on a camera in the pg aga or crrmnem      VIDEO SOURCES  gt  Cameras section of AEE  the Navigator sidebar panel and select      Properties from the context menu     User name  admin    Password  seeseee    In the Properties of dialog  click on the ihiak Wei eneitel  Change button  see figure      Set the options in the Access Recordings of  dialog as required  if a default file server has  been set in Options  gt  Connection Defaults   you can use it here               MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       2 O 8   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       Changing MxControlCenter   s Access To The Recordings Of Many Cameras    If you want to reconfigure MxControlCenter   s access to the recordings for many cameras  at once  you can use the Access Recordings dialog     Access Recordings    El Select how MxControlCenter should access the recordings of     e main gate   north gate    east gate  e south gate    i 1  e parking 2    main entrance   lobby    Via camera  Default file server path  factory IP address will be appended   Specific file server path  factory IP will be appended      Specific File Server      Use preview data for playback and Video Search       To do so  select one or more cameras  Using CTRL SHIFT click  in the VIDEO SOURCES  gt   Cameras section of the Navigator sidebar panel  Then right click on one of the highlighted  cameras and select Access r
308. ges to the  alarm list if they are sending alarm messages to the MxControlCenter computer   For more information on how to do this  Section 4 5 1    Configuring Alarms on the  Cameras   and Section 4 5 3    Configuring MxControlCenter Reactions                Showing Connection Alarms In The Alarm List    JI  plete   TT    iz    In case MxControlCenter loses the connection to any camera  E  in the system  MxControlCenter adds a Connection Lost alarm Hi   to the alarm list  If alarm acknowledgement has been set in   EEFI  MxControlCenter  you can acknowledge the alarm as any other   EAr  alarm  Section 3 4 3    Reacting To Alarms     airone          If the MxControlCenter Alarm List is not visible or does not open when an alarm  comes in  you should ask your system administrator for assistance           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    How The Alarm Features Work    997 392       Title Bar Colors And Types Of Alarm List Images    Every image in the alarm list is shown with a title bar  It displays the alarm time  camera  name and the elapsed time since the alarm  The colors of the title bar have the following  meaning     Title Bar Explanation    MxControlCenter detects an alarm in this camera within current  layout     Unacknowledged event alarm     Unacknowledged event alarm from selected camera     Alerting camera sends network message to MxControlCenter   which gets the alarm image     Unacknowledged IP Noti
309. get Computer    file server  i e   not this computer      Storage  SOD Flash Card    Set the type of Storage  make sure     that you have the correct access infor    shared roider  mation when using NFS  SMB or CIFS          SD Flash Card is the default  setting li e   the camera uses  the built in SD card to store its  recordings          Select USB Storage device or USB  Hard Drive if one of these devices  is attached to the camera     Max  age     Max  sequences        File sharing is set up correctly           Use SMB or CIFS if you are using  a Windows server or a Mac OS X Linux server running Samba         Use NFS if you are using a Linux server with NFS shares     Fill in the appropriate fields for the selected type of storage     Finishing The Setup    Set the Quota fields as required  used by the camera to limit the size of the storage      Make sure that you are setting at least one of the options in the Quota group   If you do not use any of these limits  the camera will stop recording once it  has used up the available storage capacity              Click on OK to close the External Recording dialog     Click on Apply and wait until the configurations of all selected cameras have been  saved     Click on OK to close the Camera Configuration dialog        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring Alarms And Recordings    207 392       Configuring How MxControlCenter Accesses The Recordings    Sinc
310. groups to structure the searches  simply        DES HES  Search    4    Indoor cameras  P Last weekend    move asearch onto another one  You can thus create overview  searches  e g       Indoor cameras     and detail searches  e g        Yesterday     asa   child    element of   Indoor cameras     Dies  To remove an element from a group  simply drag it outwards P Nesterday         ee a P Outdoor cameras  until the insertion cursor is only a bar between two other ele  TERS  ments  Once a parent element has lost its last child element  Da       the parent becomes a regular element again  P Yesterday    Note that the parent elements are still working as regular searches  allowing you to create  overview and detail searches as in the example above        When dealing with grouped event searches  both the parent and the child elements  remain active searches        Editing Existing Event Searches    To edit an existing event search  simply click on the search you want to edit in the EVENT  SEARCHES section of the Navigator sidebar panel  Then proceed as described in   Creating  An Ad Hoc Event Search   above     Opening The Event In The Player Panel  Once MxControlCenter is displaying events in the search results panel  you can use one  of the methods listed below to show individual events in the Player panel   e Double click on an event in the search results panel   e Right click on an event and select Open in Player   You can now use the buttons of the Player sidebar panel to pl
311. gurations is to save  different configuration files  using the File  gt  Save as menu command  and to load them    again  using File  gt  Open      Prerequisites    e One MxControlCenter program folder that is accessible from the computer     e Several MxControlCenter configuration files that have been created using the File  gt   Save as menu command or through exporting  see   The Export Configuration Dialog      above      e Make sure that the Always choose configuration file checkbox  Tools  gt  Options  gt   General  is activated  Otherwise  MxControlCenter loads the configuration file last used     Manually Loading A Configuration File On Startup    e Select one of the displayed config   uration files  or a file at a different  location      e Click on Open to use the selected file     In case you do not want to use a configu   ration file  click on Cancel  Note that you  will have to reconfigure MxControlCenter  from scratch  add the video sources again   create new layouts  etc   see Section 2 4 1     Finding And Configuring Video Sources           EB Open 27     G   d Desktop    MxCC Configurations       Date modifed Type  6 MLLULIAM Configuration Sett    1  6 1 2011 4 21 PM Configuration Sett       d MCC 25  A MxCC 25   Virtual   d MCC Configueatix  E M  syld    Filename  Branch Office ri     Configueaton fle  inv          Loading A Specific Configuration Using An Absolute File Name    If you would like to use different MxControlCenter configurations  e g  for diffe
312. guring Live Recording And The Local Archive       e The Player sidebar panel controls the playback of stored recordings  If the layout    Player 4  contains more than one camera  you can show the recordings in synchronized mode eam aa        ne es    based on the time of the recording   Besides showing the playback commands  this    sidebar panel also allows adding video clips to the Export List for exporting purposes           09 02 12    ee ee    For more information  see Section 3 5    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings   y  and   Configuring How MxControlCenter Accesses The Recordings   in Section 4 5 4  aceite        Configuring Where To Record      e The PTZ Controls sidebar panel is used to control the PTZ  Pan Tilt Zoom  functions PTZ Controls  of a camera  Depending on the type of camera  this may be the virtual PTZ or a cme  fw   camera on a pan tilt head  This panel can also contain additional controls depend    O 2  ing on the camera and lens you are using  If the current camera supports Hemispheric ems         features  a MOBOTIX Q24M  for example   this panel will be expanded accordingly  eee  For more information  see Section 3 2 9    Using The Virtual PTZ Functions On Live peat   Pen  Images   and Section 3 5 7    Using The Virtual PTZ Features When Playing Back aes ee  Recordings      e The Softbuttons sidebar panel contains the same buttons as the web interface of softbuttons  the selected MOBOTIX camera  These    softbuttons    are used to access specia
313. h    Insert manuall      MPEG dip                          Recording path            This task is performed by MOBOTIX MxServer  a software component for Windows com   puters that uses a special frame grabber card connected to the analog cameras and  provides the digitized analog signals as an M JPEG data stream just like an IP camera  in an IP network  This means the analog camera is integrated in MxControlCenter via the  IP address of MOBOTIX MxServer  The cameras connected to the frame grabber card   which accepts up to four cameras  are normally accessed via port numbers 81 to 84   Analog cameras are integrated accordingly using the Add Camera dialog box  Section 5 5     MxServer   Integrating Third Party Cameras   and Section 5 5 3    Connecting An Analog  PTZ Camera To MxServer        To connect an analog PTZ camera for live streaming and playback using MxServer     1  Connect the analog PTZ camera to MxServer    2  Set up recording of the analog PTZ camera in MxServer    3  Add the analog PTZ camera in MxControlCenter as an MxServer channel   4  Set the storage location of the analog PTZ camera in MxControlCenter      These steps are described in more detail in the following     Step 1  Connect The Analog PTZ Camera To MxServer    To integrate and connect a third party analog camera into MxControlCenter  requires  you to have a configured  and running MxServer environment with a Falcon QuattroPro  frame grabber card  Section 5 5 3    Connecting An Analog PTZ Camera To 
314. h    Searching for an event  e g  shoplifting  that is supposed to have occurred at a known  location is particularly easy using the chronological display of all event recordings  of one camera  The search results are displayed in a time line     the selected event in  a larger window  The image settings can be immediately optimized here and the event  can be directly exported     ECEE            Last event seque Con coo      ed      Name IF    Versand S w Eck 192 168 41 120 15 5929 Tue 21 0    Con    Versand  NW 14  16H 41 177 TRUAIN Tue 710 Con    Lager Gang 6 192 168 41 134 15 41 19 Tue 21 0    Con         PKwW Einfaht T24  192 168 41 177   03 04 20 Mon 20    Coni    Flu 20G Warten 192 168 41 57 16 02 59 Tue 21 0    Con  Foyer Q24 2 192 168 41 73 18 07 15 Thu 26 0    Con       EA itt            Start 15 38 04 Tue 07 09 2010 End 16 06 30 Tue 21 09 2010  Search Time 14 27 00 14 27 12 14 27 59    16112006   142712   ie  KLCC le Laa    Reference Time    JEE                Preview of single events Video Player Image post processing       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       31 392       Time Search For Multiple Cameras    The synchronization function via timeserver lets you store all cameras integrated in  MxCC with the same system time  This is an important prerequisite for data to meet  court standards  but also for the special MxCC function of directly finding all events that  were recorded in a specific time 
315. h grid layouts that can be  selected using the layout buttons in the toolbar     Store detective   s view  View with all required sidebar elements  Navigator  Player   PTZ Controls  etc    You can select this view after logging in        If you are working on a multi user system  i e   you have used a specific user name  and password to login to MxControlCenter   you may not have the rights to save views   in this case  the View  gt  Save views menu command is not active   For information  on how to save different views  Section 4 4 3    Configuring MxControlCenter Views             Besides the customized views  the following three preconfigured views are available in  MxControlCenter     Standard  All control elements  menu  title bar  etc    the sidebar  with Navigator   Player control  PTZ control  Softbuttons  and the toolbar  at the top  are shown     Display area only  Only the display area in the size of the MxControlCenter window  is shown in this view  Press the ESC key to return to the previous view     Full screen  The display area in the size of the entire screen is shown  Press the ESC  key to return to the previous view     To activate one of these views  select View  gt  Saved views from the menu or right click in  the display area and select View  gt  Saved views from the context menu        MxControlCenter stores the view that was used last and will use this view after a restart           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www moboti
316. h in this box     txt     htm1  etc    When  executing the Show alarm instructions command for this video source  see adjacent  buttons   MxControlCenter shows the file in its default application  i e   an HTML file  will be shown in the default web browser      e Preferred Alarm Layout  Select one of the layouts of this MxControlCenter installation  from this dropdown  MxControlCenter automatically shows this layout if the application  receives an alarm message from the camera and the Switch to Preferred Layout  checkbox has been activated on the Alarm Handling tab of the Options dialog        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Properties of    Dialog 3 07  3 92       e Display strategy  The following options can be used to improve the display of the  video stream shown in display windows         Minimum  MxControlCenter minimizes the latency in order to show the images  as quickly as possible  even if this could cause some jittering         Smooth display  MxControlCenter focuses on displaying the images without any  jitter  even if this increases the latency     e Audio path  Allows selecting a different camera to output the audio from the com   puter  Using this option  you can attach one camera to an announcement system  and select this camera in all others as the audio path  The audio path of the camera  attached to the announcement system remains set to Se f default setting   For more  information 
317. he    active video source     Its time and date are indicated in the  status bar at the bottom right hand corner  Besides the standard display windows   which contain the live images of a specific camera  you can use other types of dis   play elements in a layout  e g  player windows for displaying the recorded images  of one or more cameras      The alarm list shows the alarm images of all MOBOTIX cameras that are sending  alarms to MxControlCenter  You can also use this list to acknowledge new alarms     For more information  see Section 3 4 1    Visual Alarm Features   and Section 4 5 3     Configuring MxControlCenter Reactions       The Navigator sidebar panel contains several sections  which can be shown and  hidden again by clicking on the show hide controls in the tree structure         LAYOUTS  Contains a hierarchical list of all existing layouts of an MxControlCenter  installation  Click on a layout to see its contents  i e   video sources  see below   on the display area of MxControlCenter  The tree structure allows for grouping  the layouts     For more information  see Section 3 2 2    Switching Layouts   and Section 4 2     Creating And Editing Layouts       VIDEO SOURCES  Shows all video sources  cameras  clips and storage devices   that are known to this MxControlCenter installation  Double click on a camera  to open an extra  floating  window  When configuring layouts  you can pull the  video sources directly onto the layouts     For more information  see Sect
318. he MxControlCenter sequencers work on three levels     e The Layout Sequencer switches between all layouts that have been defined in the  LAYOUTS section of the Navigator sidebar panel     e The Camera Sequencerswitches between the specified cameras within a grid layout   not available for background layout  and displays the images they capture at their  maximum size in the display area  The other cameras of the current layout are not  visible any more     e A Sequencer window inside a layout cycles through specific cameras of the layout   See Section 4 3 3    Configuring Sequencers    on how to add such a display element  to a layout and how to configure the element     To activate one of the sequencers  click on the dropdown arrow of the Activate Layout or  Camera Sequencers button and select the sequencer you want to use     To stop the sequencer  simply deactivate the button and MxControlCenter displays the last  layout  camera sequencer or the current layout  layout sequencen  Since MxControlCenter     remembers    the last sequencer you used  you can simply activate the button to start the  same sequencer again        If the users should be able to configure the camera sequencer themselves  you  can add a    Configure Sequencer    button to the background layout  see   Ofher  Elements   in Section 4 2 4    Defining Background Layouts                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    sF     Layout Sequence
319. he camera  By placing a video motion window on the area  where the computer used to be  they can quickly find the person that stole the computer     3 5 2 Search Playback In A Live Display Window    When accessing a normal layout with live cameras  the display windows show the live  video streams of the cameras  By switching a display window to Player mode  you can  quickly search through the recorded video data     Switching A Live Display Window To Player Mode    To switch a window to Player mode  first  click on the live image of a specific camera  to select it  yellow frame   Next  click on the  Activate Player mode button or right click  on the camera s display window and select  Recording  gt  Player mode from the context  menu     Ifthe selected camera has recorded events   the Player panel opens in the sidebar  Next   MxControlCenter activates the playback      buttons  they are grayed out otherwise  and the display window shows the last recorded  event  indicated by the recording icon in the top right corner   see red arrow in figure          MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       30 09 11 09 02 12  05 50 54 OIN OADE   072245   WwW   no one  DED    108 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter          0 5x speed  2x speed  4x speed  8x speed  Max speed          above   You can now use the playback buttons in the sidebar to examine the recorded  video sequences    Navigating The Recordings   below  
320. he camera uses Secure Socket  Layer  default port is 443      e User name  Enter the user name required for accessing the camera     e Password  Enter the password required for accessing the camera        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 O 6   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference       e Access recordings  By default  MxControlCenter retrieves the stored video sequences  via the MOBOTIX camera  Click on the Change button to use a different storage  location as shown in Section 4 5 4    Configuring Where To Record       6 2 2 The    Information    Tab    This tab contains the following information boxes     Access Data   Information   Display   PTZ Rotor    Model  Q24M Secure  Software version  MX V4 0 7 31  MAC address  00 03 c5 09 2a 63    Factory IP address  10 9 42 99  Current IP addresses    10 9 42 99       e Model  Shows the camera model    e Software version  Shows the version of the camera software    e MAC address  Shows the MAC address of the camera    e Factory IP address  Shows the original factory IP address of the camera     e Current IP addresses  Shows the IP address es  currently in use     6 2 3 The    Display    Tab    This tab contains the following parameters     Access Data Information Display PTZ Rotor    Instruction file   Preferred Alarm Layout  Not defined  Display strategy    Minimum delay  Smooth display    Audio path    Self       fF  ci e Instruction file  Enter a file name and pat
321. he display of the layouts  and the application window itself     Alarm Handling  This tab configures the application   s behavior when receiving  camera alarms via live images or in alarm messages  TCP IP network messages      Remote Control  This tab allows setting up MxControlCenter to receive remote control  commands via network messages from MOBOTIX cameras and other MxControlCenter  computers or applications     Monitoring  This tab contains the settings to monitor cameras and to display camera  failures and latency timeouts  In addition  this tab contains the parameters of the     dead man   s switch    and the event cache     Action Log  This tab allows setting a different location for the action log  including user  name and password information  if required  and controls how often MxControlCenter  archives the log files        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Options    Dialog    289 392       6 1 1 The    General    Tab    This tab contains the following group boxes          General   Connection Defauits   View _  Aam Handing   Remote Control   Monitoring   Action Log         On Startup       Load   start    Last layout z    Retum to Start Layout after  seconds          Registered cameras    Nothing     Always choose configuration file   v        Behavior     Store changed image settings in camera   Never S  local Recorder sae   Sequencertime  5 seconds  Playback sync mode    High performance 
322. he figures         Move the start stop indicators of the slider to the desired positions   Changing The Order Of The Video Sequences In The Export List    The video sequences are always added at the end of the Export List dialog  If you want to  change the order of the sequences  simply drag one or more sequences to a new position   Use CTRL click or SHIFT click to select more than one item   Drop the selected sequences  at the position indicated by a thin horizontal line     To sort according to one of the columns  simply click on the column header  Click again  on the header to reverse the sort order     Step 3  Set The Video Format And The Export Options    You now are ready for setting the format of the video and some other export options   provided the Export List dialog contains at least one scene   The format of the exported  video depends on the operating system of the target computer and the intended use of  the video  table in the   Deciding On A Target Video Format   section above         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    140   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       Setting The Video Format    Export List    Start Stop  12 6 10 12 59 37 AM 12 6 10 10 49 18 PM    12 7 10 6 04 26 AM 12 7 10 6 14 49 PM    12 1 10 6 42 04 AM 12 8 10 7 46 22 AM    Export as    MxPEG    mxg  X  Detais    Container  MPEG    mxg   video  MxPEG  audio  MxPEG  max   fle size  128 MB    Copy application files    Ch
323. he grid of the current grid layout  You can  also create your own grid definitions in addition to  the predefined ones  click on the Edit grid button at the bottom  or select Auto  grid  see below in Section 4 2 1    Creating Layouts             Background Images  In this sidebar panel  you can set the background image  for the current background layout  You can also add more background images  by clicking on the Add Image button at the bottom     Deactivating The Layout Manager    To deactivate the Layout Manager  do one of the following        e Deactivate the Layout Manager button in the toolbar  eg  e Select Layout  gt  Quit Layout Manager in the menu     e Right click in the LAYOUTS section of the Navigator sidebar panel and select Quit  Layout Manager     4 2 1 Creating Layouts    To create a new layout  proceed as follows   e Do one of the following       Select Layout  gt  New in the menu       Right click in the LAYOUTS section of the Navigator sidebar panel and select       New layout to create a new  empty  layout that is inserted on the same  level as the current layout      New sub layout to create a new  empty  layout that is inserted as a sub  layout to the current layout        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com      5 8   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       e Select the type of layout you want to create                           B hew tayo e   B hew Layout EA     Gee Layne    Geast  
324. he manual provides an overview of the  tasks you need to accomplish in order to set up the system efficiently     There are many ways to accomplish the specific tasks  but in order to save time and  costs  this chapter presents a collection of best practice approaches for setting up a VSS   Generally speaking  you need to complete the following steps     e Collect information about the system  A 1    e Configure the system in the lab as much as possible   A 2       Configure the storage systems  A 3       Configure the camera network settings  A 4       Create and distribute a camera master configuration  A 5       Adjust sets of cameras with specific settings  A 6       Finish the lab configuration of the cameras  A 7       Configure MxControlCenter  A 8    e Test all components in the lab  A 9    e Mount components and bring system into service  A 10    e Adjust individual cameras  A 11    e Run final test of all components  A 12     e Execute Hand off and user training  A 13     The focus of this part of the manual is on setting up and configuring the system   It does not cover any planning or design of the system  If you are interested in the  quoting and planning aspects  it is recommended to enroll in one of the MOBOTIX  Sales  Planning  amp  Installation Workshops  see www  mobotix   com  gt  Partners  gt   Seminars      Since implementing a video surveillance system is a complex process  it is highly  recommended to have recently completed the MOBOTIX Basic Seminar   
325. he same audio path camera  Clicking on  any camera in a group  yellow frame  will use the assigned audio path camera for  the announcement     e All cameras in the layout have the same audio path camera  including the audio  path camera itself   Regardless of whether or not you have selected a camera in the  layout  any audio announcement will be output using the assigned audio path camera    To set an audio path for a camera  do the following    e Right click on the camera and select Properties from the context menu    e Click on the Display tab    e Select the camera to use as audio path camera in the Audio path dropdown     MxControlCenter will now use the audio path camera to play back the sound sent from  the MxControlCenter computer        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Setting Up Live Video Monitoring    175 392       Setting the audio path of all other cameras in the layoutio the audio path camera  will always use that camera to make the announcement  regardless if a camera has  been selected or not  If only some of the cameras in a layout are using the audio  path property  you need to select at least one camerato make an announcement              4 3 Setting Up Live Video Monitoring    This section contains information on how to set up alive video surveillance system including  some hints for planning a layout structure for the users  for configuring the user interface  and for powering video walls
326. he saved alarms from any cam   era that you click on in the alarm list  for more information on how to work with this  display element  see Section 3 5 5    Playback In Layouts With Alarm Player Windows        The saved alarms are not displayed in a list  but rather as a video from a video recorder   You can therefore fast forward or rewind through the alarms and the recorded image  sequences of each alarm  You can only define one alarm player window in each  layout  Alarm player windows in background layouts have a gray title bar      Live  Alarm window  This display window automatically shows the live image of the  camera or video source for which an alarm was triggered most recently     If you add several  live  alarm windows to a layout  the first alarm window always  shows the live stream of the camera with the most recent alarm and the last alarm  window shows the live stream of the camera with the nth alarm  Upon a new alarm   the live streams of all other cameras are pushed back by one window  If you have  five alarm windows in one layout  for example  you will always see the live streams  of the last five cameras that have triggered an alarm     Note that you also need to activate the Alarm List feature on the Tools  gt  Options  gt   Alarm Handling tab   Live  alarm windows in background layouts have a gray title bar     Sequencer window  This display window is used to display the content of all elements  in the current layout in alternating order  For example  you 
327. he selected profile can be adjusted by setting  a reference date  Activate the Set date checkbox and select the desired date   The current date is automatically set as the reference date if no date is entered        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    It is not necessary to  perform steps two and  three for predefined  MxAnalytics evalua   tions  Adjusting the  date in step three   is an exception       46   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       The movement data is analyzed and displayed according to the selected settings        Datei Ansicht Layout Videoquelle Aufzeichnung Extras Hilfe    BS tv   SV2HBOG OO  G BseS8s ASo0fgsx  b o f00 A             a LAYOUTS Quelen    Zablinien Profi   Aktuele Wot       V  Datum setzen  Woche  07 08 2012     Export        Properties bar to  Q24     3  gt  i Aktuaieeren  ee  amodat  Hestapfrof   rtaga  E ootmsewen  lt j  SEleCt Nd Setup   B moe profile and time   Boo S data  E sl Zahllinien Bericht   32 2012  2012 08 06   2012 08 12    Line1   Q24  DEO N Mittwoch Donnerstag E s      es ner HEN  amp  MxANALYTICS       saci delman Area for counting  P Suche Zeit ost west ost west ost west ost west ost west line reports ina  4 LOKALES ARO  2 3 0 0    R S a table  2 i 0 0 0 0 0 0  10 00   11 00 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0  a   11 00   12 00 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0    3 a     oC r Y      Be    Camera reference  image with heat  map to display the  heat map and or       BEREE  alj oi a     
328. hen setting up a system with many cameras  the network infrastructure needs provide  sufficient bandwidth  Make sure that the switches support 100 Mbps and 1000 Mbps     User Accounts    When testing MxControlCenter  you should have administrative rights on the computer  you are using  When installing MxControlCenter in a multi user environment for produc   tion purposes  however  it is highly recommended to create at least one dedicated user  with limited rights     Time Synchronization    Make sure that the MxControlCenter workstation is set up for automatic time synchroniza   tion  By default  Windows systems use time   windows   com and synchronize once a  week  Go to Microsoft s web site and search for Windows Time Service to find more  information about using   NTP  Network Time Protocol on Windows computers  To find a  list of publicly accessible time servers  go to www  pool  ntp org        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Installing MxControlCenter    53 392       The entire system  i e   the MxControlCenter computer and all cameras  should use  a common time server  This ensures that all recordings are using the same time  base  see Section 4 1 5    Configuring A Common Time Server                 2 3 2 Automatic Installation of MxControlCenter    e Obtain the MxcontrolCenter V2 5 1 Setup exe installation file         Download the installation file from the MOBOTIX website and save the file on  your 
329. her with the Repeat every option and repeats  the alarm until the user has clicked on any alarm  the most recent alarm or every  alarm  the latter setting is the most demanding one as the user needs to click on  every alarm to stop the alarm from repeating      Repeat for at most  Use this option to stop the alarm repetition after the specified  number of seconds  provided new alarm occurred in the meantime      Setting The Preferred Layout For The Camera    Set the preferred layout of a camera to West gate  Player      Open the camera s Properties of dialog doing one of the following            Right click on a camera in the VIDEO SOURCES  gt  Cameras section of the Navigator  sidebar panel and select Properties from the context menu         Right click on a camera in any layout and select Properties from the context menu   Open the Display tab   From the Preferred Alarm Layout list  select the West gate  Player  layout     Click on OK to close the Properties of dialog        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 O 2   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration          Setting The Instruction File For The Camera    To set the instruction file   e Open the camera s Properties of dialog doing one of the following         Right click on a camera in the VIDEO SOURCES  gt  Cameras section of the Navigator  sidebar panel and select Properties from the context menu         Right click on a camera in any layout and s
330. highly modern  football stadium with a seating capacity of 51 504   93  under roof  is the home base of FK Schachtar  Donezk  the Ukrainian champion many times over   and will be an important venue of the European  Football Championship in 2012  The stadium has  over 1 000 parking spaces  more than 60 restaurants   bars and caf  s  numerous shops  VIP areas  a fitness  center and even a football museum  In addition to  sporting events  the stadium is also used for large  company events  international concerts and shows  By giving the Donbass Arena its  highest rating of 5 stars  UEFA categorized it as the first elite stadium in Eastern Europe     The Most Advanced Network Infrastructure    With 6 000 ports  the arena possesses one of the largest computer networks ever installed  in the Ukraine  During construction  60 kilometers of glass fiber cable and more than  400 kilometers of shielded Cat 6 copper cable were installed  This network simultane   ously constitutes the perfect basis for an IP based high resolution video surveillance  solution  To fulfill the expectations for elite status  UEFA requires a permanent video  surveillance system both within and outside of the stadium  The cameras must have  a still image function and be connected to color monitors housed in the control room     High Demands On The Video System    The specifications for the Ukrainian MOBOTIX partner UNITOP responsible for the planning  and installation of the video system contained the following 
331. hone and speaker on the cameras   e Events  This tab configures the video motion windows of a camera     e Network Messages  This tab allows defining alarm messages on the cameras   When detecting alarms  the cameras are sending these messages to one or more  MxControlCenter computers        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    310 392    MxCC User Manual  Reference          When working with the Camera Configuration dialog  the following applies     e Changes to the camera settings are automatically stored in the camera s   when you click on Apply or OK     e When making changes without saving them  MxControlCenter will remind you  to store the changes when you are switching tabs or closing the dialog              6 3 1 The    Overview    Tab    This tab shows an overview of the most important settings for all cameras that are part  of this MxControlCenter installation  The first column lists the video sources and allows  changing access information  similar to the VIDEO SOURCES  gt  Cameras section in the  Navigator sidebar panel   Click on a camera to see a preview window and more detailed  information at the bottom of the dialog     E Camers Configuration oto       o HOE S O  amp     Overview Image Settings Exposure Recording Audio Events Network Messages Time Server MxAnalytcs    IIl    Name W arming f Recording    ado fj Events  H Mode ER Recording Target     as     E  Codec  E  Reston JEI  Quaity        m W
332. ical user interface 61  Grid layout  glossary  355  Grid layouts 22  Defining 158  Grids  Sidebar panel  Layout Manager mode   66  Group rights  Editing 202  Editing  overview  201  Groups 36  Creating 201  Creating  overview  201  Editing 201  Editing  overview  201       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 8 2   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Index       GSM 2G  glossary  355  GUI 61    H 264 AVC 10  H 264  glossary  355  HDTV  glossary  355    Hidden MxControlCenter  Configuring functions for 186    HiRes  glossary  355  Hub  glossary  355    Icons  Layout elements 69    Image compression  glossary  355  Image post processing 76  Image post processing  glossary  355    Images  Printing 33    Image Settings  Camera Configuration tab 302    Implementing  Two man rule 203    Information  Properties tab 296    Installations  Exporting 218    Installing   MOBOTIX application software 231   MxControlCenter automatically 51   MxControlCenter language packages 145   MxControlCenter manually 144   MxPEG DirectShow Codec 146   MxRemotePreview 268   MxRemotePreview on Microsoft Internet  Information Server 7 270   MxRemotePreview on Windows with  Apache Web Server 268    MxServer 259  Software 222  System and initial operation 48    Integrating  Analog PTZ cameras 253  Third party IP PTZ dome cameras 250    Introduction  Display modes 78    IP Network  glossary  355  IP phone  glossary  355    IP PTZ dome cameras  Integrating
333. ices correctly to NPA        Network interface speed set  incorrectly  e g  1 Gbit s      Set speed to 10 100 Mbit s        MxCC does not find camera  automatically     After manually adding camera   camera does not show images     Camera is behind a router   connected via Internet     Add camera manually       No power supply to camera   not connected to PoE switch     Port has been included in  camera address     Connect power supply PoE  switch    Specify port in separate text  field        Protocol  e g  http       has been added in camera  address     Remove protocol  e g   http      from camera  address        Camera is running  but does  not show images     Manageable PoE switch is  supplying power  but data  connection on the port is  deactivated     Activate the data connection  on the port        Camera display window shows     disconnected    message    Power supply of camera failed     Check power supply of cam   era        Connection to switch failed     Check camera and computer  connection to switch        Power supply of switch or  switch itself failed     Check power supply of switch  and switch itself        Browser does not show camera  image but camera responds  to PING     Proxy blocks video stream     Add camera IP address to  proxy exceptions in browser        Remote access to camera does  not work     Default gateway in camera not  or incorrectly set     Set proper default gateway in  camera        Port forwarding in router not or  incorrectly set     
334. ick and select Access Recordings   see   Changing MxControlCenter   s  Access To The Recordings Of  Many Cameras   in Section 4 5 4     Configuring Where To Record           Via camera  Default file server path  factory IP address will be appended   Specific file server path  factory IP will be appended      Specific File Server    Path    nxstorage 1  l Browse       User name  mxcc    Password  eeeeesee    Create layouts  To help you in creating the layouts for MxControlCenter  it is recom   mended to proceed as outlined in Section 4 3 1    Planning A Layout Structure    and    the following sections     Create event searches  Create and structure event searches to user requirements   e g  by location  all gate cameras  all door cameras  all elevator cameras  etc    See       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring MxControlCenter 3 5 5   3 9 2         Creating New Event Searches   in Section 3 5 8    Using Event Searches   for more  information     A 8 4 Configuring The Alarm Handling    Setting Up Alarm Handling  Proceed as outlined in Section 4 5 3    Configuring MxControlCenter Reactions    but use  the following settings    e Activate the alarm list    e Setup a permanently stored alarm list file    e Deactivate the Add live stream events checkbox    e Configure the reception of alarm messages    e Activate the alarm sound and set the corresponding options    e Set the instruction file  if required a
335. ick the corresponding button briefly to access a saved  3  Go   position  Gs   Positions can be defined and then accessed in the following cases    e Live PTZ in MOBOTIX cameras    e Pan tilt heads that can be controlled via MOBOTIX cameras  Resetting The Image    You can click on the 1x Zoom button to reset the visible image to the unzoomed camera  image  If you click on the Center button  MxControlCenter moves the center of the zoomed  image to the center of the original camera image     Automatically Moving The Visible Image    The buttons in the Auto Move panel control the automatic camera movements  Hemispheric  cameras in particular offer a number of automatic movement features     e Pan Left  Click on this button to slowly move the visible image to the left  The visible  image will keep on moving until you click one of the other buttons     e Pan Right  Same as above  but moves the visible image to the right        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    90 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       e Views 1 15  Click on this button to cycle through all stored views from 1 to 15     e Jump N E S W  When watching Gay  a Hemispheric camera mounted  to the ceiling  the camera can  create images of four virtual  cameras from one 180 degree  image  In this Surround mode   each virtual camera s viewing  direction is perpendicular to the  previous camera  Click on this  button to cycle through the four  vi
336. ics file if the following is true  for the latency  time between capturing the image by the camera and displaying  it on the monitor          Ifthe latency exceeds the Maximum latency time  MxControlCenter starts mea   suring the time span during which this is the case         If this time span surpasses the value specified in Maximum overdue time   MxControlCenter executes the latency error display specified in this group box        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Options    Dialog    303 392       e Automatic stream recovery  If this checkbox is activated  MxControlCenter automati   cally tries to recover after the occurrence of a latency timeout and resumes showing  the video stream from the video source  If this checkbox is deactivated  the error  message or graphic will be shown until you switch the selected video source online  again  To do so  right click in the display window and select Remove Stream Lock  from the context menu        When using the latency time options  make sure that the system time of the camera  and the system time of the MxControlCenter computer are precisely synchronized        Dead Man   s Switch  amp     This option is primarily used to ensure that the staff of a monitoring workstation are well  and fulfilling their task  If MxControlCenter does not detect any activity within the specified  period of time  the application shows a prompt to remind the user that this alar
337. ideo surveillance system   Adjusting individual cameras 344   Adjusting sets of cameras 336   Collecting information about the system  321   Configuring MxControlCenter 339   Configuring the camera network set   tings 324   Configuring the storage systems 323   Creating and distributing a camera  master configuration 326   Final lab test of all components 342   Final tests 345   Finishing the lab configuration of the  cameras 339   Hand off and user training 346   Lab installation of components 321   Mounting and initial operation 343   Overview 48    Video system 13    Video wall 24  Configuring 175  Using 74    Video wall  glossary  360  View  Options tab 284  Virtual PTZ  For Live images 78  Functions 78  When playing back recordings 113    Visual alarm features 93  VM  glossary  360  VoIP  glossary  360    vPTZ  For Live images 78  Functions 78       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Index       Ww    Wi Fi  glossary  360   Wireless devices  glossary  360  Wizard  glossary  360   WLAN  glossary  360    Working  With MxControlCenter configurations 216    Working folder 217    Workstation  Security 207    Z    Zeroconf  glossary  360       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       MxCC User Manual       Notes                                                                                  MOBOTIX AG      Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    
338. ight and shadow  The quality of the analysis results is dependent on the light   ing and environmental conditions to which the camera is exposed  You can set  various parameters that adapt the camera to different lighting and environmental  conditions in order to maintain good quality  Three environment settings are pre   defined for this purpose  Itis also possible to customize the environment setting       Artificial light  no shadows  Select this option if the environment to be ana   lyzed is illuminated by artificial light only and there are no shadows cast by  the objects to be detected         Sparse sunlight  blurred shadows  Select this option if the environment to be  analyzed is subject only to minimal changes in illumination  such as sunlight   and any shadows cast are of a diffuse nature       Heavy sunlight  well defined shadows  Select this option if the environment  to be analyzed is subject to serious changes in illumination  such as a large  window  or harsh shadows arise         Custom setup  Selecting custom setup opens options and checkboxes that  can be used to select and link different illumination situations and shadow  detection methods        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring MxAnalytics    211 392           Constant illumination  Select this option if there will be no changes in illu   mination in the environment to be analyzed  for example  in a windowless  hall  This optio
339. iguration  D ig      N E   f N      Q EREJE S O m  Overview Image Set Exposure Recording Audo Events Network Messages Time Server MxAnalytics    Video Motion 1   Video Moton 2  disabled     image Sensors   J Enable VM Event 1   Sees Wises Detect video motion on both sensors   Display YM windows in current live image SNOPES O DOS  SU   When armed  Hide    Show Low Light Conditions  Disable detection if Bumination drops   During an event  Hide    Highlight below the selected level     mx10 9 42 99 Left Sensor   Off     Right Sensor        man entrance     Downtown office       back door          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 24   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference          This tab of the Camera Configuration allows selecting several video sources     Note that the right sensor is always the default image sensor  this is true for all  dual cameras except the    D14D 180     which always shows both image sensors      Some of the settings shown in the dialog in the Image Sensors section and the  Sensor Control section are only available for Dual camera models  with exeption  of the D14D 180   model         Video Motion 1 2    ay    Enable VM Event 1 2  Activates the corresponding set of video motion windows     Show Frames  These options control the behavior of the video motion windows in  the live and recorded video streams         When armed  Set this option to Show to see the video motion windows when  the c
340. ill be using this MxControlCenter installation and assign the proper privileges        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    192 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       To Set Up A Reduced View     1     Create an MxControlCenter user group and user and set the privileges  see Section 4  7     Users  Groups And Group Rights        Set up the layouts and make one the start layout  see Section 4 2    Creating And  Editing Layouts        Configure the MxControlCenter user interface to show only the required elements   see Section 4 4    Configuring The Program Views And The User Interface        Copy the MxControlCenter configuration and program files to the workstations  see  Section 4 9    Working With MxControlCenter Configurations        Login as user and test the configuration on the MxControlCenter workstation        e Make sure that you have administration privileges on the MxControlCenter    e Make sure that you document the following items     workstation         Which layouts are to be used for which situation         How can the operators switch layouts           4 4 4 Configuring Functions For A Minimized Or Hidden MxControlCenter    If the MxControlCenter computer is also used for other tasks and it is not necessary that  the application is visible in the foreground at all times  you can minimize MxControlCenter  to the taskbar or hide it behind other windows     Bringing MxControlCenter Back 
341. image has 33 43  image     been set in Properties  Ji    Available if microphone has  Play camera audio    been enabled in Camera  Configuration     Available if speaker has  been enabled in Camera  Configuration     Activate announcement to  camera     Switches on the light if the  selected video source has an  attached light source     Switch on light via cam   era     Opens the door if the selected  Open door via camera  video source has an attached  door opener     Applies to all video sources  in layout  use dropdown for  selected video source only     Activate camera connec   tions     Allows changing the configura   tion of one or more cameras in  Camera Configuration     P l Shows the camera s browser   js        Show camera information   Shows comprehensive informa   in browser  tion about the camera status     Use this button to log on as     On  Logout  requires restart  a different user  MxCC restart  as required      Open camera configu   ration       1 Available only when camera is selected  2 Drop down button       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       68 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter          3 1 3  MxControlCenter Sidebar Panels    The MxControlCenter sidebar contains several panels that can be shown or hidden by  clicking on the corresponding heading  Section 3 1    Elements Of The Application Window        Sidebar Panel Explanation See    Navigator Collection of sections list
342. in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Connecting Remote Cameras Using DynDNS 2 5 7 3 92       Adding A Remote Camera In MxControlCenter    To add a remote camera using DynDNS  proceed as described in   Manually Adding Video  Sources To The List   of Section 2 4 1    Finding And Configuring Video Sources    Instead of  an IP address  enter the DynDNS name of the router and the corresponding port of the  camera     Descriptive name of  the camera    DynDNS name of the  router             Address  mycamera dyndns drg   F  Secure connection  SSL     Camera port on the  router           OYPSss proxy        User name  remote user User name and pass   word for accessing the    camera          Password  eeesecee        Storage location  Via camera          Sa          Name  Descriptive name for easy identification of the camera     Back door    in  this example     Address  mycamera dyndns org  Port  8001  User name  User name for accessing the camera     remote user    in this example     Password  Password for the user name    If everything has been configured properly  the status icon changes to green B and  MxControlCenter shows a preview image for this camera        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 5 8   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features    Activating SSL Encryption       Once SSL Encryption has been activated  all communication to and from the camera is  encrypted using SSL  Using this 
343. in the camera list     2  Select Camera  gt  Save Settings from the menu  press CTRL ALT S or click on the  Save Settings button  This opens a Save Configuration File dialog that saves differ   ent files depending on the number of cameras you selected         One camera selected  Creates a backup configuration file      cfg  of the selected  camera     Syntax   lt camera name gt   year month day  cfg    Example  mx10 8 195 72 2013 04 02 cfg           More than one camera selected  Creates a zipped backup archive      zip  for  the selected cameras     Syntax  MxConfig   year month day  zip    Example  MxConfig 2013 04 02 zip       3  If required  select a different target folder     4  Click on OK to save the file        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    246 392    MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       pl   Upload Settings pe  1 MxConfig 2011 07 06 2ip  2 MxConfig Backup 2011 06 30 2ip  3 20n 1 2011 06 30 cfg    Contents Of A Zipped Backup Archive    The zipped archive consists of the Mx Configuration folder that contains a camera list  and individual camera configuration files based on the camera name     Contents of the Mx Configuration folder     CameraList mxu  camera list    mx10 8 82 206 2013 04 02  cfg  camera configuration file   mx10 3 94 200 2013 04 02 cfg  camera configuration file   mx10 8 195 72 2013 04 02 cfg  camera configuration file        Restoring Camera Configuration Settings From A Back
344. indows to control  the exposure in relation to the rest of the image  0  to 100       A value of 700   default  means that only the exposure windows are used for deter   mining exposure  the rest of the image area does notinfluence exposure  A value of  0  is useful if the exposure windows are to be used only for automatic white balance     e White Balance  Controls to which degree the camera uses exposure windows to  control the white balance in relation to the rest of the image  Total  0  to 100       A value of Jofa uses the whole image area for adjusting white balance  and ignores  the exposure windows  This setting is useful if the exposure windows are to be used  only for automatic exposure     e Brightness  This parameter sets the average image brightness  0  to 100   that  should be reached within the exposure windows        Ifthe options of this section are not available  Exposure Mode has been set to Virtual  PTZ  In this mode  the camera cannot use any exposure windows        Frame Details O    This section shows the dimensions of the selected exposure window  click on such a  window to activate it   Changing the values of the coordinates and the dimensions modi   fies the selected window accordingly   If no exposure windows are present  click into the  display area and draw a rectangle with the mouse      e Geometry  Use the spin buttons to modify the size and position of the selected  exposure window     e Exclude window area from exposure  If this option is acti
345. inese  PRC      Italian  Japanese  Dutch  Russian   Spanish        Program views       Standard program view    Reduced program view    Yes  individually  configurable    Yes  individually    Complete program view with all  functions     Minimal view showing only the usable                      configurable functions   Full Image Yes  individually   Complete utilization of the complete  configurable monitor area for display of building  plans grid layouts   Work areas Yes  individually   Storage loading of the current program  configurable view as work area  can be linked to user  groups    Monitor walls Yes Directly via an MxCC instance or by  remote control of individual MxCC client  computer    Layouts       Structured layouts    Yes  practically  unlimited    Rapid grouping by shifting the layouts    Tree structure            Linked layouts    Yes  practically    Simple navigation from overview plans          unlimite to detail plans for branch operation   Search filter functions Yes Rapid mee layouts  e g  locations   by entering the search filter criteria in  the text field   Process navigation of the layouts Yes Display of the most recently used layouts    as in browser     forward    and    back     buttons with selection lists                        Building plans Yes  practically Symbol display with automatic alarm  unlimited activation with live player alarm focus  windows   Grid layouts Yes  practically Automatic  predefined and individually  unlimited configurabl
346. ing message in this area     6 3 5 The    Audio    Tab    This tab contains the following sections     Camera Configuration      E R  BJE SV OC    Overview Image Settings Exposure Recording Audio Events Network Messages Time Server MxAnalytics  Name a     axis 1      main gate i      north gate d     east gate     Parking 1     mx10 9 42 99                MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Camera Configuration    Dialog 3 2 3   3 9 2          This tab of the Camera Configuration allows selecting several video sources        Microphone      e Audio input  Controls the camera microphone  On  Off     e Sensitivity  Controls the sensitivity of the camera microphone  Low  Medium  High      Speaker 2     e Audio output  Controls the camera speaker  On  OM     e Volume  Controls the volume of the camera speaker     6 3 6 The    Events    Tab    Video motion detection is a software feature of the MOBOTIX cameras that recognizes  movements between two consecutive images of the live video stream  The camera uses  intelligent algorithms and the values of the pertinent parameters to decide when to trigger  the VM  Video Motion  event     You can define the video motion  VM  windows and set related options on this tab  The  MOBOTIX cameras support two sets of video motion windows  Video Motion 1 and 2    where each set can contain several video motion windows     This tab contains the following sections     Camera Conf
347. ingly   If no video motion win   dows are present  click into the display area and draw a rectangle with the mouse      VM Set  Shows to which video motion set  Video Motion 1 or 2  the selected video  motion window belongs  This is also shown by the different colors of the video  motion windows         Video Motion 1  White outline and background      Video Motion 2  Blue outline and background    Motion Detection  These options control the trigger thresholds for the selected video  motion window  note that these are per video motion window settings          Low threshold  Sets the minimum number of pixels in the video window that needs  to change from one frame to the next in order to trigger an event  Decreasing  this value will make the video motion window more sensitive         High threshold  Sets the maximum number of pixels in the video window that  may change from one frame to the next in order to trigger an event  You can       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 2 6   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference       use this value to suppress false alarms resulting from global changes  e g  when  the lights are turned on          Sensitivity  Sets the amount of change that must be detected in the pixels of a  video motion window in order to trigger an event  Besides Low threshold  this  is the second parameter for fine tuning the triggering  By default  this value is  20 for regular video motion windows and  
348. inting into four  different directions  perpendicular to one another  North  East  South and West   This  display mode does not support zooming     e Panorama  Delivers one horizontal 180 degree view  mostly used for door cameras      e Panorama Focus  Delivers one horizontal 180 degree view on top and two additional  windows below with vPTZ functionality  mostly used for door cameras      e Double Panorama  Delivers one horizontal 180 degree view on top and one 180  degree view pointing downwards  mostly used for door cameras      If you select the Surround  Panorama Focus or Double Panorama view for a hemispheric  dual model  such as the S14D  the corresponding partial views can be edited individually   To do this  select the desired partial view using ALT Cclick     The display modes provide an efficient way of distributing the load between the  MxControlCenter computer and the cameras     e Many cameras in one layout        Set the cameras to the desired display mode  e g  Panorama  the cameras  handle the load of creating the desired display mode          Set MxControlCenter to Unchanged     This approach requires less bandwidth per camera since you can use smaller  image sizes  e g  CIF instead of VGA  for the individual cameras     e Few cameras in one layout       Set the cameras to Full Image         Set MxControlCenter to Panorama  MxControlCenter handles the load of  creating the desired display mode      This approach requires more bandwidth per camera since MxCon
349. ion 2 4 1     Finding and Configuring Video Sources      Section 3 2 3    Using Extra Windows To Display Video Sources   and Section 4 3 5     Configuring Extra Windows       EVENT SEARCHES  Contains all predefined event searches  by default  this section  only contains one Search   Click on one search  select video sources and set the       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Elements Of The Application Window 6 5   3 9 2    time frame to find the events  Event searches also include Post VM searches   which allow searching movements in the recordings of one video source        For more information  see Section 3 5 8    Using Event Searches   and Section 3 5 9     Using Post Video Motion Detection In Recordings        LOCAL ARCHIVE  This section serves two purposes  First  you can drag amp drop 4 LOCAL ARCHIVI  results from event searches  see above  into your own folder structure within the ji Se  local archive  Second  the local archive stores the video stream from the current Teena  camera when you using the live recording feature  In both cases  MxControlCenter   stores the recordings in a local folder  i e   not in any storage location that is   controlled by a camera  and thus prevents deletions by the camera     For more information  see   Storing Entire Events In The Local Archive   in Section 3 5 8     Using Event Searches    Section 3 2 10    Using The Live Recording Feature   and  Section 4 3 4    Confi
350. ion dialog opens     Click on the Recording tab     Activate the Digital sign   ing of recorded images  checkbox  red frame in  figure      Click on Apply     Wait until MxControlCenter  has rebooted the camera     Close the Camera  Configuration dialog        Arming Switch       Pa Arming    On       Recording Switch    A Recording    On ov    4  Display recording symbol in live image          V  Digital signing of recorded images  Recording Mode    B Recording Mode   Events  MxPEG clip     v  Audio          Full image recording       Image Size   Mega  1280x960           JPEG Quality   60          Text Display    Date Time    Recording Start and Duration E    i Recording       Image Anaysis  VM    Frame rate    Maximum x  F s     Time before    Off x     Time after    10 sec  v      V  External Recording    He Folder   CIFS  172  16 250  111 mxdata    By default  the camera uses the self generated digital certificate  If you want to use a dif   ferent digital certificate  please proceed as described in Section 4 8 4    Using Encrypted    Connections To Access Cameras          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 2  amp    3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       Downloading The Public Key To Check Data Integrity    This is only required if you want to check the digital signature of storage folders created  with a MOBOTIX camera that has a software version lower than 4 0 6  x   To automatically store 
351. ion of an IP PTZ dome   please proceed as described in   Step 3  Set The Storage Location Of The IP PTZ Dome  In MxControlCenter   of Section 5 4 2    Integrating Third Party IP PTZ Dome Cameras          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    MxServer   Integrating Third Party Cameras 2 6 9   3 9 2       5 5 MxServer   Integrating Third Party Cameras    MOBOTIX MxServer allows integrating IP and analog surveillance cameras from third   party manufacturers into a MOBOTIX system  Its main application is to digitize the images  from expensive analog PTZ dome cameras and to execute the PTZ commands of an  MxControlCenter workstation     MxServer consists of a Windows computer with a frame grabber card  IDS Falcon QuattroPro   and the MOBOTIX MxServer software     5 5 1 Introduction To MxServer    In summary  MxServer carries out the following tasks     e Converts the images of a third party analog camera to a digital video stream in    M JPEG format  which can be used as a live video source in MxControlCenter     e Sends the PTZ commands from MxControlCenter to the analog PTZ dome using  the serial cable     e Continuously records the images of a third party analog or IP camera to a format  that can be read by MxControlCenter     How MxServer Works    3rd party IP camera pe as pia 1Zc oNmands MxControlCenter workstation        e e e             Pe Ta           Switch       3rd party SN MxServer  analog camera    N   gt 
352. ions     Full Image       Zoomed Image Area    Si   m            Moved image area   virtual PTZ     Titl down up    Pan left right    O    aD When looking at the images from an M24M  for example  the default display mode  Full Image always shows the entire image as it is delivered by the image sensor     2  Once you zoom into the image  the camera shows only a section of the image  the  Image Area        If the image has been zoomed  you can virtually pan tilt the zoomed image area  within the borders of the full image        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    R 2   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       Different Display Modes For Different Cameras    MOBOTIX cameras nowadays comprise a whole range of cameras for various purposes   Depending on the underlying construction principles of the cameras  the cameras have  different display modes     e    Regular    cameras  in general  these cameras have lenses with focal lengths  gt    32 mm    Display Modes of    Regular    Cameras   below      e Cameras with L22 lens  These cameras only have L22 lenses installed    Display  Modes of Cameras with L22 Lens   below      e    Hemispheric    cameras with L11 lens  These cameras have only L11 lenses installed     Display Modes Of    Hemispheric    Cameras With L11 Lens   below      Display Modes of    Regular    Cameras       Regular    cameras  such as the M12D  D12D  M24M  D24M  etc   basically offer the f
353. ior  and to use an ALT click for executing pan tilt actions     Mouse Over  Controls the behavior of MxControlCenter when the mouse is moved  over a video source in a layout         On  Shows the original resolution image   either as live or recorded video stream         By MultiView  Shows the default MultiView layout of this camera  if such a layout  has been defined on the camera itself        Small area  If activated  MxControlCenter automatically opens and closes the  mouse over window if the mouse pointer enters or leaves a small area in the  center of the display window  If deactivated  the mouse over window remains  open until the mouse pointer leaves the area of the mouse over window     Layouts 2     Show toolbar at bottom  Displays the toolbar at the bottom of the main window  instead of at the top     Layout buttons in toolbar  Replaces the regular toolbar  function  buttons by names  of the first layouts in the LAYOUTS section of the Navigator sidebar  see Section 4 4 2     Configuring The Toolbar    for more information      Show grid borders  Shows the display windows in grid layouts with a thin white  border  You can use this option to provide a better overview when showing many  cameras in small display windows     Center grid layouts  Centers the grid if it is smaller than the entire display area     Show Player icon in recordings  Activates the Player indicator  see adjacent icon   when playing back recordings     Application       On top after  After the i
354. irectional audio for audio connections to MOBOTIX  cameras  which support this  e g  the MOBOTIX T24M      Save Bandwidth       Reduce frame rate  CPU usage   When using many live cameras in one layout   MxControlCenter can automatically monitor the CPU usage on the computer  If the  CPU usage passes the limit set in this dropdown  MxControlCenter automatically  reduces the frame rate that is requested of the displayed cameras     When minimized  Controls the behavior of MxControlCenter if the application has  been minimized to the task bar        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Options    Dialog 2 91   3 Q 2           Stop all  Stops retrieving the video streams from all cameras while the application  is minimized  Once the MxControlCenter window has been restored  it automati   cally resumes the retrieval of the video streams       Continue decoding  Continues to retrieve the video streams from all cameras as  if the application were not minimized         Pause  Temporarily suspends the retrieval of the video streams while the appli   cation is minimized  Once the MxControlCenter window has been restored  it  automatically resumes the retrieval of the video streams     Note that MxControlCenter will be restored automatically when the applica   tion receives a valid camnotify or ip command  for more information  see  Section 6 1 5    The    Remote Control    Tab                 If MxControlCenter is mi
355. ision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com      3 8   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       You can now use the Player controls in the sidebar or in the Video Search dialog to find  the video sequences you want to export     Step 2  Add Events To The Export List    Once you have identified the event sequence you want to export  you are ready to add  these sequences to the export list     Adding The Entire Recording To The Export List    e Using the Player sidebar panel       Make sure the Player sidebar panel is open       Click on the Add to Export List button  the Export List dialog opens    fos  e Using the Video Search dialog         Make sure the Video Search dialog is open       Select a camera in the Cameras tab         Click on the Export button  the Export List dialog opens      Although it is technically possible to export the entire recordings of one camera  we  recommend to use this feature with caution  The data generated this way is most  likely too much to process in a practical manner              Adding Selected Video Sequences To The Export List  e Using the functions of the Player sidebar panel         Find the start of the interesting scene usin p    vE 9 om  lt 3  ca a  the playback buttons  the slider or set a fix fa fa ee te i   date and time and click on the Go to Date        w  Time button       Activate the Marker Mode button to set the start of the clip            Use the playback buttons or the slider to 
356. ith a few cameras each and use  MxControlCenter   s mechanisms for switching layouts automatically  This will support the  operators rather than confuse them        When using third party cameras  you should not put too many cameras in one  layout  As a rule of thumb  third party cameras create four fo five times more CPU  loadthan MOBOTIX cameras running on MxPEG  Open the Windows Task Manager  and monitor it closely when loading a layout with third party cameras     Make sure that you document the following items           e Which layouts are used for which purpose   e Label the layouts properly         Make sure that the operators can tell live layouts from player layouts  e g   by adding      Live    and     Player    postfixes to the layout names         Make sure that you document the naming conventions you used              4 3 2 Configuring Layout Selection    Selecting different layouts is one key feature that controls how the operators of a security  system work with the system  When setting up the system  you need to decide how the  operators should switch layouts     e Operators are using the LAYOUTS section of the Navigator sidebar panel  Continue  with   Arranging Grouping Layouts In The Layout Manager       e Operators are using buttons within background layouts  Continue with   Using Layout  Buttons In Layouts          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    178 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configur
357. ix com    sales mobotix com    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings   27  392    3 5 10 Using The Video Search       If you have defined an external recording target  file server  for the relevant video source  or the MOBOTIX camera has an SD CF card for internal storage  the camera can store  large amounts of data  Searching all of this data may prove to be challenging  especially  when dealing with several cameras at once     This is where the Video Search dialog provides extensive search features  To open the  dialog  click on the Open Event Search button in the MxControlCenter toolbar    6    Video Search    Camera  D  MxControlCenter    Mx_ES Gateway   Cameras Events   Time  amp  Date   14 25 00 Thu 16 11 2006   14 26 00 Thu 16 11 2006   14 26 29 Thu 16 11 2006   14 26 45 Thu 16 11 2006   14 27 00 Thu 16 11 2006       14 28 00 Thu 16 11 2006  14 28 57 Thu 16 11 2006  14 23 00 Thu 16 11 2006  14 23 26 Thu 16 11 2006  14 30 00 Thu 16 11 2006         Stat 1259 40 Thu 16 11 2006 End 14 41 00 Thu 16 11 2006  Search Time  11 16 2008   1 59 40 PM   Seach KIKKA aL    Reference Time    TRISTE  ference  00 00 00  F  98   8  xS           The Video Search dialog box can be used to browse through the recordings from all  cameras defined in the current layout  In the Cameras tab  select the camera whose  recordings you want to examine  MxControlCenter now shows all recorded events in  chronological order in the Events tab     The vertical slider bar next to the event list provides a
358. k on  in the alarm list  The saved alarms are not displayed in a list  but rather as a video from  a video recorder  You can therefore fast forward or rewind through the alarms and the  recorded image sequences of each alarm  Alarm player windows in background layouts  have a gray title bar     For more detailed information about how alarm player windows work  Section 3 5 5     Playback In Layouts With Alarm Player Windows       Application Related Options    When an alarm arrives  MxControlCenter can also execute the following actions     e Add the camera alarm image to the Alarm List even though the camera is not part  of the current layout     e Restore the application window if MxControlCenter is minimized     e Bring the application to the foreground if MxControlCenter is hidden behind other  windows     3 4 2 Acoustic Alarm Features    In the event of an alarm  MxControlCenter can play back sounds over the audio system  of the computer  This can be a standard sound  beep  or a custom sound file      wav      To set the sound file  open Options  gt  Alarm Handling in the menu and search for a sound  file  Likewise  you can set how often MxControlCenter will repeat the sound and when the  sound will stop after acknowledging an alarm  see Section 3 4 3    Reacting To Alarms           Acoustic alerting is only available if either the Alarm List or the Alarm Messages  have been activated in the Options  gt  Alarm Handling dialog           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Syste
359. kstations that are each using different cameras  for example              Starting Update Assistant    By default  the MxControlCenter setup wizard creates a link in the Windows Programs  folder  this is usually Start  gt  Programs  gt  MOBOTIX  gt  MxCC   Click on the Update Assistant  icon to start the application  If you started MxControlCenter from a desktop icon and the  Update Assistant icon is not there  search for the Update Assistant exe file and  create a link on the desktop     Working With Camera Lists    Camera lists can be used in a variety of ways to help maintain  update and configure a  larger number of cameras consistently and simultaneously  In addition  you can manually  create your own lists and administer them as needed     The camera list file  CameraList  mxu by default  contains the camera addresses and  additional information  This file is first created when using the File  gt  Save Camera List       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    250 392    MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       command in Update Assistant  This mechanism lets you save and load cameras into  Update Assistant without having to load them into the MxControlCenter installation     The camera list file CameraList mxu can be renamed accordingly to describe  the cameras location  purpose  or function  and stored on file server as needed   Thereby  the user can group cameras  and maintain them as a group              Fi
360. l Languages  German Russian Japanese English Italian French Spanish  Chinese    with this software release  the new hardware platform of these models reaches about twice the frame rates as in  the predecessor models Q22M  D22M and M22M  This software release contains the same functions as its    predecessor 4 0 4  18  Among other improvements  you can implement flexible alarm reactions for one event by  executing virtually any number of action profiles  FTP  e mail  sound  phone call and network messages   This  release also brings enhanced functionality in the VoIP SIP telephony area  DHCP server functionality for self   sustaining networks  encrypted e mail transfer using SSL TLS and also supports devices with RS232 interface  via  US8 to FTDI adapter   In addition  this release also contains the adjustments and enhancements to the MxPEG  video stream that are required for the new features of the upcoming software releases MxControiCenter V2 5  and MxEasy V1 4           e To see the release notes of this software  click on the Info button  Update Assistant  downloads the release notes and shows them in your web browser     Why Is The Software Packages Panel Empty     Certain settings in the Options dialog can prevent Update Assistant from downloading  the list of software updates from the update server  Do the following to check the settings     e Select View  gt  Options from the menu of Update Assistant     e Click on the Settings button in the Software Downloads dialog  
361. l cam   E  era functions  making them available directly from MxControlCenter  a E on    C E  a es      MxControlCenter provides many ways to customize its user interface  If you cannot  find some of the user interface elements described in the following  you should    read Section 4 4    Configuring The Program Views And The User Interface   or ask  your system administrator                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    66 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       3 1 2 MxControlCenter Toolbar Buttons    As shown in the overview of the MxControlCenter main window  Section 3 1    Elements  Of The Application Window     the toolbar provides quick access to the most important  functions of the application  Note that the following table shows all buttons  Depending  on your user rights  however  you may not see all of these buttons  Section 4 7    Users   Groups And Group Rights        Toolbar Button Name Remark See        Only active if configuration has      Save MxCC configuration 34 9 2  Also switches the contents of the  Activate Layout Manager 4 2  Activate Layout or Camera   MxControlCenter stores the last 3 2 4  sequencer  selection of the dropdown  4 3 3    Available if the video source of  Activate Player mode  the selected display window has   3 5 2  recorded at least one event     Provides access to the record     Open Video Search ings of all cameras for exporting  via the export list  
362. lable on Day Night and IT models         This section is available for all Dual camera models with exeption of the D14D 180    model            MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Camera Configuration    Dialog    313 392       Saturation  Brightness  Backlight and Sharpness 2     e Saturation  Adjusts the color saturation of the image  default is 0    e Brightness  Adjusts the image brightness  default is 0      e Backlight  Improves images that contain bright and or overex   posed areas  default is 4      e Sharpness  This parameter can almost fully compensate reduced  image contrast due to dirty lenses and optical phenomena attrib   uted to aging lenses  default is 4      Format       e Video codec  Selects the MxPEG or M JPEG codec for encoding video   e Resolution  Sets the current size of the camera image   e JPEG Quality  Sets the JPEG quality of the camera image     e Camera frame rate  Sets the maximum frame rate of the video stream delivered  by the camera     e Image quality  Sets the desired image quality with regards to the frame rate       Quality  Delivers the best quality at lower frame rates but uses more bandwidth         Normal  default   Represents the best compromise for a good frame rate and  quality         Speed  Delivers higher frame rates using less bandwidth but shows some loss  in quality     Image Settings O  e Night improvement  Enables amplification for dark images but can in
363. lding jog    5  Create a display window for a video source      s  using one of these methods  Ge op  S        Drag amp drop a camera or other video source  from the sidebar onto the display area  by  default  these video sources are shown in  Add Image       live display windows      Main Building  jpg Main Parking  jpg           Right click on an existing display window  select Insert from the context menu   select an Element type and select a Video source     See the   Additional Rules For Editing Background Layouts   section below for more  information on the available options        6  Quit the Layout Manager  see   Deactivating The Layout Manager   in Section 4 2     Creating And Editing Layouts          a  The layout will be saved automatically     Additional Rules For Editing Background Layouts    e Display elements already placed in the layout can be moved to a different position  using drag amp drop     e The size of the display elements is determined automatically  taking into account the  existing elements and the proximity of the element to the border        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    170   3 92 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       N e When moving a video source to a display window that is already used  the two video  sources swap positions as soon as you release the mouse button  as indicated by  the    swap    mouse cursor and the green frame of the target window      e Dragging a 
364. le MOBOTIX Installation 38  Total Costs Make The Difference 40  An Example  Donbass Arena  Ukraine 42  MxCC Performance Details 44  2 System Installation and Initial Operation 48  2 1 Setting Up MxControlCenter   Overview 48  2 2 Power Supply And Network Connection Of Cameras 49  2 2 1 Power Supply When Connected Directly To A Computer 49  2 2 2 Power Supply And Network Connection Using A PoE Switch 50  2 3 Installing MxControlCenter 51  2 3 1 System Requirements 5   2 3 2 Automatic Installation of MxControlCenter 53  2 4 Launching MxControlCenter For The First Time 54  2 4 1 Finding And Configuring Video Sources 54  2 4 2 Using The Video Sources In MxControlCenter 57  2 4 3 Initial Installation Of Hemispheric And 180   Cameras 60  2 4 4 Saving The Initial Configuration 61  3 Using MxControlCenter 62  3 1 Elements Of The Application Window 63  3 1 1 MxControlCenter User Interface Elements 64  3 1 2 MxControlCenter Toolbar Buttons 66  3 1 3 MxControlCenter Sidebar Panels 68       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 392    4 392       MxCC User Manual   3 2 Live Video Surveillance 69  3 2 1 Displaying Video Content In Layouts 69  3 2 2 Switching Layouts 73  3 2 3 Using Extra Windows To Display Video Sources 74  3 2 4 Using Sequencers To Automatically Switch Cameras Or Layouts 75  3 2 5 Using A Video Wall To Display Cameras 76  3 2 6 Using The Audio Features Of A Camera 77  3 2 7 Using The Camera To Switch Lights 
365. le click on any video source in the Navigator sidebar panel     e Click on the Open extra window button  This opens an additional live window of  the active video source in a layout  as indicated by the yellow frame      Once MxControlCenter shows the window  you can move it to any location on your com   puter   s desktop  even to a second monitor      When resizing  the images of the displayed video source are scaled automatically  regard   less of the actual image size  To return to the original size of the displayed video source   right click into the extra window and select the Restore original image size command  from the context menu     To close the extra window  simply click on the window   s Close button or press the ESC key  when the window is active        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Live Video Surveillance    75 392       Double clicking on a camera window by default always opens an extra five window  of the video source you clicked on  Note that double clicking on a video source can  also be set to other options  see the Options  gt  View  gt  Mouse  gt  On double click  dropdown      If your MxControlCenter installation behaves differently  please ask your system  administrator for assistance              3 2 4 Using Sequencers To Automatically Switch Cameras Or Layouts    The MxControlCenter sequencers are used to automatically switch between cameras or  layouts at specified intervals     T
366. lect Configure from the context menu  The  Camera Configuration dialog opens     e Click on the Events tab   7  Enable VM Event 1  e Click on the Video Motion 1 tab  Show Frames    e Make sure that the Enable VM Event 1 checkbox  is activated  The Video Motion 1 tab should  now look like in the figure     Video Motion 1   VideoMotion2      Display VM windows in current live image    When armed  Hide   Show  During an event  Hide     Highlight    f      V  Display window IDs  e Move the white frame of the Video Motion 1  VM set to a suitable position  e g  a door  or    draw a new frame using your mouse            The new changed video motion window  has a solid white border while any existing  window on the camera has a dotted line           Add more windows as required by drawing  them with your mouse     e Click on Apply and wait until the camera con   figuration has been saved        The new video motion windows appear as dotted  frames in the camera s live image     Setting up Alarm Messages from the Camera to MxControlCenter    e Open the Camera Configuration dialog   e Click in the Network Messages tab        This tab of the Camera Configuration dialog allows selecting several cameras   Use CTRL SHIFT click   Any changes to this tab are applied to all selected cameras        e Inthe Alarm Targets group box  activate the Enable checkbox   e Set the Acknowledge dropdown to On     e Add anew IP address in the list box        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in 
367. linked together directly  This allows a fast search  for the camera  for example  at the customer parking lot of branch XY via real maps                                A German map contains links to all branch establishments  gt  each branch establish   ment with all branches  gt  each branch with its building plan  gt  building plan XY with  parking lot camera and five additional cameras        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    22 392    MxCC User Manual  Practical Camera Layouts       In a grid layout the  image windows can be  of varying size  e g   for panorama images    A specific layout can  be assigned to the  cameras  prefer   ably in case of alarm   location layout           Individual Grid Layouts    In addition to the background layouts with map and building plans  the image windows   live video film or only preview image  of several dozen cameras can be displayed  simultaneously in a grid defined by the user with varying window sizes     fom fxControlCente Ee  lc View Layout VideoSource Recording Took     B ww  B nBoa   me      aamonga ay ae Le       M    125 kbi r MOI 14 41 25 Wed 15 09 10    Grid layouts can display not only current live images of selected cameras but also  preview images of the most recent alarms  triggered  for example  by movement in the  image  automatically in the display panel of alternating live images of specific cameras   sequencers   video clips recorded before in loop mo
368. lossary  358    Restoring  Camera configurations 234    Restricting public access to the cameras  205    Ring buffer  glossary  358  RoHS  glossary  358  Router  glossary  358    Saved views 90    Saving 130  Camera configurations 231  Initial configuration 59  Program settings 218  Single images 130    Scaling commands 89    Scaling functions  Configuring 181    Scenarios  MOBOTIX systems 16    SD card  glossary  358    SD cards  Accessing the recordings 276    Searching  In a Live display window 103  In Layouts with display windows in Player  mode 107  Several cameras in synchronized mode  108    Searching  glossary  358    Security 205  Alarms 26  MxControlCenter workstation 207  Network 205    Sequencers  Configuring 173  Using 73    Sequencers  glossary  358    Settings  Saving program settings 218    Setting up  Recording in MxServer 264    Sidebar  Navigator 18  Player 18  PTZ Controls 18  Softbuttons 18    Sidebar panels  Background Images  Layout Manager  mode  66  Grids  Layout Manager mode  66  MxControlCenter 66  Navigator 66  Player 66  PTZ Controls 66  Softbuttons 66    Signal input  glossary  359  Signal output  glossary  359  Signing  Recordings 211  Single images  Printing 131  Saving 130  SIP  glossary  358  Snap Server  Editing settings 239  Using 237    Snap Server  glossary  359  Snapshot  glossary  359    Softbuttons 18  Sidebar panel 66    Softphone  glossary  359    Software  Downloading 222  Installing   222  Updating 222       MOBOTIX AG    Security 
369. ls if and how changes are saved         Never  Changes are not saved to the camera       Always  Changes are always saved  without prompting     Ask user  Before the changes are saved  you will be prompted     This applies to changes of the following image settings  lens selection  dual cam   eras   display mode  hemispheric installation  setting of preset views  and locking   unlocking of the PTZ feature     Local Recorder size  MxControlCenter creates a buffer of this size in the computer  memory  RAM  for each live camera  The buffer allows controlling the smoothness  of the video streams before showing them        Using a Local Recorder size higher than 2 MB per camera when viewing many  live streams will use large amounts of RAM on the MxControlCenter computer        Sequencer time  Allows setting a default time during which MxControlCenter shows the  cameras or layouts when the application runs in sequencer mode  see Section 3 2 4     Using Sequencers To Automatically Switch Cameras Or Layouts        Playback sync mode  Controls how synchronized playback in the Player sidebar  panel works         Real time focuses on getting the recorded images of all selected cameras in  real time  even if this means dropping single frames in between  because they  are not received quickly enough          High performance focuses on getting all images without dropping any frames   even if this means that the recordings cannot be shown in real time     Bidirectional Audio  Activates bid
370. lt parameter gt  amp  lt parameter gt  amp         Parameters can be single parameters or parameter value pairs      Example  http     lt server gt   lt camera folder gt   lt event folders gt  E00001   jpg  previewsize 320x240   amp framerate 1 0   amp quality 20   amp noaudio       Make sure that a camera has created atleast one recording  Then copy the URL command  example above into the address bar of the web browser as a whole without blanks or  spaces between the parameters  replace  lt server gt  by the corresponding server name        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Using MxRemotePreview To Access Remote Recordings 2 8 3   3 9 2        lt camera folder gt  by an existing folder name of a camera and  lt event folders gt   by the folder structure  The following rules apply     e The          question mark  separates the image file extension   jpg  and the first  parameter     e The    s     ampersand  separates one parameter or parameter value pair from the  next parameter or parameter value pair     e Parameters and parameter value pairs can appear in any order        URL Parameters for Testing CGI Settings    Maximum dimension in pixels  such as  320x240   320 px  previewsize  lt h gt x lt v gt  horizontally by 240 px vertically   e g    previewsize 320x240    Frames per second  fps  with decimal  e g     framerate    lt fps gt   amp framerate 1 5    Quality of JPEG encoding  integers from 1 to 100   e
371. lume  Partitioning dialog  To open it  click on the Set up MxAnalytics storage button in the Basic  Configuration sub tab  The dialog contains the following areas           Format Mode  Select Quick Format if you know for certain that  your camera is not being accessed  Secure deletion mode  requires significantly more time     MxFFS Volume Partitioning    Format Mode     Quick format    Secure deletion mode  slow   Backup existing recordings e Activate the Backup existing recordings checkbox to secure  sich recorded data  Otherwise you will permanently lose the data     Device Usage   i go  MxAnalytics only        D Recording and orice e Device Usage  Select whether MxAnalytics recordings only  no    MxAnallytics Volume Size  Tm oo other recordings are stored  or all other recordings are to be stored     pee oe ere ee e MxAnalytics Volume Size  Approximately 1 GB per month is  er required to permanently store results data     __ Cancel    e Enable Data Encryption  You can encrypt the recordings to ensure   the SD cards can be read only by entering the corresponding  password  To do this  activate the checkbox and select either the automatically created  encryption password  recommended  or create your own password           4 6 2 Controlling Motion Detection  Time Tables    Optional    As mentioned in the previous section  video motion analysis can be permanently enabled  or managed by a time table     If  for example  you only want video motion analysis to be active during 
372. lution 13  Decentralized concept 14    Monitoring  Action log 214  Action Log 214  Camera connections 215  Options tab 292    Monitor wall 24   MonoDome  glossary  356  Motion detection  glossary  356  MPEG 4 Part 10 357   MPEG  glossary  357    MxControlCenter  Alarm features 92  Alarm List 97  Configuring reactions to alarms 192  Display modes of application window 89  Elements of application window 61  Installing language packages 145  Installing manually 144  Launching for the first time 52  Options dialog 278  Performance details 44  Sidebar panels 66  Start Layout 71  Toolbar buttons 64  User interface elements 62  Using 60    MxControlCenter  glossary  357    MxControlCenter views  Configuring 183    MxEasy  glossary  357    MxPEG DirectShow Codec  Installing 146       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 84   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Index       MxPEG  glossary  357    MxRemotePreview   Installing on Microsoft Internet  Information Server 7 270   Installing on Windows with Apache Web  Server 268   System requirements and installation 268   Testing the web server 272   Using different servers 273   Using to access remote recordings 266    MxServer  Connecting third party IP cameras  Integrating analog third party cameras  Introduction 258  Starting automatically 265  System requirements and installation 259    MxStatus  Status monitoring 147    NAS  glossary  357    Navigator 18  Sidebar panel 66    Naviga
373. ly appends new alarms     Auto acknowledge alarms after  Automatically acknowledges new alarm list entries  after the time span set for this option     Configuring The Reception Of Alarm Messages    Alarm messages instruct MxControlCenter to add alarms to the alarm list even if the  alerting camera does not belong to the current layout        Select Tools  gt  Options from the MxControlCenter menu   Click on the Alarm Handling tab     Configure the Alarm Messages group box as shown below     Alarm Messages    Activate alarm message server  listening for TCP IP messages   Port  31754    Allowed IP addresses       Accept only    camnotify    and    MxCC Alarm    message types  V    Add image to Alarm List   V  Open extra live window   Restore MxCC  when minimized    Switch to Preferred Layout        Explanation Of Options    Port  This is the port on the computer on which MxControlCenter listens for alarm  messages from cameras     Allowed IP addresses  By default  MxControlCenter accepts network messages from all  other network devices          When you enter a filter string  e g  10       MxControlCenter  filters network messages and only allows messages from network devices that  match the filter     Accept only    camnotify    and    MxCC Alarm    message types  This filter checks the  contents of the alarm messages and rejects messages that do not correspond to  the allowed types     Add image to Alarm List  When receiving an accepted message  MxControlCenter  adds the ala
374. m is about  to be triggered  Ifthe prompt remains unconfirmed  MxControlCenter plays an alarm sound  and optionally sends an e mail to the specified address     e Activate after  Activates an alert that triggers after the specified number of minutes  without detecting any monitoring activity     e Send e mail message to  Sends an e mail to the specified address entered in the  Mail Settings dialog         Mail settings  Opens the Mail Settings dialog to define the SMTP Settings and  the Message header  address  etc           Preview  Activates the preview pane and shows the generated e mail         Edit Template  Shows the XSL file that formats the e mail output in a web browser   You can use a text editor to modify the XSL file  recommended for experts only          Send Test Mail  Sends an e mail using the settings you specified above     For more information on this topic  see Section 3 8 1    Working With The Dead Man   s Switch       Event Cache O    This checkbox enables MxControlCenter   s event cache  which downloads event information  from all cameras that are listed in the VIDEO SOURCES  gt  Cameras section of the Navigator  sidebar panel  If this option is deactivated  the event searches  EVENT SEARCHES section  of the Navigator sidebar panel  will not work  see Section 3 5 8    Using Event Searches        The default setting of the Network cache size is 64MB  the maximal value is 2GB  Provided  that you have sufficient storage capacity on your hard drive  we recom
375. machines     The P4 release is optimized for Pentium 4 machines with SSEII     2  Double click on the MxServer  lt version gt  Px msi file to start the Windows  installer     3  Follow the instructions of the setup wizard     Find more documentation on the system in the PDF documentation that is installed with  MxServer        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 I 2   3 Q 2 MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       Running And Configuring MxServer    Once MxServer has been installed properly  you can start it by double clicking on the  MxServer   exe file     When launching MxServer for the first time  Windows shows a message asking you  whether or not to block the application  Make sure that you click on Unblock so that  MxServer can function properly              MxServer shows its application window        BE  MxServer 1 3 11  File    22 Channels  T  0 0 0 0 80  configure    To Configure MxServer     e Click on File  gt  Configure in the MxServer menu  MxServer starts a web browser  and connects to port 80 of this computer  i e   MxServer opens the http    loc   alhost 80  address      MOBOTIX M lt xServer 1 3 1 1 Configuration       System state    System Settings  Existing channels  he s  Configuration IP address  Log file path   Log file max size  Mb     New channels   New Axis IP          Add a new administrator  New login  New password  Retype new password    Send   Reset    e Set a new password        
376. mage coverage settings control the area covered in vertical direction by the  graphic files you have specified     The Automatic stream recovery checkbox ensures that MxControlCenter does all it can  to recover a lost stream as quickly as possible        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Security Considerations    231 392       4 8 8 Configuring The Dead Man s Switch    The dead man   s switch is a tool for monitoring the activity of the guards on duty  for  example  see Section 3 8 1    Working With The Dead Man   s Switch        To configure these settings  select Tools  gt  Options from the menu and click on the Monitoring  tab  The options in the Dead Man s Switch group box on this tab are controlling how  MxControlCenter reacts when loosing the connection to one of the cameras     Activate after  Activate this  checkbox and set the num   ber of minutes to wait before  playing an alarm sound     Send e mail message to   Activate this checkbox to use  this function  then click on  the Mail settings button to  configure the e mails sent by  MxControlCenter  see figure  to the right   Note that you  need to know the address of  a valid e mail server  a valid  e mail account and possi   bly a password for using  this function  Activate the  Preview checkbox to see the  e mail as it will be sent and  click on the Send Test Mail  to test the configuration        E mail Settings    SMTP Settings    Server  smtp my
377. many    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 8 6   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       5 7 Using MxControlCenter To Read SD Cards    MOBOTIX cameras  IT and Secure models  store their recordings on an internal SD card   see the corresponding manual of your camera for more information on SD card storage    Since MOBOTIX cameras use a special file system for storing the recordings on the SD  card  you cannot read the cards in a computer  This requires a MOBOTIX driver  which is  available for Windows computers     Follow these steps to read an SD card with recordings of a MOBOTIX camera on a  computer     e Quit MxControlCenter if it is running   e Insert the SD card into a card reader     e Windows shows a message that it found new hardware  Do not attempt to access  the drive in Windows Explorer and ignore any warning messages     e Double click on the FFSSetup exe file in the MxControlCenter program folder   usually C  Program Files MOBOTIX MxCC   and follow the instructions     e Launch MxControlCenter  MxControlCenter shows the New MxFFS volume dialog  and offers to create a new layout     New MxFFS volume o   B  Em   A MxFFS volume with recordings from the camera mx10_10_49_22  10_10 49 22  is    added to the list of video sources  folder   Recording Folders        The list is visible inside the Layout Manager     Properties  Name  MxFFS Volume 1 of mx10 10 49 22  Folder Path  Path  667926 0    Encryption keys    Tene range     Mi 12  Dez 05 00 08 2012   
378. matically v  a x   Search mode     Until Now X Go to Order   Ascendng v Search    e Select one video source       Click on the Sources button and select one camera       Click on OK to close the dialog   e Set the time range for searching       Click on the From dropdown and set the start time of the search       Click on the Until dropdown and set the end time of the search     e Set the sort order in which the recordings are to be displayed in the Order drop   down  Depending on the sort order  MxControlCenter sets the current position of  the player as follows         Ascending  Sets the current position to the first available recording       Descending  Sets the current position to the last available recording   e Create a video motion window in the Player panel         Click with the mouse  keep the mouse key pressed and pull in any direction to  draw a frame  see adjacent figure          Repeat to draw as many frames as required that exactly cover the area s  you  are interested in  e g  a door and a window      Note that you can move an entire frame by dragging its ay  interior  To create other shapes than rectangles  simply drag k   the corners until the window matches the area of interest    see figure to the right   If you want to delete a window  click   on the close icon in the top right corner        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    126 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       C 100    
379. me and Password fields  this may be the case if you  are using a network share    Setting The Archiving Options For The Action Log  e In the Archive Action Log group box  select one of the options     e Incase you are using the When exceeding box  enter a suitable size in megabytes   no decimals      When the action log reaches the limit specified in this group box  MxControlCenter com   presses the file and creates a new  empty file     Monitoring And Filtering The Action Log    To see the contents of the action log  select Tools  gt  Show Action Log from the menu  You  can now activate the filters  see red frame in figure below  and configure them by clicking  on the corresponding button behind the checkbox  In addition  you can export the log file  into an XML file format and print it        E  x   Export    Print       Details  4 12 11 9 29 AM f 1 User    admin    successfully logged in     4 12 11 9 29 AM Update Assistant Update Assistant opened     4 12 11 11 02 AM Shutdown Shutting down MxControlCenter        4 12 11 11 02 AM Start Launching  MxControlCenter        Note  The Action Log refreshes automatically  even when opened  and therefore will  always contain the last logged action        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    230 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       4 8 7 Monitoring Camera Connections    Regardless of how many cameras your system contains  you will want to let the users  kn
380. me server setting since all components of the VSS must have the  same time base   Network data Gateway  DNS  available IP addresses        Access data  user names pass   words     Router information for remote      DynDNS public IP address  ports for port forwarding     A 2 Lab Installation Of Components    Network shares  e mail  SIP servers providers                 After you have made sure that you have the information you need  you can begin to  connect components  or groups of components in larger systems  in the lab installation   During the lab installation  you can accomplish many of the configuration tasks before  going out to the customer to set up the real system     A 2 1 Defining Hardware Groups    When defining hardware groups  you should keep in mind that the main focus of this  step is to configure the groups as efficiently as possible  Although it is possible to use  other criteria for grouping your hardware components  e g  according to location  storage       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 3 6   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline       target  etc    practice has shown that it is most efficient to group the devices according to  their function and to assign IP address ranges accordingly     Note that it is not advisable to use a DHCP server to automatically assign IP addresses   but to always assign IP addresses manually     The following table shows an 
381. mend setting the  maximum value to minimize the loading times of the video system for event searches   Limit the setting of the Network cache to   0    to prevent local access to the data        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 04   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference    6 1 7 The    Action Log    Tab       This tab contains the following group boxes     Options    General   Connection Defaults   View   Alam Handling   Remote Control   Monitoring   Action Log  Action Log File    Custom     Archive Action Log    Every day  2  Every week    Every month  When exceeding       No configuration loaded       Action Log File      e Custom  Shows the current location of the action log file and allows setting a dif   ferent location  Besides folders on local or mapped network drives  you can also  use a UNC path  e g     myfileserver Logs MxCC MxControlCenter mx1      e User name  If access to the path of the action log is protected  enter the user name  in this field     e Password  Enter the corresponding password in this field  if required     Archive Action Log 2    e Every day  MxControlCenter creates a new action log every day   e Every week  MxControlCenter creates a new action log every week   e Every month  MxControlCenter creates a new action log every month     e When exceeding  If the action log gets larger than the size specified here   MxControlCenter creates a new action log and archives the old one      
382. menu                 Generating A Layout    MxControlCenter now shows the Create New     New tyout  Layout dialog  which lets you automatically   vouhevecrosen to add 2 video source s    create a new   Grid Layout with the Selected   a cenerate new grd layout for selected video sources    cameras or add the cameras without creating Name  ESET  anew layout Only add video sources to system  do not create layout     If you choose to create a new layout  highly rec   ommended   you should enter a suitable name   e g  Entrance East  before clicking on OK      ox   cancel       A layout can display the video streams from multiple video sources either in a   Grid  Layout or a   Background Layout layout  When using a background layout  you can  show the video sources either as a video window or an icon  Grouped layouts provide  a structured  tree  view        Automatically Generated Layout In MxControlCenter    ED MxcontrotCenter   Inside   Player  File View Layout VideoSource Recording Tools Help    Navigator  a LAYOUTS  2 Overview   Outside   H man Entrance   H west gate  Parking   H Garage Entrance  E Command 8 TEST   H Gate Guard   B auto crid   B ques vea  4 g Overview   Inside   B Recepton   H elevators   B Beck Entrance   D outside  Player   B inside   Player   B az   B    Gateway    Event Search   H Event Search cips 1  DEO SOURCES  Cameras  rw    Player   PTZ Controls   Softbuttons   j Fis 53 kb s 842   12 52 38 Fri 25 02 11          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   M
383. minimum requirements     e The recorded video material must permit identification of each individual visitor    e Recording of high detail and thus high resolution images evidence in case of  adverse incidents in the surveillance areas    e Camera coverage of all entrances exits  spectator stands  access paths and wait   ing areas  elevators  restaurants  shops  parking areas  offices  the museum and  the server and equipment rooms       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    43 392       Complete Solution Using 528 MOBOTIX Cameras And MxCC    After an intensive comparison with other providers  the decision was clearly made in  favor of a complete MOBOTIX high resolution  decentralized and weatherproof camera  system with the free MxCC video management software      featuring integrated software   storage unit and high performance computer  simple integration in the existing computer  network and the low number of cameras and network components     Control center with  MxCC worksta   tions and 42  live  image monitors        User interface  in Russian    Allin all  the installation comprises 528 MOBOTIX cameras that record  to four SAN servers  a total of 210 terabytes   The video control center  completely uses MxCC and includes four workstations with several  42    monitors for live monitoring by the security staff plus two monitor  workstations for administration and data archiving           Shortly after install
384. ministration  gt  Time Tables     e Possibly move the time of the daily camera reboot to an uncritical time during the  day in Admin Menu  gt  General Administration  gt  Time Tasks     A 5 5 Storing And Testing The Master Configuration    Before distributing the master configuration  you need to permanently store the camera  configuration  then reboot and test the configuration     e Store the configuration  Admin Menu  gt  Configuration  gt  Store      e Reboot the camera  Admin Menu  gt  General Tasks  gt  Reboot         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 48   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline       Check the camera time and the time server status  Admin Menu  gt  General  Administration  gt  Time and Date      Test the e mail profiles  DNS servers  etc  in Admin Menu  gt  Network Setup  gt  Test  Current Network Configuration     Check the system messages for errors  Admin Menu  gt  System Information  gt  System  Messages      Are the camera LEDs showing the intended behavior     If you find errors in the configuration  correct the settings and repeat the test  If everything  is working as planned  proceed by distributing the configuration to all other cameras   see below      A 5 6 Distributing The Master Configuration    You are now ready to copy the master configuration to other cameras  The ideal tool  for this purpose is the Update Assistant  see Section 5 1    Updat
385. mmended to export as a File Server  Structure or as MxPEG and to include the MxControlCenter application files  You can  burn the exported folder structure to a CD DVD to hand over to the authorities  All that is  required to play back the video is a Windows computer with a CD DVD drive  Playing back  the structure does not involve any installation  simply double clicking onthe PlayVideo   cmd file in the export folder starts the playback in MxControlCenter        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Saving  Printing And Exporting    137 392       This format also allows checking the data integrity to prove that the video has not been  manipulated afterwards  The camera s public key file cert   pem that is required for check   ing the integrity of the exported data is automatically included in the export     Note that MxControlCenter can also create a compressed ZIP archive of the entire folder  structure  which can be password protected  This file format is ideally suited when transfer   ring the video by e mail or FTP  See   Step 3  Set The Video Format And The Export Options    below for information on how to set the corresponding options for this export format     Format For Windows Media Player Users    If you want to create a video that requires very little adjustment on the target computer   you can create an MxPEG video  To view the MxPEG  MxG  file in Windows Media Player   you only need to install the co
386. mobotix com      6 R   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       the element will be placed in the next row with sufficient space  This means that  large elements may be placed in a new row at times  while small elements are  added to any unused areas at the top of the layout        The grid definition strings can be separated by spaces  commas or line breaks        4  Make sure the resulting layout meets your specifications and save it by clicking on  the Save button          The new layout is now available in the Grids sidebar panel                                         Grid Windows   s   small 160x120 PDA   1 large 640x480 VGA   h huge 1280x960 MEGA  Double Width Size Size Pixel  Format   du double tiny 160x60       ds    double small 320x120 Double PDA   dm double medium 640x240 Double CIF   dl double large 1280x480 Double VGA   dh double huge 2560x960 Double MEGA                      The double width grid elements  du  ds  dm  d1  dh  are ideal for the Panorama  display mode of Hemispheric cameras  since they also have an aspect ratio of 8 3     However  double width grid elements are not suitable for layouts in the format of  16 9  Because of the aspect ratio of 8 3  the image height gets adjusted  makes the  image thus narrower and the areas on the left and right of the image are greyed out              4 2 4 Defining Background Layouts    Unlike grid layouts  see Section 4 2 3   background layouts allow you to freely arrange   i the video sources on top of 
387. ms   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    How The Alarm Features Work    101 392       3 4 3 Reacting To Alarms    When MxControlCenter receives an alarm  the application can execute the defined auto   matic functions  e g  switching to the preferred layout of the alerting camera   In addition   the operator can execute specific functions to react to such an alarm     Acknowledging Alarms    If MxControlCenter has been set up so that the operator needs to acknowledge incoming  alarms  MxControlCenter shows the alarms as described in Section 3 4 1    Visual Alarm  Features   in the alarm list     To acknowledge an alarm  you simply click on the title bar of the alarm image  Once all  images in the alarm list have been acknowledged  the red status bar at the top of the  alarm list turns green     Title Bar Colors Of Acknowledged Alarm List Images    Once you have acknowledged an alarm  its title bar changes from the status shown in    Title Bar Colors And Types Of Alarm List Images   to the colors shown in the table below     Title Bar Explanation    eee teens eee   Acknowledged event alarm     eo   Acknowledged event alarm from selected camera     14 20 25  doku d12d 180  N mm   Acknowledged IP Notify alarm     Pee   Acknowledged IP Notify alarm from selected camera      180 See    Acknowledged connection alarm   Acknowledged connection alarm from selected camera     For more information on how to change the display and filtering options of alarms  see   
388. n    figuration  only MxCC    access data     Video source s Properties and  access data  reload configuration   reboot video source     ft In video source s Properties of dialog  O  Can be changed in Overview tab  T  Use tab to change  this setting        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Camera Configuration    Dialog       Column Provides Access to Remark Change       Same options as on  O arming Arming status of a video source  Recording tab  po      l Same options as on  Recording status of a video source  Recording tob  o  Audio recording status of a video Same checkbox as on  source  Recording tab   Status of individual event triggers of  O mode Recording mode of a video source  ALAA a o  Recording Target   Recording tab  Information only   Codec for live stream and recording    MxPEG  M JPEG EE        Same options as on  All available resolutions  image Settings tab  Ea  A l Same options as on  Quality     JPEG quality  image Settings tob  o    Same options as on  Activation status of video source s Same options as on  Activation status of video source s Same options as on  microphone  Audio tab   Activation status of the Microphone   MI  event     D In video source s Properties of dialog  O  Can be changed in Overview tab  T  Use tab to change  this setting           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       3  2   3 9 2 MxCC User Manu
389. n  an analog system until a relatively high number of cameras is purchased  MOBOTIX  proves that even small installations can be implemented extremely cost efficiently with  a high resolution system     Fewer Cameras Thanks To Higher Resolution    The more accurate detail of megapixel technology requires fewer cameras compared  to conventional solutions     A MOBOTIX  camera delivers up    as many as six   standard cameras       Less Cabling    Because MOBOTIX cameras are simply connected via the network cable and are  simultaneously supplied with energy  their installation is significantly simpler  faster  and more economical than in all other camera systems     Less Network And Storage Load    MOBOTIX cameras can record on flash memory devices  such as MicroSD cards  to  help reduce the load on the network  Through the camera s efficient internal software   MOBOTIX allow a standard network storage medium to have enough capacity to record  10 times more cameras than is ordinarily the case        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com          Conventional video system    MOBOTIX complete HiRes solution                                        Cameras  3x dome cameras 2 700 1x  store cash register  798  4x cameras with weather protection 4 000 1xD24M  4 gas pumps  748  2x cameras with weather protection 2 000 2x D24M  car wash  1 496  1x mechanical dome camera 2 300 1x M24M Sec  repair shop  798  2x day night cameras 2 20
390. n OK to close the dialog     e Copy the different shortcuts to the users    Desktop folders or to the users    network share     Loading A Specific Configuration Using A Relative File Name    Using a relative file name for the configuration file  i e   without the path  works just like  when using an absolute file name  see previous section   The only difference is that you  specify the configuration file  without the path  and the working folder     Target field  launch command         C  Program Files MOBOTIX MxCC MxCC exe    MxNoSave    SouthGate ini       Start in field  working folder         C   MxCC GateGuards          The shortcut properties dialog looks like in this figure     E3  MxCC GateGuards   South Gate Properties    Details   __ Previous Versions  Shortcut Compatibilty    FN  MxCC GateGuards   South Gate    Target type  Application  Target location  MxCC                         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       236 392    MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       5 ENHANCED FEATURES    The previous chapter has shown you how to set up the MOBOTIX video surveillance sys   tem for the end users  This chapter covers special tasks that go beyond the initial setup     e Using the Update Assistant   e Using Snap Server NAS systems to store recordings   e Connecting to cameras via DynDNS   e Using Pan Tilt heads  third party cameras and joysticks   e Setting up MxServer to integrate analog third party
391. n also allows you to follow objects that do not move for  several seconds  It has a positive effect on the frame rate as it generates  a very low computing load         Slow change in illumination  This option is suitable for rooms with few win   dows  Changes in illumination occur gradually and are not distinct         Quick change in illumination  This option is particularly well suited for rooms  prone to sharp illumination changes  such as is the case in large windows   The computing load is highest here  which has a negative effect on the  frame rate       Shadow  Link the illumination situation selected with a shadow detection  method  It is helpful to activate the first shadow detection method for unevenly  structured or dark backgrounds  Use the second shadow detection method  for bright or finely structured backgrounds  This can be set with one of three  sensitivity levels  The more sensitive the detection  the more the image is  cleansed of shadows  However  the likelihood that the object will be clas   sified as a shadow increases     Show detection areas  Choose whether you would like to display the detection  areas in the camera image     Object Display    Bounding boxes  Specify the color for the bounding box surrounding the detected  objects     Track color  Specify the color for object tracking     Object halo  Specify the color for the movement outline of the moving objects     Counting lines    Counting line deadtime  Specify the period of time within which 
392. n enabled      Recordings are stored on the built in SD Flash card  e MxControlCenter computer       IP address  172 16 0 23      Alarm list enabled      Alarm messages port  31754        Preferred layout for this camera  West gate  Player     e MxControlCenter opens the preferred layout for this camera and plays back a  sound file     e User needs to acknowledge the alarm  or else the sound file will be repeated every  five seconds  and can access the EmergencyProcedures  txt instruction file  to get important phone numbers etc        The IP addresses  ports and layout names used here are only examples  Make sure  that you are using the proper IP addresses  ports and layout names of your installation        System Structure    MOBOTIX camera    172 16 0 100 MxControlCenter workstation  172 16 0 23            Switch          S  SM   yy    s SSsagq  ES  S172  16 0 23 31754  7       ee              MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    196 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       Events    4 5 1 Configuring Alarms on the Cameras    In this step  you will use the Camera Configuration dialog to configure a video motion alarm  on the camera  it detects movement when someone tries to enter a door  for example      Configuring the Video Motion Event  e Right click on the camera you would like to configure  either in a layout or in the  Navigator sidebar panel and the VIDEO SOURCES  gt  Cameras section      e Se
393. n in the title bar  and then adjust it by selecting Display area only     e   Ifthe Alarm List has been activated  it will automatically appear if MxControlCenter  receives an alarm message     e If you do not see the menu any more after executing one of the commands  listed above  press the ESC key to return to the default display mode                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    fejes         v    Defined by layout  Full screen  Maximize    Original size    All windows full screen    94 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       3 3 2 Using Saved Views    A view basically contains the current settings of the Save View As  nfo   commands accessible from MxControlCenter   s View         Name  Gate Guard v  menu  When saving a view  you can select what PR JE TEES EPL RR A A  to include by activating deactivating the following mede A seee e Eo  options  Include   V  Display Area Options    Sequencer states  scaling and grid  options     Display Area Options  Sequencer  scaling and   V  Application Window Areas    grid options   Title bar  ao bar  lege bar   Application Window Areas  Show options apt ea   menu  title bar  etc    sidebar and toolbar       options     Example for Using Views    In this example  two views are used on one MxControlCenter installation  a simple view  for live monitoring only and the view of the store detective     Live monitoring only  Reduced     bare bones     view wit
394. n of Global System for Mobile Communication  Second generation of wireless  telephone technology     H 264  A standard for video compression  also called AVC video or MPEG 4 Part 10   H 264 is com   monly used in   HDTV video broadcasting and SIP Video applications     HDTV  Abbreviation of High Definition TV  Describes a TV and video broadcasting standard with a    Resolution of 1980x1080 that commonly uses   H 264 as compression method to reduce  requirements     HiRes  Abbreviation of High Resolution  Refers to high resolution images  more than 1 megapixel      Hub  Legacy hardware used to connect multiple network devices  computers  cameras  printers   etc   within a network  As opposed to a   Swiftch  a hub splits the bandwidth among the con   nected devices  which may lead to drastic bandwidth limitations  Because of this drawback   hubs are rarely used nowadays     Image Compression  Reduces the file size of an image by reducing the amount of redundant image information   This is particularly important when transferring and saving files  since it lowers the required    Bandwidth     Image Post Processing  Digital image processing  The goal is to correct errors made during image generation  caused  by overexposure  underexposure  blurring  weak contrast  image noise  etc   in order to  create a    better    image     IP Network  Data   Network based on the Internet protocol  TCP IP      IP Phone  Hardware phone  which uses IP packets to establish phone connections via a
395. n the documentation  Furthermore  you should activate the  remote configuration of your router  at least temporarily      e Setting up port forwarding  Open the broadband router   s configuration page for  port forwarding in the web browser  Read the documentation of the router or search  the router s online help to find more information on the    port forwarding    topic     Assign every local IP address  192 168 178 201  192 168 178 202  you would  like to access from outside of the local network to one port         192 168 178 201  gt  8001      192 168 178 202  gt  8002    Testing The DynDNS Configuration  Once you have completed the previous steps  you should run the following tests     e Test DynDNS  Open your web browser and enter the DynDNS name you registered   example  http    mycamera dyndns  org   If everything has been configured  properly and the remote configuration has been activated  you should see the user  interface of the router     e Test the cameras  Open your web browser and enter the DynDNS name and the  port of the first camera  example  http    mycamera   dyndns   org   8001   You  should now see the user interface of the camera and the browser should prompt  you for access data  user name and password   Test all other cameras that are to  accessed remotely using the appropriate ports  see above         Deactivate the remote configuration of your router if you had activated this feature  before           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made 
396. nal telephone  standard based on ISDN  and analog telephony    28 392    MxCC User Manual  More Security In Case of An Alarm       Only after all  alarms from the list  are clicked does  the status display  switch from red to  green  at the top     For each alarm  the  display shows how  long ago it was    Acknowledging Alarms    The responsible person must act appropriately after an alarm is triggered  MxCC provides  an Acknowledgment Feature that can be used to ensure that all alarms are noticed  and checked  Once all alarms have been acknowledged  the status field of the alarm  list changes from red to green        Example     if  for example  a camera detects the movements of an intruder in the area it records   video motion detection  in the sales room of a retail branch location at night  the camera  immediately triggers an acoustical alarm automatically via signal outputs and a  network connection  contacts the security service via e mail with an alarm image  attachment  and sends an alarm SMS  via a provider  to the mobile telephone of  the security guard in charge     The building plan of the sales room of the branch in question opens automatically in  the central security control center of the headquarters  in which the live image from  the camera reporting the alarm is in turn displayed  The security staff at the MxCC  control center immediately have a view of the cameras in the immediate surroundings  and can directly access their live images and recordings     In
397. nd alarm mes    is used as an alarm target  sages to the MxCC computer    in Camera Configuration  gt   Network Messages     Make sure that the port of  the alarm target in Camera  Configuration  gt  Network  Messages is the same as                                              The port of the alarm target to  which the camera is sending  the messages and the port on  the MxCC computer used to      the port in Tools  gt  Options  gt   deel cid aaa Alarm Handling  gt  Alarm  i Messages in MxControlCenter                                                                                                        B 2 Using The MxControlCenter Error Log    If directed by MOBOTIX Support personnel to activate MxControlCenter   s debug error log   perform the following steps     e Make sure that MxControlCenter is not running on the system   e Depending on the Windows version in use  open the following folder         Windows XP   SUSERPROFILE S Local Settings Application Data   MOBOTIX MxControlCenter  and create an empty file named  MxControlCenter log       Windows Vista    LOCALAPPDATA  Mobotix MxControlCenter  and create an empty  file named MxControlCenter log       Windows 7    LOCALAPPDATA  Mobotix MxControlCenter  and create an empty  file named MxControlCenter log    e Start MxControlCenter and attempt to perform the steps needed to reproduce the  error s      e Let MxControlCenter run until the error or performance problem occurs  then quit  MxControlCenter        MOBOTIX AG    
398. nd in  gigabits per second  short Gbit s  also Gbps  for superfast connections    Gigabit Ethernef     Bonjour   French for    hello     is a technology developed by Apple based on the   Zeroconf protocol   Bonjour is a method for network devices to automatically advertise and detect services on  IP networks  For example  you can find a printer or a network camera on the local network  without knowing the exact IP address of the device you are looking for     CamlO  MOBOTIX signal module that the camera uses to directly operate lamps  sirens and access  controls  as well as external audio components  speakers and microphones         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    369 392       CCTV  Abbreviation of Closed Circuit Television  A television system in which the analog video signal  is transmitted to monitor within one particular environment only  for example  a building   The  term CCTV is often used for video surveillance systems     CF Card  Abbreviation of Compact Flash Card  An ultra compact  digital  random access  memory  medium based on flash memory modules and well known as an image storage medium  for digital cameras     CIF  2CIF  4CIF  in accordance with PAL TV standard   Abbreviation of Common Intermediate Format  Corresponds to 1 4 TV image with 288 rows    and 352 columns  0 1 megapixels   2CIF  1 2 TV image  has the same number of rows  288      but 704 columns  0 2 megapixels   4CIF corresponds t
399. nder VIDEO SOURCES  gt  Storage Devices        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    252 392    MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       a     Quick Setup    xt       cp    Expert Setup      52 gt     Browser    5 2 2 Configuring And Editing Snap Server Settings    To modify the settings of a Snap Server  open the Navigator sidebar panel and the Video  Source  gt  Storage Devices section  Then do the following     1  Right click on a Snap Server and select Configure from the context menu  This opens    the Configure Snap Server dialog     2  Seta Snap Server Mode by selecting one of these configuration methods         Quick Setup  This is the fastest  method for configuring a Snap  Server so that MOBOTIX cameras  can use it as a storage location   You only need to enter two pass   words  MxControlCenter will con   figure the remaining settings  automatically  Open the tabs of  the Expert Setup to see the settings  preset by MxControlCenter  see  below      Expert Setup  This section con   tains different tabs for setting the  most important parameters of a  Snap Server  General  Users   Shares  UPS and Time   In con   trast to Quick Setup  you can use  this section for adjusting the Snap  Server more precisely to the cur   rent application scenario  If you  need to customize the setup even  further  you should use the Snap                         E Configure Snap Server ax    a       z      Sp d  Quick Seto Expert
400. nding Cameras    The first step to generate a camera list is to find all cameras on the physical network   When starting Update Assistant with an empty camera list  the application automatically  starts searching for cameras  To start the search manually  click on the Search Cameras  button     Adding Cameras To A Camera List    To add cameras that are not part of the current physical network  e g  remote cameras  via DynDNS  click on the Add Cameras button  Then enter the IP Address  IP Range  URL   User Password and Proxy information as required     Creating A New Camera List    You may want to place the cameras of your security system into different groups according  to their function or location  Using this approach  you can make sure that all cameras for  e g  the gate guards use the same settings     To create a new camera list file  do the following     1  Click on File  gt  New Camera List to create an empty camera list in Update Assistant   2  Click on Add Cameras to open the Add Cameras dialog     3  In the Add Cameras dialog  add the IP Address  IP Range  URL  User Password  and Proxy information as required     4  Click on Add to create an entry in the camera list   5  Repeat steps 2 to 4 until the list contains the cameras you would like to keep in this list     6  Select File  gt  Save Camera List or Save Camera List As to save the camera list        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Using Snap Se
401. needs to be in MxPEG format  event or continu   ous recording      e The software version of the MOBOTIX camera that recorded the video needs  to be MX v4 0 4 18 or higher     Post video motion searches only make sense on cameras that are recording con   tinuously   f you need this feature and the camera in question does not record  continuously  make sure that your system administrator changes the recording of  this camera accordingly                          MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings   2 5   3 92    Creating A Post Video Motion Search       A Post VM search is a special type of event search on one camera  Creating a Post VM  search is thus similar to creating a    regular    event search  see   Creating New Event Searches    in Section 3 5 8    Using Event Searches    except that it uses a different search mode     e Create a new search       Open the Navigator sidebar panel if it is not visible       Right click anywhere in the EVENT SEARCHES section       Select New search from the context menu         Enter a name that describes the search  you may want to add    Post VM    or  something similar at the end of the search      e Click on the Search mode button in the properties bar     e Select the Offline search for motion  Post VM  option  The properties bar now looks    like this   Sources From 3  Daysago v  6 00AM   Go to Sort By   Date Time v   Reload  Auto
402. network  see also Section 2 4 1     Finding And Configuring Video Sources      Manually reboots the selected cameras  for  uw Reboot testing purposes      Manually uploads software packages down   en   Upload Software    oaded bears   a Save sengs Saves the camera configurations from one or  _ g more selected cameras           Uploads one or more camera configuration   amp    Upload Settings    files to one or more cameras  either in parts  or as a whole        Opens the camera s browser based user  interface     1 Available only when camera is selected    Drop down button    5 1 3 Getting Started With Update Assistant       IN    SY Open browser              Update Assistant automatically copies the list of cameras from MxControlCenter  retrieves  the list of software packages available for downloading and tries to connect to the cameras   In addition  the Update Assistant also shows a preview image of all connected cameras     The    Camera List    Panel    This panel shows alist of available cameras  _ Name Address Version Alt   preview images and additional information                  DO east gate ae MX V3 5 2 23 r3    When launched from MxControlCenter MX V4 0 6 9     select Tools  gt  Update Assistant from ae ti  the menu   this list automatically con  aushcs an tae oe  tains all cameras that are available in this sin a  MxControlCenter installation      north gate mg  gt  MX V3 5 2 23 r3       Note that you can also add cameras either manually or by searching them on 
403. nimized  the alarm list is always updated by the cameras  that send network messages to the MxControlCenter computer  Alarm images  in the live streams of cameras in the current layout that do not send network  messages are only added to the alarm list if the When minimized option has  been set to Continue decoding              e Sequential Mode  If this option is activated  the live cameras of one layout are shown  one after the other for the specified interval  Since MxControlCenter suspends the  video stream of the cameras that are not shown  this mode saves a considerable  amount of bandwidth     Since MxControlCenter suspends the video stream of the cameras that are not  shown  alarm information that is send via video stream is not displayed  Alarms  that are received as alarm messages  network messages  are not affected              e Disconnect streams during Video Search  Allows disconnecting the live video streams  from the cameras when executing a search in the Video Search dialog  This is help   ful when using a low bandwidth connection  since this leaves more bandwidth to  the search and playback features  Once the Video Search dialog has been closed   MxControlCenter resumes showing the live video streams     Local Archive O    e User folder  Shows the default storage location of the local archive  LOCAL ARCHIVE  section in the Navigator sidebar panel      e Custom folder  Use this option to store the local archive in a different location        MOBOTIX AG    Sec
404. ns to play back continuous recordings  in accelerated fashion                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com                0  5x speed  2x speed  4x speed  8x speed  Max speed    110 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       be     gt      06 09 11 11 27 09      Using The Slider For Navigating Recordings    In addition to the playback buttons  the Player sidebar contains a slider control for quickly  navigating the recordings  Drag the red position indicator to the right and left to set the  date time you are looking for  Let go of the position indicator to show the recording that  is closest to the selected date time     Current date time    First recorded image Last recorded image    ale 11 FEA ale 11  03 41 23 06 03 11 11 27 03 11 27 09    a       Position indicator    The date time fields at the top show the date and time of the first recorded image  the  current image and the last recorded image  respectively     The clip start end markers are only visible if you have activated the Marker Mode button   They are used to select time ranges for exporting later on  Section 3 6 3    Exporting Recorded  Video Footage        Using The Date Time Control For Searching    Another method for findingevents   11 s 1   00 00 00   lt  1Go to oo  is to search for recordings that T5 November  2010  gt   occurred near a specific date or sun Mon Tue Wed Thu Fri    time  Available    recordings  Enter a search date
405. ntainer  AMEA z   lution  frame rate and performance             t  settings when encoding the video     Prefer    Quality Performance       When selecting the export profile Time  lapse  the two control boxes Fixed frame rate and Time lapse are automatically aktive   To better recognize objects  it is recommended to set a low frame rate  Activating the  Only use event images checkbox will speed up the export  However  the images in  the time lapse export may not correspond exactly to the previously set interval  but  may be slightly off  With the minimum interval between frames  you set the interval  in which the images are selected for export     Audio  Controls if the finished video contains an audio track of the camera  provided  audio recording had been activated for the camera at the time of recording      File Size Limitation  If MxControlCenter reaches the limit set on this tab  it will cre   ate additional  numbered  files until the end of the video data in the export list has  been reached     When exporting large amounts of recorded video data  make sure that the  individual clips of the exported video data are not larger than the amount of  RAM that is available on the target computer  If in doubt  use the default set   ting  128 MB  to create smaller clips              Subtitle  Provides options for generating overlays with additional information  such  as timestamp  camera name  custom text and information about gaps in the record   ing  In addition  you can gen
406. nter Reactions       3 5 1 Example Scenarios    One of the key features of a MOBOTIX video surveillance system is its high degree of flex   ibility  To illustrate some of the aspects of working with such a system  we will be using  the scenarios described in this section     Live Monitoring With Simultaneous Recording    In this scenario  MxControlCenter is used in a soccer stadium  The background layout  shown below uses the plan of the stadium and its surroundings to show the location of  four cameras  using icons  and four live display windows  cameras positioned near the  entrances   On other layouts  numerous live cameras are monitoring the spectators while  the match is going on     Before  during and after a match  the MOBOTIX cameras are providing live video streams  and are also recording continuously        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings   05  3 9 2       Live display windows    Camera status icons    Live display windows       Two operators of the surveillance system are monitoring the entrances as people enter  and leave the stadium  The first operator is only monitoring the live cameras while the  second one is monitoring the live cameras and can switch to the recordings of specific  cameras or of all cameras at once     In case of a critical situation  the second operator stores the images or live recordings to  MxControlCenter   s Local Archive  The secon
407. nterception by unauthorized persons     To encrypt the transferred data and at the same time verify its authenticity  the camera  uses digital certificate  private public key pair  that is either self signed by the camera   generated using data you have entered or which has been issued by a certificate authority   CA in short   MxControlCenter uses the public key of the same certificate to decrypt the  data sent from the camera  To establish an encrypted connection  both parties use the  SSL protocol  see secure sockets layer on en wikipedia org      MOBOTIX camera MxControlCenter     amp  Network connection  e using SSL  HTTPS     M m  gt     Private      Public       How MxControlCenter Uses Ssl    e MxControlCenter connects to a camera  requesting a secure connection   e The camera sends back the public key of its digital certificate     e MxControlCenter encrypts a random number using the camera s public key and  sends it to the camera     e The camera uses its private key to decrypt the random number        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 2 4   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       e Using the random number  both parties generate sessions keys to encrypt and  decrypt all communication for the duration of the connection     Setting Up Encrypted Connections    If you want to implement a secure infrastructure  you need to configure all cameras you  would like to use via SSL and set up MxContr
408. nterval in this field has elapsed  MxControlCenter auto   matically restores the application window on top of all other application windows   This is a convenient option to use when other applications are running alongside  MxControlCenter and may be covering the MxControlCenter window  Leave the field  empty to deactivate this option     Always on top  Always shows the MxControlCenter window on top of all other  applications  This option can be used to ensure that MxControlCenter is not covered  by other application windows     Demo mode  Activates the demo mode  in which MxControlCenter automatically  executes typical actions for all cameras in the current layout     Synchronize clips on start  When showing exported MxPEG clips in display windows  of a layout  MxControlCenter sets a common time base for these clips before start   ing the playback        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 Q 6   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference       6 1 4 The    Alarm Handling    Tab    This tab contains the following group boxes        Options    General   Connection Defaults   View   Alam Handling   Remote Control   Monitoring   Action Log    Alam List  Activate    Alam Messages  Activate alarm message server  listening for TCP IP messages     24    Alam Sound          No configuration loaded    Alarm List  amp      Activate  Activates the alarm list  see Section 3 4 1    Visual Alarm Features   and  Section 4 5    Configu
409. o  the right and left until you find the event you are looking for     e Highlight the scene you want to export       Activate the Marker Mode button       Click on the Play button to show the video       Click again on the Play button if you reach the end of the scene you want to export      Note that you can also highlight scenes by dragging the red position indicator of  the slider      e Click on the Add to Export button to add the highlighted  green  part of the event to  the Export List     e To add other sections from this and other events  simply highlight a different scene  in the Player panel and repeat the steps above     Once you have added the desired parts to the Export List  you can export the entire list  as a video clip in different formats  For more information on how to do this  Section 3 6 3     Exporting Recorded Video Footage       Storing Entire Events In The Local Archive    Storing an event in the local archive is a good method of sav   s LOCAL ARCHIVE  ing it permanently  This also protects the event from getting Live Recordings  overwritten by the camera s   Ring Bufferstorage mechanism        To export entire events to the local archive   e Open the Navigator sidebar panel if it is not visible     e Open a predefined event search in the EVENT SEARCHES section or create an ad   hoc search        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       124 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter   
410. o MxServer  Proceed as described in  Step 4  Set The  Storage Location Of The Analog PTZ Camera In MxControlCenter   of Section 5 4 3     Integrating Analog Third Party PTZ Cameras       IP cameras  Proceed as described in  Step 3  Set The Storage Location Of The IP PTZ  Dome In MxControlCenter   of Section 5 4 2    Integrating Third Party IP PTZ Dome  Cameras       5 5 6 Automatically Starting MxServer On The Computer    For using MxServer productively  it is recommended to add the MxServer    exe file as  a scheduled task in Windows  This makes sure that MxServer starts automatically when  booting the computer     On a Windows Vista computer  click on Start  gt  Control Panel     Click on System and Maintenance and in the Administrative Tools section on  Schedule tasks     In the Actions panel  click on Create Basic Task     On the Create a Basic Task page  enter a name in the Name field  e g  MxServer   and click on Next     On the Trigger page  select the When the computer starts option and click on Next     On the Action page  select the Start a Program option and click on Next        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    276   3 92 MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       e On the Start a Program page  click on the Browse button     e Navigatetothe MxServerprogramfolder c    Program Files MOBOTIX MxServer   by default   select the MxServer    exe file and click on OK     e Click on Next   e Click on Finish t
411. o be played back over the com     puter speakers when receiving a remote control command        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       3 00   3 92 MxCC User Manual  Reference       Network Message Log 2     This box logs all remote control commands received from other MxControlCenter computers  or third party applications as well as the alarm messages received from MOBOTIX cameras     Syntax of Network Messages Sent to MxControlCenter    Syntax  http    lt ip_address gt   lt port gt    lt parameter 1 gt   lt value  1 gt  amp  lt parameter 2 gt   lt value 2 gt     amp  lt parameter n gt   lt value n gt     Examples     http   192 168 1 182 8001  fullscreen 0  minimizes MxControlCenter  to the taskbar     http    192 168 1 182 8001  fullscreen 1  restores the MxControlCenter  application window and displays it on top of other applications in full screen mode        Getting a List of Remote Control Commands    Enter the following link in the address bar of a browser to get a list of the supported  parameters and values from the specified computer running MxControlCenter     Syntax  http     lt ip_address gt   lt port gt      Example  http    192 168 1 182 8001   orhttp   127 0 0 1 8001   ifMxControlCenter is running on the current computer        List of Remote Control Commands    Command Values Remarks    Prompts MxControlCenter to show the  images of the cameras with the speci     i  lt IP address list of IP fied 
412. o close the wizard     Scroll down in the Task Scheduler Summary to see the MxServertask in the Active Tasks list        If you are using a different version of Windows than Vista  please proceed as outlined  in the Windows help  search for    Scheduled Task               MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Using MxRemotePreview To Access Remote Recordings    277 392       5 6 Using MxRemotePreview To Access Remote Recordings    MxRemotePreview has been developed to overcome one problem when using low   bandwidth connections  e g  when accessing recordings in a remote location with a  slow DSL or UTMS 3G connection   In such a case  MxControlCenter retrieves the original   stored  video sequences  but since they are too large for the bandwidth  the images are  transferred too slowly  making video searches nearly impossible     MxRemotePreview helps to overcome this problem by reducing     recoding     the image size   quality and other parameters on the fly without changing the stored recordings  Instead of  getting the images via the camera or directly from the file server  MxControlCenter gets the     recoded    video sequences from the MxRemotePreview server to accelerate image retrieval     How MxRemotePreview Works           MOBOTIX camera Internet         Bupiozay         S          oe    MxRemotePreview yA  server   lt S  ceq     DSL router    MxControlCenter sends an HTTP request to the web server  which 
413. o deactivate this option        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Options    Dialog    293 392       Access Recordings 2     e File server path  MxControlCenter can access stored video sequences either via  the camera  default setting  or directly from the file server on which the camera  has stored the data  MxControlCenter uses this path to access the recordings of all  MOBOTIX cameras if the corresponding Access Data tab of the Properties of dialog  has been set to use the Default file server path  Besides folders on local or mapped  network drives  you can also use a UNC path  e g    10 1 1 111 mxdata or    mxstoragel  mxdata      e User name  User name for accessing the default file server path     e Password  Password for accessing the default file server path     Retrieving stored video data from a file server is much faster than retrieving video  data via the MOBOTIX camera  This approach does not put any strain on the camera   since it is not involved in providing any files           Default Preview Settings       When searching recorded video  MxControlCenter can obtain preview datainstead of the   original recorded video to reduce the required bandwidth  You can use this section to set   specific preview parameters for all cameras  see Section 5 6    Using MxRemotePreview To   Access Remote Recordings    for more information on setting up an MxRemotePreview server    e Preview mode         Cam
414. o motion analysis  Open  the camera you would like to configure by right clicking  either in a layout or in the VIDEO  SOURCES section in the Navigator sidebar panel  and select the Configure entry from  the shortcut menu           BE Camere Configuration  Opening the MxAnalytics tab automatically     Sj   aos 2 O  amp   opens the Basic Configuration sub tab    Sot esme sess te Ae Ses neetnesors Teese Mains    hare Seen Contour eton Veual Configuraton    There it is possible to permanently activate oao General  MxAnalytics or activate it temporarily via a    camera time table  To do this  a suitable time  table must be defined in the camera and  then selected for MxAnalytics activation  see  Section 4 6 2    Controlling Motion Detection   Time Tables      Optional        The settings regarding basic configuration and  permanent storage of detected movement  data for future evaluation are also set in the  same sub tab  Define the detection areas   counting lines and object sizes in the Visual  Configuration sub tab of the MxAnalytics tab  However  before setting up storage for  future evaluation  test the settings for basic configuration and visual configuration and   where necessary  adjust them until you obtain the desired results  This way  you can avoid  storing any corrupt data that may result during this stage           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    210 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration    
415. o select it  Next  drag the window  to any position within the image area     e To delete a window  Click on the small    x    in the top right hand corner of the frame   Highlighted frames can also be deleted by pressing the DEL key        You can select any one of the predefined exposure windows  then click on it and  move it to a different position to create a custom exposure window        e Show windows  These options allow you to define if and when the exposure and  exclusion window frames are shown in the camera   s image         Off  Does not show any exposure window frames in the camera images         Show Frame  Permanently shows the exposure window frames in the camera  images  and not only on this tab          Frame and Histogram  Permanently shows the exposure window frames and a  histogram of the measured exposure values in the camera images        Ifthe options of this section are not available  Exposure Mode has been set to Virtual  PTZ  In this mode  the camera cannot use any exposure windows           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Camera Configuration    Dialog    317 392       Weights O    The settings in this group box are used in special situations for fine tuning and adjust   ing images to attain the desired result  These settings should only be altered if all other  measures have not produced the desired results     e Exposure  Controls to which degree the camera uses exposure w
416. o streams  but keeps the layout and the connections to the  cameras  Upon restoring the application window  MxControlCenter quickly resumes  video streaming  This option corresponds to deactivating the Activate camera con   nections button in the toolbar     Stop all  Disconnects all video streams and unloads the current layout  Upon restoring  the application window  MxControlCenter again establishes the connections to the  cameras and resumes video streaming  This option requires a bit more time than  Pause before video streaming resumes     Continue decoding  Only minimizes the application window  but continues to decode  the video streams  i e   MxControlCenter can detect alarms in the current layout         When using the Pause and Stop alloptions  MxControlCenter cannot detect alarms  in the live video streams  If this a requirement  make sure that you do the following     e SetWhen minimized to Continue decoding     e Configure the cameras so they send network messages to the MxControlCenter  computer  see Section 4 5 3    Configuring MxControlCenter Reactions                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    194 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       4 5 Configuring Alarms And Recordings    When configuring this part of the MxControlCenter installation  you are setting up the  autonomous system functions of the cameras and MxControlCenter and how the users  will interact with the system    
417. o the image quality of a traditional TV  image with 576 rows and 704 columns  0 4 megapixels      CMOS  Abbreviation of Complementary Metal Oxide Semiconductor  MOBOTIX cameras rely on this  type of image sensor for energy efficient digitalization of image information     DevKit  Camera development kitwith independent image sensors based on MOBOTIX M12D or M24M  cameras  intended for concealed installation in other devices     DHCP  Abbreviation of Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol  Allows a server to automatically assign  devices in the network with the appropriate configuration  including the IP address  DNS server  and gateway   as opposed s fixed IP addresses on the individual network devices     DNS  Abbreviation of Domain Name Service  Allows the domain names of servers on the Internet     e g  www mobotix   com  to be linked     resolved     to their corresponding IP addresses  e g        Dome Camera  Most often refers to cameras with a round and compact design  The lens can be freely  positioned and is protected by a transparent dome shaped plastic housing     DSL  Abbreviation of Digital Subscriber Line  Denotes a fast Internet connection capable of providing  bandwidth of up to 16 Mbps for a typical household     DualDome  Dome camera with two lenses and image sensors such as the MOBOTIX D12D  These lenses  can deliver wide angle and telephoto images independently of one another     DVR  Abbreviation of Digital Video Recorder  Commonly describes a dedicated comput
418. ogy and its several cameras    decentralized concept has made high resolution video systems cost efficient  rae    Licence free    MOBOTIX AG    D 67722 Langmeil    Tel   49 6302 9816 103    Fax   49 6302 9816 190    sales mobotix com  video Management   Software        e   v  x      Q   e   E  3  3  3          File View Layout VideoSource Recording Tools Help    GA  Be HA aa  SRA  AAIE    t    Browser vser en    a   A T     d LAYOUTS  a j CHINA  a   SINGAPORE   H Warehouse   South Docks  a    EROE  4  GERMANY  bea  Cresden  fei  Frankfurt  faa  Hamburg  a    Kaiserslautern  EJ Store   Konigstrasse 5  Store   Reichssrasse 10    Bal Synch sor r    16 09 10 14S 6          Floor Plan                               Pee eee eee eee eee  ent y    Peete eee e  amp     Ee    tee 8     Reena  ie actpe ef ee we ol       Hemispheric Installation    C Wall mounted    W Ceiling mounted   Set North      Pee eee ee ee 8  ee HHE M     1 34    Eten Rae eee E  ttt itenh  e ae  amp        kx Xi    kat Rll     o       a  Fij  ttt  amp  8h N O  O  Bi    a    LAC Event         MxControlCenter                    Contents  1 Introduction 13  MOBOTIX Video System Solution 13  The Decentralized MOBOTIX Concept 14  For A Wide Variety Of Applications 16  All Functions At A Glance 18  Practical Camera Layouts 20  Cost Efficient Monitor Wall Solution 24  More Security In Case of An Alarm 26  Fast Availability Of Video Evidence 30  Get the Most Of What Is There 34  Secure Handling Of Sensitive Data 36  Simp
419. ol   lowing display modes  see figure below               Regular    cameras  lenses  gt   32 mm        F AA         m  Zoom  or    select    Image Area     Full Image Image Area    e Full Image  Delivers the full image as generated by the image sensor  This is the  default display mode     e Image Area  Once you start zooming in  the camera shows the image area  which  is only a section of the full image        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Live Video Surveillance       Display Modes of Cameras with L22 Lens    Cameras with L22 lens  such as the Q24M  M24M  D24M and T24M basically offer the  following display modes     e Full Image  Delivers the full image as generated by the image sensor  This is the  default display mode     e Image Area  Delivers a zoomed section of the full image  i e   anytime you zoom  into the image      e Area Corrected  Delivers a section of the image  where the slightly distorted lines  have been corrected  the same as for Hemispheric cameras  see next section      The Area Corrected display mode is only available if this lens has been explicitly  selected in the camera   s Admin Menu  If you need this image mode  please ask  your system administrator for assistance              Display Modes Of    Hemispheric    Cameras With L11 Lens    The area in which you can execute the virtual PTZ actions is rather limited for    regular     lenses  i e   lenses with focal lengths of 32 mm 
420. olCenter accordingly  The entire process  involves the following steps    1  Open the camera s browser interface    2  Configure the camera to use a certificate   3  Activate HTTPS in the camera and set a port   4     Instruct MxControlCenter to use SSL for connecting the camera s      Step 1  Open the Camera s Browser Interface    Q e Click on the Open camera in browser button in MxControlCenter     e Click on the Admin Menu button in the camera s browser interface and enter the  user name and password     e Inthe Administration Overview dialog  click on the Web Server link  Network Setup  section      Step 2  Configure the Camera to Use a Certificate    Do the following depending on which type of certificate you would like to use     e Camera s self signed certificate  When using this certificate  you do not need to  change any settings in this step  Proceed directly to   Step 3  Activate HTTPS in the  Camera and Set a Port          Generated certificate  using data you have entered          In the Web Server dialog  activate the Generate option  Replace the X 509  certificate and private key currently used by the camera section          Fill in the fields in the Generate self signed X 509 certificate and X 509 cer   tificate request section         Click on the Set button at the bottom of the dialog to generate the certificate  this  may take a moment to complete          Click on the Close button at the bottom of the dialog and permanently store the  entire camera configu
421. ome or all of your components and to power them up  in this order    e Uninterruptible Power Supplies  UPS    e File servers NAS   e Switches   e Cameras    e MxControlCenter workstation       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring The Storage Systems    3 3  392       A 2 4 Installing MxControlCenter On One Workstation    The next step is to install MxControlCenter on one workstation in the lab  This workstation  can be either your own or one of the computers of the VSS  The workstation is needed to  configure the entire system and to create an MxControlCenter master configuration later on     For more information on installing MxControlCenter  see Section 2 3 2    Automatic Installation  of MxControlCenter    When starting MxControlCenter  the application automatically searches  for MOBOTIX devices on the network  Add Video Sources dialog   Click on Cancel to close  this dialog and close MxControlCenter without saving the configuration  You will later find  and configure the cameras     A 3 Configuring The Storage Systems    If the surveillance system is using one or more external file servers or NAS systems  you  should configure them now  Since the cameras are using these settings  you can test them  when setting the corresponding options on the cameras     Due to the many different scenarios that are largely customer dependent  listing all pos   sible configuration options would be beyond the scope o
422. on   Switches to a different layout of this  MxControlCenter installation    B Executes an http command  e g  to remote   control a video wall     DW   Display window  IC   Icon  BT   Button  BG   Background layout   X   Multiple elements per layout  1   One element per layout  O   Not available       Layout       W  Ww  W  This element is not tied to a specific camera  and only displays the live video stream of the  Focus last camera or status icon you clicked on   W   When used on a computer system with two  7  7  button T  7    Display Windows On Background Layouts    In contrast to the display windows in grid layouts  display    in the title bar are yellow  you can execute additional com   mands for this video source  such as opening an instruction          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Live Video Surveillance    73 392       file  the preferred layout  a reference image  etc  See Section 3 4 3    Reacting To Alarms     for more information on the available functions     The    Show As Grid Layout  Auto Grid     Button    When you click on this button  MxControlCenter shows all video sources in the current  layout in an automatically generated grid layout  This is especially helpful if you are using  a background layout with camera icons and you would like to get a quick overview of all  live streams     The    Start Layout       This is the layout loaded automatically after launching MxControlCenter  If
423. on this topic  see Section 3 2 6    Using The Audio Features OfA Camera       6 2 4 The    PTZ Rotor    Tab    This tab contains the following parameters     AccessData   Information   Display  PTZ Rotor       Type   No pan tilt head  Sensitivity    Normal  Fast Patch   Joystick control  Invert horizontal direction                Invert vertical direction       e Type  The following pan tilt heads are supported in MxControlCenter  For third party products     Videotronic SN 15AH Be ior ictal    Provitek tion and configuration        VPT 42 VPT501      Provitek PT 2 3 4    Pelco D        MxProtocol  This protocol is used for controlling analog pan tilt cameras that are  connected to a computer running MxServer     When selecting Pelco Din the Type dropdown  MxControlCenter shows two additional  options at the bottom of the dialog     e Mechanical zoom  Sends the zoom commands to the PTZ dome instead of  the camera     e PTZ head address  Only change this setting if it is requested in the PTZ head s  installation instructions                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 O 8   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference       e Sensitivity  Use the values of this dropdown to change the behavior and the speed  of a pan tilt head in relation to the movement with a mouse or a joystick  This option  is only available for specific pan tilt heads     The joystick model and the skills of each individual user have an influen
424. ontains the controls to select cameras  filter the events  set the  time range to search in  etc  The   Creating An Ad Hoc Event Search   section below  explains how to use the elements of the properties bar     Predefined event searches  These searches have been stored in the MxControlCenter  installation  Simply click on any search in the EVENT SEARCHES section of the Navigator  sidebar panel to open the search  There are two types of searches         Event searches  This is the default search type that finds the events recorded by  the selected cameras in the specified time range         Post Video Motion searches  This search type finds all events in which  MxControlCenter detects movements in a custom    search window    of one camera   more on this in Section 3 5 9    Using Post Video Motion Detection In Recordings        Search results  This panel shows the events found by MxControlCenter using the  search criteria defined in the properties bar  Move your mouse over any event to get a  tooltip help with information on the event  camera name  date time and event type      Selected event  Click on any eventin the search results panel to select it  MxControlCenter  highlights the event with a dotted frame      Player panel  This panel shows the recorded video stream of the event and allows  setting export ranges        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       Property bar    Predefined  event searches    Selec
425. ontrolCenter       MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    A    MxCC User Manual  Cost Efficient Monitor Wall Solution             Plan Monitor Walls Efficiently And Economically    Monitor walls can be found in many professional control centers  They are generally made  up of a large number of screens in which the live images from one or more cameras are  displayed simultaneously on each monitor  The display and distribution of the cameras  to the individual monitors is controlled by a central computer  However  depending on  the size of the monitor wall and the number of integrated cameras  this usually requires  very high computing power which can no longer be provided by standard hardware     With MxCC and the client patent pending concept invented by MOBOTIX  MOBOTIX  offers a monitor wall control which can be controlled remotely from a single worksta   tion economically and efficiently     For this purpose  a standard PC with MxCC used as a main computer is connected to  the cameras and any number of economical mini PCs with an MxCC installed as clients  via the video network  In turn  each client is connected to a monitor on which the images  of one or a small number of cameras are displayed     The highest computing power to fetch and display camera images via network is thus  transferred from the central main computer to each decentralized client  However  the  image displayed by each client on the monitor 
426. ontrolCenter computer should  never be used to surf the Internet     4 8 2 Restricting Public Access To The Cameras    You can improve the security of the entire system by disabling public access on all cameras  and setting up a dedicated user for MxControlCenter on each camera        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Security Considerations    221 392       Camera Settings  In The Browser     Open the user interface of each camera in the browser and do the following     Change the default password for the admin user in Admin Menu  gt  Users and  Passwords     Make sure the cameras    web interface cannot be accessed by unauthorized users by  blocking the public access in Admin Menu  gt  Users and Passwords  Security section      Create a new group  for example  MxCC  and activate the MxControlCenter privilege  in Admin Menu  gt  Group Access Control Lists     Create a new user  for example  mxcc  for the MxCC group in Admin Menu  gt  Users  and Passwords  This user and the appropriate password will now be required to  access the cameras from MxControlCenter  see   Settings In MxControlCenter   below      Click on Set to apply the current settings     Click on Close and permanently store the entire configuration        When using many cameras  executing the tasks above for each camera can be very  time consuming  In this case  configure one camera in the browser as described  above  Then use the Update Assistant
427. or QXGA  Text Display On   Comment      ID   HOSTNAME           Date and Time       Date  amp  Time     Hemispheric has additional options    help     For help on the individual image and event control settings  please consult the camera       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Finishing The Lab Configuration Of The Cameras    353 392       A 7 Finishing The Lab Configuration Of The Cameras    Configuring A Time Server Camera    In case the cameras do not have an Internet connection or there is no internal time server   you need to configure one or more cameras as time server for the other cameras  Click  on Admin Menu  gt  General Administration  gt  Time and Date in the time server camera s  browser interface and activate the time server as outlined in the help     A 8 Configuring MxControlCenter    After having completed as much as possible of the lab configuration of the cameras   you can now start to configure MxControlCenter on one workstation  Later on  this pre   configured installation is applied to the remaining workstations of the VSS     If you cannot access all cameras of the system in the lab  e g  because the system is  too large   you may have to postpone this step until you are on site and all compo   nents of the system are running  see Section A 10    Mounting And Initial Operation                 A 8 1 Configuring The Global Settings    e Start MxControlCenter and click on Cancel to close the 
428. orage limits   max  MB  for camera        File server NAS down     Check restore file server NAS        MxCC cannot find file server  path of specified camera     MxCC cannot find file server  path     Check if you can access  file server path in Windows  Explorer        MxCC cannot read from file  server path     Check if MxCC has read  access to file server path        Camera does not store on file  server NAS     Check camera system mes   sages and Storage on  External File Server dialog        Camera only stores single JPEG  images although set to Event   Continuous recording        Intended behavior   camera  stores segmented MxPEG  stream in  jpg files of max  10 s  length        Only use MxCC to read file  server contents           B 1 3 Camera Issues       Camera only shows gray image     Possible Cause    Lens missing lens protection  foil still on lens    Solution    Mount lens remove protec   tion foil        Images of M24 D14 D24 Q24  cameras are out of focus     Lens not properly focused     Correct focus of lens        Images in darkness are out  of focus high image noise  although this is a Day Night  camera     Minimum lighting required     Install  IR  lamps for additional  lighting        Dual camera does not detect  video motion in darkness     Video motion only activated  on Day sensor of Day Night  camera     Activate video motion on Night  sensor        Camera does not detect video  motion in darkness     Low Light Suppression for  video motion detection
429. ork    97 392           Speaker  The camera plays back a specific sound on its integrated  or an exter   nal  speaker or plays the sound from the computer microphone on its speaker         SIP video calls with bidirectional audio  The camera calls a SIP video phone and  establishes two way communication between itself and the MxControlCenter  computer  intercom mode          Other actions  Using its signal outputs or attached MOBOTIX modules  the camera  can switch on lights  open or close doors  etc     e Once a notification reaches the assigned persons  we consider this the actual alarm   e The usercan react by acknowledging or by escalating the alarm     e The user can also rely on the instructions and additional information  like a standard  operating procedure  provided for the corresponding camera     You can use MxControlCenter to program the system so that the cameras fulfill these  tasks and create a fully integrated security system  Thanks to today   s virtually limitless  possibilities of wireless computing  this system works almost anywhere on the globe         New York       Alarm center    Tokyo    3 4 1 Visual Alarm Features    When a MOBOTIX camera triggers an alarm  MxControlCenter uses several visual methods  for alerting the operator of the security system  This section describes the options that  are available     Highlighting Of Live Display Windows    The red frame around a live display window in a  layout is the most immediate signal that a camera  has 
430. ormat according to the table below     Operating System Format Applications    Video playback with   integrity check File Server Structure MxControlCenter  MxEasy  MxControlCenter  MxEasy   Few video files for Aue ecg  Windows Media Player    playback  AVI MPEG4      avi  P Player    Video playbackt File Server Structure   Few cs files for MxPEG      mxq     playback MOV MPEG4     mov    Quicktime  VLC  others  Video playbackt File Server Structure  Few video files for MxPEG      mxg   playback AVI MPEG4     avi  MPlayer  xine  VLC  others    Remarks    Codec to be installed separately  see Section 4 1 4    Installing The MOBOTIX MxPEG  Directshow Codec     t Integrity check not available        MxControlCenter does notinclude support for exporting AVC H 264 videos  For an  explanation  please read   Why MxControlCenter Does Not Support AVC H  264   at  the beginning of this manual  This section also provides a list of applications that  can convert the MxControlCenter export formats to AVC H 264              Proposed Video Formats    Among the supported formats  two formats merit special attention  The File Server Structure  allows verifying the integrity of the exported video on Windows machines  whereas MxPEG  can be played back in Windows Media Player  As opposed to the other formats  both of  these formats do not involve any recoding  i e   the original image format is preserved     Proposed Format For Legal Purposes    When exporting video for legal purposes  it is reco
431. ow if a camera has stopped working  for technical reasons  such as a network failure  or because a cable has been cut  for example      To configure such a warning  select Tools  gt  Options from the menu and click on the  Monitoring tab  The options in the first two group boxes on this tab are controlling how  MxControlCenter reacts when loosing the connection to one of the cameras     Setting A Warning Sound    In the Warning Sounds group box  you can choose to suppress the sound  No sound    to have MxControlCenter play back the system sound or to play back a specific     wav  sound file     Displaying A Visual Warning    The Error Display group box contains options for displaying an error message or a graphic  in the image in case one of the following happens     e Onconnection loss  If MxControlCenter loses the connection to one of the cameras   it will show an error message or a graphic set in this parameter     e On latency timeout  MxControlCenter shows the error message or graphic if the  following is true         MxControlCenter measures the latency  time between capturing the image by  the camera and displaying it on the monitor  for each generated image         Once the latency exceeds the Maximum latency time  MxControlCenter starts  measuring the time span during which this is the case         If this time span surpasses the value specified in Maximum overdue time   MxControlCenter executes the latency error display specified in this group box     The Vertical i
432. pen source operating system based on the work of Linus Torvalds  Serves as the  operating system for all MOBOTIX cameras     Logical Network  A system of computers and networked devices that appear as a single network to the user   even if it runs on one or more   Physical Networks      Megapixel  One million pixels  Larger formats of images can be displayed as a multiple of this  for example   3 megapixels is equal to 3 million pixels     MonoDome  Dome camera with one lens     Motion Detection  Action of sensing a movement within a particular area  MOBOTIX cameras use algorithmic  methods to detect changes from image to image in predefined areas  while taking into account  preset conditions  If a camera detects a movement  it signals an event and triggers an alarm     M JPEG  Abbreviation of Motion JPEG  Video compression method where each individual image is  compressed separately as a   JPEG image  Unlike MPEG  the quality of M JPEG recordings is  not dependent on movement within the image        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    373 392       MPEG  Motion Pictures Expert Group  Standard for compressing and saving image and video data   resulting in quality loss  Originally created for playing entertainment content on PCs  MPEG  concentrates on displaying still image material and compromises the quality of moving image  material in order to increase the transmission speed     MPEG 4 Part 10  A standard for 
433. period and displaying them together on the monitor     For example  the path of an intruder from the parking lot until the break in can be  traced in the server room  The compiled video reproduces the complete event up to the  point when the stolen devices are loaded into the trunk of a vehicle with a recognizable  license plate  It can thus provide valuable evidence for further criminal investigation        This event sequence   1 to 9  recorded by  several cameras can  be storend in MxCC  as a complete video              aj a ai  aa  s 5 4 a d       mI      Ga Srch  Modei Off         041971    0 00 00 H 0       And what is most useful  In the event search  you discover the man  with the suitcase in the parking lot  By stopping the recording  you  now know the exact system time     Then you simply press a button to have all cameras in the immediate area display the  event recordings from this point in time on the monitor           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       32 392    Variable search criteria  can be easily stored with    MxCC and brought up at  the push of a button    Search Criteria    Table of predefined    Event Searchs    Search Results       MxCC User Manual  Fast Availability Of Video Evidence          High Speed Search At The Push Of A Button  Customer Specific     Using the integrated storage function of the MOBOTIX cameras reduces the permanent  network load  which in turn speeds up the event
434. played  image  MxControlCenter now shows a print preview of the image  If this image has been  corrected by post processing  the original  non processed image will be added as well     You can also export event images as     pdf files using the integrated PDF print feature  for easy sending and archiving of printouts     Exporting Events As Video    The Video Search dialog also allows adding sequences to the Export List dialog for sub   sequent exporting of video content  For more information on how to do this  Section 3 6 3     Exporting Recorded Video Footage       3 5 11 Playing Back Recordings From The Local Archive    The recordings in the LOCAL ARCHIVE section of the Navigator panel are created using  either the Live Recording function  Section 3 2 10    Using The Live Recording Feature    or  by dragging amp dropping clips from an event search into a folder within the local archive   The clips in the local archive can be played back just like the event searches  Section 3 5 8     Using Event Searches        To play back clips from the Local Archive   e In the Navigator sidebar panel  open the LOCAL ARCHIVE section   e Click on one of the clips in any one of the folders     MxControlCenter loads the clip in the display area and opens the Player sidebar panel   You can now use the player controls to find the images you are looking for     Editing The Folder Structure    Folders in the LOCAL ARCHIVE section of the Navigator  sidebar panel help finding clips later on  You 
435. ples     e A shop owner wants to see if a person who entered the shop in the last 30 minutes  had been carrying any items when he she entered     e The security staff of a hotel wants to check if a specific car entered or left the hotel  parking lot in the last hour     e The manager of a gas station wants to know if the cameras detected any events  that happened the last night        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    118 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       Activating The Event Cache       The following only applies to a new MxControlCenter installation        When clicking for the first time on Search in the EVENT SEARCHES section of the Navigator  sidebar of a new MxConitrolCenter installation  the following dialog appears     Fast Event Search Disabled    The fast event search is disabled  If you want to use it  the event cache has to be  Q enabled first  If you enable it  all events of all recordings will be cached on your local   hard disk  This may take a long time and may consume a large amount of hard disk space    You will be able to use the Post Video Motion search in any case    You can change this behavior any time in the application options        By default  the event searches are disabled  Click on Enable in this dialog to activate  the event searches  Note that these searches depend on the event cache  see below      The event cachestores information about the events of all came
436. pond  x x    ing release notes    Provide access to the download options  proxy server    automatically checking for updates upon launching X X  MxControlCenter      Launch Update Assistant for automatic installation of cam  x  era software        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Update Assistant   Software Updates And More 2 3 7 3 9 2                   Software Update   Downloads Assistant  Automatically download and install software to one or more _ x  cameras   Back up the configuration of one or more cameras    X  Restore the configuration of one or more cameras from 7 x  previous backups   Using the backup restore mechanism  apply the configura  E x  tion of one camera to many others  as a whole or in parts    Maintain camera lists that are independent of specific  MxControlCenter installations to accomplish all of the above S x  tasks  Section 5 1 10    Using Update Assistant As A Stand   Alone Application                       5 1 1 Elements Of The Update Assistant Dialog    To open the Update Assistant dialog  select Tools  gt  Update Assistant from the  MxControlCenter menu                    i Update Assistant   New Camera List oO       pes   File Camera View  P a Af a ey a a E a Q Toolbar  Add Cameras Connection Settings Search Cameras Reboot Upload Software Save Settings Upload Settings Open Browser  Name Address Version Alt Address Progress   Software Packages   x   ul a Name Platform Version Time 
437. port list  If other cameras have recorded relevant video footage   the operators can also add the footage to the export list        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings    107 392       After having collected the video clips they want to send to the police  the operators can  export the clips in the export list as one MxPEG clip  The operators can then send the  exported MxPEG clip together with a viewer version of MxControlCenter to the police  The  recorded video is then played back simply by double clicking the PlayVideo  cmd batch  file without having to install any software     As an alternative  the police can install the MxPEG DirectShow codec and can play back  an exported MxPEG file in Windows Media Player     Using Post VM On Continuous Recordings    In addition to the event controlled camera recordings of the cameras that are securing  the factory s perimeter  some cameras have been set up for continuous recording  They  are recording video continuously at a set rate  e g  2 fps  24 hours every day to make sure  that specific areas of the factory are monitored around the clock     A missing computer at the entrance of the storage facility requires checking the record   ings of such a camera  Since the Q24M Hemispheric is mounted to the ceiling and is  monitoring the entire entrance area  the operators of the security system can run a Post  Video Motion search on t
438. position the current image on the end  of the sequence you want to add to the export list         Click on the Add to Export List button  the Export List dialog opens        Repeat for all other sequences you want to add to the export list   e Using the Video Search dialog   Y i        Select an event in the Events list  find the start of the interesting scene using the  playback buttons  the slider or set a search time and click on the Search button         Right click on the slider and select Set begin marker        Use the playback buttons or the slider to EN      position the current image on the end of K       K   gt   ti El     Dy  the sequence you want to add to the export list        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Saving  Printing And Exporting   3 9  3 9 2           Right click on the slider and select Set end marker  MxControlCenter highlights  s  the selected part of the recording         Click on the Add to Export List button  the Export List dialog opens        Repeat for all other sequences you want to add to the export list       Modifying The Start And Stop Positions Of A Sequence In The Export List  To adjust the beginning or end of a sequence that has already been added to the Export  List  proceed as follows   e Select an item in the Export List dialog  MxControlCenter highlights the item    e Doone of the following       Click in the date time fields in the Start Stop columns and change t
439. pplication and ancillary files to a net   work share or other storage medium so you can later add the entire installation to the  remaining MxControlCenter workstations  see Section 4 9 2    Saving Program Settings  And Exporting Installations        This concludes the final lab test of all components and you are now ready to set up the  actual VSS on site        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Mounting And Initial Operation 3 5 7  3 9 2       A 10 Mounting And Initial Operation    When on site  it is suggested to proceed as outlined in the following   e Check the infrastructure       Are the test protocols of the network cabling OK       Are the cable outlets at the locations as defined by the planner       Is the gateway for Internet access running and configured properly   e Mount the components       Mount the switches and the file servers NAS       Mount all cameras as labeled   e Install and configure the MxControlCenter workstations         Set up the hardware of the MxControlCenter workstations  establish the network  connections and power them up         Copy the exported installation from the network share or storage medium you cre   ated in   Exporting And Distributing MxControlCenter   above to the MxControlCenter  workstations     e Power up all remaining components       Power up alll file servers NAS         Power up all cameras     A 11_ Adjusting Individual Cameras    Since all cameras are r
440. program      s user interface can have a different  appearance  The range extends from the live image recorded by a single camera to  the professional desktop with all active MxCC functions and control elements        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       Owners Users     V  Allow  7  Allow  Live PTZ configuration  V  Allow  7  Allow  V  Allow  Post processing  V  Allow  7  Allow  7  Allow    Post PTZ configuration  V  Allow  V  Allow  V  Allow  au  Camera sonal outputs  Sequencer  7  Allow  7  Allow  V  Allow   V  Allow  V  Allow  V  Allow       Scheduled Access Control    The basic functions activated for a user can be individualized even further  For example   the event search can be limited to the last 30 minutes and only for specific cameras     Dual Control Prevents Uncontrolled Data Transfer    By permitting a supervisor  MxCC prevents unexamined data disclosure to third parties   In this respect  a supervisor  e g  company data protection officer  must first activate the  data export function by password entry and directly on the PC of the house detective     User Logs Against Data Abuse    In order to see which persons have used functions of MxCC at a specific time  an  authorized person can bring up the complete action logs of all registered users  This  makes it possible to see at a glance who has  for example  exported stored video  data from the system  Possible attempts of abuse can already be dete
441. ptional       It is possible to create multiple MxAnalytics evaluations  depending on your needs  To  reduce your workload  you can save the various MxAnalytics evaluations in order to call  them us as predefined evaluations with one click     Open the EVENT SEARCHES  amp  MxANALYTICS section of the Navigator sidebar panel to  call up the evaluations     1  Click on Search or a predefined MxAnalytics analysis  by default  the section only  contains Search  to display the user interface     2  Select the desired camera in the properties bar  Source  and set the search mode   MxAnalytics      BB MeContralCenter  file View Layout VideoSource Recording Tools Help        f pan y  E hae Hla g  s    Navigator    sources          4 LAYOUTS   B mam  4 VIDFO SOURCES    By setting MxAnalytics as the search mode  the properties bar in the right corner of  the window has the following elements     ED MuControiCenter  File View Layout VideoSource Recording Toots Help       SBSi Oecg g  nevsA  f O G eaage  Navigator       Box    H 124    Sources    Line count profile   Currentiveel   Set Date    Search mode     Heatmapprofie   LastOay       SetDate Dey  19 07 2012   Expert       3  Select the desired profile in the Counting line profile and Heat map profile selection  box and set the date  if needed         Counting line and heat map profiles  Days  periods of time and type of export   weekly  monthly  are specified in the predefined report profiles         Set date  The period of time in t
442. r    Camera Sequencer    76 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       3 2 5 Using A Video Wall To Display Cameras    Video walls provide an ideal setup for monitoring many cameras at once  Think of a traf   fic control unit  for example  The operators of the video wall need to be able to switch from  one camera to the next with some  or all  monitors cycling through specific cameras     MxCC Workstation       jor    Parking 1    w2   Parking     x  Clien Client 3 Clien  eer oel rere 192 168 1 203 jez ice 08       Monitor 1 Monitor 2 Monitor 3 Monitor 4    When operating a video wall as shown in the scenario above  the workstation computer  shows an overview layout with the monitors and a number of layout buttons  In this  scenario  you can select a layout by clicking on the button below the monitor you want to  use  to configure such a system  see Section 4 3 6    Configuring MxControlCenter Remote   Control And A Video Wall           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Live Video Surveillance    77 392       3 2 6 Using The Audio Features Of A Camera    Besides video streams  most MOBOTIX cameras  except Web and Basic models  can also  transmit and record audio streams  In order to use these features  the MxControlCenter  computer needs sound support  i e   a microphone and speakers      Play camera audio  If the video stream includes audio data  this button plays the  audio channel from the active cam
443. r configuration to all cameras        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 5 O   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline       A 6 Adjusting Sets Of Cameras    The underlying idea of this section is to define sets of cameras  grouping by file server NAS  or camera type  such as Dual  Day Night  etc    create the configuration for one camera  of a set and distribute this configuration to the remaining cameras of a set using the  Update Assistant  see Section A 5 6    Distributing The Master Configuration        Changing The Camera Names    Before you can start defining sets of cameras  however  you need to assign the camera  names according to the List of components and locations  see the table in Section A 1     Collecting Information About The System        The Manage Other Cameras dialog of the browser interface provides the most efficient  method for assigning the camera names   e Click on Admin Menu  gt  Configuration  gt  Manage on the master camera     e Select all cameras  choose Change the host names of the selected cameras from  the dropdown at the bottom of the dialog and click on OK     A     MOBOTIX Q24 Cam1 B10 F2 S3 A210 Manage Other Cameras    Screens  Cameras  New Screen   Camera information    Name IP  mx10 2 1 43  10 2 1 43 Image Change host name  Cam1 B810 F2 S3 A210    mx10 2 17 175 10 2 17 175 Image Change host name     Cam2 B10 F2 S3 A210    mx10 2 24 80 10 2 24 
444. rama display mode  to all Hemispheric  cameras that have been mounted to a wall     Distributing A Specific Storage Target To A Set Of Cameras    In order to distribute only the File Server section using the Update Assistant  set the fol   lowing options in the Admin Menu of one camera        Use different file servers NAS for one  group  if available  redundancy      Change storage target       Storage on External File    Server   Flash Device    Change storage limits    Always configure Storage Size limit        Activate external  logging    Store web server logfile system mes   sages        Storage Failure Detection    Enable  Blink LEDs   select e mail profile    Max  two cameras per file server NAS  recommended                 For help on the individual settings of the Admin Menu  please consult the camera help     Distributing Specific Image And Event Settings To A Set Of Cameras    In order to distribute only the Image Control and Event Control sections using the  Update Assistant  use the Setup Menu to set the options listed in the table below  This  table uses the hardware properties as criteria for creating different sets of cameras     Criteria for Creating Sets    Day   Dual Night    Hemil Mono                                    Image Control  Camera selection   Both   Auto              Camera Night Switch          17 lux               Resolution   As required  Image Quality                          General Image Settings As required  depends on frame rate require
445. ras of an MxControlCenter  installation on the computer s local hard disk  MxControlCenter then searches the event    cache rather than searching all cameras individually  This provides for much quicker  searches        If you do notneed event searches  you should keep the event cache disabled to save  computer resources  To manually control the event cache  select Tools  gt  Options from  the menu  then click on the Monitoring tab  In the Event Cache group box  you can  activate deactivate the Enable fast event search  requires event cache  checkbox              The Event Search User Interface    Open the EVENT SEARCHES section of the Navigator sidebar panel and click on one of the  predefined event searches or on Local Searches to see the interface below   Note that the  search results may still be empty on a fresh installation of MxControlCenter         MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Playing Back And Evaluating Recordings       119 392          Hep  AB 20 1 O H BISA  3   0O20    Temy   neo  Sartay   CaneiTime  gt    Setoad   Manay v        Order  Cescending  gt     jf 4 EVENT SLARCHE    s  Astos entering te man gate Arro Pe past har    AJ persons entering the Port door ha       The figure above contains the event images of all selected cameras in the search results  panel in the sort order set in the properties bar  e g  by name  descending      Event Search User Interface Elements    Properties bar  It c
446. ration     e Certificate issued by a certificate authority         Make sure that you have a third party certificate file from a certificate authority  or your system administrator         Inthe Web Server dialog  activate the Upload the X 509 certificate and private  key option  Replace the X 509 certificate and private key currently used by  the camera section         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Security Considerations    225 392           Click on the Browse button behind the Upload X 509 certificate from file field   navigate to the certificate file  select it and click on OK         Click on the Set button at the bottom of the dialog to upload the certificate         Click on the Close button at the bottom of the dialog and permanently store the  entire camera configuration     In the following dialog  do not reboot the camera  but click on the Return to menu button  at the top  you will reboot the camera at the end of the next step      Step 3  Activate HTTPS in the Camera and Set a Port    In the Web Server dialog  activate the Enable HTTPS checkbox  HTTPS Settings section      If you want to prevent regular  i e   unencrypted  HTTP connections  you can deactivate  the Enable HTTP checkbox in the same section  optional      If you want to use a different port than the default port 443  you can enter that port  in the SSL TLS port for HTTPS server field  optional  leave this field empty to use  the d
447. ration   microphone  etc  in the cameras an  withdrawal of all previous user rights    Installation updates   Transmission of complete work environ    Yes By simple export directly from MxCC  fast    ments    configuration of several workstations         Update assistant for program and  cameras    Yes  practically  unlimite    Convenient updating of MxCC and  camera software including backup and  restoration of all configuration data of  the cameras                    Configuration   Global configuration for multi user Yes By access of all systems to a write    systems protected directory containing all  relevant configuration data  includin  building plans  information files  etc      Centralized control of the program Yes Import export and modification of rel    configurations evant contiguration data of the branches  by headquarters    Special functions   Translation of the user interface into own   Yes Translation package available for   languages MOBOTIX partners worldwide on  www mobotix com    Integration in other programs Yes Via HTTP API for remote control of the       most important functions  live image  display  reproduction of recordings   activation of layouts                    MOBOTIX AG e     Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       MOBOTIX AG e Technical information subject to change without notice        48 392    MxCC User Manual  System Installation and Initial Operation       2 SYSTEM INSTALLATION AND INITI
448. rd  Configuring MxControlCenter Reactions  Configuring Where To Record    Configuring MxAnalytics   Activating  Setting Process Parameters And Setting Up Storage  Controlling Motion Detection  Time Tables      Optional  Customizing The Report Profiles Used For Analysis     Optional  Generating Reports And Sending Automatically Via E Mail  Creating And Storing Suitable Evaluations In MxControlCenter    Users  Groups And Group Rights   Creating And Editing Groups And Users   Editing Group Rights   Implementing A Two Man Rule   Requiring Users To Enter A Reason For An Action       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    150    150  150  151  151  152  152  153    156  157  159  165  168  171    175  175  177  179  180  181  181    188  188  188  190  192    194  196  198  199  205    209  209  214  215  215  215    216  216  217  218  220    5 392    6 392       MxCC User Manual   4 8 Security Considerations 220  4 8 1 General Thoughts On Network Security 220  4 8 2 Restricting Public Access To The Cameras 220  4 8 3 Securing The MxControlCenter Workstation 222  4 8 4 Using Encrypted Connections To Access Cameras 223  4 8 5 Signing The Recorded Video Data 226  4 8 6 Configuring And Monitoring The Action Log 229  4 8 7 Monitoring Camera Connections 230  4 8 8 Configuring The Dead Man s Switch 231  4 9 Working With MxControlCenter Configurations 232  4 9 1 Automatically Loading Program Settings 232  4 9 2 Saving Program S
449. rding in the MOBOTIX file server structure     For additional information on digitalizing and storing video streams of analog cameras   see Section 5 5 3    Connecting An Analog PTZ Camera To MxServer          Some third party IP cameras can only deliver one video stream  e g  Axis M7001   If  this is the case  you need to decide if you want to either display the live video stream  in MxControlCenter or just record it using MxServer  Devices with such a limitation  should be replaced as soon as possible by MOBOTIX cameras  since they can handle  multiple video streams and store their recordings autonomously           5 4 1 Using MOBOTIX Cameras With Pan Tilt Heads    Pan Tilt Heads Supported By MOBOTIX    e Provitek  Provitek PT2  Provitek PT3  Provitek PT4   e PelcoD   e Videotronic SN 15AH   e VPT 42  RS232 RS485 configuration with VT protocol        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    260 392    MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       An overview of the necessary steps for configuring a MOBOTIX camera in conjunction with  a motorized pan tilt head is provided below  More detailed information on the connection  and control commands can be found in the documentation of the respective pan tilt head     MOBOTIX Pan Tilt Head Camera Setup    MOBOTIX cameras  currently M12 and D12 models only  can be connected to the motorized  pan tilt heads via the D SUB 15HD connector  Once the cable has been attached  you can 
450. rding of the analog PTZ camera in MxServer as described in Section 5 5 5     Setting Up Recording In MxServer       Step 3  Add the Analog PTZ Camera in MxControlCenter as a Video Server Channel    e Select Video Source  gt  Add from the menu to open the Add Video Sources dialog     e Click on the Camera button to open the Add Camera dialog     awe SEE e Select the name of the video server channel  e g  Axis Server Channel as the cam        era Type    comer Please select the camera type and specify the connection details   Recording path       Axis Server chann    MOBOTIX IP camera    Merit Li Lin IP camera    Toshiba IP camera  Axis Server channel  Panasonic IP camera  Sony IP camera                e Select a channel number for the video stream     Add Camera       Please select the camera type and specify the connection details        Type   Axis Server channel x        Address           User name   e Enter the IP address  or DNS name   port number and login data  user name and  password  of the video server for the camera  and activate SSL  if necessary      e Click on OK to close the dialog  This adds the video server channel to the Add Video  Sources list     e Select the video server channel in the Add Video Sources list and add it to the sys   tem as described in Section 2 4 2    Using The Video Sources In MxControlCenter       Step 4  Set The Storage Location Of The Analog PTZ Camera In MxControlCenter    Since this step works exactly as for setting the storage locat
451. rent folder for the local archive  using the browse button         MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Setting Up Live Video Monitoring    181 392       4 3 5 Configuring Extra Windows    Extra  floating  windows provide a quick way to show the video stream of a camera in a  larger window or on a different monitor  see also Section 3 2 3    Using Extra Windows To  Display Video Sources     To activate extra windows  do the following     e Select Tools  gt  Options from the menu   e Open the View tab     e In the Mouse section  the On double click dropdown contains these two options  for extra windows         Select Open extra Live window if you want to open an extra window always  shows the live video stream of this camera  regardless of the display element  type  live  player  etc           Select Open extra window if you want to show an extra window of the display  element that has the same type as the original  live  player  etc       4 3 6 Configuring MxControlCenter Remote Control And A Video Wall    MxControlCenter offers remote control features for other applications devices using network  messages  TCP IP   These messages are sent to a specific port on a computer running  MxControlCenter     MxControlCenter Remote Control Scenarios    You can use the remote control features of MxControlCenter in the following scenarios     e MxControlCenter computer remotely controls other MxControlCenter computers  e g  
452. rent users    there is a much more comfortable method to do this  By creating different shortcuts for  launching MxControlCenter  you can automatically load specific configuration files     e Create a shortcut to MxCC exe in  the MxControlCenter program folder     e Set the shortcut properties  right click  on the shortcut  select Properties from  the context menu          If required  add the MxNoSave  parameter to the MxControlCenter  launch command in the Target  field to prevent inadvertent  changes to the configuration        la  gt   E3  MxCC GateGuards   South Gate Properties  Es  Security Details Previous Versions  General Shortcut Compatibility    FX  MxCC GateGuards   South Gate    Target type Application    Target location  MxCC    AxNoSave C  MxOC GateGuards SouthGate ini          Ghata t baw Nana       C  Program Files MOBOTIX MxCC MxCC exe    MxNoSave       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Working With MxControlCenter Configurations    235 392           Add the absolute file name  i e   including the path  at the end of the Target field        C  Program Files MOBOTIX MxCC MxCC exe    MxNoSave    C  MxCC   GateGuards SouthGate ini       e Remember to add quotes before and after the absolute file name to avoid    problems with blanks in the path or file name     folder specified in the Start in field        e When using an absolute file name  MxControlCenter ignores any working              Click o
453. rface  Admin Menu  gt   Network Setup  gt  Quick Installation      Do not change the suggested settings  except on the following pages     Language  Select the language for  the browser interface     Factory Reset  Activate Modify the  current configuration    Public Access Settings  Activate Deny  public access     Country Settings  Set the proper time  zone        MOBOTIX Q24 mx10 8 85 61 Live     ume  J9   25 fps  gt     Display Mode _3   Panorama      Setup Menu  Arm  amp  Record       eM AAEE  Factory Reset    In order to obtain a valid configuration  it is recommended to reset the camer  configuration to its factory defaults         Dismiss current configuration and continue with factory defaults     Note  the settings for users and their passwords will not be changed         Modify the current configuration     Domain Name Service  DNS   If this list is empty  enter the IP addresses of the DNS    server s      Store Configuration  Check the settings  then click on Store Configuration and reboot   Admin Menu  gt  General Tasks  gt  Reboot      A 5 3 Setting The Admin Menu Options    Click on the Admin Menu button to open the Administration Overview page     Creating The User Groups    The video surveillance system requires users with certain rights for accessing the cameras     Click on Security  gt  Group Access Control Lists     Click on the More button     Create the user groups as in the figure below        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany   
454. rface of the camera on which you would like to set up the  Multiwatcher     e Click on the Multiwatcher button     e Configure the Multiwatcher screens as described in the camera help     A MOBOTIX Q24 mx10 8 85 61 Multiwatcher  Screen   Reception F   Audio Notification    mf    Configure Screen   stop      Reception 3  West gate    mx10 8    10 13 02 01 09  10 12 42  10 12 02 01 09  10 12 29 uc    10 10 02  10 09 02    TT   TT I   TT   10 11 02  TT   TT   TT 10 08 02      Store   To permanently use the current settings  you need to store the complete configuration to flash  memory     A 12 Final Tests    Repeat the tests you performed during the lab test in Section A  9 1    Testing And Correcting     If you do not get the same results as in the lab test  you need to check for errors and  correct the corresponding settings  The table in Section B    Troubleshooting    lists some  typical errors in such a system and how to correct them        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Hand Off And User Training 3 5 9  3 Q 2       A 13 Hand Off And User Training    e Finalize the system documentation         Compile the system documentation you received from the planner and in which  you documented the camera names  for example         Create a list of all user names and passwords for the entire system         Create alist of cameras and reference images using the Update Assistant  activate  View  gt  Preview Image  then
455. rform additional func   tions  The start parameters are entered in the shortcuts     Adding Start Parameters To A Shortcut    e If this has not been done already  cre     8  MxCC GateGuards   South Gate Properties  ate a shortcut to MxcC exe in the     Secumy   Details   Previous Versions  MxControlCenter program folderand   Sesel   SHH Compatibty  save it to your desktop  FN  HCC GateGuards   South Gate    e Set the shortcut properties  right click  on the shortcut and select Properties  from the shortcut menu      Target type  Application  Target location  MxOC  C MxCC exe    MxNoSave SouthGate ini  e Add parameters to the start com   mand in the Target field  see the    List   L MCC GatoGuarde   South Gate  of MxControlCenter Start Parameters    table            Syntax      lt    program location gt    lt parameter block gt   lt configuration file gt     Examples       C  Program Files  MOBOTIX MxCC MxCC exe     NoWatchDog  0 MxNoSave  C   GateGuards MxCC  ini       C  Program Files MOBOTIX MxCC MxCC exe    NoWatchDog  0 MxMulti  instances  MxNoSave C   GateGuards MxCC2 ini       List Of MxControlCenter Start Parameters    Start Parameter   Meaning                     NoWatchDoq  0 Prevents the Watchdog  application that monitors MxControlCenter     g  from starting automatically     MeMurtiinstanees   Suppresses the note when launching the second  third  etc  instance    of MxControlCenter   MxOnlyDemoPlayer LaunchesMxControlCenter in demo Player mode   MxNoLoad Launches 
456. ring Alarms And Recordings   for more information      List size  Controls the maximum amount of RAM reserved for the alarm list  If the  value specified here is exceeded  the oldest alarms are automatically deleted to  make room for new alarms     Add live stream events  Adds the alarms to the alarm list that are detected in  the live streams of the cameras in the current layout  If this option is deactivated   MxControlCenter only adds images to the alarm list when cameras are sending   network  alarm messages     Alarm List file  Stores the alarm list as a file instead of only in the computer   s RAM   This means that the alarm list will also be available when launching MxControlCenter  the next time     Open on new alarm  Automatically shows the alarm list when detecting a new  alarm  This feature is useful if alarms do not occur very offen  In such a case  you can  use the entire display area of MxControlCenter to display the live camera images        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Options    Dialog    297 392       When MxControlCenter detects an alarm  it automatically shows the alarm list with  the new alarm highlighted in red     e Auto acknowledge alarms after  Prompts MxControlCenter to automatically acknowl   edge new alarms after the specified time has elapsed     Alarm Messages 2    The options on this tab allow defining the reactions to incoming alarm messages  see  Section 3 4    How Th
457. ring device  for example a fire alarm system or a network camera   to a control center or another type of transmitter  for example  a phone or IP network   A  typical signal input output scenario in video surveillance progresses as follows  an event  triggers an alarm that then displays  for example the video image from the network camera  that triggered the alarm on the monitor at a control center     Snap Server    NAS system manufactured by Overland Storage     MOBOTIX MxControlCenter automatically  finds all Snap Servers in a   Physical Network     Snapshot  Photograph of a situation created spontaneously and directly with a mouse click or other  such event directed by the user     Softphone  Computer application that simulates an    P Phone     Subnet  Synonym for   Logical Network     Switch  Hardware used to connect multiple network devices  computers  cameras  printers  etc   within  a network  As opposed to a   Hub  a switch does not split the bandwidth among the con   nected devices  A   PoE switch can also supply the cameras with power over an Ethernet cable     UMTS 3G    UPS  Abbbreviation of Uninterruptible Power Supply  Refers to devices that continue to supply power  in the event of a sudden power failure  These devices usually operate using a battery  UPS  units are commonly installed on the power lines of devices and systems in order to protect  them in the event of a power failure     Video Motion Detection  Ability to find movements in a video stream  MOBO
458. rity as described in Section 3 5 12    Checking The  Data Integrity Of Recordings    MxControlCenter automatically obtains the camera s  public key to check its recordings     While exporting  MxControlCenter automatically obtains the camera   s public key  to check its recordings  see   How To Export A Video From Camera Recordings   in  Section 3 6 3    Exporting Recorded Video Footage         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Security Considerations    227 392       After exporting as file server structure together with MxControlCenter  activate the  Copy application files checkbox as described in   Step 3  Set The Video Format And  The Export Options   of Section 3 6 3    Exporting Recorded Video Footage         When setting up digital signing of the recordings  you need to set up digital signing  before the system goes productive     Once digital signing has been set up  you should not change the digital certificate  any more  It is hence recommended to use the default  self signed  certificates of  the cameras since they are valid for 25 years           Configuring The Cameras To Sign The Recordings    To ensure that a camera is digitally  signing its recordings  proceed as  follows     Right click on the camera  you would like to configure   either in a layout or in the  Navigator sidebar panel  and the VIDEO SOURCES  gt   Cameras section      Select Configure from the  context menu  The Camera  Configurat
459. rm image to the alarm list     Restore MxCC  when minimized   If this option is unchecked  MxControlCenter will  stay minimized even if an alarm message arrives  Checking this option restores  MxControlCenter   s application window and brings to the foreground     Switch to Preferred Layout  Automatically loads the preferred layout of the alerting  camera  if such a layout has been set  see   Setting The Preferred Layout For The  Camera   below         MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring Alarms And Recordings 2 0    3 9 2       Configuring The Alarm Sound On The MxControlCenter Computer    Select Tools  gt  Options from the MxControlCenter menu        Click on the Alarm Handling tab     Configure the Alarm Sound group box as shown below     Alam Sound  J Activate System sound   File     C  Users   Desktop MxCC 2 5 Soun     Deadtime     Repeat every  vV 5 seconds    Until acknowledging    Every alam    Repeat for at most        Explanation Of Options    File  Allows setting a specific sound file to play back when MxControlCenter detects  an alarm  in a live video stream or when receiving an alarm message      Deadtime  Prevents alarms from occurring    back to back    and waits for the specified  time after one alarm before processing the next     Repeat every  Repeats the alarm after the specified time until the option set in Until  acknowledging has been fulfilled     Until acknowledging  Works toget
460. rmany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       MxCC User Manual  For A Wide Variety Of Applications       MxCC is versatile  and is suitable not  only for security  applications    MxCC in use  from  left to right   Traffic  monitoring in Ghent   Lohbriigge power plant  and Commerzbank       For Every Size Of System    As professional video management software  MxCC is subject to no restrictions     either  with regard to technology or system size  It makes no difference if you only want to use  one camera like the shop owner on the corner     or several hundred simultaneously  like an international football arena     For Every Situation    The possibilities of MxCC     primarily in combination with the high resolution network  cameras from MOBOTIX     far exceed the standard of a traditional video management  system  The program layout and functions can be tailored for nearly any application  and any user type           MOBOTIX AG e     Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    O      V   O             MxCC is perfectly suited for controlling security oriented CCTV systems  however  it is  also a suitable operating software for the video monitoring of production processes  for  preparing time lapse videos  for documenting construction progress and for controlling  information monitors with live video in car washes or events     For A Variety Of Camera Systems  Hybrid Solution     MOBOTIX makes it especially easy to decide in f
461. rogram is installed in the same folder as  MxControlCenter        Running MxStatus is only required if you want to see whether specific  or all  MOBOTIX  cameras are actually monitored on more than one MxControlCenter workstation     MxStatus is not required if you are using only one MxControlCenter workstation                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    154 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       Starting MxStatus    Since MxStatus is part of the MxControlCenter installation  no additional setup is required   Do the following to manually start MxStatus     e Open a command prompt         On the Windows desktop  click on Start  gt  Run         Enter emd and click on OK   o  Files MOBOTIX MxCC       Navigate to the MxControlCenter program folder  usually C  Program    Enter MxStatus in the command prompt and press RETURN     The command prompt should now look like this     By default  MxStatus uses any net   work card  i e   IP address  of the  computer and port 8080  see blue  frame in figure   MxStatus accepts  two parameters  shown as  lt ip gt   and  lt port gt  in the figure      e  lt ip gt   Use a specific IP  address if you have more  than one network card on  your computer and you  would like to use only one    of these cards        EA Command Prompt   MxStatus    C  Users  weber  MxCC 2 5 gt MxStatus  This is MxStatus 1 3 15 1    MxStatus   lt ip gt   xport gt       1p 0 0 0 0  rt 808
462. rsn  RAAD         3 4   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       3 6 2 Printing Single Images    Just like saving single images of recorded video footage as bitmap  BMP  or JPEG  JPG   file  Section 3 6 1    Saving Single Images     you can also print images directly from  MxControlCenter     If you have zoomed into an image to examine a particular section of the image  more closely or you have used other post processing functions of MxControlCenter   printing a single image will always print two images   the modified image and the  original image as stored by the MOBOTIX camera              To print an image   e Select the camera you want to use  yellow frame      e Ifyou want to print an image from a recording         Make sure that the camera is in Player mode  it shows a red recording icon in  the top right corner    F gt       Navigate to the image you want to export using the controls in the Player section  of the sidebar     e Click on the Print current image button     MxControlCenter now shows the imagels  in the Print Preview dialog     This dialog provides mech   anisms for changing the  Layout  the Page Setup   etc  Click on the Print button   select a printer and click on  Print again to send the file  to the printer        Print to PDF    The Print to PDF button isa aS WS      useful tool when it comes to 4  DA    IP Address  q24 thio    F     NoControlCenter e video Search Comero  sending the image via ii ATES saa Nic ie E ae    vawwe MODO com       
463. rver NAS Systems    251 392       5 2 Using Snap Server NAS Systems    MOBOTIX cameras in larger installations typically use file servers to store their record   ings  Instead of file servers  you can also use   NAS  Network Attached Storage  systems   MxControlCenter supports Overland Storage Snap Server NAS systems     When adding new video sources  MxControlCenter automatically finds new Snap Servers with  a firmware     GOS     version 5 2 056 and higher  In addition  you can use MxControlCenter  to set up the Snap Servers  add users  configure the network settings  etc       5 2 1 Adding Overland Storage Snap Servers    When setting up a new system that includes Snap Servers  MxControlCenter automati   cally finds all Snap Servers on the same physical network  see Section 2 4 1    Finding And  Configuring Video Sources        When adding Snap Servers to an existing system  make sure they are properly connected  to the network  then select Video Source  gt  Add from the menu  Wait until all Snap Servers  have been found  highlight them and add them to the system without creating a new layout     When adding Snap Servers  you can edit the properties in the same way as when  adding MOBOTIX cameras  see Section 2 4 1    Finding And Configuring Video Sources        e Create user names and passwords to access the Snap Servers     e Configure the network settings              Once the Snap Servers have been added to MxControlCenter  they appear in the Navigator  sidebar panel u
464. s        Before starting  make sure that the cameras have been powered up and that you can  reach them via the network     When dealing with many cameras  it may be advisable to change the network  configuration in sets of e g  20 to 30 cameras within a range of IP addresses  e g   from 192 168 1 100 to 119 for 20 cameras   Power up the cameras of the first  set  proceed with steps 1 to 9 below  then repeat steps 2 to 9 for each remaining  set of cameras              MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring The Camera Network Settings    339 392       In order to configure the network settings of all powered up cameras of a set of cameras  at once  it is best to use MxControlCenter and the Add Video Sources dialog     1  Start MxControlCenter     2  The automatic search finds all MOBOTIX cameras  select Video Source  gt  Add from  the menu and click on Automatic search to start the search        Add Video Sources       4      Name IP Address Path Version    ODSGE Ship kr 10 8  100 132 MX V4 0 4  19  Ce  mx 10 8 100 13S 10 8  100 135 MX V4 0 4  19  F  mx10 8 104 199 10 8  104  199 MX V4 0 4  19  Ce  mx 10 8 104 200 10 8  104 200 MX V4 0 4  19  fs  mx 10 8 104 201 10 8  104 201 MX V4 0 4  19   5  mx 10 8 104 203 10 8  104 203 MX V4 0 4 19  J mx 10 8 104 204 10 8  104 204 MX V4 0 4  19  10 8  104 205 MX V4 0 4  19  fs  mx 10 8 104 206 10 8  104 206 MX V4 0 4  19  fo  mx 10 8 104 207 10 8  104 207 MX V4 0 4  1
465. s  in Snap Shot recording         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 2 O   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference    Note  The HD  1280x720  and Full HD  1920x1080  resolutions available in the  live image and in the image profiles are not available for this mode  Since these  resolutions do not have an aspect ratio of 4 3  full image recording would clip  parts of the image at the top and the bottom of the image            JPEG Quality  This parameter allows using a different JPEG quality for full image  recording than for the live image  for example       Text Display  These parameters allow showing different text messages in the  images for full image recording than for the live image  for example     Full image recording should be applied especially when recording Hemispheric  cameras  which rely strongly on the vPTZ features in the live image  This means  that you can use the vPTZ features to pan  tilt and zoom the live image while the  camera is recording full images at 1 fps in MEGA or QXGA resolution  Thanks to  the advanced distortion correction features of MxControlCenter and MxEasy  you  can still play back and examine the recorded full images of Hemispheric cameras  normally  that is  without distortion     You should use at least MEGA format  ideally QXGA  if you are using Full image  recording  The applications need high resolution to deliver satisfactory image quality  when viewing the recorded image
466. s an alarm message     e Restore MxCC  when minimized   Restores the MxControlCenter main window to  the size and position it had before it was minimized     e Switch to Preferred Layout  Switches to the Preferred Layout of the camera that  sent an alarm  if such a layout has been set in the camera s Properties of dialog      e Always ask before switching  Prompts the user before switching from one preferred  layout to a different one        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 Q 8   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference       Alarm Sound       Activate  Plays back the sound on the computer speakers when MxControlCenter  detects an alarm     System sound  Plays back the system sound when MxControlCenter detects an alarm   File  Plays back the selected audio file      wav  when MxControlCenter detects an alarm     Deadtime  Suspends the playback of sounds for the specified period of time after  MxControlCenter has played back a sound for an alarm     Repeat every  Repeats the selected sound at the specified interval until the user  acknowledges the alarm in the alarm list     Until acknowledging  Select one of the values  Any alarm  Most recent alarm or  Every alarm  to specify which alarm image s  need to be acknowledged in order to  stop repeating the sound     Repeat for at most  Sets the maximum number of seconds during which  MxControlCenter repeats the sound     Example    e Repeat every  3 seconds    e Repeat 
467. s feature  see   Other Elements    in Section 4 2 4    Defining Background  Layouts        Note that double clicking on an icon can  open an extra  floating  window with the  video stream of that camera  see Section 4 3 5    Configuring Extra Windows           In addition  you can also use focus windows to show the live video streams of the status  icons you just clicked on  see   Status Icons And Focus Windows   in Section 4 2 4    Defining  Background Layouts           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Setting Up Live Video Monitoring    177 392       Live Layouts And Player Layouts    When planing your layout structure  one approach would be to create a complete layout  structure with all live cameras  then copy the structure and switch all cameras in the lay   outs to player mode  The    live    layouts would use display windows showing the live video  streams of the cameras  while the    player    layouts would use player windows to show the  camera s recordings  see Section 4 2 2    Element Types Used In Layouts        This way  the operators can easily switch back and forth between the live and player  modes of the entire layout     General Remarks On The Layout Structure    You should keep an eye on the number of cameras in one layout  Putting too many cam   eras  six or more  in one layout will only reduce the chances that the operators will see  everything they need to see  Instead  use more layouts w
468. s in MxControlCenter or MxEasy     Since the processing power of the camera is limited  full image recording reduces  the attainable data rate of the live image stream  which may drop by about 10 to 30  percent  In order to minimize the effects on the live image stream  it is recommended  to reduce the frame rate for storage as much as possible              Recording Start and Duration O  Some of these parameters vary depending on which recording mode has been set  see     Recording Mode    above    e Snapshot  JPEG images        Start Trigger  Sets the events which trigger a recording       Image Interval  Sets the time span between each of the pre alarm and post   alarm images that are recorded  Values can be entered from zero to a maximum of  600 000 ms  where 250 ms   1 4 s  1000 ms   1 s  60 000 ms   1 min  600 000 ms   10 min         Pre Alarm images  Number of images recorded before the event        Post Alarm images  Number of images recorded after the event   e Events  MxPEG clip         Start Trigger  Sets the events which trigger a recording        Event frame rate  Frame rate for recording         Time before  Period of time recorded before the event        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    The    Camera Configuration    Dialog 3 2     3 9 2           Time after  Period of time recorded after the event   e Continuous  MxPEG stream        Frame rate  Standard frame rate for continuous recording     
469. s setting adds a digital sig   nature to the recorded images and is archived with the recordings  This option is very  useful when submitting recorded images as digital evidence for legal proceedings     Recording Mode       Recording Mode  Sets the type of recording       Snapshot  JPEG images   Records triggered events as a series of individual images         Events  MxPEG clips   Records triggered events as a MxPEG video clip  Audio can  be included when recording event clips         Continuous  MxPEG stream   Continuously records the live video stream at a  specified frame rate  When the camera triggers an event  the camera uses the  Event frame rate  which can be higher to record more details  see    Recording  Start and Duration    below  w    The standard frame rate for continuous recording is set in the Frame rate drop   down next to the Mode dropdown     Audio  If activated  also records the audio channel from the camera  Note that this  option is not available for Snapshot recording mode     Full Image Recording  Always records the full image of the camera  regardless of  the size and format of the live image stream that is being displayed  e g   Panorama  format of a Hemispheric camera   This also ensures that the recording always con   sists of the full image  even though the operator may have used the vPTZ features  to zoom into the image in order to examine a specific detail         Resolution  Controls the size of the recorded video stream  or of the JPEG image
470. s that are to be recoded by MxRemotePreview       Set the camera recordings folder       Set default recording parameters  optional     e Test the web server installation     e Test the MxRemotePreview CGI module     Please make sure that you observe the following security recommendations     e Protect the web server computer and shared folder by assigning special user  names and passwords for the cameras to access the recordings  full access  required   Other users should not be able to access these folders at all     e Protect your web server installation and the recordings by assigning a user  name and password to the corresponding folders  You should even consider  encrypting the entire traffic to and from the web server using SSL     For more information on this and other settings  please refer to the Apache documen   tation on the web  httpd  apache  org docs project   or to the Microsoft  Internet Information Server help              5 6 1 MxRemotePreview   System Requirements And Installation    The web server computer needs a fast connection with high bandwidth to access the file  server recordings of the MOBOTIX cameras  MxRemotePreview runs on computers with  Windows or Ubuntu Linux     Computer System       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Using MxRemotePreview To Access Remote Recordings 279   3 92       e Computer with Intel Pentium 4 processor  or better    e Atleast 2 GB RAM   e Operating system
471. several    cameras in video windows of any size  or as clickable icons    Video sources  All cameras integrated  BS  MxControiCenter  L    in the security system File View Layout VideoSource Recording Tools Help  Als  d oer umma  Sed  Haal      REAY       Event search  Individual search queries  for specific cameras  events and time  periods  e g  all motion sensor alarms  of the previous night at the parking lot                Gel  ndeplan    Local Archive  Stores photos of all regis   tered shoplifters or persons banned from  the store  for example          Video Player  2     Playback of recorded videos or single TSE Eo Es  images  also simultaneously shows the a edema  videos of all cameras that have made m   oe don Soe Hol Med gle      recordings at a specific point in time or        Y  immediately before or after tn tee OE  noho  SEIE   panet   ranoo   A  Views 1 15 mo nesw   CSJOHUSIUE          Hemnuberk batalotun      PTZ Controls       Control of the pan tilt functions and  image detail enlargement of one  camera  PTZ   pan tilt zoom using  a virtual joystick                 Camera Soft Buttons O    Contain all individually programmed      functions of a selected camera  e g    special image setting  start irrigation   via camera  etc            MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    19 392               Title Bar       For a quick orientation  primarily when  several program windows are open or  distribute
472. sidebar  and other controls from view  the commands listed below provide access to specific display  functions of MxControlCenter     Apply Free Scaling Of Display Windows    If you activate View  gt  Free scaling in the menu  MxControlCenter automatically adjusts  the size of all display windows in a grid to the space that is available within the display  area  To do so  MxControlCenter smoothly adjusts the size of the display windows while  maintaining the aspect ratio  In contrast to    regular    scaling  the application does not  switch back and forth between the predefined display window sizes  Quarter PDA  PDA   CIF  VGA  Mega      Activate View  gt  Free scaling  then click on the Maximize button of the application window  to see how MxControlCenter is automatically scaling the display windows     Free scaling substantially increases the CPU load on the computer that is running  MxControlCenter  If you are using many cameras in one layout  you may have to  change the interpolation method  see   Setting The Interpolation Method For Free  Scaling   in Section 4 2 5    More Options When Editing Layouts    or reduce the frame  rates of the cameras you are displaying                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Display Modes Of The Application Window    93 392       Click on the Restore button of the application window fo return to the regular window and  deactivate View  gt  Free scaling     Changing Th
473. sistant   Software Updates And More       e Click on the Install button  red box in figure below  to update the software on the  selected cameras            For  M22M D12 V12 022M M12 Q22M Date      Fie  MX_system_de_3_52233 mpl Languages  German Engish         Software version in al available languages for all MOBOTIX M12  D12   V12  M22M  022M and Q22M cameras  Besides the many proven  features of the predecessor versions  this versions brings a number of f  improvements and enhancements in exposure control  image settings   sme cai  Hamer Sones LED rai eel anes eek           MX V3 5 2 23 13            MX V3 5 2 23 13      mxi0 s05 61 Domo    v4 0 6 9        a2  thio HR a omvv40 7 31                  e The Update Assistant asks you to confirm the storage location of the camera con   figuration backup files        cA  Soft    Upload software version  MX V3 5 2 23 r3  to 3 cameras     Store Configuration Files    rs  wte Desktop MxCC 2 5 MxConfig Backup 2011 06 30 2   Choose            Cx   cancel      e Ifyou click on OK  Update Assistant creates the configuration backup file and starts  uploading the software     YL 100 1 Be SAAS tmx Reading part 1of8  jpart 1of8   9 mx10 2 1 43 S MUV3 S 223r3 WiReading part 10f8       N mx10 3 94 200 MENIS 2 ee y Wek Reading part 10f 8   e Finally  the Update Assistant reboots the cameras and shows the status behind the   software version  Move the mouse over one of the status icons to get more information       110 1 Ee MX V3 5 2 23 13 R 
474. sor events  etc       O HBIDBOld s   OSHS o o   Ram e  oo   Sorter  Comin    Saat ana e  d Property bar    Owr  Ondino   Reload Now       Astos entering he man gate Arro the past haur  Ad persona ervtering the ont door thet mong    Predefined  event searches    Selected video   double click to  open event in  Player window     Search results    Player window    Player controls       The MxControlCenter   s Event Search feature provides the proper mechanisms for this  job  Using three stored searches  the operators can easily check for events that had been  recorded during the period of time in question   The Last Night search could be defined as follows  for example    e Includes all relevant cameras for the search    e Searches from yesterday 18 00  6 pm  until 07 00  7 am  today     The second and third searches are duplicates of the Last Night search  but cover different  periods of time     e Last Week searches from 07 00  7 am  seven days ago until now   e Last Month searches from 07 00  7 am  30 days ago until now     Since the operators can easily adjust the times after running a search  they can modify  the settings of a search and run it again if they need to examine different times  Likewise   they can select other cameras or search all cameras  should the need arise     Once the events have been found  the operators can double click on an event to examine  the recorded video footage of a camera  The operators can now select interesting parts  and add them to the ex
475. sufficient for most of the application  scenarios  If no other interpolation method than Default has been set for individual  display windows  activating free scaling will automatically switch to this method   This is the default setting     e Lanczos  This method delivers images with higher sharpness than Linear  but does  not perform any anti aliasing     e Super Sampling  This method delivers the best results when scaling down images   but it also creates the highest CPU loads  This method should only be used for  special  single display windows  When scaling up  this setting will automatically  apply the Lanczos method        The interpolation method setting is a per display window setting           MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Creating And Editing Layouts 173  392       Special Features Of Display Elements    The display elements of both grid and background layouts  have a number of special features that are described in  the following     Note that activated features are indicated by the following  buttons icons     e Background layouts  The corresponding toolbar and  title bar buttons of the display windows will be active   title bar icons are yellow         e Grid Layouts  The corresponding toolbar buttons of MxControlCenter will be active  f   Preferred Alarm Layout    MxControlCenter can automatically open a camera s preferred alarm layout when it receives    a E   a network message from the corr
476. t  enter the number of seconds to wait  before returning to the start layout in the Return to Start Layout after box  To deac   tivate this feature  delete the contents of this box              Setting The Interpolation Method For Free Scaling    When displaying grid layouts  you can use the View  gt  Free Scaling menu command to  expand the display windows to the entire display area  In conjunction with the free scal   ing of the entire MxControlCenter application window  you can adjust the display of the  layout to best fit your monitor     Free scaling of a grid layout to any size of the display area also means that the individual  display windows within the layout will be scaled freely   as opposed to the fixed grid sizes   Quarter PDA  PDA  CIF  VGA  Mega  used otherwise  This re scaling can be achieved using  different interpolation methods  To set these methods  activate the Layout Manager and  select the desired method from the context menu for each display window     Beginning with the first method  each subsequent method listed below delivers higher  quality while also requiring more computing power  i e   creates higher CPU load  on the  computer running MxControlCenter     e Default  Delivers the lowest quality and creates the lowest CPU load  Since the quality  is rather low  this setting will not be offered when using free scaling     e Linear  This setting is a good compromise between the achieved image quality and  the required computing time  This is usually 
477. t dialog  right click a display  window and select Edit in the context menu   Depending on the selected element type   MxControlCenter shows different configuration options  The maximum size of a display  window is 2560x960 pixels  see the   Changing Existing Or Creating New Grid Definitions    section below        Edit Display Element    Eleneri vpe  Empty    Video source  Live  Preview    Video clip   File server path   Live  Alam window  Sequencer window  Focus window         Remember last settings          MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Creating And Editing Layouts   67  392       For more information about the different types of display elements for layouts in general   see Section 4 2 2    Element Types Used In Layouts       Changing Existing Or Creating New Grid Definitions    To create a new grid  make sure that the Layout Manager is activated  then click on the  Edit Grids buttons in the Grids sidebar panel  MxControlCenter automatically splits the  available space according to the width of the display area  the maximum dimensions are  2560x960 pixels         na                      tiny element    80x60    1 2 column Available grid definitions in this    MxControlCenter configuration       P small  PDA  160x120  element   1 column  2 medium 320x240  sized  CIF    2 columns  Ferssan List of grid elements  1 large  VGA  640x480  element   4 columns  h   huge  MEGA  1280x960  element   8 columns  du 
478. t to at least one group  e g  Admins in  the example   but not to any other groups who could change and thus damage the  MxControlCenter configuration        If you are setting up a professional video surveillance system  you need to ensure that  only very few people have the rights to change the configuration of the surveillance  system  Make sure that you restrict the following rights to e g  an Admins group     e Access control section     Access control   e Application section       MxCC configuration        Layout Manager  if you want to prevent other users from changing layouts              Using The Options Of The Dropdowns  The dropdowns on the Group Rights tab have two options besides A ways and Never  that require some explanation     e Reason  Requires that the user of the system enters a reason that is logged in  MxControlCenter s action log  see Section 4 7 4    Requiring Users To Enter A Reason  For An Action        e Authorize  Allows implementing a two man rule  where specific actions can only  be executed if two persons are present  see Section 4 7 3    implementing A Two   Man Rule        Click on OK to close the dialog     4 7 3 Implementing A Two Man Rule    A two man rule mandates that two persons need to be present to execute certain   critical  system functions  A common task where the two man rule is required is the    playback of recordings in which the employees of a company are visible  This usually  necessitates the presence of an employees    repr
479. t you keep the access data   User name and password  stored in a safe place  You will need this information later on   when configuring the DynDNS client of the router     In this step  you should also register the DynDNS name for the router that you would like  to use for accessing the remote cameras  The DynDNS name in our example would be     mycamera     The DynDNS service providers usually offer a selection of domains to add  after the DynDNS name  separated by a dot   For this example  we selected    dyndns  org      The name for accessing the cameras thus always starts with    mycamera   dyndns   org           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 5 6   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       Configuring The Router    e Setting up the DynDNS client on the router  Open the user interface of the router  in your web browser by entering the router   s IP address or its mDNS name  e g      http    192 168 178 1    or http    fritz  box     respectively   If this does  not work  please read the documentation of your router to find the correct IP address  for accessing the router        Open the broadband router   s configuration page of the DynDNS client in the web  browser  Read the documentation of the router or search the router   s online help to  find more information on the    DynDNS    topic     Enter the DynDNS name and the access data you have registered with your DynDNS  provider as described i
480. te compressed Zip folder  This option creates a compressed z1P folder of  the exported video that can be sent by e mail  if it is small enough  or transferred  using   FTP or any other means     e Check digital signature  Checks the digital signature of the video data while export   ing to make sure that the video images have not been manipulated     Step 4  Export  the Video  Optionally Check Data Integrity     below         MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Saving  Printing And Exporting 143  392    Step 4  Export The Video  Optionally Check Data Integrity        You are now ready to create the video format you selected above  If you want to check  the integrity of the video data while exporting  make sure that you have activated the  Check data integrity checkbox in the Export List dialog     Click on Export to start the process and set    e   e o Darang lot  a file name and location for the finished   Emm bme SNIN O Nayi maa  video file  While exporting  the application te Lar a tun rer    shows the event images and the prog   ress bar  Once the export has finished   MxControlCenter shows the results in the  dialog in the figure  in this case  the results  include the data integrity check         When exporting large recordings to MxPEG  MxControlCenter may need to split the  resulting MXG file  In this case  the first MXG file will be called  lt file name gt  01   mxg  the second  lt file name gt  02 mxg  
481. ted video   doble click to open event  in Player window     Search results    Player window    Player controls    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter                09 02 12  exsist 07 23 45    v  mozi v craw   Pe     e Player controls  Click on any event to select it  then click on any of the buttons in the  Player sidebar panel to start playing back the contents of the clip     Using Predefined Event Searches    Simply click on one of the searches in the EVENT SEARCHES section of the Navigator  sidebar panel to open it  MxControlCenter automatically searches all events recorded by  the selected cameras during the specified period of time  For example  your installation  could have the following predefined event searches     e Last 30 minutes  e Last night    e Last week    If you have installed MxControlCenter for the first time  you will not see any predefined  event searches  To find out how to create new event searches and how to customize  them  see   Creating New Event Searches   further down      Since MxControlCenter event searches can be defined very flexibly  the searches  of your system are most likely different from the examples above  Make sure that  you have access to the documentation of your system so you know how to use the  predefined searches              Creating An Ad Hoc Event Search    Apart from the predefined event searches mentioned in the last section  there is one  additional event search named Search  This is an    empty    search without any
482. tems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Connecting Remote Cameras Using DynDNS    255 392       A port allows offering different services on one computer using the same IP address   This way  one computer can be used as web server  port 80  and as e mail server   port 25 for sending  port 110 for receiving e mails  at the same time  for example     The router can assign certain ports of its external interface to specific internal addresses   this is called port forwarding   For more information on ports  please see the TCP port  numbers topic on en wikipedia org        The port forwarding itself is also configured on the router  Ports of the router   s external IP  address  8001 and 8002 in the example  are assigned to local  private  IP addresses of  the cameras  192 168 178 201 and 192 168 178 202   In the example  the two  ports are assigned to the IP addresses of the following cameras     e 8001  192 168 178 201  e 8002  192 168 178 202    Once this has been configured  the router will forward a query from the Internetto port 8001  of its external IP address 213  63 87 154 to the local IP address 192 168 178 201  and thus to camera 1  In the same manner  the router will be forwarding queries on port  8002 to the local IP address 192 168 178 202  i e   to camera 2     Registering A DynDNS Name    In this first step  you need to create an account at a suitable DynDNS service  if you have  not already done so  e g  www  dyndns   org   Make sure tha
483. ter backup using File  gt  Export configuration and select  the Complete package option     e Complete the user documentation       Which layouts show which cameras       How can the users access the recordings         List adjustments to the user interface  special buttons in background layout  for  example          List alerting procedures  e g  does the user need to acknowledge new alarms           List emergency procedures         List other specific adjustments        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    MxCC User Manual  Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline       e Conduct a user training       Present live monitoring and vPTZ functions       Demonstrate how to search  print and export recordings       Show how alerting and user feedback work         Present emergency procedures        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com          Notes                                                                                  MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       3 6 2   392 MxCC User Manual  Troubleshooting       B TROUBLESHOOTING    B 1    B 1 1    Issue    Solutions To Common Issues    Power and Connectivity Issues    Possible Cause    Solution       Network interface switch indi     cates    no connection    to camera     Cables at NPA improperly con   nected  switched      Attach dev
484. the alarm list  but  shows only the alarms of the selected camera         MxControlCenter shows only the alarms of the selected camera  until a new  alarm from a different camera arrives   oe i        Shows only    Lost Connection    errors of the selected camera  Click on the button  again to return to the unfiltered list        Connection Lost  1 10 7 10 1258 57 PM    Adding Images To The Alarm List    i MxControlCenter automatically adds the alarm images of the alerting cameras to the  Alarm List  If you want to store additional images in the list  you can use this command   Click on the Copy current image to Alarm List toolbar button to execute this command  or right click on the window and select Image  gt  Copy to Alarm List     Showing The Alarm Instructions Of A Video Source    The Alarm Instructions are used to store important information for specific cameras  If  an instruction file has been set for the active video source  yellow frame   this button is  active in the toolbar     To open the alarm instructions file of a camera     fF  e Grid layouts  The Show camera s alarm instructions button in the toolbar indicates  that an instruction file is available  Click on the button to see the file or right click on  the window and select Show Alarm Instructions        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    How The Alarm Features Work    103 392       e Background layouts  The Show camera   s alarm instructions 
485. the opening hours  of a store  you must create a time table with the opening hours  Then  proceed to activate  video motion analysis and select the time table with these opening hours     Hint  Limiting the analysis using a time table increases the accuracy of the results as  objects outside the analysis time frame are not captured or evaluated   You can set up a suitable time table in the browser    1  Select the camera in a layout and click Open camera in browser in MxCC     2  Open the Time Tables dialog in Admin  gt  Camera Administration in the browser  interface of the camera  Define a suitable time table     3  Next  select this time table in MxCC in the MxAnalytics  gt  Basic Configuration tab  to activate arming        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Configuring MxAnalytics    215 392       4 6 3 Customizing The Report Profiles Used For Analysis   Optional    You can call up the movement and heat map evaluations as daily heat map reports or  as weekly and monthly counting line reports  To do this  select heat map counting line  report profiles  There are several predefined profiles available  which you can adapt to  your requirements  You can adapt the profiles in the browser     1  Select the camera in a layout and click Open camera in browser in MxCC     2  Open the Counting line report profiles dialog under Setup Menu  gt  MxAnalytics  Control  Customize the report profile to your requirements  Th
486. the physi   cal network        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Update Assistant   Software Updates And More    239 392       The    Software Packages    Panel    The Software Packages panel automati  See Packages   iba  cally retrieves a list of available software  S emerson  Tme Languages  Extenson  packages from the update server  see   Why     System mE a  Is The Software Packages Panel Empty    if  gt  a ak a pace E  this is not the case      lt a MX System 4 0 2 33 12  Similar to the Software Downloads dia    D2m Qzm mz  7 8 2010  log  see   Using The Software Downloads i lar aE  Dialog    you can use the tabs at the bottom    n  MX System 3 5 2 23 r3  to switch between camera and application  gt  N ae ee  software  The New tab shows software that 3    has been made available since you last     _ Camera   Applications Le XY    opened Update Assistant  The dropdown in the bottom right corner of the panel  red  frame in the figure  allows filtering the packages     Getting Information On Software Versions       Every entry in the Software Packages panel  represents one downloadable software PR   version  When you click on a download   the Info  Save and Install buttons display     D24M T24M 024M M24M 5 13 2011  Dino H sae E erisa pa    e Move the mouse over an entry to get more detailed information on the software  download           MX System Version      e See    D24M T24M Q24M M24M    MX_system_4_0419 mp
487. the public key in a file server path    e Click on the Open camera in browser button in MxControlCenter     e Click on the Admin Menu button in the camera s browser interface  you most likely  need to enter the proper user name and password      e Inthe Administration Overview dialog  click on the Storage on External File Server    Flash Device link  Storage section      e Inthe Storage on External File Server   Flash Device dialog  click on the More button  at the bottom of the dialog     e Inthe External Logging section at the bottom of the dialog  set Camera Logfiles to On     The camera now periodically stores its logfiles and the cert   pem file with the public key  in the camera   s storage location on the file server        e This option is only available on cameras with software version MX V4 0 6 x  or higher     e This only works if the camera is using a file server to store its recordings              To manually download the public key   e Click on the Open camera in browser button in MxControlCenter     e Click on the Admin Menu button in the camera s browser interface  you most likely  need to enter a user name and password      e Inthe Administration Overview dialog  click on the Web Server link  Network Setup  section      e In the HTTPS Settings section  click on the Download button next to Download  X 509 certificate     e Store the file as cert   pem in the root directory of the file server path that is used by  this particular camera  If several cameras are
488. ting  procedure for the operator of such a security system     Before we go into detail  however  we need to take a look at the basics   mem   Alarm management     T e      Speaker    N j      Py  ma    Microphone Notification  ta    Recording       A MOBOTIX camera not only provides high resolution images and the camera s audio  channel for live viewing  It is a complex system that combines sensors  alerting features  and recording to fulfill specific tasks in a security system  for example     e Internal and external sensors  Video motion detectors  temperature changes  noises   external light barriers  magnetic contacts etc  create events     e The events can trigger camera actions  such as shown in the figure above         E Mail  The camera sends one or more e mails concurrently or one by one to  the recipients         Notification by alarm  network  messages  The camera can send TCP network  messages to MxControlCenter or other systems that react to these messages         Visual notification  The camera shows a red frame around the image in case  it detects an alarm         Recording  The camera starts recording the video stream for a predefined period  of time         Microphone  After calling the recipient  the camera can transmit the sound from  its integrated  or an external  microphone to the computer or mobile device of  the recipient        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    How The Alarm Features W
489. tor sidebar panels  EVENT SEARCHES 66  LAYOUTS 66  LOCAL ARCHIVE 66  VIDEO SOURCES 66    Network  Security 205    Network connection  Directly connected to a computer 49  PoE Switch 50  Power supply 49    Network  glossary  357    Network Messages  Camera Configuration tab 318    NTP  glossary  357    O    Operation  Installing and initial operation 48    Options  Action Log tab 294  Alarm Handling tab 286  Connection Defaults tab 282  General tab 279  Monitoring tab 292  MxControlCenter dialog 278  Remote Control tab 289  View tab 284  When editing layouts 164    Overland Storage  Adding Snap Servers NAS systems 238  Editing Snap Server settings  Using Snap Server NAS systems 237    Overview  Camera Configuration tab 300  Video surveillance system 48    Pan tilt heads  Using 246    Pan Tilt Zoom 35  Physical network  glossary  357  PIR  glossary  357    Planning  Layout structure 169    Player 18  Sidebar panel 66    Playing back  In a Live display window 103  In Layouts with display windows in Player  mode 107  Recordings 100  Several cameras in synchronized mode  108       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    385 392       Index  PoE  glossary  357 PTZ  glossary  358  PoE switch PTZ Rotor  Network connection 50 Properties tab 297  Power supply 50 Public access to the cameras    Post processing  Images 76  Recorded images 111    Post Video Motion detection 34  Using in recordings 120    Power supply  Cameras 49  
490. triggered an alarm  Since the cameras add the  red frame to the images of the transmitted video  stream  cameras in grid and background layouts  show the same red frame as cameras in extra  float   ing  windows           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    98 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter          Showing Alarm Images In The Alarm List    The Alarm List collects the alarm images from alerting cameras   Once a camera detects an alarm  MxControlCenter adds the new  alarm image to the top of the list and the green bar  see figure   turns red     e The alarm image of any camera in the current layout that  triggered an alarm is added to the top of the Alarm List     p      a    e Alarm images of cameras not in the current layout are  added to the top of the list only if they are sending alarm  messages  see Caution note below      el  tip    D     l     eoseeeoeesceoeeeeeeeee eee 6 8       e The title bar of the alarm image indicates which camera has sent the image and  how long ago that happened     e The green status bar at the top of the Alarm List turns red  This indicates that the list  still contains an alarm image that has not been acknowledged  you will learn how  to do this in Section 3 4 3    Reacting To Alarms        lf the alarm list is hidden when an alarm occurs  MxControlCenter will automatically show  the list again     MOBOTIX cameras that are not in the current layout can only add ima
491. trolCenter  needs larger image sizes  e g  MEGA or QXGA  for the individual cameras in order  to generate distortion corrected images that still have a satisfactory resolution                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    86 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter          Using    Full Image    For Recording And    Area Corrected    For Live Images    As we have seen above  both the camera and MxControlCenter can generate different  types of images  The following approach to recording and live viewing has proven to  bring the highest benefit        Recording  Full Image  Live vPTZ  Area Corrected     Recording the Full Image and using Area Corrected for live viewing offers a number of  advantages     e Load can be balanced between the cameras and MxControlCenter     e Although the user at the live monitor has moved the visible image section and is  looking into a different direction  the camera always records the full image     e Users at other locations can get different live views  e g  reduced image size  and can  execute their own PTZ commands without disturbing the recording or other users     For more information on searching events in recordings  please see Section 3 5 8    Using  Event Searches    For more information on how to automatically search for video motion  using custom video motion windows in recordings  see Section 3 5 9    Using Post Video  Motion Detection In Recordings       vP
492. ts       4 3 3 Configuring Sequencers    The MxControlCenter sequencers provide different mechanisms for automatically switching  the displayed video streams     If you want to prevent an operator from using the layout and camera sequencers  you need  to deactivate the Live  gt  Sequencer right  see Section 4 7 2    Editing Group Rights     Note that  the sequencer windowis not assigned to any specific right   it is part of a layout definition     Configuring The Camera And Layout Sequencers    The camera sequencer shows only one camera at a time on the entire display area and  automatically cycles through all cameras in the current layout  Note that you can set the  number of seconds to show each camera  see below      The layout sequencer automatically cycles through all defined layouts of an MxControlCenter  installation     To set the number of seconds to show each camera or layout   e Select Tools  gt  Options from the menu   e Open the General tab     e Inthe Behavior section  enter the number of seconds to show each camera or layout  in the Sequencer time box     Configuring Sequencer Windows In Layouts    A sequencer window is a display element used in layouts to cycle through different live  video streams        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    R f     Layout Sequencer    Camera Sequencer    wF   Layout Sequencer    Camera Sequencer    180 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       To define 
493. u can talk back and forth between the computer  and the camera   Intercom    mode         Audio features are only available for cameras that support audio and on which the  microphone and speaker have been activated     If one or both of these buttons are gray  the corresponding commands have not  been activated  If you need these commands  you should ask your system admin   istrator for assistance              MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    78 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter          Playing Back Sounds On The Camera    In addition to hearing and playing live audio streams  the MOBOTIX cameras can play  back sound files over the camera   s built in speaker  or the audio path   To do so  simply  press the Play Sound button in the Softbuttons panel of the sidebar  The camera plays  back the preset sound file     3 2 7 Using The Camera To Switch Lights And Open Doors    If a camera has been set up to switch lights or open doors  you can use the buttons  described in this section     e Switch lights via camera on off  Click on this button to activate the lights that are  operated by the selected camera     e Open door via camera  Click on this button to open the door that is controlled by  the selected camera     If one or both of these buttons are gray  the corresponding commands have not  been activated  If you need these commands  you should ask your system admin   istrator for assistance     
494. ual cameras and their  images and videos in a particularly clear manner and adapted to the application   The display possibilities can be prepared rapidly and easily with MxCC using the Layout  Manager     Background Layouts  Building Plans With Integrated Cameras    Images from real building plans  individual floors in the building  underground garage  plans  street maps or other maps with camera locations  sales premises  branch offices   etc   can be inserted in the display panel of the MxCC Layout Manager     Fecorting Teels Help    ala solo Aoo          The corresponding cameras from the video sources list are then positioned in the  building plan as a video window or camera symbol  This eliminates laborious and  time consuming searching for cameras in long lists  Using the building plan as the basis  makes the work much easier and faster        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    21 392       In addition to live images  the most recent alarms or recordings can also be displayed   in the plan immediately  Special MxCC camera symbols contain information about   every camera type and lens positioning  Any number of these types of building plans   can be created in MxCC    Each layout can also  YDlO FOO contain buttons for  switching devices    integrated in the  network  e g  light     Resta t A  an  door opener  blinds   Kurhaus      CVENT SEARS  nen    LOCAL AROYE          Various building plans can also be 
495. unning  you should now adjust those camera settings  which can  only be adjusted at their final mounting positions  such as exposure and video motion  windows  etc    Depending on the parameter you need to adjust  you can either use  MxControlCenter or the individual camera   s browser interface     The following table shows some of the parameters you can adjust and where you can do this     Parameter Tool Where    Camera Configuration gt  Exposure tab    MxControlCenter      Video motion windows Camera Configuration gt  Events tab  SIP client options Admin Menu  gt  SIP Client Settings    PIR   PIR trigger level     PIR trigger level     Browser Setup Menu  gt  Event Settings Overview  K a trigger  depends on the camera s software version   level    Configuring The Multiwatcher On One Camera       After you have adjusted individual cameras as required  you can now configure the  Multiwatcher  The Multiwatcher allows you to remotely access a camera network via       MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    358 392    MxCC User Manual  Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline             one camera only  which in turn collects the images from other cameras  These cameras  can be grouped according to your requirements on different Multiwatcher screens  When  accessing the Multiwatcher camera remotely  also from mobile devices   the users can  select the screens to see the corresponding cameras     e Open the web inte
496. up  but the left monitor shows  a map of an entire stadium with all cameras as status icons  see   Element Types  Used In Layouts   below   This officer constantly checks if all cameras are monitored        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       Live Video Surveillance 7    3 9 2       Element Types Used In Layouts    Now that we know the basics of the different layout types   we need to take a look at the different element types that  can be used in layouts     e Display windows are used to show live or recorded  video streams of various sources  Display windows are  used in grid layouts  see figure at the right   background  layouts and in extra  floating  windows        e  consare used to monitor the status of cameras  for overview and security purposes    to show the video streams on demand  double clicking on an icon opens an extra  window   or to automatically show the camera image in case of an alarm  Icons are  only available in background layouts     Status icon Live icon    e Buttons can execute specific commands  e g  close all extra windows   switch to  different layouts or send remote control commands to other MxControlCenter com   puters  Buttons are only available in background layouts     West gate    The following table shows the individual layout elements grouped according to the type  of video source they can display and their availability on grid background layouts     Element Type Explanation
497. up File    Select one or more cameras in the camera list   2  Select a backup configuration file      cfg  or backup archive      zip          Select Camera  gt  Upload Settings from the menu  press CTRL ALT U or click on    the Upload Settings button  Select the configuration file you want to upload in  the Open Configuration File dialog         Click on the down arrow of the Upload Settings button and select the configura     tion file you want to upload     In the Upload Camera Settings dialog  select the configuration sections you would  like to upload to the cameras            Upload Camera Settings       Upload configuration files to 2 cameras   Please select the sections of the configuration that should be updated        Sections for Updating  v  Security   Network  vV  Transfer Profiles IP address and host name  V  Time Tasks  V  File Server   7  Time Tables  v  Logos  V  Audio  V  Page  language  softbuttons    V  Image Control  V  Event Control  er even  tere rere LE   V  Video Motion windows  T Select all If this option is activated  camera settings will be replaced   File sections   Warning time  signals  signalout  time  timestamp  weatherstat systemalarm sensors           i  Configuration file not found for   LS mx10 8 85 61     7  Back up Configuration Files  Before uploading  store configuration files  ers Thilo Desktop MxCC 2 5 MxConfig Backup 20 11 07 06  zip     V  Reboot the camera after the configuration has been updated    Lox   cancel           MOBOTIX 
498. ups dialog  Tools  gt  Users  amp  groups in the menu  see Section 4  7     Users  Groups And Group Rights        4 4 1 Configuring The Scaling And Display Functions    The scaling and display functions of MxControlCenter are controlling how the application  shows video sources when scaling the entire application or individual display windows   see Section 3 3 1    Scaling And Display Command s        Make sure that you are using the interpolation method that is best suited to the  number of cameras to be displayed and to the computer hardware  see   Setting  The Interpolation Method For Free Scaling   in Section 4 2 5    More Options When  Editing Layouts              Preventing Users From Changing The Scaling And Display Settings  If you want to prevent the users of a group from changing the scaling and display set   tings  proceed as follows    e Open the Users  amp  Groups dialog  Tools  gt  Users  amp  groups in the menu     e Click on the Group Rights tab     e Deactivate the Allow checkbox of the Application  gt  Camera display scaling right in  the column of the user group that is not supposed to use this function     e Click on OK to close the dialog     For more information on users and rights  see Section 4  7    Users  Groups And Group Rights       4 4 2 Configuring The Toolbar    The toolbar provides a quick way to access often used functions of MxControlCenter  You  can configure the toolbar using one of these methods    e Remove group rights    e Activate the l
499. urity Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    2 9 2   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Reference       6 1 2 The    Connection Defaults    Tab    This tab contains the following group boxes   Options      General   Connection Defaults View   Alarm Handling   Remote Control   Monitoring   Action Log  Connections to Cameras  Username  Si    i Password  eeeese    Proxy server IP  Por        MxStatus Server  Pot  8080  Access Recordings  File server path   2  User name   Password     Default Preview Settings       Preview mode     Camera Preview    Remote Preview       JPEG quality           Frame rate    1 0          Resolution    CIF  320x240   Audio        No configuration loaded       Connections to Cameras aD  e User name  Default user name used by MxControlCenter when accessing a camera   Note that you can set individual user names in the Properties of dialog of a video source     e Password  Default password used by MxControlCenter when accessing a camera  Note  that you can set individual passwords in the Properties of dialog of a video source     e Proxy server IP  Activate this option and set a proxy IP address and port if this is  required to access the video sources in your network     e MxStatus Server  Enter an IP address or computer name and the port of an MxStatus  computer in this field  see Section 4 1 6    MxStatus  Status Monitoring For Multiple  MxControlCenter Computers    for more information on MxStatus   Leave the field  empty t
500. user controls the PTZ functions using a joystick or the PTZ Control  panel in the sidebar  No further configuration is necessary     MOBOTIX cameras are using the mechanical pan tilt actions of the heads  i e    right left and up down  respectively   but the zoom actions are carried out by  the camera using the various software zoom functions                 Setting The Pan Tilt Head Sensitivity             The sensitivity settings are provided for   AssssDsta   informaton   Oipley   PTZ Rotor    Videotronic  Provitek and VPT 42 pan itilt Type    Ta2  heads  Sensitivity   oema 7     Fast Patch  pame  The settings in this dropdown change the   20ystck controt  Eyponensal    Ultra short    behavior and the speed of a pan tilt head  in relation to the movements of the mouse or the joystick           The joystick model and the skills of each individual user can have an influence on the ideal  sensitivity  Therefore  we recommend conducting a field test to determine the best setting     Using Fast Patch    The Fast Patch setting lets pan tilt heads move faster and more precisely for Videotronic   Provitek and VPT 42 pan tilt heads  This setting is intended only to be used with those models        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       262 392    MxCC User Manual  Enhanced Features       The Fast patch option requires a camera software version that has been modified  by a patch from MOBOTIX     Do not activate the Fast
501. using ALT click  The symbol to open the OnScreen Control  is then displayed in the top left corner of the camera image  You can perform PTZ com   mands either using the OnScreen Control  which can be opened and closed using ALT click   or the PTZ Controls sidebar panel     The OnScreen Control displayed in the browser interface of the camera can be activated  and deactivated in Setup Menu  gt  vPTZ Settings     Changes of various image settings that are made in the PTZ Controls sidebar panel are  saved only when you change the camera or the layout of the camera  In the Options dialog   you can set if and how changes are saved  see Section 6 1 1    The    General    Tab     This  applies to changes of the following image settings  lens selection  dual cameras   display  mode  hemispheric installation  setting of preset views  and locking unlocking of the PTZ  feature  Image settings that are changed by camera zoom are never saved in the camera        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Live Video Surveillance 8    3 9 2       Introduction To Display Modes    Regular PTZ cameras rely on electric actuators and motorized zoom lenses to execute  pan  tilt and zoom actions  MOBOTIX cameras  on the other hand  use high resolution  image sensors to provide virtual PTZ functionality     Once you zoom into the image  you can use the mouse or the virtual joystick in the PTZ  Controls sidebar panel to execute virtual PTZ act
502. vailable     e Set an audio path  if applicable  see Section 6 2 3    The    Display    Tab        Configuring Alarm Messages Using Network Messages    Proceed as outlined in Section 4 5 1    Configuring Alarms on the Cameras    and set up the  alarm messages to the IP addresses of the MxControlCenter workstations     A 8 5 Setting Additional Operating System Options    Setting The Time Zone And The Time Server  In order to use the same time base for the entire surveillance system  you need to set up  the following on the MxControlCenter workstations    e Set the same time zone as on the master camera     e Activate automatic time synchronization and set the same time server as for the  time server camera     Adding Virus Scanner Exceptions    Since most of the virus scanners are also monitoring the network traffic that enters the  workstation via the HTTP ports  they can considerably slow down the workstation   s perfor   mance  You should hence add the camera ports  typically 80 and 443  and the ports used  for remote control and alarm messaging  see Tools  gt  Options on the Remote Control  and Alarm Handling tabs  to the exceptions that are notmonitored by the virus scanner        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    356 392    MxCC User Manual  Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline       A 9 Final Lab Test Of All Components    Since you have set up your components and configured the cameras  you are now
503. vated for the last exposure  window you clicked on  its area is excluded from exposure control        lf the options of this section are not available  Exposure Mode has been set to Virtual  PTZ  In this mode  the camera cannot use any exposure windows           MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    318 392    MxCC User Manual  Reference       6 3 4 The    Recording    Tab    This tab allows you to configure the Recording settings  which determines how image data  is stored  To record events  the Arming Switch and Recording Switch need to be activated     This tab contains the following sections   a Camera Configuration      a B q     O fe    Overview Image Settings Exposure Recording Audio Events Network Messages Time Server MxAnalytics    kn    Saaiic    A   Arming   north gate Recording Switch    east gate p Recording   south gate    Display recording symbol in live image  Parking 1   mx 10 9 42 99             main gate    Digital signing of recorded images  main entrance  Recording Mode   Downtown office  Audio     Full image recording    JPEG Quality     Text Display    Date Time        eeeeee          back door    Recording Start and Duration       ioe Start Trigger  All Events     M  Enviroment  PI     J  Enviroment  MI  O Image Anayss  Vi     E  Image Anaysis  VM2   Vv  Signal  SI    Frame rate   F s        Tme afr    External Recording O    E Folder    CIFS  10 0 30 39 mxdata          This tab of the Camer
504. video compression  same as   H 264      MxControlCenter  MOBOTIX video management software for professional control of mid sized and large camera  networks     MxEasy  MOBOTIX video management software for small and compact camera networks of up to  16 cameras     MxPEG  MOBOTIX developed protocol for compression and storage of image and video data with  minimal network load and high image quality  The MxPEG   ActiveX control allows video and  audio data from MOBOTIX cameras to be displayed in other applications  including Internet  Explorer   To date  MxPEG remains the only protocol specifically designed for security applications     NAS  Abbreviation of Network Attached Storage  A storage system connected via an Ethernet cable   All network devices  cameras  in a   Physical Network have access to this storage system     Network  Group of computers that are connected via various cables and switches  or hubs  and share  access to data and devices such as printers and network cameras     NTP  Abbreviation of Network Time Protocol  This protocol is designed to synchronize the clocks  of network devices from a time server that supports this protocol  Go to to find public NTP  time servers     PIR  Abbreviation of Passive Infrared Sensor  This sensor is Used to detect movements based on  the infrared light emitted by moving persons     PoE  Abbreviation of Power over Ethernet  A technology for supplying network ready devices  such  as network cameras  with power via the Ethernet 
505. video security system is based on the software  that is installed on every MOBOTIX camera     without additional costs and directly  from the factory  You can get a free update conveniently via MxCC and synchronously  for all the cameras in the network  Without changing to new hardware  you can use  the newest camera functions developed by MOBOTIX  You can also obtain all MxCC  updates free of charge at the push of a button     Example    In a single step via the MxCC control center  the latest  software is installed on all 270 MOBOTIX hemispheric  cameras in the shops of a retail chain  Now this software  also contains video analysis tools for customer behavior   feature soon available         MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       The hemispheric door  camera captures the  entire entrance area  without any blind  spots  from wall to  wall  floor to ceiling    The video analysis     pursues    each per   son and shows which  areas are frequented  particularly heavily    MxCC User Manual  Total Costs Make The Difference       MxCC For No Cost At All  But           isn   t the entire system with the necessary hardware and software very expensive  all the same  Clear answer  No  The high resolution MOBOTIX systems with fewer  cameras  less installation and fewer recording devices  servers  offer unbeatable value  for the money     While many people still believe that IP cameras do not become more cost efficient tha
506. video source from the Navigator sidebar panel to a display window that  is already used replaces the original source with the dragged one     e You can drag amp drop multiple video sources to any empty layout  keep the CTRL or  SHIFT key pressed and click with the mouse to select multiple video sources   When  you let go of the mouse  MxControlCenter will ask you to select an element type     e To change the type of an existing display element or to assign a different video  source  right click on an element  select Edit from the context menu and then set  the new Element type     e Todelete a display element  right click on an element  select Delete from the context  menu and confirm the prompt        Fle View Layeut VideoSeurce Recoring Tosis Help  Gig t l  S rHhBog 80O GO 8    aeo0la s   Movtgeter J x y A    Drag amp drop video  Sources          MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Creating And Editing Layouts    171 392       Configuring Display Elements In Background Layouts    You can configure a display element in the Edit Display Element dialog  right click a display  element and select Edit or Insert in the context menu   Depending on the selected element  type  MxControlCenter shows different configuration options     Edit Display Element    Element type        Windows  button  closes all floating Live windows      Configure Sequencer    button  T button  Fps    Command  button             Remember last s
507. w DynDNS Works     Private IP addresses                              Camera 1  Camera 2  6 Ko   Back door Front door ve    o 4 I X 4  WF gly  RY le ST     I gal  O   MIR  S   I  a alias  V    5  i  O   S 4 et ER  N L GAI  S l 4 Ie    oy    S   Internet    a   y      public IP addresses   L    DSL router     mycamera dyndns org       DynDNS server       The router updates its IP address at the DynDNS server   QO The computer asks for the IP address of mycamera   dyndns   org      The DNS service sends the IP address 213 63 87 154 back to the computer     O The computer uses different ports  8001 and 8002  when accessing the router s  external IP address 213 63 87 154     O The router forwards queries on ports 8001 and 8002 of its external IP address    213 63 87 154 to the internal IP addresses  192 168 178 201 and  192 168 178 202  respectively      Scenario  Internet Connection Of The Cameras Using A Broadband Router    In this scenario  all cameras are connected to the Internet via a broadband router with  a flat rate tariff  Note that you only need a DynDNS name for the router itself  This name  and the corresponding access data are then entered in the router   s DynDNS client  The  router uses port forwarding to provide access to the individual cameras  e g  mycam   era dyndns org  8001 forthe first camera  mycamera dyndns org  8002 forthe  second  etc   the numbers following the colon         are examples for the individual ports         MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Sys
508. while the log is visible  close and reopen the Options dialog              Step 4  Configure The Application Device To Send A Remote Command    The application or device that is trying to remote control MxControlCenter needs to able  to send an HTTP GET request  this is basically what the browser does when you press the  RETURN button in   Step 3  Test The Remote Control        In this example  we will implement a video wall by using MxControlCenter on the main  computer to remotely control anther MxControlCenter instance running on the    client     computer  The remote control command switches to a different layout that is part of the  client computer s MxControlCenter configuration     The operator clicks on a layout button on the main computer  MxControlCenter on the main  computer then sends the following command to MxControlCenter on the client computer     http   192 168 1 204 31667  layout Parkingl  amp beep    Explanation   e layout Parkingl1  Show the    Parking1    layout     e beep  Play the sound specified on the target computer in the Options  gt  Remote  Control dialog of MxControlCenter     e     amp          introduces the first command         amp     separates the commands     Certain characters in the URL need to be percent encoded  also called     URL encoded      e g  a space character would be     20      For more information on percent encoded  characters  see the Percent encoding topic on en wikipedia org                 MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision 
509. windigkell der Scnnitisielic  Anzani der Daten Bits pro Zeichen    Pamlatsmodus der Feniererkennung  N  Keine  E  Gerado  O   Ungerade    Anzani der Stop Bits    An der Flusskontrolle    Aus  Keine Flusskontrolie   criscts  Hardware Flusskontrolie   Speicnem der ausgehenden Zeichen im Putter    Legt Zeichen tor Zellenende fest  GOtige Zeichen nangen vom  angescniossenen Geral ab     Gro  e des Putters in Zeichen zum Protokolieron der Ein  und  Ausgaben der serielien Scnnintsteio     FOgt vor jeder Zele im Putter einen Zenstempo  cin        Setzen           Siehe auch     Y Voreinstellung jd Zur  ckholen    Schlie  en    Serielles Terminal  Zustand der Signaleing  nge          Once you have completed these steps  the pan and tilt features of the pan tilt head will  be available for the camera in MxControlCenter        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Using Pan Tilt Heads  Third Party Cameras and Joysticks    261 392       Selecting A Pan Tilt Head Protocol For A MOBOTIX Camera          e Highlight a camera in the layout  yel    Assessoata   infomation   Display   PT2 Rotor  low frame      e Select Video Source  gt  Properties    Fast Patch  a  from the menu  Joystick controk  Provitek PT2    ear  e In the Properties of dialog  click on  Pelco D  the PTZ Rotor tab     e Select the appropriate protocol from the Type dropdown     Control over the Pan Tilt Zoom functions in MOBOTIX cameras is identical  whether the 
510. would like to add     e Press CTRL A to select all cameras     e Use CTRL click to select deselect single cameras        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Automatic search       Insert manually  Camera          MXPEG dip               Recording path         Select all  Deselect all  Remove    Remove all    User  amp  password       5 8   3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  System Installation and Initial Operation       e Use SHIFT click to select a range of cameras     If one or more of the selected cameras are not directly accessible  i e   on a different  logical network   MxControlCenter automatically offers to reconfigure these cameras   see   Reconfiguring Cameras On Different Logical Networks   below              Reconfiguring Cameras On Different Logical Networks       If one or more of the selected MOBOTIX cameras   E micontioicente  have the status Different subnet  e g  cameras with  factory IP addresses   MxControlCenter automatically oe hedyrrioes Sepania  offers to reconfigure the network settings of these them now   cameras  In this case  the application will display  the dialog shown at the right  Click on Yes to  reconfigure the cameras for the subnet of your com     puter        In most networks  a DHCP server automatically assigns the IP addresses for network  devices so you can apply the default settings in the Configure Selected Cameras dialog  box  Get IP address automatically      If the IP addresses
511. ww mobotix com    sales mobotix com    346 392    Time Server Status     10 8 52 239    LOCAL  1     MxCC User Manual  Video Surveillance Implementation Guideline       You can check the time server in the Time and Date dialog by clicking on the view  link in the explanation to the Adjust automatically checkbox  If the camera has  synchronized the time  the contents of the dialog are green     If no other time server is available  you can use one camera as a time server for all  other devices  See the camera   s online help on how to do this              Setting Up The Camera LEDs    If you want to deactivate the camera LEDs or use special blinking patterns for all cameras   you should do this now  If you only need to deactivate the LEDs for some cameras  you  should do this when applying individual settings  For further information  see Section A 6     Adjusting Sets Of Cameras       Click on General Administration  gt  LED Setup and set LED Main Switch to Disabled or  apply the settings as required     Configuring The Time Tables    Enter the custom days and set the profiles and options as required  see the camera help  for more information      Configuring the Time Tasks    Change the time for the Reboot camera time task to an uncritical time of day  see the  camera help for more information  or disable it        MOBOTIX AG e   Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Creating And Distributing A Camera Master Configuration 347  3
512. www mobotix com    sales mobotix com          MOBOTIX   The HiRes Video Company    Security Vision Systems    cA    MOBOTIX       To demonstrate our confidence in the quality of our products   MOBOTIX cameras have been used to capture all images that  appear in this manual     Manufacturer Executive Board  MOBOTIX AG Dr  Ralf Hinkel  Kaiserstrasse    67722 Langmeil  Germany Registration Office  Kaiserslautern Local Court    Germany Registration Number  HRB 3724   Tel   49 6302 9816 103 Tax Code  44 676 0700 4   Fax   49 6302 9816 190 Tax Office  Worms Kirchheimbolanden  Germany  http   www mobotix com VAT ID    sales mobotix com DE202203501    You can find the latest version of this document at www  mobotix  comin the Support section     CE    Technical specifications subject to change without notice        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    Z  Li       Free Software Download mome  www mobotix com T a    V 2 5 3 03 2013        e   v  x      Q   e      3  3  3       MxCC User Manual       MxControlCenter  Professional Video Management    E pre oiae ee    ee    ameta        o  gt     Q 2 7 i     e Proven worldwide in the most demanding video applications  e Unlimited number of users and cameras  no license fees   e Individual user interface  adaptable to each individual user   e Simplest installation and complete use on any standard PC   e Convenient layout editor for integrating real building plans   e Integration
513. x com    sales mobotix com    Display Modes Of The Application Window 9 5   3 Q 2       Using A View  This procedure opens the selected view and applies its user interface configuration     e Select View  gt  Saved Views from the menu     e Click on the view you would like to use     3 3 3 Functions When The Application Window Is Minimized    If you have reduced the application to the taskbar  by clicking on the Minimize button of          the application window  for example   MxControlCenter will    wake up    if it receives an  eo     x  alarm  At the same time  the application requests an alarm image from the alerting   camera that is added to the Alarm List     If you need this feature and it does not work  either MxControlCenter has not been  set up to receive network messages or the cameras do not send network mes   sages to the MxControlCenter computer  or both   see Section 4 5 3    Configuring  MxControlCenter Reactions                   MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    96 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter       3 4 How The Alarm Features Work    Since MxControlCenter is most likely used in some kind of security context  the alarm  features are among the application   s most important ones  This means that you have to  know how alarms are signaled and what to do with them  While the exact procedure will  most likely be different in your installation  this section describes a standard opera
514. xternal systems sensors    Yes       Integration of e g   alarm reporting  systems  smoke detectors  light barriers  possible via cameras             MOBOTIX AG e     Security Vision Systems   Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com       MOBOTIX AG e Technical information subject to change without notice        MxCC User Manual  MxCC Performance Details    46 2       MxControlCenter Functions                         Alarming   Visual alarm Yes Entry in alarm list  immediate access to  recording  prioritizable alarms    Acoustic alarm Yes ee sound or any sound files   WAV format  can be used including  automatic repetition until alarm is  acknowledged    Remote activation Yes For example to alarm center police with  direct activation via network message   e mail with alarm image  phone call    Alarm acknowledgment Yes Including display of the point in time  and ongoing display of the time passed  since the alarm was reported    Automatic activation of layouts Yes Activation at the camera fe ale the  alarm including selection of the specified  layout    Immediate access to emergency plans    Yes Can be defined for each camera and   etc  brought up as an information file in the  standard program  e g  text  HTML  PDF   sound  can be retrieved    Alarm to external locations Yes By e mail  phone call  network message    Recording       Decentralized recording with file server   Yes  internal SD   Flash recording integrated in the camera  synchronization card or NA
515. y Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    3 80  3 9 2 MxCC User Manual  Index       D    Data integrity  Checking in recordings 127    Dead Man   s Switch 37  Configuring 216  Using 141    Decentralized MOBOTIX concept 14    Defining  Background layouts 162  Grid layouts 158  Layouts 61  Video sources 61    Detecting  Video Motion 34    DevKit  glossary  353  DHCP  glossary  353  Dialogs  Camera Configuration 299  Options 278  Properties of  video source  295  Display  Properties tab 296    Display commands 89    Display functions  Configuring 181    Displaying  Video content in layouts 67    Display modes  Cameras with L22 lens 79  Example 89  Hemispheric cameras with L11 lens 80  Introduction 78  MxControlCenter application window 89  Regular cameras 79    Display Panel 19  Display windows  Layout elements 69    Distortion  Correcting 34    Distributing   Camera configurations 234  DNS  glossary  353  Dome camera  glossary  353  Donbass Arena  Ukraine 42    Downloading  Software 222    DSL  glossary  353  DualDome  glossary  353  DVR  glossary  353    DynDNS  Connecting remote cameras 240    DynDNS  glossary  354    Editing  Group rights 202  Group rights  overview  201  Groups 201  Groups  overview  201  Layouts 150  List of video sources 56  Snap Server Settings 239  Users 201  Users  overview  201    Editing layouts  overview  149  Elements of application window 61    Element types   Layouts 69  Encrypting   Connections to cameras 208
516. y Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    80 392    MxCC User Manual  Using MxControlCenter        lt 0      aeua  leen          3 2 9 Using The Virtual PTZ Functions On Live Images    Current MOBOTIX camera models and software  Prz controli    versions include enhanced virtual PTZ features a Caria ode ot oes            vPTZ      These features allow using a joystick or A      the mouse to digitally zoom in on images fromthe    Area Corrected    _       N   selected video source and to    virtually    move the MxCC Display Mode  lt  O  gt O   enlarged image section within the entire image J   sensor area  Unchanged z   J  PTZ Views   In Camera   The image area available for these virtual PTZ xz  r  Gen an    commands depends on the options available on Auto Move   the camera model  Cameras featuring lenses with Panteft    PanRight    9 Jo EN    focal lengths  gt  32 mm  M12D  D12D  M24M  etc      ens  15   2unene s w    3 G8  5 Gs     have an image area significantly smaller than in  hemispheric cameras  Additional camera views are provided for hemispheric cameras  to quickly adjust the camera image to current conditions  In hemispheric cameras  this  also includes the suitable mounting position setting  Both of these functions  image view  and mounting position  are set per image sensor in hemispheric S14D models  PTZ com   mands can also be executed per image sensor  To do this  select the desired image  sensor in a displayed dual image 
517. ytics evaluations in order to  call them with one click  Proceed as follows to create new MxAnalytics evaluations in the  Navigator sidebar panel     1  Right click anywhere in the EVENT SEARCHES  amp  MxANALYTICS section   2  Select New search from the shortcut menu    3  Enter a name that describes the setting   4      Create an MxAnalytics evaluation as outlined in Section 3 7 2    Calling Up Evaluations     The setting is saved under the corresponding name and can be accessed with one click        MOBOTIX AG    Security Vision Systems    Made in Germany    www mobotix com    sales mobotix com    216 392    MxCC User Manual  System Configuration       4 7 Users  Groups And Group Rights    By default  MxControlCenter is a single user application where the user that started the  application has full control of the entire system  By adding groups and users  however   you can configure the application as a multi user system  In this case  you will need to  decide on who will use the system and which roles these persons will play     MxControlCenter uses a group oriented approach  in which the groups have specific privileges  and each user is assigned to one of the groups  For your convenience  MxControlCenter  comes with a default group structure that you can adjust to the requirements of the cur   rent surveillance system     4 7 1 Creating And Editing Groups And Users    To create new groups and users or to edit existing ones  click on Tools  gt  Users  amp  Groups  in the m
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
MANUAL DO USUÁRIO Compex MI-FITNESS®    Instructivo  Echelle avec marches amovibles  取扱説明書(PDF)  VDP401GLD7  2015 Profession de foi des listes présentées par le SNESUP  Rechercher un itinéraire avec Google Maps Observer via  EN HYPERF RE QUENCES  Fiber Defender FD525 User Manual    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file